xref: /dragonfly/contrib/gcc-8.0/gcc/dwarf2out.c (revision a4da4a90)
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2    Copyright (C) 1992-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3    Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4    Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5    Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
6 
7 This file is part of GCC.
8 
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
13 
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
18 
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3.  If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.  */
22 
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 	   the file numbers are used by .debug_info.  Alternately, leave
25 	   out locations for types and decls.
26 	 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 	 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs.  */
28 
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30    information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31    mechanism.  The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32    DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33    information.  */
34 
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
36 
37    CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 	   a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 	   We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 	   The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 	   of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
42 
43    CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 	   an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
45 
46    CIE = Common Information Entry
47 	   information describing information common to one or more FDEs
48 
49    DIE = Debugging Information Entry
50 
51    FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 	   information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 	   how to restore registers
54 
55    DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56    DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
57 
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "memmodel.h"
66 #include "tm_p.h"
67 #include "stringpool.h"
68 #include "insn-config.h"
69 #include "ira.h"
70 #include "cgraph.h"
71 #include "diagnostic.h"
72 #include "fold-const.h"
73 #include "stor-layout.h"
74 #include "varasm.h"
75 #include "version.h"
76 #include "flags.h"
77 #include "rtlhash.h"
78 #include "reload.h"
79 #include "output.h"
80 #include "expr.h"
81 #include "dwarf2out.h"
82 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
83 #include "toplev.h"
84 #include "md5.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "print-rtl.h"
87 #include "debug.h"
88 #include "common/common-target.h"
89 #include "langhooks.h"
90 #include "lra.h"
91 #include "dumpfile.h"
92 #include "opts.h"
93 #include "tree-dfa.h"
94 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
95 #include "rtl-iter.h"
96 #include "stringpool.h"
97 #include "attribs.h"
98 #include "file-prefix-map.h" /* remap_debug_filename()  */
99 
100 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, unsigned int, const char *,
101 				   int, bool);
102 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
103 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
104 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
105 
106 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
107 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
108 #endif
109 
110 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
111 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
112 #endif
113 
114 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
115 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
116 
117 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
118     which are output in the debug info should end with a separator.  */
119 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
120 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
121    from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
122    if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
123    process them properly or uses VMS Debug.  */
124 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
125 #else
126 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
127 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
128 #endif
129 
130 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically.  They've been
131    totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way.  */
132 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
133 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
134 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
135  #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
136 #endif
137 
138 /* The size of the target's pointer type.  */
139 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
140 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
141 #endif
142 
143 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
144    must be kept around forever.  */
145 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
146 
147 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
148    completed at some later time.  incomplete_types_list needs to be a
149    vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
150    it.  */
151 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
152 
153 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
154    scopes.  This table is a display which tracks the nesting
155    of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
156    scopes.  This table is used to find the proper place to
157    define type declaration DIE's.  */
158 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
159 
160 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections.  */
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
166 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
167 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
168 static const char *debug_macinfo_section_name;
169 static unsigned macinfo_label_base = 1;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
172 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
173 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
174 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
175 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
176 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_str_section;
177 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
178 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
179 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
180 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
181 
182 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label.  */
183 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES	40
184 
185 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
186    should either be 4 or 12 bytes.  When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
187    bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
188    bytes.
189 
190    However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
191    DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE.  It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly.  */
192 
193 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
194 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
195 #endif
196 
197 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR
198 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "-4" : "-12")
199 #endif
200 
201 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY.  */
202 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
203   ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
204 
205 /* CIE identifier.  */
206 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
207 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
208   (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
209 #else
210 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
211 #endif
212 
213 
214 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
215    information for each routine.  */
216 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
217 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
218 
219 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
220 
221 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
222   const char *str;
223   unsigned int refcount;
224   enum dwarf_form form;
225   char *label;
226   unsigned int index;
227 };
228 
229 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
230 {
231   typedef const char *compare_type;
232 
233   static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
234   static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
235 };
236 
237 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
238 
239 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_line_str_hash;
240 
241 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
242    main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
243    parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
244 
245    1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
246    That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
247 
248    2) Strings can use four forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp,
249    DW_FORM_line_strp or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
250 
251    3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
252    reference count.
253 
254    Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
255    callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
256    special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
257    main object file.  This limits the complexity to just the places
258    that need it.  */
259 
260 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
261 
262 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
263 
264 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section.  */
265 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
266 
267 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all.  */
268 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
269 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
270 
271 /* The default cold text section.  */
272 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
273 
274 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type.  */
275 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
276 
277 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type.  */
278 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
279 
280 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
281 
282 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
283 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
284 
285 /* Personality decl of current unit.  Used only when assembler does not support
286    personality CFI.  */
287 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
288 
289 /* Whether an eh_frame section is required.  */
290 static GTY(()) bool do_eh_frame = false;
291 
292 /* .debug_rnglists next index.  */
293 static unsigned int rnglist_idx;
294 
295 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data.  */
296 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
297 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
298 
299 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
300 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION	".debug_frame"
301 #endif
302 
303 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
304 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL	"LFB"
305 #endif
306 
307 #ifndef FUNC_SECOND_SECT_LABEL
308 #define FUNC_SECOND_SECT_LABEL	"LFSB"
309 #endif
310 
311 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
312 #define FUNC_END_LABEL		"LFE"
313 #endif
314 
315 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
316 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL	"LPE"
317 #endif
318 
319 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
320 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL	"LEB"
321 #endif
322 
323 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
324 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL	"Lframe"
325 #endif
326 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LSCIE"
327 #define CIE_END_LABEL		"LECIE"
328 #define FDE_LABEL		"LSFDE"
329 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LASFDE"
330 #define FDE_END_LABEL		"LEFDE"
331 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL	"LSLT"
332 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL	"LELT"
333 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL	"LASLTP"
334 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL	"LELTP"
335 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX	"DW"
336 
337 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
338 
339 static int
340 matches_main_base (const char *path)
341 {
342   /* Cache the last query. */
343   static const char *last_path = NULL;
344   static int last_match = 0;
345   if (path != last_path)
346     {
347       const char *base;
348       int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
349       last_path = path;
350       last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
351                     && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
352     }
353   return last_match;
354 }
355 
356 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
357 
358 static int
359 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
360 		   enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
361 		   int matches, int result)
362 {
363   /* Find the type name. */
364   tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
365   tree t = type_decl;
366   const char *name = 0;
367   if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
368     t = DECL_NAME (t);
369   if (t)
370     name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
371 
372   fprintf (stderr, "	struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
373 	   criterion,
374            DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
375            matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
376            generic ? "gen" : "ord",
377            usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
378              usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
379            result,
380            (void*) type_decl, name);
381   return result;
382 }
383 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
384   dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
385 
386 #else
387 
388 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
389   (result)
390 
391 #endif
392 
393 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
394    of the number.  Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
395    we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number.  */
396 
397 static unsigned int
398 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
399 {
400   int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
401   return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
402 	  / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
403 }
404 
405 static bool
406 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
407 {
408   enum debug_struct_file criterion;
409   tree type_decl;
410   bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
411 
412   if (generic)
413     criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
414   else
415     criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
416 
417   if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
418     return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
419   if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
420     return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
421 
422   type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
423 
424   if (type_decl != NULL)
425     {
426      if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
427         return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
428 
429       if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
430         return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
431     }
432 
433   return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
434 }
435 
436 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section.  If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
437    switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
438    for collect2 the first time around.  */
439 
440 static void
441 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
442 {
443   if (eh_frame_section == 0)
444     {
445       int flags;
446 
447       if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
448 	{
449 	  int fde_encoding;
450 	  int per_encoding;
451 	  int lsda_encoding;
452 
453 	  fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
454 						       /*global=*/0);
455 	  per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
456 						       /*global=*/1);
457 	  lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
458 							/*global=*/0);
459 	  flags = ((! flag_pic
460 		    || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
461 			&& (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
462 			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
463 			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
464 			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
465 			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
466 		   ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
467 	}
468       else
469 	flags = SECTION_WRITE;
470 
471 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
472       eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
473 #else
474       eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
475 			  ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
476 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
477     }
478 
479   switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
480 
481 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
482   /* We have no special eh_frame section.  Emit special labels to guide
483      collect2.  */
484   if (!back)
485     {
486       tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
487       ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
488       targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
489 					IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
490       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
491     }
492 #endif
493 }
494 
495 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
496    FOR_EH.  */
497 
498 static void
499 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
500 {
501   if (for_eh)
502     switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
503   else
504     {
505       if (!debug_frame_section)
506 	debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
507 					   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
508       switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
509     }
510 }
511 
512 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used.  */
513 
514 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
515 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
516 {
517   switch (cfi)
518     {
519     case DW_CFA_nop:
520     case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
521     case DW_CFA_remember_state:
522     case DW_CFA_restore_state:
523       return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
524 
525     case DW_CFA_set_loc:
526     case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
527     case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
528     case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
529     case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
530       return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
531 
532     case DW_CFA_offset:
533     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
534     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
535     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
536     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
537     case DW_CFA_restore:
538     case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
539     case DW_CFA_undefined:
540     case DW_CFA_same_value:
541     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
542     case DW_CFA_register:
543     case DW_CFA_expression:
544     case DW_CFA_val_expression:
545       return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
546 
547     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
548     case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
549     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
550       return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
551 
552     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
553       return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
554 
555     default:
556       gcc_unreachable ();
557     }
558 }
559 
560 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used.  */
561 
562 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
563 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
564 {
565   switch (cfi)
566     {
567     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
568     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
569     case DW_CFA_offset:
570     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
571     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
572       return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
573 
574     case DW_CFA_register:
575       return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
576 
577     case DW_CFA_expression:
578     case DW_CFA_val_expression:
579       return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
580 
581     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
582       return dw_cfi_oprnd_cfa_loc;
583 
584     default:
585       return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
586     }
587 }
588 
589 /* Output one FDE.  */
590 
591 static void
592 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
593 	    char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
594 	    bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
595 {
596   const char *begin, *end;
597   static unsigned int j;
598   char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
599 
600   targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
601 				     /* empty */ 0);
602   targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
603 				  for_eh + j);
604   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
605   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
606   if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
607     {
608       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
609 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
610 			     " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
611       dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
612 			    "FDE Length");
613     }
614   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
615 
616   if (for_eh)
617     dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
618   else
619     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
620 			   debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
621 
622   begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
623   end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
624 
625   if (for_eh)
626     {
627       rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
628       SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
629       dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
630 				       "FDE initial location");
631       dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
632 			    end, begin, "FDE address range");
633     }
634   else
635     {
636       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
637       dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
638     }
639 
640   if (augmentation[0])
641     {
642       if (any_lsda_needed)
643 	{
644 	  int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
645 
646 	  if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
647 	    {
648 	      int offset = (  4		/* Length */
649 			    + 4		/* CIE offset */
650 			    + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
651 			    + 1		/* Augmentation size */ );
652 	      int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
653 
654 	      size += pad;
655 	      gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
656 	    }
657 
658 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
659 
660 	  if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
661 	    {
662 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
663 					   fde->funcdef_number);
664 	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
665 					       gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
666 					       false,
667 					       "Language Specific Data Area");
668 	    }
669 	  else
670 	    {
671 	      if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
672 		ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
673 	      dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
674 				   "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
675 	    }
676 	}
677       else
678 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
679     }
680 
681   /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE.  */
682   fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
683   {
684     size_t from, until, i;
685 
686     from = 0;
687     until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
688 
689     if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
690       ;
691     else if (!second)
692       until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
693     else
694       from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
695 
696     for (i = from; i < until; i++)
697       output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
698   }
699 
700   /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
701      do it now.  This is typically performed to make sure that tables
702      associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
703      garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
704      cope with -ffunction-sections.  */
705 
706 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
707   /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
708      switch *back* into the table section.  */
709   switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
710   ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
711   switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
712 #endif
713 
714   /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary.  */
715   ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
716 		    floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
717   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
718 
719   j += 2;
720 }
721 
722 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH.  */
723 
724 static bool
725 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
726 {
727   if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
728     return true;
729 
730   if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
731     return true;
732 
733   if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
734     return true;
735 
736   /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info.  */
737   if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
738     return false;
739 
740   return true;
741 }
742 
743 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
744    that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
745    location of saved registers.  */
746 
747 static void
748 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
749 {
750   unsigned int i;
751   dw_fde_ref fde;
752   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
753   char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
754   char section_start_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
755   bool any_lsda_needed = false;
756   char augmentation[6];
757   int augmentation_size;
758   int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
759   int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
760   int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
761   int return_reg;
762   rtx personality = NULL;
763   int dw_cie_version;
764 
765   /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs.  */
766   if (!fde_vec)
767     return;
768 
769   /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all.  */
770   if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
771     return;
772 
773   /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
774      any EH unwind information.  If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
775      emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted.  We
776      want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
777      is discarded.  Example where this matters: a primary function template
778      in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't.  */
779   if (for_eh)
780     {
781       bool any_eh_needed = false;
782 
783       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
784 	{
785 	  if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
786 	    any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
787 	  else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
788 	    any_eh_needed = true;
789 	  else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
790 	    targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
791 	}
792 
793       if (!any_eh_needed)
794 	return;
795     }
796 
797   /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app.  */
798   if (flag_debug_asm)
799     app_enable ();
800 
801   /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time.  */
802   switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
803 
804   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
805   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
806 
807   /* Output the CIE.  */
808   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
809   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
810   if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
811     {
812       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
813 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
814 	  "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
815       dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
816 			    "Length of Common Information Entry");
817     }
818   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
819 
820   /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
821      use 0 to identify the CIE.  */
822   dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
823 		       (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
824 		       "CIE Identifier Tag");
825 
826   /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
827      use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
828      due to overflowing the return register column.  */
829   return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
830   dw_cie_version = 1;
831   if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
832     dw_cie_version = 3;
833   dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
834 
835   augmentation[0] = 0;
836   augmentation_size = 0;
837 
838   personality = current_unit_personality;
839   if (for_eh)
840     {
841       char *p;
842 
843       /* Augmentation:
844 	 z	Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
845 		augmentation section.
846 	 L	Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
847 		an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
848 	 R	Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
849 		FDE code pointers.
850 	 P	Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
851 		personality routine in the CIE augmentation.  */
852 
853       fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
854       per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
855       lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
856 
857       p = augmentation + 1;
858       if (personality)
859 	{
860 	  *p++ = 'P';
861 	  augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
862 	  assemble_external_libcall (personality);
863 	}
864       if (any_lsda_needed)
865 	{
866 	  *p++ = 'L';
867 	  augmentation_size += 1;
868 	}
869       if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
870 	{
871 	  *p++ = 'R';
872 	  augmentation_size += 1;
873 	}
874       if (p > augmentation + 1)
875 	{
876 	  augmentation[0] = 'z';
877 	  *p = '\0';
878 	}
879 
880       /* Ug.  Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all.  */
881       if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
882 	{
883 	  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
884 			+ 4		/* CIE Id */
885 			+ 1		/* CIE version */
886 			+ strlen (augmentation) + 1	/* Augmentation */
887 			+ size_of_uleb128 (1)		/* Code alignment */
888 			+ size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
889 			+ 1		/* RA column */
890 			+ 1		/* Augmentation size */
891 			+ 1		/* Personality encoding */ );
892 	  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
893 
894 	  augmentation_size += pad;
895 
896 	  /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
897 	     iterate for a solution.  Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte.  */
898 	  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
899 	}
900     }
901 
902   dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
903   if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
904     {
905       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
906       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
907     }
908   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
909   dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
910 			       "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
911 
912   if (dw_cie_version == 1)
913     dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
914   else
915     dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
916 
917   if (augmentation[0])
918     {
919       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
920       if (personality)
921 	{
922 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
923 			       eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
924 	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
925 					   personality,
926 					   true, NULL);
927 	}
928 
929       if (any_lsda_needed)
930 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
931 			     eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
932 
933       if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
934 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
935 			     eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
936     }
937 
938   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
939     output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
940 
941   /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary.  */
942   ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
943 		    floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
944   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
945 
946   /* Loop through all of the FDE's.  */
947   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
948     {
949       unsigned int k;
950 
951       /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it.  */
952       if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
953 	continue;
954 
955       for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
956 	output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
957 		    augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
958     }
959 
960   if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
961     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
962 
963   /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker.  */
964   if (flag_debug_asm)
965     app_disable ();
966 }
967 
968 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed.  */
969 
970 static void
971 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
972 {
973   int enc;
974   rtx ref;
975 
976   fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
977 
978   /* .cfi_personality and .cfi_lsda are only relevant to DWARF2
979      eh unwinders.  */
980   if (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2)
981     return;
982 
983   rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
984 
985   if (personality)
986     {
987       enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
988       ref = personality;
989 
990       /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent.  We have to
991 	 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
992 	 in the assembler.  Further, the assembler can't handle any
993 	 of the weirder relocation types.  */
994       if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
995 	ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
996 
997       fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
998       output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
999       fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1000     }
1001 
1002   if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
1003     {
1004       char lab[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1005 
1006       enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1007       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
1008 				   current_function_funcdef_no);
1009       ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
1010       SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
1011 
1012       if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
1013 	ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
1014 
1015       fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
1016       output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1017       fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1018     }
1019 }
1020 
1021 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE.  Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1022    this allocation may be done before pass_final.  */
1023 
1024 dw_fde_ref
1025 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1026 {
1027   dw_fde_ref fde;
1028 
1029   fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1030   fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1031   fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1032   fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1033   fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1034   fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1035   fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1036   fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1037   fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1038 
1039   /* Record the FDE associated with this function.  */
1040   cfun->fde = fde;
1041   vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1042 
1043   return fde;
1044 }
1045 
1046 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1047    the prologue.  */
1048 
1049 void
1050 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1051 			  unsigned int column ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1052 			  const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1053 {
1054   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1055   char * dup_label;
1056   dw_fde_ref fde;
1057   section *fnsec;
1058   bool do_frame;
1059 
1060   current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1061 
1062   do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1063 
1064   /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1065      call-site information.  We must emit this label if it might be used.  */
1066   if (!do_frame
1067       && (!flag_exceptions
1068 	  || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1069     return;
1070 
1071   fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1072   switch_to_section (fnsec);
1073   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1074 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
1075   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1076 			  current_function_funcdef_no);
1077   dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1078   current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1079 
1080   /* We can elide FDE allocation if we're not emitting frame unwind info.  */
1081   if (!do_frame)
1082     return;
1083 
1084   /* Unlike the debug version, the EH version of frame unwind info is a per-
1085      function setting so we need to record whether we need it for the unit.  */
1086   do_eh_frame |= dwarf2out_do_eh_frame ();
1087 
1088   /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1089      emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1090      would include pass_dwarf2_frame.  If we've not created the FDE yet,
1091      do so now.  */
1092   fde = cfun->fde;
1093   if (fde == NULL)
1094     fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1095 
1096   /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier.  */
1097   fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1098   fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1099   fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1100 			 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1101 
1102   /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1103      prologue case, not the eh frame case.  */
1104 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1105   if (file)
1106     dwarf2out_source_line (line, column, file, 0, true);
1107 #endif
1108 
1109   if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1110     dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1111   else
1112     {
1113       rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1114       if (!current_unit_personality)
1115         current_unit_personality = personality;
1116 
1117       /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1118 	 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1119 	 function anymore.  */
1120       if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1121 	sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1122 	       "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1123     }
1124 }
1125 
1126 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1127    for a function prologue.  This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1128    been generated.  */
1129 
1130 void
1131 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1132 			    const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1133 {
1134   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1135 
1136   /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1137      function.  */
1138   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1139 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
1140   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1141 			  current_function_funcdef_no);
1142   cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1143 }
1144 
1145 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1146    for a function epilogue.  This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1147    been generated.  */
1148 
1149 void
1150 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1151 			  const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1152 {
1153   dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1154   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1155 
1156   if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1157     return;
1158 
1159   /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1160      function.  */
1161   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1162 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
1163   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1164 			  current_function_funcdef_no);
1165   fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1166 }
1167 
1168 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1169    for a function definition.  This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1170    been generated.  */
1171 
1172 void
1173 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1174 			const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1175 {
1176   dw_fde_ref fde;
1177   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1178 
1179   last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1180   cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1181 
1182   if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1183     fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1184 
1185   /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1186      function.  */
1187   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1188 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
1189   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1190   fde = cfun->fde;
1191   gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1192   if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1193     fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1194 }
1195 
1196 void
1197 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1198 {
1199   /* Output call frame information.  */
1200   if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1201     output_call_frame_info (0);
1202 
1203   /* Output another copy for the unwinder.  */
1204   if (do_eh_frame)
1205     output_call_frame_info (1);
1206 }
1207 
1208 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code.  */
1209 
1210 static void
1211 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1212 {
1213   section *sec = current_function_section ();
1214   if (sec == text_section)
1215     text_section_used = true;
1216   else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1217     cold_text_section_used = true;
1218 }
1219 
1220 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1221 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1222 
1223 void
1224 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1225 {
1226   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1227   section *sect;
1228   dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1229 
1230   gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1231 
1232   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_SECOND_SECT_LABEL,
1233 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
1234 
1235   fde->dw_fde_second_begin = ggc_strdup (label);
1236   if (!in_cold_section_p)
1237     {
1238       fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1239       fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1240     }
1241   else
1242     {
1243       fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1244       fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1245     }
1246   have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1247 
1248   /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging.  */
1249   if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1250     dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1251 
1252   if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1253     fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1254 
1255   /* Now do the real section switch.  */
1256   sect = current_function_section ();
1257   switch_to_section (sect);
1258 
1259   fde->second_in_std_section
1260     = (sect == text_section
1261        || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1262 
1263   if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1264     dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1265 
1266   var_location_switch_text_section ();
1267 
1268   if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1269     set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1270 }
1271 
1272 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1273    for emitting location expressions.  */
1274 
1275 /* Data about a single source file.  */
1276 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1277   const char * filename;
1278   int emitted_number;
1279 };
1280 
1281 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section.  */
1282 
1283 enum ate_kind {
1284   ate_kind_rtx,
1285   ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1286   ate_kind_label
1287 };
1288 
1289 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1290   enum ate_kind kind;
1291   unsigned int refcount;
1292   unsigned int index;
1293   union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1294     {
1295       rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1296       char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1297     }
1298   GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1299 };
1300 
1301 typedef unsigned int var_loc_view;
1302 
1303 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1304    so you can track variables that are in different places over
1305    their entire life.  */
1306 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1307   dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1308   const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1309   addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1310   const char *end;  /* Label for end of range */
1311   char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1312 		      Only on head of list.  */
1313   char *vl_symbol; /* Label for beginning of view list.  Ditto.  */
1314   const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1315   dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1316   var_loc_view vbegin, vend;
1317   hashval_t hash;
1318   /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1319      resolved.  */
1320   bool resolved_addr;
1321   /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next.  */
1322   bool replaced;
1323   /* True if it has been emitted into .debug_loc* / .debug_loclists*
1324      section.  */
1325   unsigned char emitted : 1;
1326   /* True if hash field is index rather than hash value.  */
1327   unsigned char num_assigned : 1;
1328   /* True if .debug_loclists.dwo offset has been emitted for it already.  */
1329   unsigned char offset_emitted : 1;
1330   /* True if note_variable_value_in_expr has been called on it.  */
1331   unsigned char noted_variable_value : 1;
1332   /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1333      are the same.  */
1334   bool force;
1335 } dw_loc_list_node;
1336 
1337 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (poly_int64);
1338 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1339 
1340 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name.  */
1341 
1342 static const char *
1343 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1344 {
1345   const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1346 
1347   if (name != NULL)
1348     return name;
1349 
1350   return "OP_<unknown>";
1351 }
1352 
1353 /* Return TRUE iff we're to output location view lists as a separate
1354    attribute next to the location lists, as an extension compatible
1355    with DWARF 2 and above.  */
1356 
1357 static inline bool
1358 dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ()
1359 {
1360   return debug_variable_location_views == 1;
1361 }
1362 
1363 /* Return TRUE iff we're to output location view lists as part of the
1364    location lists, as proposed for standardization after DWARF 5.  */
1365 
1366 static inline bool
1367 dwarf2out_locviews_in_loclist ()
1368 {
1369 #ifndef DW_LLE_view_pair
1370   return false;
1371 #else
1372   return debug_variable_location_views == -1;
1373 #endif
1374 }
1375 
1376 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description.  Location
1377    descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1378    together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions.  */
1379 
1380 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1381 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1382 	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1383 {
1384   dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1385 
1386   descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1387   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1388   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1389   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1390   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1391   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1392   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1393 
1394   return descr;
1395 }
1396 
1397 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression.  */
1398 
1399 static inline void
1400 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1401 {
1402   dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1403 
1404   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
1405   for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1406     ;
1407 
1408   *d = descr;
1409 }
1410 
1411 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality.  */
1412 
1413 static bool
1414 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1415 {
1416   if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1417     return false;
1418   switch (a->val_class)
1419     {
1420     case dw_val_class_none:
1421       return true;
1422     case dw_val_class_addr:
1423       return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1424 
1425     case dw_val_class_offset:
1426     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1427     case dw_val_class_const:
1428     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
1429     case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
1430     case dw_val_class_range_list:
1431       /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned.  */
1432       return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1433 
1434     case dw_val_class_loc:
1435       return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1436     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1437       return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1438     case dw_val_class_view_list:
1439       return a->v.val_view_list == b->v.val_view_list;
1440     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1441       return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1442     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1443       return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1444     case dw_val_class_symview:
1445       return strcmp (a->v.val_symbolic_view, b->v.val_symbolic_view) == 0;
1446     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1447     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1448     case dw_val_class_macptr:
1449     case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
1450     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1451       return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1452     case dw_val_class_str:
1453       return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1454     case dw_val_class_flag:
1455       return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1456     case dw_val_class_file:
1457     case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
1458       return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1459     case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1460       return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1461 
1462     case dw_val_class_const_double:
1463       return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1464 	      && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1465 
1466     case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1467       return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1468 
1469     case dw_val_class_vec:
1470       {
1471 	size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1472 	size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1473 
1474 	return (a_len == b_len
1475 		&& !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1476       }
1477 
1478     case dw_val_class_data8:
1479       return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1480 
1481     case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1482       return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1483               && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1484 
1485     case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1486       return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1487 	      && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1488     case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1489       /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists.  */
1490       return false;
1491     }
1492   gcc_unreachable ();
1493 }
1494 
1495 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality.  */
1496 
1497 static bool
1498 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1499 {
1500   if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1501     return false;
1502 
1503   /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1504      address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1505      should be zero for other types of locations.  */
1506   if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1507     return false;
1508 
1509   return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1510 	  && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1511 }
1512 
1513 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality.  */
1514 
1515 bool
1516 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1517 {
1518   while (1)
1519     {
1520       if (a == b)
1521 	return true;
1522       if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1523 	return false;
1524       if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1525 	return false;
1526 
1527       a = a->dw_loc_next;
1528       b = b->dw_loc_next;
1529     }
1530 }
1531 
1532 
1533 /* Add a constant POLY_OFFSET to a location expression.  */
1534 
1535 static void
1536 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, poly_int64 poly_offset)
1537 {
1538   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1539   HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1540 
1541   gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1542 
1543   if (known_eq (poly_offset, 0))
1544     return;
1545 
1546   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
1547   for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1548     ;
1549 
1550   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1551   if (!poly_offset.is_constant (&offset))
1552     {
1553       loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (poly_offset);
1554       add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
1555       return;
1556     }
1557 
1558   p = NULL;
1559   if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1560       || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1561     p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1562   else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1563     p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1564 
1565   /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1566      offset.  Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen.  */
1567   if (p != NULL
1568       && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1569 	  || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1570     *p += offset;
1571 
1572   else if (offset > 0)
1573     loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1574 
1575   else
1576     {
1577       loc->dw_loc_next
1578 	= uint_loc_descriptor (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset);
1579       add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1580     }
1581 }
1582 
1583 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1584    REG and OFFSET.  */
1585 
1586 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1587 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, poly_int64 offset)
1588 {
1589   HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
1590   if (offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
1591     {
1592       if (reg <= 31)
1593 	return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1594 			      const_offset, 0);
1595       else
1596 	return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, const_offset);
1597     }
1598   else
1599     {
1600       dw_loc_descr_ref ret = new_reg_loc_descr (reg, 0);
1601       loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, offset);
1602       return ret;
1603     }
1604 }
1605 
1606 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list.  */
1607 
1608 static void
1609 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, poly_int64 offset)
1610 {
1611   dw_loc_list_ref d;
1612   for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1613     loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1614 }
1615 
1616 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE	\
1617   (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1618 
1619 /* The number of bits that can be encoded by largest DW_FORM_dataN.
1620    In DWARF4 and earlier it is DW_FORM_data8 with 64 bits, in DWARF5
1621    DW_FORM_data16 with 128 bits.  */
1622 #define DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS \
1623   (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 128 : 64)
1624 
1625 /* Utility inline function for construction of ops that were GNU extension
1626    before DWARF 5.  */
1627 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
1628 dwarf_OP (enum dwarf_location_atom op)
1629 {
1630   switch (op)
1631     {
1632     case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1633       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1634 	return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
1635       break;
1636 
1637     case DW_OP_entry_value:
1638       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1639 	return DW_OP_GNU_entry_value;
1640       break;
1641 
1642     case DW_OP_const_type:
1643       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1644 	return DW_OP_GNU_const_type;
1645       break;
1646 
1647     case DW_OP_regval_type:
1648       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1649 	return DW_OP_GNU_regval_type;
1650       break;
1651 
1652     case DW_OP_deref_type:
1653       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1654 	return DW_OP_GNU_deref_type;
1655       break;
1656 
1657     case DW_OP_convert:
1658       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1659 	return DW_OP_GNU_convert;
1660       break;
1661 
1662     case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1663       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1664 	return DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret;
1665       break;
1666 
1667     default:
1668       break;
1669     }
1670   return op;
1671 }
1672 
1673 /* Similarly for attributes.  */
1674 static inline enum dwarf_attribute
1675 dwarf_AT (enum dwarf_attribute at)
1676 {
1677   switch (at)
1678     {
1679     case DW_AT_call_return_pc:
1680       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1681 	return DW_AT_low_pc;
1682       break;
1683 
1684     case DW_AT_call_tail_call:
1685       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1686 	return DW_AT_GNU_tail_call;
1687       break;
1688 
1689     case DW_AT_call_origin:
1690       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1691 	return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1692       break;
1693 
1694     case DW_AT_call_target:
1695       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1696 	return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target;
1697       break;
1698 
1699     case DW_AT_call_target_clobbered:
1700       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1701 	return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered;
1702       break;
1703 
1704     case DW_AT_call_parameter:
1705       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1706 	return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1707       break;
1708 
1709     case DW_AT_call_value:
1710       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1711 	return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value;
1712       break;
1713 
1714     case DW_AT_call_data_value:
1715       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1716 	return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value;
1717       break;
1718 
1719     case DW_AT_call_all_calls:
1720       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1721 	return DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites;
1722       break;
1723 
1724     case DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls:
1725       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1726 	return DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites;
1727       break;
1728 
1729     case DW_AT_dwo_name:
1730       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1731 	return DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name;
1732       break;
1733 
1734     default:
1735       break;
1736     }
1737   return at;
1738 }
1739 
1740 /* And similarly for tags.  */
1741 static inline enum dwarf_tag
1742 dwarf_TAG (enum dwarf_tag tag)
1743 {
1744   switch (tag)
1745     {
1746     case DW_TAG_call_site:
1747       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1748 	return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site;
1749       break;
1750 
1751     case DW_TAG_call_site_parameter:
1752       if (dwarf_version < 5)
1753 	return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter;
1754       break;
1755 
1756     default:
1757       break;
1758     }
1759   return tag;
1760 }
1761 
1762 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1763 
1764 /* Return the size of a location descriptor.  */
1765 
1766 static unsigned long
1767 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1768 {
1769   unsigned long size = 1;
1770 
1771   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1772     {
1773     case DW_OP_addr:
1774       size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1775       break;
1776     case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1777     case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1778       gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1779       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1780       break;
1781     case DW_OP_const1u:
1782     case DW_OP_const1s:
1783       size += 1;
1784       break;
1785     case DW_OP_const2u:
1786     case DW_OP_const2s:
1787       size += 2;
1788       break;
1789     case DW_OP_const4u:
1790     case DW_OP_const4s:
1791       size += 4;
1792       break;
1793     case DW_OP_const8u:
1794     case DW_OP_const8s:
1795       size += 8;
1796       break;
1797     case DW_OP_constu:
1798       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1799       break;
1800     case DW_OP_consts:
1801       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1802       break;
1803     case DW_OP_pick:
1804       size += 1;
1805       break;
1806     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1807       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1808       break;
1809     case DW_OP_skip:
1810     case DW_OP_bra:
1811       size += 2;
1812       break;
1813     case DW_OP_breg0:
1814     case DW_OP_breg1:
1815     case DW_OP_breg2:
1816     case DW_OP_breg3:
1817     case DW_OP_breg4:
1818     case DW_OP_breg5:
1819     case DW_OP_breg6:
1820     case DW_OP_breg7:
1821     case DW_OP_breg8:
1822     case DW_OP_breg9:
1823     case DW_OP_breg10:
1824     case DW_OP_breg11:
1825     case DW_OP_breg12:
1826     case DW_OP_breg13:
1827     case DW_OP_breg14:
1828     case DW_OP_breg15:
1829     case DW_OP_breg16:
1830     case DW_OP_breg17:
1831     case DW_OP_breg18:
1832     case DW_OP_breg19:
1833     case DW_OP_breg20:
1834     case DW_OP_breg21:
1835     case DW_OP_breg22:
1836     case DW_OP_breg23:
1837     case DW_OP_breg24:
1838     case DW_OP_breg25:
1839     case DW_OP_breg26:
1840     case DW_OP_breg27:
1841     case DW_OP_breg28:
1842     case DW_OP_breg29:
1843     case DW_OP_breg30:
1844     case DW_OP_breg31:
1845       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1846       break;
1847     case DW_OP_regx:
1848       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1849       break;
1850     case DW_OP_fbreg:
1851       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1852       break;
1853     case DW_OP_bregx:
1854       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1855       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1856       break;
1857     case DW_OP_piece:
1858       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1859       break;
1860     case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1861       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1862       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1863       break;
1864     case DW_OP_deref_size:
1865     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1866       size += 1;
1867       break;
1868     case DW_OP_call2:
1869       size += 2;
1870       break;
1871     case DW_OP_call4:
1872       size += 4;
1873       break;
1874     case DW_OP_call_ref:
1875     case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
1876       size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1877       break;
1878     case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1879       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1880 	      + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1881       break;
1882     case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1883     case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1884       size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1885       break;
1886     case DW_OP_entry_value:
1887     case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1888       {
1889 	unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1890 	size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1891 	break;
1892       }
1893     case DW_OP_const_type:
1894     case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1895       {
1896 	unsigned long o
1897 	  = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1898 	size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1899 	switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1900 	  {
1901 	  case dw_val_class_vec:
1902 	    size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1903 		    * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1904 	    break;
1905 	  case dw_val_class_const:
1906 	    size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1907 	    break;
1908 	  case dw_val_class_const_double:
1909 	    size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1910 	    break;
1911 	  case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1912 	    size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1913 		     * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1914 	    break;
1915 	  default:
1916 	    gcc_unreachable ();
1917 	  }
1918 	break;
1919       }
1920     case DW_OP_regval_type:
1921     case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1922       {
1923 	unsigned long o
1924 	  = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1925 	size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1926 		+ size_of_uleb128 (o);
1927       }
1928       break;
1929     case DW_OP_deref_type:
1930     case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1931       {
1932 	unsigned long o
1933 	  = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1934 	size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1935       }
1936       break;
1937     case DW_OP_convert:
1938     case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1939     case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1940     case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1941       if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1942 	size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1943       else
1944 	{
1945 	  unsigned long o
1946 	    = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1947 	  size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1948 	}
1949       break;
1950     case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1951       size += 4;
1952       break;
1953     default:
1954       break;
1955     }
1956 
1957   return size;
1958 }
1959 
1960 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors.  */
1961 
1962 unsigned long
1963 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1964 {
1965   dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1966   unsigned long size;
1967 
1968   /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1969      field, to avoid writing to a PCH file.  */
1970   for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1971     {
1972       if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1973 	break;
1974       size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1975     }
1976   if (! l)
1977     return size;
1978 
1979   for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1980     {
1981       l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1982       size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1983     }
1984 
1985   return size;
1986 }
1987 
1988 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute.  */
1989 
1990 static int
1991 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
1992 {
1993   if (discr_value->pos)
1994     return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
1995   else
1996     return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
1997 }
1998 
1999 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_list attribute.  */
2000 
2001 static int
2002 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
2003 {
2004   int size = 0;
2005 
2006   for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
2007        list != NULL;
2008        list = list->dw_discr_next)
2009     {
2010       /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
2011 	 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
2012 	 range label.  */
2013       size += 1;
2014       size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
2015       if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
2016 	size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
2017     }
2018   return size;
2019 }
2020 
2021 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
2022 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
2023 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
2024 
2025 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2026    The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2027    converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2028    hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2029    info).  This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2030    (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0.  See PR47324.  */
2031 
2032 static void
2033 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2034 {
2035   dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2036   dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2037 
2038   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2039     {
2040 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2041     case DW_OP_const2u:
2042     case DW_OP_const2s:
2043       dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2044       break;
2045     case DW_OP_const4u:
2046       if (loc->dtprel)
2047 	{
2048 	  gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
2049 	  targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
2050 					       val1->v.val_addr);
2051 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2052 	  break;
2053 	}
2054       /* FALLTHRU */
2055     case DW_OP_const4s:
2056       dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2057       break;
2058     case DW_OP_const8u:
2059       if (loc->dtprel)
2060 	{
2061 	  gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
2062 	  targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
2063 					       val1->v.val_addr);
2064 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2065 	  break;
2066 	}
2067       /* FALLTHRU */
2068     case DW_OP_const8s:
2069       gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2070       dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2071       break;
2072     case DW_OP_skip:
2073     case DW_OP_bra:
2074       {
2075 	int offset;
2076 
2077 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2078 	offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2079 
2080 	dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2081       }
2082       break;
2083     case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2084       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2085       switch (val2->val_class)
2086 	{
2087 	case dw_val_class_const:
2088 	  dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2089 	  break;
2090 	case dw_val_class_vec:
2091 	  {
2092 	    unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2093 	    unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2094 	    unsigned int i;
2095 	    unsigned char *p;
2096 
2097 	    if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2098 	      {
2099 		elt_size /= 2;
2100 		len *= 2;
2101 	      }
2102 	    for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2103 		 i < len;
2104 		 i++, p += elt_size)
2105 	      dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2106 				   "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2107 	  }
2108 	  break;
2109 	case dw_val_class_const_double:
2110 	  {
2111 	    unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2112 
2113 	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2114 	      {
2115 		first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2116 		second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2117 	      }
2118 	    else
2119 	      {
2120 		first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2121 		second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2122 	      }
2123 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2124 				 first, NULL);
2125 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2126 				 second, NULL);
2127 	  }
2128 	  break;
2129 	case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2130 	  {
2131 	    int i;
2132 	    int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2133 	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2134 	      for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2135 		dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2136 				     val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2137 	    else
2138 	      for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2139 		dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2140 				     val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2141 	  }
2142 	  break;
2143 	case dw_val_class_addr:
2144 	  gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
2145 	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
2146 	  break;
2147 	default:
2148 	  gcc_unreachable ();
2149 	}
2150       break;
2151 #else
2152     case DW_OP_const2u:
2153     case DW_OP_const2s:
2154     case DW_OP_const4u:
2155     case DW_OP_const4s:
2156     case DW_OP_const8u:
2157     case DW_OP_const8s:
2158     case DW_OP_skip:
2159     case DW_OP_bra:
2160     case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2161       /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2162 	 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2163 	 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2164 	 only doing unwinding.  */
2165       gcc_unreachable ();
2166 #endif
2167     case DW_OP_const1u:
2168     case DW_OP_const1s:
2169       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2170       break;
2171     case DW_OP_constu:
2172       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2173       break;
2174     case DW_OP_consts:
2175       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2176       break;
2177     case DW_OP_pick:
2178       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2179       break;
2180     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2181       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2182       break;
2183     case DW_OP_breg0:
2184     case DW_OP_breg1:
2185     case DW_OP_breg2:
2186     case DW_OP_breg3:
2187     case DW_OP_breg4:
2188     case DW_OP_breg5:
2189     case DW_OP_breg6:
2190     case DW_OP_breg7:
2191     case DW_OP_breg8:
2192     case DW_OP_breg9:
2193     case DW_OP_breg10:
2194     case DW_OP_breg11:
2195     case DW_OP_breg12:
2196     case DW_OP_breg13:
2197     case DW_OP_breg14:
2198     case DW_OP_breg15:
2199     case DW_OP_breg16:
2200     case DW_OP_breg17:
2201     case DW_OP_breg18:
2202     case DW_OP_breg19:
2203     case DW_OP_breg20:
2204     case DW_OP_breg21:
2205     case DW_OP_breg22:
2206     case DW_OP_breg23:
2207     case DW_OP_breg24:
2208     case DW_OP_breg25:
2209     case DW_OP_breg26:
2210     case DW_OP_breg27:
2211     case DW_OP_breg28:
2212     case DW_OP_breg29:
2213     case DW_OP_breg30:
2214     case DW_OP_breg31:
2215       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2216       break;
2217     case DW_OP_regx:
2218       {
2219 	unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2220 	if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2221 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2222 	gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2223 		    == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2224 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2225       }
2226       break;
2227     case DW_OP_fbreg:
2228       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2229       break;
2230     case DW_OP_bregx:
2231       {
2232 	unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2233 	if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2234 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2235 	gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2236 		    == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2237 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2238 	dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2239       }
2240       break;
2241     case DW_OP_piece:
2242       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2243       break;
2244     case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2245       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2246       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2247       break;
2248     case DW_OP_deref_size:
2249     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2250       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2251       break;
2252 
2253     case DW_OP_addr:
2254       if (loc->dtprel)
2255 	{
2256 	  if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2257 	    {
2258 	      targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2259 						   DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2260 						   val1->v.val_addr);
2261 	      fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2262 	    }
2263 	  else
2264 	    gcc_unreachable ();
2265 	}
2266       else
2267 	{
2268 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2269 	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2270 #else
2271 	  gcc_unreachable ();
2272 #endif
2273 	}
2274       break;
2275 
2276     case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2277     case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2278       gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2279       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2280                                    "(index into .debug_addr)");
2281       break;
2282 
2283     case DW_OP_call2:
2284     case DW_OP_call4:
2285       {
2286 	unsigned long die_offset
2287 	  = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2288 	/* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2289 	   an operand.  */
2290 	gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2291 		    && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2
2292 				     ? 0xffff
2293 				     : 0xffffffff));
2294 	dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2295 			     die_offset, NULL);
2296       }
2297       break;
2298 
2299     case DW_OP_call_ref:
2300     case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
2301       {
2302 	char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2303 		   + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2304 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2305 	get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2306 	dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2307       }
2308       break;
2309 
2310     case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2311     case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2312       {
2313 	char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2314 		   + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2315 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2316 	get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2317 	dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2318 	dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2319       }
2320       break;
2321 
2322     case DW_OP_entry_value:
2323     case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2324       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2325       output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2326       break;
2327 
2328     case DW_OP_const_type:
2329     case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2330       {
2331 	unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2332 	gcc_assert (o);
2333 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2334 	switch (val2->val_class)
2335 	  {
2336 	  case dw_val_class_const:
2337 	    l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2338 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2339 	    dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2340 	    break;
2341 	  case dw_val_class_vec:
2342 	    {
2343 	      unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2344 	      unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2345 	      unsigned int i;
2346 	      unsigned char *p;
2347 
2348 	      l = len * elt_size;
2349 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2350 	      if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2351 		{
2352 		  elt_size /= 2;
2353 		  len *= 2;
2354 		}
2355 	      for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2356 		   i < len;
2357 		   i++, p += elt_size)
2358 		dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2359 				     "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2360 	    }
2361 	    break;
2362 	  case dw_val_class_const_double:
2363 	    {
2364 	      unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2365 	      l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2366 
2367 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2368 	      if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2369 		{
2370 		  first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2371 		  second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2372 		}
2373 	      else
2374 		{
2375 		  first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2376 		  second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2377 		}
2378 	      dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2379 	      dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2380 	    }
2381 	    break;
2382 	  case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2383 	    {
2384 	      int i;
2385 	      int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2386 	      l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2387 
2388 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2389 	      if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2390 		for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2391 		  dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2392 	      else
2393 		for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2394 		  dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2395 	    }
2396 	    break;
2397 	  default:
2398 	    gcc_unreachable ();
2399 	  }
2400       }
2401       break;
2402     case DW_OP_regval_type:
2403     case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2404       {
2405 	unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2406 	unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2407 	gcc_assert (o);
2408 	if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2409 	  {
2410 	    r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2411 	    gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2412 			== size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2413 	  }
2414 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2415 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2416       }
2417       break;
2418     case DW_OP_deref_type:
2419     case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2420       {
2421 	unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2422 	gcc_assert (o);
2423 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2424 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2425       }
2426       break;
2427     case DW_OP_convert:
2428     case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2429     case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2430     case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2431       if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2432 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2433       else
2434 	{
2435 	  unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2436 	  gcc_assert (o);
2437 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2438 	}
2439       break;
2440 
2441     case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2442       {
2443 	unsigned long o;
2444 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2445 	o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2446 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2447       }
2448       break;
2449 
2450     default:
2451       /* Other codes have no operands.  */
2452       break;
2453     }
2454 }
2455 
2456 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2457    The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2458    converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2459    hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2460    info).  This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2461    (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0.  See PR47324.  */
2462 
2463 void
2464 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2465 {
2466   for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2467     {
2468       enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2469       /* Output the opcode.  */
2470       if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2471           && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2472 	{
2473 	  unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2474 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2475 	  gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2476 	  opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2477 	}
2478       else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2479 	       && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2480 	{
2481 	  unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2482 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2483 	  gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2484 	  opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2485 	}
2486 
2487       dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2488 			     "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2489 
2490       /* Output the operand(s) (if any).  */
2491       output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2492     }
2493 }
2494 
2495 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2496    The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape.  */
2497 
2498 static void
2499 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2500 {
2501   dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2502   dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2503 
2504   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2505     {
2506     case DW_OP_addr:
2507     case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2508     case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2509     case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2510       /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes.  */
2511       gcc_unreachable ();
2512 
2513     case DW_OP_const1u:
2514     case DW_OP_const1s:
2515     case DW_OP_pick:
2516     case DW_OP_deref_size:
2517     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2518       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2519       dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2520       break;
2521 
2522     case DW_OP_const2u:
2523     case DW_OP_const2s:
2524       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2525       dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2526       break;
2527 
2528     case DW_OP_const4u:
2529     case DW_OP_const4s:
2530       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2531       dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2532       break;
2533 
2534     case DW_OP_const8u:
2535     case DW_OP_const8s:
2536       gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2537       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2538       dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2539       break;
2540 
2541     case DW_OP_skip:
2542     case DW_OP_bra:
2543       {
2544 	int offset;
2545 
2546 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2547 	offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2548 
2549         fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2550 	dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2551       }
2552       break;
2553 
2554     case DW_OP_regx:
2555       {
2556 	unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2557 	gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2558 		    == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2559 	fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2560 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2561       }
2562       break;
2563 
2564     case DW_OP_constu:
2565     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2566     case DW_OP_piece:
2567       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2568       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2569       break;
2570 
2571     case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2572       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2573       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2574       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2575       break;
2576 
2577     case DW_OP_consts:
2578     case DW_OP_breg0:
2579     case DW_OP_breg1:
2580     case DW_OP_breg2:
2581     case DW_OP_breg3:
2582     case DW_OP_breg4:
2583     case DW_OP_breg5:
2584     case DW_OP_breg6:
2585     case DW_OP_breg7:
2586     case DW_OP_breg8:
2587     case DW_OP_breg9:
2588     case DW_OP_breg10:
2589     case DW_OP_breg11:
2590     case DW_OP_breg12:
2591     case DW_OP_breg13:
2592     case DW_OP_breg14:
2593     case DW_OP_breg15:
2594     case DW_OP_breg16:
2595     case DW_OP_breg17:
2596     case DW_OP_breg18:
2597     case DW_OP_breg19:
2598     case DW_OP_breg20:
2599     case DW_OP_breg21:
2600     case DW_OP_breg22:
2601     case DW_OP_breg23:
2602     case DW_OP_breg24:
2603     case DW_OP_breg25:
2604     case DW_OP_breg26:
2605     case DW_OP_breg27:
2606     case DW_OP_breg28:
2607     case DW_OP_breg29:
2608     case DW_OP_breg30:
2609     case DW_OP_breg31:
2610     case DW_OP_fbreg:
2611       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2612       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2613       break;
2614 
2615     case DW_OP_bregx:
2616       {
2617 	unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2618 	gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2619 		    == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2620 	fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2621 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2622 	fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2623 	dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2624       }
2625       break;
2626 
2627     case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2628     case DW_OP_entry_value:
2629     case DW_OP_const_type:
2630     case DW_OP_regval_type:
2631     case DW_OP_deref_type:
2632     case DW_OP_convert:
2633     case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2634     case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2635     case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2636     case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2637     case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2638     case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2639     case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2640     case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2641     case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2642       gcc_unreachable ();
2643       break;
2644 
2645     default:
2646       /* Other codes have no operands.  */
2647       break;
2648     }
2649 }
2650 
2651 void
2652 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2653 {
2654   while (1)
2655     {
2656       enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2657       /* Output the opcode.  */
2658       if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2659 	{
2660 	  unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2661 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2662 	  gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2663 	  opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2664 	}
2665       else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2666 	{
2667 	  unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2668 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2669 	  gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2670 	  opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2671 	}
2672       /* Output the opcode.  */
2673       fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2674       output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2675 
2676       if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2677 	break;
2678       loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2679 
2680       fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2681     }
2682 }
2683 
2684 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2685    dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2686    expression.  */
2687 
2688 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2689 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, poly_int64 offset)
2690 {
2691   struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2692 
2693   offset += cfa->offset;
2694 
2695   if (cfa->indirect)
2696     {
2697       head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2698       head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2699       head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2700       tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2701       add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2702       loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2703     }
2704   else
2705     head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2706 
2707   return head;
2708 }
2709 
2710 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2711    the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2712    ALIGNMENT byte.  */
2713 
2714 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2715 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2716 		       poly_int64 offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2717 {
2718   struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2719   unsigned int dwarf_fp
2720     = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2721 
2722   /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment.  */
2723   if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2724     {
2725       head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2726       add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2727       add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2728       loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2729     }
2730   else
2731     head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2732   return head;
2733 }
2734 
2735 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information.  */
2736 
2737 /* .debug_str support.  */
2738 
2739 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2740 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2741 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *);
2742 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2743 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2744 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2745 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2746 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2747 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2748 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2749 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2750 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2751 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2752 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2753 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2754 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool, bool);
2755 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2756 						 dw_die_ref);
2757 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2758 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2759 static void dwarf2out_inline_entry (tree);
2760 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2761 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2762 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2763 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2764 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2765 static void dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
2766 					     unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off);
2767 static bool dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
2768 					unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off);
2769 
2770 /* The debug hooks structure.  */
2771 
2772 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2773 {
2774   dwarf2out_init,
2775   dwarf2out_finish,
2776   dwarf2out_early_finish,
2777   dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2778   dwarf2out_define,
2779   dwarf2out_undef,
2780   dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2781   dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2782   dwarf2out_begin_block,
2783   dwarf2out_end_block,
2784   dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2785   dwarf2out_source_line,
2786   dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2787 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2788   dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2789   dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2790 #else
2791   debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2792   debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2793 #endif
2794   dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2795   dwarf2out_begin_function,
2796   dwarf2out_end_function,	/* end_function */
2797   dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2798   dwarf2out_function_decl,	/* function_decl */
2799   dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2800   dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2801   dwarf2out_type_decl,		/* type_decl */
2802   dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2803   dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl,
2804   dwarf2out_register_external_die,
2805   debug_nothing_tree,		/* deferred_inline_function */
2806   /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2807      emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2808      something tries to reference them.  */
2809   dwarf2out_abstract_function,	/* outlining_inline_function */
2810   debug_nothing_rtx_code_label,	/* label */
2811   debug_nothing_int,		/* handle_pch */
2812   dwarf2out_var_location,
2813   dwarf2out_inline_entry,	/* inline_entry */
2814   dwarf2out_size_function,	/* size_function */
2815   dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2816   dwarf2out_set_name,
2817   1,                            /* start_end_main_source_file */
2818   TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE            /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2819 };
2820 
2821 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2822 {
2823   dwarf2out_init,
2824   debug_nothing_charstar,
2825   debug_nothing_charstar,
2826   dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2827   debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2828   debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2829   debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2830   debug_nothing_int,
2831   debug_nothing_int_int,	         /* begin_block */
2832   debug_nothing_int_int,	         /* end_block */
2833   debug_true_const_tree,	         /* ignore_block */
2834   dwarf2out_source_line,		 /* source_line */
2835   debug_nothing_int_int_charstar,	 /* begin_prologue */
2836   debug_nothing_int_charstar,	         /* end_prologue */
2837   debug_nothing_int_charstar,	         /* begin_epilogue */
2838   debug_nothing_int_charstar,	         /* end_epilogue */
2839   debug_nothing_tree,		         /* begin_function */
2840   debug_nothing_int,		         /* end_function */
2841   debug_nothing_tree,			 /* register_main_translation_unit */
2842   debug_nothing_tree,		         /* function_decl */
2843   debug_nothing_tree,		         /* early_global_decl */
2844   debug_nothing_tree,		         /* late_global_decl */
2845   debug_nothing_tree_int,		 /* type_decl */
2846   debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool_bool,/* imported_module_or_decl */
2847   debug_false_tree_charstarstar_uhwistar,/* die_ref_for_decl */
2848   debug_nothing_tree_charstar_uhwi,      /* register_external_die */
2849   debug_nothing_tree,		         /* deferred_inline_function */
2850   debug_nothing_tree,		         /* outlining_inline_function */
2851   debug_nothing_rtx_code_label,	         /* label */
2852   debug_nothing_int,		         /* handle_pch */
2853   debug_nothing_rtx_insn,	         /* var_location */
2854   debug_nothing_tree,	         	 /* inline_entry */
2855   debug_nothing_tree,			 /* size_function */
2856   debug_nothing_void,                    /* switch_text_section */
2857   debug_nothing_tree_tree,		 /* set_name */
2858   0,                                     /* start_end_main_source_file */
2859   TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS                 /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2860 };
2861 
2862 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2863    "Debugging Information Entries".  This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2864    throughout the remainder of this file.  */
2865 
2866 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2867    walked to generate the DWARF debugging info.  The walk of the internal
2868    representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2869    The types below are used to describe the internal representation.  */
2870 
2871 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2872    of making them part of the .debug_info section.  Only supported for
2873    Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2874    -fno-debug-types-section.  It is more efficient to put them in a
2875    separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2876    remove duplicates.  But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2877    yet.  For Dwarf V5 or higher .debug_types doesn't exist any more,
2878    it is DW_UT_type unit type in .debug_info section.  For late LTO
2879    debug there should be almost no types emitted so avoid enabling
2880    -fdebug-types-section there.  */
2881 
2882 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 \
2883 			 && flag_debug_types_section \
2884 			 && !in_lto_p)
2885 
2886 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2887    .debug_info section to refer to each other.  */
2888 
2889 typedef long int dw_offset;
2890 
2891 struct comdat_type_node;
2892 
2893 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2894    that are used in the real dwarf line table.  Arrays of these entries
2895    are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2896    supported.  */
2897 
2898 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2899   /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index.  */
2900   LI_set_address,
2901 
2902   /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line.  This may be done
2903      via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2904      special opcodes.  */
2905   LI_set_line,
2906 
2907   /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file.  */
2908   LI_set_file,
2909 
2910   /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column.  */
2911   LI_set_column,
2912 
2913   /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored.  */
2914   LI_negate_stmt,
2915 
2916   /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored.  */
2917   LI_set_prologue_end,
2918   LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2919 
2920   /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator.  */
2921   LI_set_discriminator,
2922 
2923   /* Output a Fixed Advance PC; the target PC is the label index; the
2924      base PC is the previous LI_adv_address or LI_set_address entry.
2925      We only use this when emitting debug views without assembler
2926      support, at explicit user request.  Ideally, we should only use
2927      it when the offset might be zero but we can't tell: it's the only
2928      way to maybe change the PC without resetting the view number.  */
2929   LI_adv_address
2930 };
2931 
2932 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2933   enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2934   unsigned int val;
2935 } dw_line_info_entry;
2936 
2937 
2938 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2939   /* The label that marks the end of this section.  */
2940   const char *end_label;
2941 
2942   /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2943      These are used to minimize the changes to the next row.  */
2944   unsigned int file_num;
2945   unsigned int line_num;
2946   unsigned int column_num;
2947   int discrim_num;
2948   bool is_stmt;
2949   bool in_use;
2950 
2951   /* This denotes the NEXT view number.
2952 
2953      If it is 0, it is known that the NEXT view will be the first view
2954      at the given PC.
2955 
2956      If it is -1, we're forcing the view number to be reset, e.g. at a
2957      function entry.
2958 
2959      The meaning of other nonzero values depends on whether we're
2960      computing views internally or leaving it for the assembler to do
2961      so.  If we're emitting them internally, view denotes the view
2962      number since the last known advance of PC.  If we're leaving it
2963      for the assembler, it denotes the LVU label number that we're
2964      going to ask the assembler to assign.  */
2965   var_loc_view view;
2966 
2967   /* This counts the number of symbolic views emitted in this table
2968      since the latest view reset.  Its max value, over all tables,
2969      sets symview_upper_bound.  */
2970   var_loc_view symviews_since_reset;
2971 
2972 #define FORCE_RESET_NEXT_VIEW(x) ((x) = (var_loc_view)-1)
2973 #define RESET_NEXT_VIEW(x) ((x) = (var_loc_view)0)
2974 #define FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P(x) ((x) == (var_loc_view)-1)
2975 #define RESETTING_VIEW_P(x) ((x) == (var_loc_view)0 || FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P (x))
2976 
2977   vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2978 };
2979 
2980 /* This is an upper bound for view numbers that the assembler may
2981    assign to symbolic views output in this translation.  It is used to
2982    decide how big a field to use to represent view numbers in
2983    symview-classed attributes.  */
2984 
2985 static var_loc_view symview_upper_bound;
2986 
2987 /* If we're keep track of location views and their reset points, and
2988    INSN is a reset point (i.e., it necessarily advances the PC), mark
2989    the next view in TABLE as reset.  */
2990 
2991 static void
2992 maybe_reset_location_view (rtx_insn *insn, dw_line_info_table *table)
2993 {
2994   if (!debug_internal_reset_location_views)
2995     return;
2996 
2997   /* Maybe turn (part of?) this test into a default target hook.  */
2998   int reset = 0;
2999 
3000   if (targetm.reset_location_view)
3001     reset = targetm.reset_location_view (insn);
3002 
3003   if (reset)
3004     ;
3005   else if (JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn))
3006     reset = 1;
3007   else if (GET_CODE (insn) == USE
3008 	   || GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER
3009 	   || GET_CODE (insn) == ASM_INPUT
3010 	   || asm_noperands (insn) >= 0)
3011     ;
3012   else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) > 0)
3013     reset = 1;
3014 
3015   if (reset > 0 && !RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
3016     RESET_NEXT_VIEW (table->view);
3017 }
3018 
3019 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3020    a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3021    Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify.  */
3022 
3023 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
3024   enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3025   dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3026 }
3027 dw_attr_node;
3028 
3029 
3030 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure.  DIEs form a tree.
3031    The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3032    die_sib.  die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node.  */
3033 
3034 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
3035   union die_symbol_or_type_node
3036     {
3037       const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
3038       comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
3039     }
3040   GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
3041   vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
3042   dw_die_ref die_parent;
3043   dw_die_ref die_child;
3044   dw_die_ref die_sib;
3045   dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3046   dw_offset die_offset;
3047   unsigned long die_abbrev;
3048   int die_mark;
3049   unsigned int decl_id;
3050   enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3051   /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused.  */
3052   BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
3053   BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
3054   /* For an external ref to die_symbol if die_offset contains an extra
3055      offset to that symbol.  */
3056   BOOL_BITFIELD with_offset : 1;
3057   /* Whether this DIE was removed from the DIE tree, for example via
3058      prune_unused_types.  We don't consider those present from the
3059      DIE lookup routines.  */
3060   BOOL_BITFIELD removed : 1;
3061   /* Lots of spare bits.  */
3062 }
3063 die_node;
3064 
3065 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running.  */
3066 static bool early_dwarf;
3067 static bool early_dwarf_finished;
3068 struct set_early_dwarf {
3069   bool saved;
3070   set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf)
3071     {
3072       gcc_assert (! early_dwarf_finished);
3073       early_dwarf = true;
3074     }
3075   ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
3076 };
3077 
3078 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order.  */
3079 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do {	\
3080   c = die->die_child;				\
3081   if (c) do {					\
3082     c = c->die_sib;				\
3083     expr;					\
3084   } while (c != die->die_child);		\
3085 } while (0)
3086 
3087 /* The pubname structure */
3088 
3089 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
3090   dw_die_ref die;
3091   const char *name;
3092 }
3093 pubname_entry;
3094 
3095 
3096 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
3097   const char *label;
3098   /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
3099      bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label.  */
3100   int num;
3101   /* Index for the range list for DW_FORM_rnglistx.  */
3102   unsigned int idx : 31;
3103   /* True if this range might be possibly in a different section
3104      from previous entry.  */
3105   unsigned int maybe_new_sec : 1;
3106 };
3107 
3108 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry.  */
3109 
3110 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
3111   unsigned char code;
3112   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
3113   const char *info;
3114 }
3115 macinfo_entry;
3116 
3117 
3118 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
3119   const char *begin;
3120   const char *end;
3121 };
3122 
3123 /* The comdat type node structure.  */
3124 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
3125 {
3126   dw_die_ref root_die;
3127   dw_die_ref type_die;
3128   dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
3129   char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
3130   comdat_type_node *next;
3131 };
3132 
3133 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
3134    field) just yet.  Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
3135    missing bits.  */
3136 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
3137   dw_die_ref die;
3138   /* The tree for which this DIE was created.  We use this to
3139      determine ancestry later.  */
3140   tree created_for;
3141   struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3142 }
3143 limbo_die_node;
3144 
3145 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
3146 {
3147   dw_die_ref old_die;
3148   dw_die_ref new_die;
3149   struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
3150 }
3151 skeleton_chain_node;
3152 
3153 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3154    implicitly generated for a type.
3155 
3156    Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
3157    TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
3158    and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
3159    a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3160    These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3161    generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them.  Likewise with the Ada
3162    front-end, but for each type, tagged or not.  */
3163 
3164 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl)				\
3165   (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE			\
3166    || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)				\
3167        && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))	\
3168 	   /* This is necessary for stub decls that	\
3169 	      appear in nested inline functions.  */	\
3170 	   || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE	\
3171 	       && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl)		\
3172 		   == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3173 
3174 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3175    language, and compiler version.  */
3176 
3177 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header.  */
3178 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3179   (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE			\
3180    + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 4 : 3))
3181 
3182 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header.  */
3183 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3184   (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE					\
3185    + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3186 
3187 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF skeleton compilation unit header.  */
3188 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE \
3189   (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 8 : 0))
3190 
3191 /* Fixed size portion of public names info.  */
3192 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3193 
3194 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info.  */
3195 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE					\
3196   (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4,	\
3197 		DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2)					\
3198    - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3199 
3200 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info.  It must be
3201    aligned to twice the pointer size.  */
3202 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3203   (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3204 		DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2)				   \
3205    - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3206 
3207 /* Use assembler line directives if available.  */
3208 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3209 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3210 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3211 #else
3212 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3213 #endif
3214 #endif
3215 
3216 /* Use assembler views in line directives if available.  */
3217 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
3218 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_VIEW
3219 #define DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO 1
3220 #else
3221 #define DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO 0
3222 #endif
3223 #endif
3224 
3225 /* Return true if GCC configure detected assembler support for .loc.  */
3226 
3227 bool
3228 dwarf2out_default_as_loc_support (void)
3229 {
3230   return DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO;
3231 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
3232 # undef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3233 # pragma GCC poison DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3234 #endif
3235 }
3236 
3237 /* Return true if GCC configure detected assembler support for views
3238    in .loc directives.  */
3239 
3240 bool
3241 dwarf2out_default_as_locview_support (void)
3242 {
3243   return DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO;
3244 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
3245 # undef DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
3246 # pragma GCC poison DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
3247 #endif
3248 }
3249 
3250 /* A bit is set in ZERO_VIEW_P if we are using the assembler-supported
3251    view computation, and it refers to a view identifier for which we
3252    will not emit a label because it is known to map to a view number
3253    zero.  We won't allocate the bitmap if we're not using assembler
3254    support for location views, but we have to make the variable
3255    visible for GGC and for code that will be optimized out for lack of
3256    support but that's still parsed and compiled.  We could abstract it
3257    out with macros, but it's not worth it.  */
3258 static GTY(()) bitmap zero_view_p;
3259 
3260 /* Evaluate to TRUE iff N is known to identify the first location view
3261    at its PC.  When not using assembler location view computation,
3262    that must be view number zero.  Otherwise, ZERO_VIEW_P is allocated
3263    and views label numbers recorded in it are the ones known to be
3264    zero.  */
3265 #define ZERO_VIEW_P(N) ((N) == (var_loc_view)0				\
3266 			|| (N) == (var_loc_view)-1			\
3267 			|| (zero_view_p					\
3268 			    && bitmap_bit_p (zero_view_p, (N))))
3269 
3270 /* Return true iff we're to emit .loc directives for the assembler to
3271    generate line number sections.
3272 
3273    When we're not emitting views, all we need from the assembler is
3274    support for .loc directives.
3275 
3276    If we are emitting views, we can only use the assembler's .loc
3277    support if it also supports views.
3278 
3279    When the compiler is emitting the line number programs and
3280    computing view numbers itself, it resets view numbers at known PC
3281    changes and counts from that, and then it emits view numbers as
3282    literal constants in locviewlists.  There are cases in which the
3283    compiler is not sure about PC changes, e.g. when extra alignment is
3284    requested for a label.  In these cases, the compiler may not reset
3285    the view counter, and the potential PC advance in the line number
3286    program will use an opcode that does not reset the view counter
3287    even if the PC actually changes, so that compiler and debug info
3288    consumer can keep view numbers in sync.
3289 
3290    When the compiler defers view computation to the assembler, it
3291    emits symbolic view numbers in locviewlists, with the exception of
3292    views known to be zero (forced resets, or reset after
3293    compiler-visible PC changes): instead of emitting symbols for
3294    these, we emit literal zero and assert the assembler agrees with
3295    the compiler's assessment.  We could use symbolic views everywhere,
3296    instead of special-casing zero views, but then we'd be unable to
3297    optimize out locviewlists that contain only zeros.  */
3298 
3299 static bool
3300 output_asm_line_debug_info (void)
3301 {
3302   return (dwarf2out_as_loc_support
3303 	  && (dwarf2out_as_locview_support
3304 	      || !debug_variable_location_views));
3305 }
3306 
3307 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3308    This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values.  */
3309 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE  -10
3310 
3311 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes.  */
3312 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE  ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
3313 
3314 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode.  */
3315 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE  (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3316 
3317 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3318    In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3319    the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3320    is not made available by the GCC front-end.  */
3321 #define	DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3322 
3323 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle.  */
3324 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
3325 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
3326 #endif
3327 
3328 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3329    the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section.  */
3330 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3331 
3332 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit.  */
3333 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
3334 
3335 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections.  */
3336 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
3337 
3338 /* A list of CU DIEs that have been separated.  */
3339 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *cu_die_list;
3340 
3341 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated.  */
3342 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3343 
3344 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
3345    DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set.  */
3346 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
3347 
3348 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
3349 {
3350   typedef const char *compare_type;
3351 
3352   static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
3353   static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
3354 };
3355 
3356 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit.  */
3357 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
3358 
3359 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
3360 {
3361   typedef tree compare_type;
3362 
3363   static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
3364   static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
3365 };
3366 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3367    The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl.  */
3368 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
3369 
3370 struct GTY ((for_user)) variable_value_struct {
3371   unsigned int decl_id;
3372   vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *dies;
3373 };
3374 
3375 struct variable_value_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<variable_value_struct>
3376 {
3377   typedef tree compare_type;
3378 
3379   static hashval_t hash (variable_value_struct *);
3380   static bool equal (variable_value_struct *, tree);
3381 };
3382 /* A hash table of DIEs that contain DW_OP_GNU_variable_value with
3383    dw_val_class_decl_ref class, indexed by FUNCTION_DECLs which is
3384    DECL_CONTEXT of the referenced VAR_DECLs.  */
3385 static GTY (()) hash_table<variable_value_hasher> *variable_value_hash;
3386 
3387 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
3388 {
3389   static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
3390   static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
3391 };
3392 
3393 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
3394    The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent.  */
3395 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
3396 
3397 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
3398     dw_die_ref die;
3399     tree arg;
3400 } die_arg_entry;
3401 
3402 
3403 /* Node of the variable location list.  */
3404 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
3405   /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
3406      EXPR_LIST chain.  For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
3407      in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
3408      is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
3409      location or NULL for padding.  For larger bitsizes,
3410      mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
3411      as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
3412      NULL as second operand.  */
3413   rtx GTY (()) loc;
3414   const char * GTY (()) label;
3415   struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3416   var_loc_view view;
3417 };
3418 
3419 /* Variable location list.  */
3420 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
3421   struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3422 
3423   /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
3424      chained list.  If the list is empty, both first and
3425      last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
3426      or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
3427      to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
3428      Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain.  */
3429   struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3430 
3431   /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
3432      if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
3433      is after section switch.  */
3434   struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
3435 
3436   /* DECL_UID of the variable decl.  */
3437   unsigned int decl_id;
3438 };
3439 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3440 
3441 /* Call argument location list.  */
3442 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
3443   rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
3444   const char * GTY (()) label;
3445   tree GTY (()) block;
3446   bool tail_call_p;
3447   rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
3448   struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3449 };
3450 
3451 
3452 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
3453 {
3454   typedef const_tree compare_type;
3455 
3456   static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
3457   static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
3458 };
3459 
3460 /* Table of decl location linked lists.  */
3461 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
3462 
3463 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain.  */
3464 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
3465 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
3466 
3467 /* Number of call sites in the current function.  */
3468 static int call_site_count = -1;
3469 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function.  */
3470 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
3471 
3472 /* A cached location list.  */
3473 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
3474   /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes.  */
3475   unsigned int decl_id;
3476 
3477   /* The cached location list.  */
3478   dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
3479 };
3480 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3481 
3482 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3483 {
3484 
3485   typedef const_tree compare_type;
3486 
3487   static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3488   static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3489 };
3490 
3491 /* Table of cached location lists.  */
3492 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3493 
3494 /* A vector of references to DIE's that are uniquely identified by their tag,
3495    presence/absence of children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs.  */
3496 static GTY(()) vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *abbrev_die_table;
3497 
3498 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures.  The value
3499    stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3500    invokation and after it returned.  In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3501    that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N.  */
3502 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3503 
3504 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data.  */
3505 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3506 
3507 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3508    for the current function.  This will be set up at the beginning of
3509    assembly for the function.  */
3510 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3511 
3512 /* The two default tables of line number info.  */
3513 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3514 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3515 
3516 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info.  */
3517 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3518 
3519 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3520    refer to.  */
3521 static bool info_section_emitted;
3522 
3523 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3524    accessible names.  */
3525 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3526 
3527 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3528    accessible types.  */
3529 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3530 
3531 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3532    defines/undefines (and file start/end markers).  */
3533 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3534 
3535 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3536    emitted.  */
3537 #define have_macinfo \
3538   ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3539    && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3540    && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3541 
3542 /* Vector of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info.  */
3543 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges, va_gc> *ranges_table;
3544 
3545 /* Vector of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table.  */
3546 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges_by_label, va_gc> *ranges_by_label;
3547 
3548 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3549 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3550 
3551 /* Unique label counter.  */
3552 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3553 
3554 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables.  */
3555 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3556 
3557 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file().  */
3558 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3559 
3560 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym().  */
3561 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3562 
3563 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3564 
3565 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3566    info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3567    generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3568    we do it at the end of compilation.  */
3569 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3570 
3571 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3572    within the current function.  */
3573 static poly_int64 frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3574 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3575 
3576 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3577 
3578 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3579    a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...).  */
3580 enum dw_scalar_form
3581 {
3582   dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3583   dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3584   dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3585 };
3586 
3587 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
3588 
3589 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3590 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3591 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3592 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3593 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3594 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3595 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3596 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3597 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3598 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3599 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3600 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3601 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3602 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3603 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3604 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3605 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3606 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3607 			   HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3608 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3609 			       unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3610 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3611 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3612 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3613 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3614 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3615 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3616 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3617 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3618 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3619 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3620 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3621 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3622 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3623 			     dw_loc_list_ref);
3624 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3625 static void add_AT_view_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3626 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3627 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3628 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3629 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3630 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3631 static void add_AT_symview (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3632 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3633 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3634 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3635 static void add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3636 				const char *);
3637 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3638 			   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3639 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3640                                unsigned long, bool);
3641 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3642 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3643 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3644 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3645 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3646 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3647 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3648 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3649 static bool is_cxx (void);
3650 static bool is_cxx (const_tree);
3651 static bool is_fortran (void);
3652 static bool is_ada (void);
3653 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3654 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3655 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3656 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3657 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3658 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3659 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3660 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3661 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3662 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3663 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3664 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *, var_loc_view);
3665 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3666 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3667 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3668 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3669 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3670 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3671 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3672 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3673 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3674 				   struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3675 struct checksum_attributes;
3676 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3677 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3678 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3679 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3680 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3681 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3682 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3683 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3684 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3685 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3686 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3687 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3688 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3689 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3690 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3691 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3692 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3693 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3694 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3695 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3696 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3697                                                          dw_die_ref,
3698                                                          dw_die_ref);
3699 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3700 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3701 
3702 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3703 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3704 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3705 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3706 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3707 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3708 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3709 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3710 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3711 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3712 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3713 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3714 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3715 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3716 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3717 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3718 static void output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type);
3719 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int, const unsigned char *);
3720 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *, bool);
3721 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3722 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3723 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3724 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3725 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3726 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3727 static void output_aranges (void);
3728 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree, bool = false);
3729 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3730                                   bool *, bool);
3731 static void output_ranges (void);
3732 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3733 static void output_line_info (bool);
3734 static void output_file_names (void);
3735 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree, bool);
3736 static int is_base_type (tree);
3737 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3738 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3739 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3740 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3741 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3742 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3743 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3744 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3745 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3746 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3747 						enum var_init_status);
3748 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3749 						     enum var_init_status);
3750 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, poly_int64,
3751 					 enum var_init_status);
3752 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3753 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3754 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3755 					       enum var_init_status);
3756 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3757 					enum var_init_status);
3758 struct loc_descr_context;
3759 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3760 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3761 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3762 					   struct loc_descr_context *);
3763 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3764 						  struct loc_descr_context *);
3765 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3766 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3767 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3768 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3769 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3770 struct vlr_context;
3771 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3772 					   HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3773 static void add_AT_location_description	(dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3774 					 dw_loc_list_ref);
3775 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3776 						struct vlr_context *);
3777 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3778 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3779 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3780 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3781 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3782 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3783 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3784 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3785 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3786 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3787 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3788 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3789 			     struct loc_descr_context *);
3790 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3791 			    struct loc_descr_context *);
3792 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3793 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3794 static void add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3795 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3796 					     struct vlr_context *);
3797 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3798 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3799 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3800 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3801 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3802 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree, bool = false);
3803 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3804 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3805 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3806 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3807 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3808 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3809 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3810 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3811 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3812 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3813 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3814 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3815 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3816 #if 0
3817 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3818 #endif
3819 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3820 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3821 #if 0
3822 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3823 #endif
3824 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3825 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3826 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die  (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3827 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3828 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3829 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3830 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3831 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3832 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3833 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3834 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3835 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3836 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3837 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3838 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3839 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3840 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3841 						enum debug_info_usage);
3842 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3843 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3844 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3845 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3846 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3847 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3848 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3849 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3850 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3851 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3852 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3853 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3854 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3855 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3856 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3857 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3858 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3859 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3860 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3861 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3862 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3863 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3864 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *, var_loc_view,
3865 				     const char *, var_loc_view, const char *);
3866 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3867 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3868 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3869 
3870 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3871 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3872 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3873 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3874 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3875 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3876 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3877 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3878 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3879 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3880 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3881 				     const char *, const char *);
3882 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3883 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3884 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3885 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3886 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3887 static void resolve_variable_values (void);
3888 
3889 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3890 
3891 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3892 
3893 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3894    relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3895    not need relocation by the DWARF consumer.  */
3896 
3897 enum dtprel_bool
3898 {
3899   dtprel_false = 0,
3900   dtprel_true = 1
3901 };
3902 
3903 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable.  For dtprel_true, we
3904    use DW_OP_const*.  For regular variables, which need both link-time
3905    relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3906    loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*.  */
3907 
3908 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3909 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3910 {
3911   if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3912     return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3913             : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3914   else
3915     return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3916 }
3917 
3918 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description.  If
3919    dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3920    relocation.  */
3921 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3922 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3923 {
3924   dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3925 
3926   ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3927   ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3928   ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3929   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3930     ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3931       = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3932 			      dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3933   else
3934     ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3935 
3936   return ref;
3937 }
3938 
3939 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information.  */
3940 
3941 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3942 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION	".debug_info"
3943 #endif
3944 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3945 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3946 #endif
3947 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION
3948 #define DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION	".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info"
3949 #endif
3950 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3951 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info.dwo"
3952 #endif
3953 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3954 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION	".debug_abbrev"
3955 #endif
3956 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION
3957 #define DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev"
3958 #endif
3959 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3960 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3961 #endif
3962 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3963 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev.dwo"
3964 #endif
3965 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3966 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION	".debug_aranges"
3967 #endif
3968 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3969 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION     ".debug_addr"
3970 #endif
3971 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3972 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION     ".debug_macinfo"
3973 #endif
3974 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION
3975 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION      ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo"
3976 #endif
3977 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3978 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION      ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3979 #endif
3980 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3981 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION  ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo.dwo"
3982 #endif
3983 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3984 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION	".debug_macro"
3985 #endif
3986 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION
3987 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro"
3988 #endif
3989 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3990 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION        ".debug_macro.dwo"
3991 #endif
3992 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3993 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION    ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro.dwo"
3994 #endif
3995 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3996 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION	".debug_line"
3997 #endif
3998 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION
3999 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line"
4000 #endif
4001 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
4002 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
4003 #endif
4004 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION
4005 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line.dwo"
4006 #endif
4007 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4008 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION	".debug_loc"
4009 #endif
4010 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
4011 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION  ".debug_loc.dwo"
4012 #endif
4013 #ifndef DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
4014 #define DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION	".debug_loclists"
4015 #endif
4016 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
4017 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION  ".debug_loclists.dwo"
4018 #endif
4019 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4020 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION	\
4021   ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
4022    ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
4023 #endif
4024 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
4025 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION	\
4026   ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
4027    ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
4028 #endif
4029 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
4030 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
4031 #endif
4032 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
4033 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
4034 #endif
4035 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
4036 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str_offsets.dwo"
4037 #endif
4038 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4039 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION  ".debug_str"
4040 #endif
4041 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION
4042 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str"
4043 #endif
4044 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
4045 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION   ".debug_str.dwo"
4046 #endif
4047 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION
4048 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str.dwo"
4049 #endif
4050 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4051 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION	".debug_ranges"
4052 #endif
4053 #ifndef DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
4054 #define DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION	".debug_rnglists"
4055 #endif
4056 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION
4057 #define DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION  ".debug_line_str"
4058 #endif
4059 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION
4060 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION  ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line_str"
4061 #endif
4062 
4063 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data.  */
4064 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4065 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME	".text"
4066 #endif
4067 
4068 /* Section flags for .debug_str section.  */
4069 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS                                 \
4070   (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings               \
4071    ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1        \
4072    : SECTION_DEBUG)
4073 
4074 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section.  */
4075 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
4076 
4077 /* Attribute used to refer to the macro section.  */
4078 #define DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_AT_macros \
4079 		   : dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros)
4080 
4081 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4082    the section names themselves.  */
4083 
4084 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4085 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL                 "Ltext"
4086 #endif
4087 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4088 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL             "Ltext_cold"
4089 #endif
4090 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4091 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL           "Ldebug_line"
4092 #endif
4093 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4094 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL   "Lskeleton_debug_line"
4095 #endif
4096 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4097 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL           "Ldebug_info"
4098 #endif
4099 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4100 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL   "Lskeleton_debug_info"
4101 #endif
4102 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4103 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL         "Ldebug_abbrev"
4104 #endif
4105 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4106 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
4107 #endif
4108 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
4109 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL           "Ldebug_addr"
4110 #endif
4111 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4112 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL                    "Ldebug_loc"
4113 #endif
4114 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4115 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL         "Ldebug_ranges"
4116 #endif
4117 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4118 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL         "Ldebug_macinfo"
4119 #endif
4120 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
4121 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL          "Ldebug_macro"
4122 #endif
4123 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
4124 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
4125 
4126 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4127    (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4128    options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4129    If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4130    typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary.  */
4131 
4132 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4133 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4134 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4135 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4136 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4137 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4138 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4139 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4140 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4141 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4142 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4143 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4144 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4145 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4146 static char ranges_base_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4147 
4148 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4149 #define TEXT_END_LABEL		"Letext"
4150 #endif
4151 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4152 #define COLD_END_LABEL          "Letext_cold"
4153 #endif
4154 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4155 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL	"LBB"
4156 #endif
4157 #ifndef BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL
4158 #define BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL "LBI"
4159 #endif
4160 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4161 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL		"LBE"
4162 #endif
4163 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4164 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL		"LM"
4165 #endif
4166 
4167 
4168 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit.  */
4169 static dw_die_ref
4170 comp_unit_die (void)
4171 {
4172   if (!single_comp_unit_die)
4173     single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
4174   return single_comp_unit_die;
4175 }
4176 
4177 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4178    called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE.  */
4179 
4180 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4181 
4182 void
4183 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4184 {
4185   demangle_name_func = func;
4186 }
4187 
4188 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register.  */
4189 
4190 static inline int
4191 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
4192 {
4193   return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4194 	  || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4195 	      && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4196 }
4197 
4198 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4199    removed.  */
4200 
4201 static inline tree
4202 type_main_variant (tree type)
4203 {
4204   type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4205 
4206   /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4207      variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4208      members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4209      front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4210      here.  */
4211   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4212     while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4213       type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4214 
4215   return type;
4216 }
4217 
4218 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type.  */
4219 
4220 static inline int
4221 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
4222 {
4223   enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4224 
4225   return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4226 	  || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4227 }
4228 
4229 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference.  */
4230 
4231 static void
4232 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
4233 {
4234   sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
4235 }
4236 
4237 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type.  */
4238 
4239 static unsigned long int
4240 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4241 {
4242   if (ref->die_offset)
4243     return ref->die_offset;
4244   if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
4245     {
4246       calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
4247       gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4248     }
4249   return ref->die_offset;
4250 }
4251 
4252 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type.  */
4253 
4254 static unsigned long int
4255 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4256 {
4257   gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4258   return ref->die_offset;
4259 }
4260 
4261 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name.  */
4262 
4263 static const char *
4264 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4265 {
4266   const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
4267 
4268   if (name != NULL)
4269     return name;
4270 
4271   return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4272 }
4273 
4274 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name.  */
4275 
4276 static const char *
4277 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4278 {
4279   const char *name;
4280 
4281   switch (attr)
4282     {
4283 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4284     case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
4285       return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
4286 #else
4287     case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4288       return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4289 #endif
4290 
4291 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4292     case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
4293       return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
4294 #else
4295     case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4296       return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4297 #endif
4298     }
4299 
4300   name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
4301 
4302   if (name != NULL)
4303     return name;
4304 
4305   return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4306 }
4307 
4308 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name.  */
4309 
4310 static const char *
4311 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4312 {
4313   const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
4314 
4315   if (name != NULL)
4316     return name;
4317 
4318   return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4319 }
4320 
4321 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl.  The decl may be an inlined
4322    instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4323    function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4324    to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4325    given block.  */
4326 
4327 static tree
4328 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
4329 {
4330   if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4331     return NULL_TREE;
4332 
4333   /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
4334      we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4335   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4336     return NULL_TREE;
4337 
4338   /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4339      most distant ancestor, this should never happen.  */
4340   gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4341 
4342   return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4343 }
4344 
4345 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any.  In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4346    of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4347    parameter.  */
4348 
4349 static tree
4350 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4351 {
4352   tree context = NULL_TREE;
4353 
4354   if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4355     context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4356   else
4357     context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4358       (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4359 
4360   if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4361     context = NULL_TREE;
4362 
4363   return context;
4364 }
4365 
4366 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE.  */
4367 
4368 static inline void
4369 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
4370 {
4371   /* Maybe this should be an assert?  */
4372   if (die == NULL)
4373     return;
4374 
4375   if (flag_checking)
4376     {
4377       /* Check we do not add duplicate attrs.  Can't use get_AT here
4378          because that recurses to the specification/abstract origin DIE.  */
4379       dw_attr_node *a;
4380       unsigned ix;
4381       FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4382 	gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != attr->dw_attr);
4383     }
4384 
4385   vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
4386   vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
4387 }
4388 
4389 static inline enum dw_val_class
4390 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
4391 {
4392   return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4393 }
4394 
4395 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
4396    DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.  String indices
4397    are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
4398    pruning.  */
4399 
4400 static inline unsigned int
4401 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
4402 {
4403   if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4404     return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
4405   else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
4406     return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
4407   return NOT_INDEXED;
4408 }
4409 
4410 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE.  */
4411 
4412 static inline void
4413 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4414 {
4415   dw_attr_node attr;
4416 
4417   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4418   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4419   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4420   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4421   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4422 }
4423 
4424 static inline unsigned
4425 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
4426 {
4427   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4428   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4429 }
4430 
4431 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4432 
4433 static inline void
4434 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4435 {
4436   dw_attr_node attr;
4437 
4438   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4439   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4440   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4441   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4442   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4443 }
4444 
4445 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4446 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
4447 {
4448   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const
4449 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const_implicit));
4450   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4451 }
4452 
4453 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4454 
4455 static inline void
4456 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4457 		 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4458 {
4459   dw_attr_node attr;
4460 
4461   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4462   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4463   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4464   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4465   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4466 }
4467 
4468 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4469 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
4470 {
4471   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const
4472 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit));
4473   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4474 }
4475 
4476 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4477 
4478 static inline void
4479 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4480 	     const wide_int& w)
4481 {
4482   dw_attr_node attr;
4483 
4484   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4485   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
4486   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4487   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
4488   *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
4489   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4490 }
4491 
4492 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4493 
4494 static inline void
4495 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4496 	       HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
4497 {
4498   dw_attr_node attr;
4499 
4500   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4501   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
4502   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4503   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
4504   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
4505   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4506 }
4507 
4508 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it.  */
4509 
4510 static inline void
4511 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4512 	    unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4513 {
4514   dw_attr_node attr;
4515 
4516   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4517   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4518   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4519   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4520   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4521   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4522   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4523 }
4524 
4525 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE.  */
4526 
4527 static inline void
4528 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4529               unsigned char data8[8])
4530 {
4531   dw_attr_node attr;
4532 
4533   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4534   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4535   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4536   memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4537   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4538 }
4539 
4540 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE.  When using
4541    dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4542    final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4543    references.  */
4544 
4545 static inline void
4546 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4547                     bool force_direct)
4548 {
4549   dw_attr_node attr;
4550   char * lbl_id;
4551 
4552   lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4553   attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4554   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4555   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4556   if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4557     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4558       = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4559   else
4560     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4561   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4562 
4563   attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4564   if (dwarf_version < 4)
4565     attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4566   else
4567     attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4568   lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4569   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4570   if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4571       && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4572     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4573       = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4574   else
4575     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4576   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4577 }
4578 
4579 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash.  */
4580 
4581 hashval_t
4582 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4583 {
4584   return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4585 }
4586 
4587 bool
4588 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4589 {
4590   return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4591 }
4592 
4593 /* Add STR to the given string hash table.  */
4594 
4595 static struct indirect_string_node *
4596 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4597 			 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4598 {
4599   struct indirect_string_node *node;
4600 
4601   indirect_string_node **slot
4602     = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4603   if (*slot == NULL)
4604     {
4605       node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4606       node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4607       *slot = node;
4608     }
4609   else
4610     node = *slot;
4611 
4612   node->refcount++;
4613   return node;
4614 }
4615 
4616 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table.  */
4617 
4618 static struct indirect_string_node *
4619 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4620 {
4621   if (! debug_str_hash)
4622     debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4623 
4624   return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4625 }
4626 
4627 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE.  */
4628 
4629 static inline void
4630 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4631 {
4632   dw_attr_node attr;
4633   struct indirect_string_node *node;
4634 
4635   node = find_AT_string (str);
4636 
4637   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4638   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4639   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4640   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4641   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4642 }
4643 
4644 static inline const char *
4645 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4646 {
4647   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4648   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4649 }
4650 
4651 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4652    the string inline in the die. */
4653 
4654 static void
4655 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4656 {
4657   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4658   /* Already indirect is a no op.  */
4659   if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
4660       || node->form == DW_FORM_line_strp
4661       || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4662     {
4663       gcc_assert (node->label);
4664       return;
4665     }
4666   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4667   ++dw2_string_counter;
4668   node->label = xstrdup (label);
4669 
4670   if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4671     {
4672       node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4673       node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4674     }
4675   else
4676     {
4677       node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4678       node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4679     }
4680 }
4681 
4682 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish, called to reset indirect
4683    string decisions done for early LTO dwarf output before fat object
4684    dwarf output.  */
4685 
4686 int
4687 reset_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
4688 {
4689   struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
4690   if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4691     {
4692       free (node->label);
4693       node->label = NULL;
4694       node->form = (dwarf_form) 0;
4695       node->index = 0;
4696     }
4697   return 1;
4698 }
4699 
4700 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4701    or out-of-line in .debug_str section.  */
4702 
4703 static enum dwarf_form
4704 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4705 {
4706   unsigned int len;
4707 
4708   if (node->form)
4709     return node->form;
4710 
4711   len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4712 
4713   /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4714      always better to put it inline.  */
4715   if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4716     return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4717 
4718   /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4719      section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4720      single module.  */
4721   if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4722       || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4723 	  && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4724     return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4725 
4726   set_indirect_string (node);
4727 
4728   return node->form;
4729 }
4730 
4731 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4732    output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section.  */
4733 
4734 static enum dwarf_form
4735 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4736 {
4737   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4738   return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4739 }
4740 
4741 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
4742 
4743 static inline void
4744 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4745 {
4746   dw_attr_node attr;
4747   gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4748 
4749   /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4750      a DIE for.  Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE.  */
4751   if (targ_die == NULL)
4752     return;
4753 
4754   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4755   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4756   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4757   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4758   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4759   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4760 }
4761 
4762 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead.  */
4763 
4764 static inline void
4765 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4766 {
4767   gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4768   ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4769   ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4770 }
4771 
4772 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4773    pointer from the specification to the definition.  */
4774 
4775 static inline void
4776 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4777 {
4778   add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4779   gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4780   targ_die->die_definition = die;
4781 }
4782 
4783 static inline dw_die_ref
4784 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4785 {
4786   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4787   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4788 }
4789 
4790 static inline int
4791 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4792 {
4793   if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4794     return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4795 
4796   return 0;
4797 }
4798 
4799 static inline void
4800 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4801 {
4802   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4803   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4804 }
4805 
4806 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
4807 
4808 static inline void
4809 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4810 {
4811   dw_attr_node attr;
4812 
4813   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4814   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4815   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4816   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4817   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4818 }
4819 
4820 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.  */
4821 
4822 static inline void
4823 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4824 {
4825   dw_attr_node attr;
4826 
4827   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4828   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4829   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4830   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4831   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4832 }
4833 
4834 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4835 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4836 {
4837   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4838   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4839 }
4840 
4841 static inline void
4842 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4843 {
4844   dw_attr_node attr;
4845 
4846   if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4847     return;
4848 
4849   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4850   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4851   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4852   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4853   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4854   have_location_lists = true;
4855 }
4856 
4857 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4858 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4859 {
4860   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4861   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4862 }
4863 
4864 /* Add a view list attribute to DIE.  It must have a DW_AT_location
4865    attribute, because the view list complements the location list.  */
4866 
4867 static inline void
4868 add_AT_view_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4869 {
4870   dw_attr_node attr;
4871 
4872   if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4873     return;
4874 
4875   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4876   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_view_list;
4877   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4878   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_view_list = die;
4879   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4880   gcc_checking_assert (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location));
4881   gcc_assert (have_location_lists);
4882 }
4883 
4884 /* Return a pointer to the location list referenced by the attribute.
4885    If the named attribute is a view list, look up the corresponding
4886    DW_AT_location attribute and return its location list.  */
4887 
4888 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4889 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4890 {
4891   gcc_assert (a);
4892   switch (AT_class (a))
4893     {
4894     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
4895       return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4896     case dw_val_class_view_list:
4897       {
4898 	dw_attr_node *l;
4899 	l = get_AT (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_view_list, DW_AT_location);
4900 	if (!l)
4901 	  return NULL;
4902 	gcc_checking_assert (l + 1 == a);
4903 	return AT_loc_list_ptr (l);
4904       }
4905     default:
4906       gcc_unreachable ();
4907     }
4908 }
4909 
4910 /* Return the location attribute value associated with a view list
4911    attribute value.  */
4912 
4913 static inline dw_val_node *
4914 view_list_to_loc_list_val_node (dw_val_node *val)
4915 {
4916   gcc_assert (val->val_class == dw_val_class_view_list);
4917   dw_attr_node *loc = get_AT (val->v.val_view_list, DW_AT_location);
4918   if (!loc)
4919     return NULL;
4920   gcc_checking_assert (&(loc + 1)->dw_attr_val == val);
4921   gcc_assert (AT_class (loc) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4922   return &loc->dw_attr_val;
4923 }
4924 
4925 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4926 {
4927   static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4928   static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4929 };
4930 
4931 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section.  */
4932 
4933 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4934 
4935 /* Hash an address_table_entry.  */
4936 
4937 hashval_t
4938 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4939 {
4940   inchash::hash hstate;
4941   switch (a->kind)
4942     {
4943       case ate_kind_rtx:
4944 	hstate.add_int (0);
4945 	break;
4946       case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4947 	hstate.add_int (1);
4948 	break;
4949       case ate_kind_label:
4950         return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4951       default:
4952         gcc_unreachable ();
4953     }
4954   inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4955   return hstate.end ();
4956 }
4957 
4958 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries.  */
4959 
4960 bool
4961 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4962 {
4963   if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4964     return 0;
4965   switch (a1->kind)
4966     {
4967       case ate_kind_rtx:
4968       case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4969         return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4970       case ate_kind_label:
4971         return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4972       default:
4973         gcc_unreachable ();
4974     }
4975 }
4976 
4977 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry.  */
4978 
4979 void
4980 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4981 {
4982   e->kind = kind;
4983   switch (kind)
4984     {
4985       case ate_kind_rtx:
4986       case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4987         e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4988         break;
4989       case ate_kind_label:
4990         e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4991         break;
4992     }
4993   e->refcount = 0;
4994   e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4995 }
4996 
4997 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table.  Defer setting an
4998    index until output time.  */
4999 
5000 static addr_table_entry *
5001 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
5002 {
5003   addr_table_entry *node;
5004   addr_table_entry finder;
5005 
5006   gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
5007   if (! addr_index_table)
5008     addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
5009   init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
5010   addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
5011 
5012   if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
5013     {
5014       node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
5015       init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
5016       *slot = node;
5017     }
5018   else
5019     node = *slot;
5020 
5021   node->refcount++;
5022   return node;
5023 }
5024 
5025 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
5026    Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
5027    assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
5028    bugs.  */
5029 
5030 static void
5031 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
5032 {
5033   gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
5034   /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen.  */
5035   gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
5036   entry->refcount--;
5037 }
5038 
5039 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
5040    address_table.  */
5041 
5042 static void
5043 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
5044 {
5045   for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
5046     if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
5047       {
5048         gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
5049         remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
5050       }
5051 }
5052 
5053 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
5054    htab_traverse.  Assign an addr_table_entry its index.  All entries
5055    must be collected into the table when this function is called,
5056    because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
5057    in the same order for each run. */
5058 
5059 int
5060 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
5061 {
5062   addr_table_entry *node = *h;
5063 
5064   /* Don't index unreferenced nodes.  */
5065   if (node->refcount == 0)
5066     return 1;
5067 
5068   gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
5069   node->index = *index;
5070   *index += 1;
5071 
5072   return 1;
5073 }
5074 
5075 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE.  When using
5076    dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
5077    final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
5078    force_direct ensures this behavior.  */
5079 
5080 static inline void
5081 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
5082              bool force_direct)
5083 {
5084   dw_attr_node attr;
5085 
5086   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5087   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5088   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5089   if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
5090     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
5091   else
5092     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5093   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5094 }
5095 
5096 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute.  */
5097 
5098 static inline rtx
5099 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
5100 {
5101   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5102   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5103 }
5104 
5105 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE.  */
5106 
5107 static inline void
5108 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5109 	     struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5110 {
5111   dw_attr_node attr;
5112 
5113   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5114   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5115   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5116   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5117   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5118 }
5119 
5120 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute.  */
5121 
5122 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5123 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
5124 {
5125   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file
5126 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file_implicit));
5127   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5128 }
5129 
5130 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE.  */
5131 
5132 static inline void
5133 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5134 		  const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
5135 {
5136   dw_attr_node attr;
5137 
5138   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5139   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
5140   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5141   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
5142   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
5143   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5144 }
5145 
5146 /* Add a symbolic view identifier attribute value to a DIE.  */
5147 
5148 static inline void
5149 add_AT_symview (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5150                const char *view_label)
5151 {
5152   dw_attr_node attr;
5153 
5154   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5155   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_symview;
5156   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5157   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_symbolic_view = xstrdup (view_label);
5158   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5159 }
5160 
5161 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE.  */
5162 
5163 static inline void
5164 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5165                const char *lbl_id)
5166 {
5167   dw_attr_node attr;
5168 
5169   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5170   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5171   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5172   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5173   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
5174     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
5175         = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
5176                                 ate_kind_label);
5177   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5178 }
5179 
5180 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5181    debug_line section.  */
5182 
5183 static inline void
5184 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5185 		const char *label)
5186 {
5187   dw_attr_node attr;
5188 
5189   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5190   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5191   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5192   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5193   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5194 }
5195 
5196 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5197    debug_loclists section.  */
5198 
5199 static inline void
5200 add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5201 		    const char *label)
5202 {
5203   dw_attr_node attr;
5204 
5205   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5206   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loclistsptr;
5207   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5208   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5209   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5210 }
5211 
5212 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5213    debug_macinfo section.  */
5214 
5215 static inline void
5216 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5217 	       const char *label)
5218 {
5219   dw_attr_node attr;
5220 
5221   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5222   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5223   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5224   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5225   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5226 }
5227 
5228 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE.  */
5229 
5230 static inline void
5231 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5232 	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5233 {
5234   dw_attr_node attr;
5235 
5236   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5237   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5238   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5239   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5240   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5241 }
5242 
5243 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE.  When using
5244    dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
5245    final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
5246    force_direct ensures this behavior.  */
5247 
5248 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
5249 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
5250 
5251 static void
5252 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5253                    long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
5254 {
5255   dw_attr_node attr;
5256 
5257   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5258   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5259   /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
5260      offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics.  This
5261      value is read in output_range_list_offset.  */
5262   if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
5263     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
5264   else
5265     attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
5266   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5267   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5268 }
5269 
5270 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute.  */
5271 
5272 static inline const char *
5273 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
5274 {
5275   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
5276   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
5277 }
5278 
5279 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute.  */
5280 
5281 static inline const char *
5282 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
5283 {
5284   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
5285   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
5286 }
5287 
5288 static inline const char *
5289 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
5290 {
5291   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5292 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5293 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
5294 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loclistsptr
5295 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
5296   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5297 }
5298 
5299 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind.  */
5300 
5301 static dw_attr_node *
5302 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5303 {
5304   dw_attr_node *a;
5305   unsigned ix;
5306   dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5307 
5308   if (! die)
5309     return NULL;
5310 
5311   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5312     if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5313       return a;
5314     else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5315 	     || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5316       spec = AT_ref (a);
5317 
5318   if (spec)
5319     return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5320 
5321   return NULL;
5322 }
5323 
5324 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE.  */
5325 
5326 static dw_die_ref
5327 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
5328 {
5329   dw_die_ref t;
5330 
5331   if (!die)
5332     return NULL;
5333 
5334   if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
5335       || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
5336     die = t;
5337 
5338   return die->die_parent;
5339 }
5340 
5341 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5342    DIE.  Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5343    cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5344 
5345 static inline const char *
5346 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5347 {
5348   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5349 
5350   return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5351 }
5352 
5353 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5354    DIE.  Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5355    cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5356 
5357 static inline const char *
5358 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5359 {
5360   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5361 
5362   return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5363 }
5364 
5365 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5366    NULL if it is not present.  */
5367 
5368 static inline const char *
5369 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5370 {
5371   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5372 
5373   return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5374 }
5375 
5376 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5377    if it is not present.  */
5378 
5379 static inline int
5380 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5381 {
5382   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5383 
5384   return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5385 }
5386 
5387 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5388    if it is not present.  */
5389 
5390 static inline unsigned
5391 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5392 {
5393   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5394 
5395   return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5396 }
5397 
5398 static inline dw_die_ref
5399 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5400 {
5401   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5402 
5403   return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5404 }
5405 
5406 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5407 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5408 {
5409   dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5410 
5411   return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5412 }
5413 
5414 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++.  */
5415 
5416 static inline bool
5417 is_cxx (void)
5418 {
5419   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5420 
5421   return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
5422 	  || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
5423 }
5424 
5425 /* Return TRUE if DECL was created by the C++ frontend.  */
5426 
5427 static bool
5428 is_cxx (const_tree decl)
5429 {
5430   if (in_lto_p)
5431     {
5432       const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5433       if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5434 	return strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context), "GNU C++", 7) == 0;
5435     }
5436   return is_cxx ();
5437 }
5438 
5439 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran.  */
5440 
5441 static inline bool
5442 is_fortran (void)
5443 {
5444   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5445 
5446   return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5447 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5448 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
5449 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
5450 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
5451 }
5452 
5453 static inline bool
5454 is_fortran (const_tree decl)
5455 {
5456   if (in_lto_p)
5457     {
5458       const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5459       if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5460 	return (strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5461 			 "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0
5462 		|| strcmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5463 			   "GNU F77") == 0);
5464     }
5465   return is_fortran ();
5466 }
5467 
5468 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada.  */
5469 
5470 static inline bool
5471 is_ada (void)
5472 {
5473   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5474 
5475   return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5476 }
5477 
5478 /* Remove the specified attribute if present.  Return TRUE if removal
5479    was successful.  */
5480 
5481 static bool
5482 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5483 {
5484   dw_attr_node *a;
5485   unsigned ix;
5486 
5487   if (! die)
5488     return false;
5489 
5490   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5491     if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5492       {
5493 	if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5494 	  if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5495 	    a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5496 
5497 	/* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5498 	   that are needed.  */
5499 	die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
5500 	return true;
5501       }
5502   return false;
5503 }
5504 
5505 /* Remove CHILD from its parent.  PREV must have the property that
5506    PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD.  Does not alter CHILD.  */
5507 
5508 static void
5509 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5510 {
5511   gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5512   gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5513   if (prev == child)
5514     {
5515       gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5516       prev = NULL;
5517     }
5518   else
5519     prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5520   if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5521     child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5522   child->die_sib = NULL;
5523 }
5524 
5525 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD.  PREV must have the property that
5526    PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD.  Does not alter OLD_CHILD.  */
5527 
5528 static void
5529 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
5530 {
5531   dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
5532 
5533   gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
5534   gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
5535 
5536   new_child->die_parent = parent;
5537   if (prev == old_child)
5538     {
5539       gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
5540       new_child->die_sib = new_child;
5541     }
5542   else
5543     {
5544       prev->die_sib = new_child;
5545       new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
5546     }
5547   if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
5548     old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
5549   old_child->die_sib = NULL;
5550 }
5551 
5552 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT.  */
5553 
5554 static void
5555 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5556 {
5557   dw_die_ref c;
5558   new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
5559   old_parent->die_child = NULL;
5560   FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
5561 }
5562 
5563 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG.  Do nothing if no child
5564    matches TAG.  */
5565 
5566 static void
5567 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5568 {
5569   dw_die_ref c;
5570 
5571   c = die->die_child;
5572   if (c) do {
5573     dw_die_ref prev = c;
5574     c = c->die_sib;
5575     while (c->die_tag == tag)
5576       {
5577 	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5578 	c->die_parent = NULL;
5579 	/* Might have removed every child.  */
5580 	if (die->die_child == NULL)
5581 	  return;
5582 	c = prev->die_sib;
5583       }
5584   } while (c != die->die_child);
5585 }
5586 
5587 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE.  */
5588 
5589 static void
5590 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5591 {
5592   /* FIXME this should probably be an assert.  */
5593   if (! die || ! child_die)
5594     return;
5595   gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5596 
5597   child_die->die_parent = die;
5598   if (die->die_child)
5599     {
5600       child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5601       die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5602     }
5603   else
5604     child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5605   die->die_child = child_die;
5606 }
5607 
5608 /* Like add_child_die, but put CHILD_DIE after AFTER_DIE.  */
5609 
5610 static void
5611 add_child_die_after (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die,
5612 		     dw_die_ref after_die)
5613 {
5614   gcc_assert (die
5615 	      && child_die
5616 	      && after_die
5617 	      && die->die_child
5618 	      && die != child_die);
5619 
5620   child_die->die_parent = die;
5621   child_die->die_sib = after_die->die_sib;
5622   after_die->die_sib = child_die;
5623   if (die->die_child == after_die)
5624     die->die_child = child_die;
5625 }
5626 
5627 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
5628    NEW_PARENT.  */
5629 
5630 static void
5631 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5632 {
5633   for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5634     if (p->die_sib == child)
5635       {
5636 	remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5637 	break;
5638       }
5639   add_child_die (new_parent, child);
5640 }
5641 
5642 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5643    is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5644    This is done by removing and re-adding it.  */
5645 
5646 static void
5647 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5648 {
5649   /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5650      specification DIE at toplevel.  */
5651   if (child->die_parent != parent)
5652     {
5653       dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5654 
5655       if (tmp)
5656 	child = tmp;
5657     }
5658 
5659   gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5660 	      || (child->die_parent
5661 		  == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5662 
5663   reparent_child (child, parent);
5664 }
5665 
5666 /* Create and return a new die with TAG_VALUE as tag.  */
5667 
5668 static inline dw_die_ref
5669 new_die_raw (enum dwarf_tag tag_value)
5670 {
5671   dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5672   die->die_tag = tag_value;
5673   return die;
5674 }
5675 
5676 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE.  If
5677    PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5678    associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5679    later.  */
5680 
5681 static inline dw_die_ref
5682 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5683 {
5684   dw_die_ref die = new_die_raw (tag_value);
5685 
5686   if (parent_die != NULL)
5687     add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5688   else
5689     {
5690       limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5691 
5692       /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5693 	 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5694 	 streaming.  */
5695       if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5696 	  /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5697 	     breaking out COMDAT units late.  */
5698 	  && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5699 	  && tag_value != DW_TAG_skeleton_unit
5700 	  && !early_dwarf
5701 	  /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5702 	     only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5703 	     them up.  */
5704 	  && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5705 	      || !decl_function_context (t))
5706 	  /* Same as nested functions above but for types.  Types that
5707 	     are local to a function will be fixed in
5708 	     decls_for_scope.  */
5709 	  && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5710 	      || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5711 	      || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5712 	  /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5713 	     especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5714 	     dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception.  */
5715 	  && !in_lto_p)
5716 	{
5717 	  fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5718 	  debug_generic_stmt (t);
5719 	  gcc_unreachable ();
5720 	}
5721 
5722       limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5723       limbo_node->die = die;
5724       limbo_node->created_for = t;
5725       limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5726       limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5727     }
5728 
5729   return die;
5730 }
5731 
5732 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier.  */
5733 
5734 static inline dw_die_ref
5735 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5736 {
5737   dw_die_ref die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5738   if (die && die->removed)
5739     {
5740       TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = NULL;
5741       return NULL;
5742     }
5743   return die;
5744 }
5745 
5746 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5747    anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5748    anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef.  */
5749 
5750 static inline dw_die_ref
5751 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5752 {
5753   if (type
5754       && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5755       && type_die
5756       && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5757       && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5758     type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5759   return type_die;
5760 }
5761 
5762 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5763    typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5764    the naming typedef.  This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5765    equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5766    the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5767    struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5768 
5769    [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5770    a naming typedef is.  */
5771 
5772 static inline dw_die_ref
5773 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5774 {
5775   dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5776   return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5777 }
5778 
5779 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier.  */
5780 
5781 static inline void
5782 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5783 {
5784   TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5785 }
5786 
5787 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct).  */
5788 
5789 inline hashval_t
5790 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5791 {
5792   return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5793 }
5794 
5795 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y.  */
5796 
5797 inline bool
5798 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5799 {
5800   return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5801 }
5802 
5803 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration.  */
5804 
5805 static inline dw_die_ref
5806 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5807 {
5808   dw_die_ref *die = decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl),
5809 							 NO_INSERT);
5810   if (!die)
5811     return NULL;
5812   if ((*die)->removed)
5813     {
5814       decl_die_table->clear_slot (die);
5815       return NULL;
5816     }
5817   return *die;
5818 }
5819 
5820 
5821 /* For DECL which might have early dwarf output query a SYMBOL + OFFSET
5822    style reference.  Return true if we found one refering to a DIE for
5823    DECL, otherwise return false.  */
5824 
5825 static bool
5826 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
5827 			    unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off)
5828 {
5829   dw_die_ref die;
5830 
5831   if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5832     return false;
5833 
5834   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5835     die = BLOCK_DIE (decl);
5836   else
5837     die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
5838   if (!die)
5839     return false;
5840 
5841   /* During WPA stage we currently use DIEs to store the
5842      decl <-> label + offset map.  That's quite inefficient but it
5843      works for now.  */
5844   if (flag_wpa)
5845     {
5846       dw_die_ref ref = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
5847       if (!ref)
5848 	{
5849 	  gcc_assert (die == comp_unit_die ());
5850 	  return false;
5851 	}
5852       *off = ref->die_offset;
5853       *sym = ref->die_id.die_symbol;
5854       return true;
5855     }
5856 
5857   /* Similar to get_ref_die_offset_label, but using the "correct"
5858      label.  */
5859   *off = die->die_offset;
5860   while (die->die_parent)
5861     die = die->die_parent;
5862   /* For the containing CU DIE we compute a die_symbol in
5863      compute_comp_unit_symbol.  */
5864   gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
5865 	      && die->die_id.die_symbol != NULL);
5866   *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
5867   return true;
5868 }
5869 
5870 /* Add a reference of kind ATTR_KIND to a DIE at SYMBOL + OFFSET to DIE.  */
5871 
5872 static void
5873 add_AT_external_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5874 			 const char *symbol, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5875 {
5876   /* Create a fake DIE that contains the reference.  Don't use
5877      new_die because we don't want to end up in the limbo list.  */
5878   dw_die_ref ref = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
5879   ref->die_id.die_symbol = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (symbol));
5880   ref->die_offset = offset;
5881   ref->with_offset = 1;
5882   add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, ref);
5883 }
5884 
5885 /* Create a DIE for DECL if required and add a reference to a DIE
5886    at SYMBOL + OFFSET which contains attributes dumped early.  */
5887 
5888 static void
5889 dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
5890 				 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off)
5891 {
5892   if (debug_info_level == DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
5893     return;
5894 
5895   if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5896     decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (1000);
5897 
5898   dw_die_ref die
5899     = TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK ? BLOCK_DIE (decl) : lookup_decl_die (decl);
5900   gcc_assert (!die);
5901 
5902   tree ctx;
5903   dw_die_ref parent = NULL;
5904   /* Need to lookup a DIE for the decls context - the containing
5905      function or translation unit.  */
5906   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5907     {
5908       ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5909       /* ???  We do not output DIEs for all scopes thus skip as
5910 	 many DIEs as needed.  */
5911       while (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK
5912 	     && !BLOCK_DIE (ctx))
5913 	ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (ctx);
5914     }
5915   else
5916     ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
5917   /* Peel types in the context stack.  */
5918   while (ctx && TYPE_P (ctx))
5919     ctx = TYPE_CONTEXT (ctx);
5920   /* Likewise namespaces in case we do not want to emit DIEs for them.  */
5921   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
5922     while (ctx && TREE_CODE (ctx) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
5923       ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (ctx);
5924   if (ctx)
5925     {
5926       if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK)
5927 	parent = BLOCK_DIE (ctx);
5928       else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
5929 	       /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA.  */
5930 	       && !flag_wpa)
5931 	/* Otherwise all late annotations go to the main CU which
5932 	   imports the original CUs.  */
5933 	parent = comp_unit_die ();
5934       else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == FUNCTION_DECL
5935 	       && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL
5936 	       && TREE_CODE (decl) != BLOCK)
5937 	/* Leave function local entities parent determination to when
5938 	   we process scope vars.  */
5939 	;
5940       else
5941 	parent = lookup_decl_die (ctx);
5942     }
5943   else
5944     /* In some cases the FEs fail to set DECL_CONTEXT properly.
5945        Handle this case gracefully by globalizing stuff.  */
5946     parent = comp_unit_die ();
5947   /* Create a DIE "stub".  */
5948   switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
5949     {
5950     case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
5951       if (! flag_wpa)
5952 	{
5953 	  die = comp_unit_die ();
5954 	  dw_die_ref import = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_unit, die, NULL_TREE);
5955 	  add_AT_external_die_ref (import, DW_AT_import, sym, off);
5956 	  /* We re-target all CU decls to the LTRANS CU DIE, so no need
5957 	     to create a DIE for the original CUs.  */
5958 	  return;
5959 	}
5960       /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA.  */
5961       die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, decl);
5962       break;
5963     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
5964       if (is_fortran (decl))
5965 	die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, parent, decl);
5966       else
5967 	die = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, parent, decl);
5968       break;
5969     case FUNCTION_DECL:
5970       die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, parent, decl);
5971       break;
5972     case VAR_DECL:
5973       die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5974       break;
5975     case RESULT_DECL:
5976       die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5977       break;
5978     case PARM_DECL:
5979       die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, parent, decl);
5980       break;
5981     case CONST_DECL:
5982       die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, parent, decl);
5983       break;
5984     case LABEL_DECL:
5985       die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, parent, decl);
5986       break;
5987     case BLOCK:
5988       die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, parent, decl);
5989       break;
5990     default:
5991       gcc_unreachable ();
5992     }
5993   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5994     BLOCK_DIE (decl) = die;
5995   else
5996     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
5997 
5998   /* Add a reference to the DIE providing early debug at $sym + off.  */
5999   add_AT_external_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, sym, off);
6000 }
6001 
6002 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list).  */
6003 
6004 inline hashval_t
6005 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
6006 {
6007   return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
6008 }
6009 
6010 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
6011    UID of decl *Y.  */
6012 
6013 inline bool
6014 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
6015 {
6016   return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
6017 }
6018 
6019 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration.  */
6020 
6021 static inline var_loc_list *
6022 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
6023 {
6024   if (!decl_loc_table)
6025     return NULL;
6026   return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
6027 }
6028 
6029 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list).  */
6030 
6031 inline hashval_t
6032 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
6033 {
6034   return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
6035 }
6036 
6037 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
6038    UID of decl *Y.  */
6039 
6040 inline bool
6041 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
6042 {
6043   return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
6044 }
6045 
6046 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration.  */
6047 
6048 static void
6049 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
6050 {
6051   unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
6052 
6053   *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
6054   decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
6055 }
6056 
6057 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST.  */
6058 
6059 static HOST_WIDE_INT
6060 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
6061 {
6062   int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
6063   if (ret)
6064     return ret;
6065   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
6066 	      && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
6067   return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
6068 }
6069 
6070 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST.  */
6071 
6072 static rtx *
6073 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
6074 {
6075   if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
6076     return &XEXP (piece, 0);
6077   else
6078     return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
6079 }
6080 
6081 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
6082    Next is the chain of following piece nodes.  */
6083 
6084 static rtx_expr_list *
6085 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
6086 {
6087   if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
6088     return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
6089   else
6090     return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
6091 					       GEN_INT (bitsize),
6092 					       loc_note), next);
6093 }
6094 
6095 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
6096    LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE.  */
6097 
6098 static rtx
6099 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
6100 		      HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
6101 {
6102   if (bitsize != -1)
6103     {
6104       loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
6105       if (bitpos != 0)
6106 	loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
6107     }
6108   return loc_note;
6109 }
6110 
6111 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
6112    place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
6113    *SRC to *DEST while modifying it.  Location BITPOS is modified
6114    to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
6115    not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
6116    When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
6117    earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
6118    to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
6119    where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits.  */
6120 
6121 static void
6122 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
6123 		   HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
6124 		   HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
6125 {
6126   HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
6127   bool copy = inner != NULL;
6128 
6129   if (copy)
6130     {
6131       /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos.  */
6132       while (src != inner)
6133 	{
6134 	  *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
6135 				   decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
6136 	  dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6137 	  src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
6138 	}
6139     }
6140   /* Add padding if needed.  */
6141   if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
6142     {
6143       *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
6144 			       copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
6145       dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6146     }
6147   else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
6148     {
6149       gcc_assert (!copy);
6150       /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
6151 	 just update the location for it and return.  */
6152       *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
6153       return;
6154     }
6155   /* Add the piece that changed.  */
6156   *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
6157   dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6158   /* Skip over pieces that overlap it.  */
6159   diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
6160   if (!copy)
6161     src = dest;
6162   while (diff > 0 && *src)
6163     {
6164       rtx piece = *src;
6165       diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
6166       if (copy)
6167 	src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
6168       else
6169 	{
6170 	  *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
6171 	  free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
6172 	}
6173     }
6174   /* Add padding if needed.  */
6175   if (diff < 0 && *src)
6176     {
6177       if (!copy)
6178 	dest = src;
6179       *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
6180       dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6181     }
6182   if (!copy)
6183     return;
6184   /* Finally copy all nodes following it.  */
6185   while (*src)
6186     {
6187       *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
6188 			       decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
6189       dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6190       src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
6191     }
6192 }
6193 
6194 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL.  */
6195 
6196 static struct var_loc_node *
6197 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label, var_loc_view view)
6198 {
6199   unsigned int decl_id;
6200   var_loc_list *temp;
6201   struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
6202   HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
6203 
6204   if (VAR_P (decl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
6205     {
6206       tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
6207       if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
6208 	  || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
6209 	      && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
6210 	{
6211 	  bool reverse;
6212 	  tree innerdecl = get_ref_base_and_extent_hwi (realdecl, &bitpos,
6213 							&bitsize, &reverse);
6214 	  if (!innerdecl
6215 	      || !DECL_P (innerdecl)
6216 	      || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
6217 	      || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
6218 	      || bitsize == 0
6219 	      || bitpos + bitsize > 256)
6220 	    return NULL;
6221 	  decl = innerdecl;
6222 	}
6223     }
6224 
6225   decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
6226   var_loc_list **slot
6227     = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
6228   if (*slot == NULL)
6229     {
6230       temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
6231       temp->decl_id = decl_id;
6232       *slot = temp;
6233     }
6234   else
6235     temp = *slot;
6236 
6237   /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
6238      even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry.  */
6239   if (temp->last
6240       && temp->first == temp->last
6241       && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
6242       && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
6243       && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
6244       && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
6245       && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
6246       && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
6247 	 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
6248       && prev_real_insn (as_a<rtx_insn *> (temp->first->loc)) == NULL_RTX
6249       && (bitsize != -1
6250 	  || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
6251 			   NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
6252 	  || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
6253 	      != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
6254     {
6255       loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6256       temp->first->next = loc;
6257       temp->last = loc;
6258       loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6259     }
6260   else if (temp->last)
6261     {
6262       struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
6263       rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
6264       HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
6265       if (last->next)
6266 	{
6267 	  last = last->next;
6268 	  gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
6269 	}
6270       if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
6271 	{
6272 	  piece_loc = &last->loc;
6273 	  do
6274 	    {
6275 	      HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
6276 	      if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
6277 		break;
6278 	      piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
6279 	      piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
6280 	    }
6281 	  while (*piece_loc);
6282 	}
6283       /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
6284 	 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
6285 	 last element.  */
6286       if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0 && last->view == view)
6287 	{
6288 	  /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
6289 	     insns since last note, just modify the last node.  */
6290 	  if (piece_loc != NULL)
6291 	    {
6292 	      adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
6293 				 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6294 	      return NULL;
6295 	    }
6296 	  /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it.  */
6297 	  if (temp->last != last)
6298 	    {
6299 	      temp->last->next = NULL;
6300 	      unused = last;
6301 	      last = temp->last;
6302 	      gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0 || last->view != view);
6303 	    }
6304 	  else
6305 	    {
6306 	      gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
6307 			  || (temp->first->next == temp->last
6308 			      && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
6309 	      memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
6310 	      temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6311 	      return temp->last;
6312 	    }
6313 	}
6314       if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
6315 	last_loc_note = last->loc;
6316       else if (piece_loc != NULL
6317 	       && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
6318 	       && piece_bitpos == bitpos
6319 	       && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
6320 	last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
6321       else
6322 	last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
6323       /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
6324 	 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
6325 	 we have nothing to do.  */
6326       if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
6327 	  || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
6328 			    NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
6329 	  || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6330 	       != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
6331 	      && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6332 		   == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
6333 		  || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
6334 		      == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
6335 	{
6336 	  /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST.  If the last
6337 	     element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
6338 	     memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one.  */
6339 	  if (unused)
6340 	    {
6341 	      loc = unused;
6342 	      memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
6343 	    }
6344 	  else
6345 	    loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6346 	  if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
6347 	    loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6348 	  else
6349 	    adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
6350 			       bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6351 	  last->next = loc;
6352 	  /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
6353 	     element of the chain, or to the last element in it.  */
6354 	  if (last != temp->last)
6355 	    temp->last = last;
6356 	}
6357       else if (unused)
6358 	ggc_free (unused);
6359     }
6360   else
6361     {
6362       loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6363       temp->first = loc;
6364       temp->last = loc;
6365       loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6366     }
6367   return loc;
6368 }
6369 
6370 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
6371    output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
6372    the DIE internal representation.  */
6373 static int print_indent;
6374 
6375 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent.  */
6376 
6377 static inline void
6378 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
6379 {
6380   fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
6381 }
6382 
6383 /* Print a type signature in hex.  */
6384 
6385 static inline void
6386 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
6387 {
6388   int i;
6389 
6390   for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
6391     fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
6392 }
6393 
6394 static inline void
6395 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
6396 {
6397   if (discr_value->pos)
6398     fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
6399   else
6400     fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
6401 }
6402 
6403 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
6404 
6405 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE.  If
6406    RECURSE, output location descriptor operations.  */
6407 
6408 static void
6409 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6410 {
6411   switch (val->val_class)
6412     {
6413     case dw_val_class_addr:
6414       fprintf (outfile, "address");
6415       break;
6416     case dw_val_class_offset:
6417       fprintf (outfile, "offset");
6418       break;
6419     case dw_val_class_loc:
6420       fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
6421       if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
6422 	fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
6423       else if (recurse)
6424 	{
6425 	  fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
6426 	  print_indent += 4;
6427 	  print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
6428 	  print_indent -= 4;
6429 	}
6430       else
6431 	fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
6432       break;
6433     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6434       fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
6435 	       val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
6436       break;
6437     case dw_val_class_view_list:
6438       val = view_list_to_loc_list_val_node (val);
6439       fprintf (outfile, "location list with views -> labels:%s and %s",
6440 	       val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol,
6441 	       val->v.val_loc_list->vl_symbol);
6442       break;
6443     case dw_val_class_range_list:
6444       fprintf (outfile, "range list");
6445       break;
6446     case dw_val_class_const:
6447     case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6448       fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
6449       break;
6450     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6451     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6452       fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
6453       break;
6454     case dw_val_class_const_double:
6455       fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
6456 			HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
6457 	       val->v.val_double.high,
6458 	       val->v.val_double.low);
6459       break;
6460     case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6461       {
6462 	int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
6463 	fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
6464 	gcc_assert (i > 0);
6465 	if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
6466 	  fprintf (outfile, "0x");
6467 	fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
6468 		 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
6469 	while (--i >= 0)
6470 	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
6471 		   val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
6472 	fprintf (outfile, ")");
6473 	break;
6474       }
6475     case dw_val_class_vec:
6476       fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
6477       break;
6478     case dw_val_class_flag:
6479       fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
6480       break;
6481     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6482       if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
6483 	{
6484 	  dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
6485 
6486 	  if (die->comdat_type_p)
6487 	    {
6488 	      fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
6489 	      print_signature (outfile,
6490 			       die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6491 	    }
6492 	  else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
6493 	    {
6494 	      fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
6495 	      if (die->with_offset)
6496 		fprintf (outfile, " + %ld", die->die_offset);
6497 	    }
6498 	  else
6499 	    fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
6500 	  fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
6501 	}
6502       else
6503 	fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
6504       break;
6505     case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6506       fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
6507 	       val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
6508       break;
6509     case dw_val_class_symview:
6510       fprintf (outfile, "view: %s", val->v.val_symbolic_view);
6511       break;
6512     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6513     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6514     case dw_val_class_macptr:
6515     case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6516     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6517       fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
6518       break;
6519     case dw_val_class_str:
6520       if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
6521 	fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
6522       else
6523 	fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
6524       break;
6525     case dw_val_class_file:
6526     case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6527       fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
6528 	       val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
6529       break;
6530     case dw_val_class_data8:
6531       {
6532 	int i;
6533 
6534 	for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
6535 	  fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
6536 	break;
6537       }
6538     case dw_val_class_discr_value:
6539       print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
6540       break;
6541     case dw_val_class_discr_list:
6542       for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
6543 	   node != NULL;
6544 	   node = node->dw_discr_next)
6545 	{
6546 	  if (node->dw_discr_range)
6547 	    {
6548 	      fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
6549 	      print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6550 	      print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
6551 	    }
6552 	  else
6553 	    print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6554 
6555 	  if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
6556 	    fprintf (outfile, " | ");
6557 	}
6558     default:
6559       break;
6560     }
6561 }
6562 
6563 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute.  */
6564 
6565 static void
6566 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6567 {
6568   print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
6569 }
6570 
6571 
6572 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE.  This
6573    routine is a debugging aid only.  */
6574 
6575 static void
6576 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
6577 {
6578   dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
6579 
6580   if (loc == NULL)
6581     {
6582       print_spaces (outfile);
6583       fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
6584       return;
6585     }
6586 
6587   for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
6588     {
6589       print_spaces (outfile);
6590       fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
6591 	       (void *) l,
6592 	       dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
6593       if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6594 	{
6595 	  fprintf (outfile, " ");
6596 	  print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
6597 	}
6598       if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6599 	{
6600 	  fprintf (outfile, ", ");
6601 	  print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
6602 	}
6603       fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6604     }
6605 }
6606 
6607 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
6608    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
6609 
6610 static void
6611 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
6612 {
6613   dw_attr_node *a;
6614   dw_die_ref c;
6615   unsigned ix;
6616 
6617   print_spaces (outfile);
6618   fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
6619 	   die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
6620 	   (void*) die);
6621   print_spaces (outfile);
6622   fprintf (outfile, "  abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
6623   fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
6624   fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
6625 
6626   if (die->comdat_type_p)
6627     {
6628       print_spaces (outfile);
6629       fprintf (outfile, "  signature: ");
6630       print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6631       fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6632     }
6633 
6634   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6635     {
6636       print_spaces (outfile);
6637       fprintf (outfile, "  %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
6638 
6639       print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
6640       fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6641     }
6642 
6643   if (die->die_child != NULL)
6644     {
6645       print_indent += 4;
6646       FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
6647       print_indent -= 4;
6648     }
6649   if (print_indent == 0)
6650     fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6651 }
6652 
6653 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description.  */
6654 
6655 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6656 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
6657 {
6658   print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
6659 }
6660 
6661 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE.  */
6662 
6663 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6664 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
6665 {
6666   print_die (die, stderr);
6667 }
6668 
6669 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6670 debug (die_struct &ref)
6671 {
6672   print_die (&ref, stderr);
6673 }
6674 
6675 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6676 debug (die_struct *ptr)
6677 {
6678   if (ptr)
6679     debug (*ptr);
6680   else
6681     fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
6682 }
6683 
6684 
6685 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6686    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
6687 
6688 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6689 debug_dwarf (void)
6690 {
6691   print_indent = 0;
6692   print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
6693 }
6694 
6695 /* Verify the DIE tree structure.  */
6696 
6697 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6698 verify_die (dw_die_ref die)
6699 {
6700   gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6701   if (die->die_parent == NULL
6702       && die->die_sib == NULL)
6703     return;
6704   /* Verify the die_sib list is cyclic.  */
6705   dw_die_ref x = die;
6706   do
6707     {
6708       x->die_mark = 1;
6709       x = x->die_sib;
6710     }
6711   while (x && !x->die_mark);
6712   gcc_assert (x == die);
6713   x = die;
6714   do
6715     {
6716       /* Verify all dies have the same parent.  */
6717       gcc_assert (x->die_parent == die->die_parent);
6718       if (x->die_child)
6719 	{
6720 	  /* Verify the child has the proper parent and recurse.  */
6721 	  gcc_assert (x->die_child->die_parent == x);
6722 	  verify_die (x->die_child);
6723 	}
6724       x->die_mark = 0;
6725       x = x->die_sib;
6726     }
6727   while (x && x->die_mark);
6728 }
6729 
6730 /* Sanity checks on DIEs.  */
6731 
6732 static void
6733 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
6734 {
6735   unsigned ix;
6736   dw_attr_node *a;
6737   bool inline_found = false;
6738   int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
6739   int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_column = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
6740   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6741     {
6742       switch (a->dw_attr)
6743 	{
6744 	case DW_AT_inline:
6745 	  if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
6746 	    inline_found = true;
6747 	  break;
6748 	case DW_AT_location:
6749 	  ++n_location;
6750 	  break;
6751 	case DW_AT_low_pc:
6752 	  ++n_low_pc;
6753 	  break;
6754 	case DW_AT_high_pc:
6755 	  ++n_high_pc;
6756 	  break;
6757 	case DW_AT_artificial:
6758 	  ++n_artificial;
6759 	  break;
6760         case DW_AT_decl_column:
6761 	  ++n_decl_column;
6762 	  break;
6763 	case DW_AT_decl_line:
6764 	  ++n_decl_line;
6765 	  break;
6766 	case DW_AT_decl_file:
6767 	  ++n_decl_file;
6768 	  break;
6769 	default:
6770 	  break;
6771 	}
6772     }
6773   if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
6774       || n_decl_column > 1 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
6775     {
6776       fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
6777       debug_dwarf_die (die);
6778       gcc_unreachable ();
6779     }
6780   if (inline_found)
6781     {
6782       /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
6783 	 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
6784 	 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
6785 	 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
6786 	 expansions.  */
6787       FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6788 	gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
6789 		    && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
6790 		    && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
6791 		    && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
6792 		    && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_call_all_calls
6793 		    && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
6794     }
6795 }
6796 
6797 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6798 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6799 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6800 
6801 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression.  */
6802 
6803 static inline void
6804 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6805 {
6806   int tem;
6807   inchash::hash hstate;
6808   hashval_t hash;
6809 
6810   tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
6811   CHECKSUM (tem);
6812   hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6813   hash = hstate.end();
6814   CHECKSUM (hash);
6815 }
6816 
6817 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute.  */
6818 
6819 static void
6820 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6821 {
6822   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6823   rtx r;
6824 
6825   CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
6826 
6827   /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6828      snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters.  */
6829   if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6830     return;
6831 
6832   switch (AT_class (at))
6833     {
6834     case dw_val_class_const:
6835     case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6836       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6837       break;
6838     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6839     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6840       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6841       break;
6842     case dw_val_class_const_double:
6843       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6844       break;
6845     case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6846       CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6847 		      get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6848 		      * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6849       break;
6850     case dw_val_class_vec:
6851       CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6852 		      (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6853 		       * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6854       break;
6855     case dw_val_class_flag:
6856       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
6857       break;
6858     case dw_val_class_str:
6859       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6860       break;
6861 
6862     case dw_val_class_addr:
6863       r = AT_addr (at);
6864       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6865       CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6866       break;
6867 
6868     case dw_val_class_offset:
6869       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6870       break;
6871 
6872     case dw_val_class_loc:
6873       for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6874 	loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6875       break;
6876 
6877     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6878       die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6879       break;
6880 
6881     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6882     case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6883     case dw_val_class_symview:
6884     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6885     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6886     case dw_val_class_macptr:
6887     case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6888     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6889       break;
6890 
6891     case dw_val_class_file:
6892     case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6893       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6894       break;
6895 
6896     case dw_val_class_data8:
6897       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6898       break;
6899 
6900     default:
6901       break;
6902     }
6903 }
6904 
6905 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE.  */
6906 
6907 static void
6908 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6909 {
6910   dw_die_ref c;
6911   dw_attr_node *a;
6912   unsigned ix;
6913 
6914   /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
6915   if (die->die_mark)
6916     {
6917       CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6918       return;
6919     }
6920   die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6921 
6922   CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6923 
6924   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6925     attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6926 
6927   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6928 }
6929 
6930 #undef CHECKSUM
6931 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6932 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6933 
6934 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings.  */
6935 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6936 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6937 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6938 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6939 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6940 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6941   if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6942 
6943 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format.  */
6944 
6945 static void
6946 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6947 {
6948   unsigned char byte;
6949   bool more;
6950 
6951   while (1)
6952     {
6953       byte = (value & 0x7f);
6954       value >>= 7;
6955       more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6956 		|| (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6957       if (more)
6958 	byte |= 0x80;
6959       CHECKSUM (byte);
6960       if (!more)
6961 	break;
6962     }
6963 }
6964 
6965 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format.  */
6966 
6967 static void
6968 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6969 {
6970   while (1)
6971     {
6972       unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
6973       value >>= 7;
6974       if (value != 0)
6975 	/* More bytes to follow.  */
6976 	byte |= 0x80;
6977       CHECKSUM (byte);
6978       if (value == 0)
6979 	break;
6980     }
6981 }
6982 
6983 /* Checksum the context of the DIE.  This adds the names of any
6984    surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum.  */
6985 
6986 static void
6987 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6988 {
6989   const char *name;
6990   dw_die_ref spec;
6991   int tag = die->die_tag;
6992 
6993   if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
6994       && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
6995       && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
6996     return;
6997 
6998   name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6999 
7000   spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7001   if (spec != NULL)
7002     die = spec;
7003 
7004   if (die->die_parent != NULL)
7005     checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
7006 
7007   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
7008   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7009   if (name != NULL)
7010     CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7011 }
7012 
7013 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression.  */
7014 
7015 static inline void
7016 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
7017 {
7018   /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
7019      were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression.  */
7020   if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
7021     {
7022       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7023       CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
7024       return;
7025     }
7026 
7027   /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression.  */
7028   while (loc != NULL)
7029     {
7030       inchash::hash hstate;
7031       hashval_t hash;
7032 
7033       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
7034       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
7035       hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
7036       hash = hstate.end ();
7037       CHECKSUM (hash);
7038       loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
7039     }
7040 }
7041 
7042 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute.  */
7043 
7044 static void
7045 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
7046 		       struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7047 {
7048   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7049   rtx r;
7050 
7051   if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7052     {
7053       dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
7054 
7055       /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
7056 	 name of the target type (if there is a name).  For friend entries,
7057 	 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
7058 	 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
7059 	 is complete or not.  */
7060       if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
7061 	   && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7062 	       || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7063 	       || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7064 	       || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
7065 	  || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
7066 	      && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
7067 	{
7068 	  dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
7069 
7070 	  if (name_attr != NULL)
7071 	    {
7072 	      dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
7073 
7074 	      if (decl == NULL)
7075 		decl = target_die;
7076 	      CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
7077 	      CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7078 	      if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
7079 		checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
7080 	      CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
7081 	      CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7082 	      return;
7083 	    }
7084 	}
7085 
7086       /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
7087          target DIE has already been visited.  If it has, we emit a
7088          backward reference; if not, we descend recursively.  */
7089       if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
7090         {
7091 	  CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
7092 	  CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7093 	  CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
7094         }
7095       else
7096         {
7097 	  dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
7098 
7099 	  if (decl == NULL)
7100 	    decl = target_die;
7101 	  target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7102 	  CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
7103 	  CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7104 	  if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
7105 	    checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
7106 	  die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
7107         }
7108       return;
7109     }
7110 
7111   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
7112   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7113 
7114   switch (AT_class (at))
7115     {
7116     case dw_val_class_const:
7117     case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7118       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7119       CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
7120       break;
7121 
7122     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7123     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7124       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7125       CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
7126       break;
7127 
7128     case dw_val_class_const_double:
7129       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
7130       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
7131       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
7132       break;
7133 
7134     case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7135       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
7136       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
7137 			* HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7138       CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
7139 		      get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
7140 		      * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
7141       break;
7142 
7143     case dw_val_class_vec:
7144       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
7145       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7146 			* at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
7147       CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
7148 		      (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7149 		       * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
7150       break;
7151 
7152     case dw_val_class_flag:
7153       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
7154       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
7155       break;
7156 
7157     case dw_val_class_str:
7158       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
7159       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
7160       break;
7161 
7162     case dw_val_class_addr:
7163       r = AT_addr (at);
7164       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
7165       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
7166       CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
7167       break;
7168 
7169     case dw_val_class_offset:
7170       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7171       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7172       break;
7173 
7174     case dw_val_class_loc:
7175       for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
7176 	loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
7177       break;
7178 
7179     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7180     case dw_val_class_symview:
7181     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7182     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7183     case dw_val_class_macptr:
7184     case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7185     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7186       break;
7187 
7188     case dw_val_class_file:
7189     case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7190       CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
7191       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
7192       break;
7193 
7194     case dw_val_class_data8:
7195       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
7196       break;
7197 
7198     default:
7199       break;
7200     }
7201 }
7202 
7203 struct checksum_attributes
7204 {
7205   dw_attr_node *at_name;
7206   dw_attr_node *at_type;
7207   dw_attr_node *at_friend;
7208   dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
7209   dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
7210   dw_attr_node *at_alignment;
7211   dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
7212   dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
7213   dw_attr_node *at_associated;
7214   dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
7215   dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
7216   dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
7217   dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
7218   dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
7219   dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
7220   dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
7221   dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
7222   dw_attr_node *at_count;
7223   dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
7224   dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
7225   dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
7226   dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
7227   dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
7228   dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
7229   dw_attr_node *at_discr;
7230   dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
7231   dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
7232   dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
7233   dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
7234   dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
7235   dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
7236   dw_attr_node *at_location;
7237   dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
7238   dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
7239   dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
7240   dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
7241   dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
7242   dw_attr_node *at_small;
7243   dw_attr_node *at_segment;
7244   dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
7245   dw_attr_node *at_string_length_bit_size;
7246   dw_attr_node *at_string_length_byte_size;
7247   dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
7248   dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
7249   dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
7250   dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
7251   dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
7252   dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
7253   dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
7254   dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
7255 };
7256 
7257 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum.  */
7258 
7259 static void
7260 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
7261 {
7262   dw_attr_node *a;
7263   unsigned ix;
7264 
7265   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7266     {
7267       switch (a->dw_attr)
7268         {
7269         case DW_AT_name:
7270           attrs->at_name = a;
7271           break;
7272         case DW_AT_type:
7273           attrs->at_type = a;
7274           break;
7275         case DW_AT_friend:
7276           attrs->at_friend = a;
7277           break;
7278         case DW_AT_accessibility:
7279           attrs->at_accessibility = a;
7280           break;
7281         case DW_AT_address_class:
7282           attrs->at_address_class = a;
7283           break;
7284 	case DW_AT_alignment:
7285 	  attrs->at_alignment = a;
7286 	  break;
7287         case DW_AT_allocated:
7288           attrs->at_allocated = a;
7289           break;
7290         case DW_AT_artificial:
7291           attrs->at_artificial = a;
7292           break;
7293         case DW_AT_associated:
7294           attrs->at_associated = a;
7295           break;
7296         case DW_AT_binary_scale:
7297           attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
7298           break;
7299         case DW_AT_bit_offset:
7300           attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
7301           break;
7302         case DW_AT_bit_size:
7303           attrs->at_bit_size = a;
7304           break;
7305         case DW_AT_bit_stride:
7306           attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
7307           break;
7308         case DW_AT_byte_size:
7309           attrs->at_byte_size = a;
7310           break;
7311         case DW_AT_byte_stride:
7312           attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
7313           break;
7314         case DW_AT_const_value:
7315           attrs->at_const_value = a;
7316           break;
7317         case DW_AT_containing_type:
7318           attrs->at_containing_type = a;
7319           break;
7320         case DW_AT_count:
7321           attrs->at_count = a;
7322           break;
7323         case DW_AT_data_location:
7324           attrs->at_data_location = a;
7325           break;
7326         case DW_AT_data_member_location:
7327           attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
7328           break;
7329         case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
7330           attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
7331           break;
7332         case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
7333           attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
7334           break;
7335         case DW_AT_default_value:
7336           attrs->at_default_value = a;
7337           break;
7338         case DW_AT_digit_count:
7339           attrs->at_digit_count = a;
7340           break;
7341         case DW_AT_discr:
7342           attrs->at_discr = a;
7343           break;
7344         case DW_AT_discr_list:
7345           attrs->at_discr_list = a;
7346           break;
7347         case DW_AT_discr_value:
7348           attrs->at_discr_value = a;
7349           break;
7350         case DW_AT_encoding:
7351           attrs->at_encoding = a;
7352           break;
7353         case DW_AT_endianity:
7354           attrs->at_endianity = a;
7355           break;
7356         case DW_AT_explicit:
7357           attrs->at_explicit = a;
7358           break;
7359         case DW_AT_is_optional:
7360           attrs->at_is_optional = a;
7361           break;
7362         case DW_AT_location:
7363           attrs->at_location = a;
7364           break;
7365         case DW_AT_lower_bound:
7366           attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
7367           break;
7368         case DW_AT_mutable:
7369           attrs->at_mutable = a;
7370           break;
7371         case DW_AT_ordering:
7372           attrs->at_ordering = a;
7373           break;
7374         case DW_AT_picture_string:
7375           attrs->at_picture_string = a;
7376           break;
7377         case DW_AT_prototyped:
7378           attrs->at_prototyped = a;
7379           break;
7380         case DW_AT_small:
7381           attrs->at_small = a;
7382           break;
7383         case DW_AT_segment:
7384           attrs->at_segment = a;
7385           break;
7386         case DW_AT_string_length:
7387           attrs->at_string_length = a;
7388           break;
7389 	case DW_AT_string_length_bit_size:
7390 	  attrs->at_string_length_bit_size = a;
7391 	  break;
7392 	case DW_AT_string_length_byte_size:
7393 	  attrs->at_string_length_byte_size = a;
7394 	  break;
7395         case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
7396           attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
7397           break;
7398         case DW_AT_upper_bound:
7399           attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
7400           break;
7401         case DW_AT_use_location:
7402           attrs->at_use_location = a;
7403           break;
7404         case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
7405           attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
7406           break;
7407         case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
7408           attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
7409           break;
7410         case DW_AT_virtuality:
7411           attrs->at_virtuality = a;
7412           break;
7413         case DW_AT_visibility:
7414           attrs->at_visibility = a;
7415           break;
7416         case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
7417           attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
7418           break;
7419         default:
7420           break;
7421         }
7422     }
7423 }
7424 
7425 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes.  */
7426 
7427 static void
7428 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7429 {
7430   dw_die_ref c;
7431   dw_die_ref decl;
7432   struct checksum_attributes attrs;
7433 
7434   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
7435   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
7436 
7437   memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
7438 
7439   decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7440   if (decl != NULL)
7441     collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
7442   collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
7443 
7444   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
7445   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
7446   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
7447   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
7448   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
7449   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
7450   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
7451   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
7452   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
7453   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
7454   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
7455   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
7456   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
7457   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
7458   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
7459   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
7460   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
7461   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
7462   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
7463   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
7464   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
7465   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
7466   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
7467   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
7468   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
7469   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
7470   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
7471   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
7472   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
7473   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
7474   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
7475   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
7476   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
7477   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
7478   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
7479   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
7480   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
7481   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_bit_size);
7482   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_byte_size);
7483   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
7484   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
7485   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
7486   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
7487   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
7488   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
7489   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
7490   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
7491   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
7492   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
7493   CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_alignment);
7494 
7495   /* Checksum the child DIEs.  */
7496   c = die->die_child;
7497   if (c) do {
7498     dw_attr_node *name_attr;
7499 
7500     c = c->die_sib;
7501     name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
7502     if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7503       {
7504 	/* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates.  */
7505       }
7506     else if (name_attr != NULL
7507 	     && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
7508       {
7509 	/* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
7510 	   functions.  */
7511         CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
7512         CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
7513         CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7514       }
7515     else
7516       {
7517 	/* Use a deep checksum for other children.  */
7518         /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking.  */
7519         if (c->die_mark == 0)
7520           c->die_mark = -1;
7521         die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
7522       }
7523   } while (c != die->die_child);
7524 
7525   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
7526 }
7527 
7528 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash.  */
7529 static void
7530 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
7531 {
7532   CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7533   CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7534 }
7535 
7536 #undef CHECKSUM
7537 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
7538 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
7539 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
7540 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
7541 
7542 /* Generate the type signature for DIE.  This is computed by generating an
7543    MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
7544    children.  Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
7545    by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
7546    If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
7547    need to include that context in the signature.  The lower 64 bits
7548    of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature.  */
7549 
7550 static void
7551 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
7552 {
7553   int mark;
7554   const char *name;
7555   unsigned char checksum[16];
7556   struct md5_ctx ctx;
7557   dw_die_ref decl;
7558   dw_die_ref parent;
7559 
7560   name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
7561   decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7562   parent = get_die_parent (die);
7563 
7564   /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
7565      context, if any.  This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
7566      ODR (one-definition rule) checking.  */
7567 
7568   if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
7569     {
7570       md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7571 
7572       /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures.  */
7573       if (parent != NULL)
7574         checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7575 
7576       /* Checksum the current DIE. */
7577       die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
7578       md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7579 
7580       add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
7581     }
7582 
7583   /* Next, compute the complete type signature.  */
7584 
7585   md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7586   mark = 1;
7587   die->die_mark = mark;
7588 
7589   /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures.  */
7590   if (parent != NULL)
7591     checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7592 
7593   /* Checksum the DIE and its children.  */
7594   die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
7595   unmark_all_dies (die);
7596   md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7597 
7598   /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
7599      type node together.  */
7600   memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
7601           DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
7602   die->comdat_type_p = true;
7603   die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7604   type_node->type_die = die;
7605 
7606   /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
7607      as well.  */
7608   if (decl != NULL)
7609     {
7610       decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7611       decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7612     }
7613 }
7614 
7615 /* Do the location expressions look same?  */
7616 static inline int
7617 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
7618 {
7619   return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
7620 	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
7621 	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
7622 }
7623 
7624 /* Do the values look the same?  */
7625 static int
7626 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
7627 {
7628   dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
7629   rtx r1, r2;
7630 
7631   if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
7632     return 0;
7633 
7634   switch (v1->val_class)
7635     {
7636     case dw_val_class_const:
7637     case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7638       return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
7639     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7640     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7641       return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
7642     case dw_val_class_const_double:
7643       return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
7644 	     && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
7645     case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7646       return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
7647     case dw_val_class_vec:
7648       if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
7649 	  || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
7650 	return 0;
7651       if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
7652 		  v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
7653 	return 0;
7654       return 1;
7655     case dw_val_class_flag:
7656       return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
7657     case dw_val_class_str:
7658       return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
7659 
7660     case dw_val_class_addr:
7661       r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
7662       r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
7663       if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
7664 	return 0;
7665       return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
7666 
7667     case dw_val_class_offset:
7668       return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
7669 
7670     case dw_val_class_loc:
7671       for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
7672 	   loc1 && loc2;
7673 	   loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
7674 	if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
7675 	  return 0;
7676       return !loc1 && !loc2;
7677 
7678     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7679       return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
7680 
7681     case dw_val_class_symview:
7682       return strcmp (v1->v.val_symbolic_view, v2->v.val_symbolic_view) == 0;
7683 
7684     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7685     case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7686     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7687     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7688     case dw_val_class_macptr:
7689     case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7690     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7691       return 1;
7692 
7693     case dw_val_class_file:
7694     case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7695       return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
7696 
7697     case dw_val_class_data8:
7698       return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
7699 
7700     default:
7701       return 1;
7702     }
7703 }
7704 
7705 /* Do the attributes look the same?  */
7706 
7707 static int
7708 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
7709 {
7710   if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
7711     return 0;
7712 
7713   /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
7714      snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
7715   if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
7716     return 1;
7717 
7718   return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
7719 }
7720 
7721 /* Do the dies look the same?  */
7722 
7723 static int
7724 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
7725 {
7726   dw_die_ref c1, c2;
7727   dw_attr_node *a1;
7728   unsigned ix;
7729 
7730   /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
7731   if (die1->die_mark)
7732     return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
7733   die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7734 
7735   if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
7736     return 0;
7737 
7738   if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
7739     return 0;
7740 
7741   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
7742     if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
7743       return 0;
7744 
7745   c1 = die1->die_child;
7746   c2 = die2->die_child;
7747   if (! c1)
7748     {
7749       if (c2)
7750 	return 0;
7751     }
7752   else
7753     for (;;)
7754       {
7755 	if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
7756 	  return 0;
7757 	c1 = c1->die_sib;
7758 	c2 = c2->die_sib;
7759 	if (c1 == die1->die_child)
7760 	  {
7761 	    if (c2 == die2->die_child)
7762 	      break;
7763 	    else
7764 	      return 0;
7765 	  }
7766     }
7767 
7768   return 1;
7769 }
7770 
7771 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
7772    children, and set die_symbol.  */
7773 
7774 static void
7775 compute_comp_unit_symbol (dw_die_ref unit_die)
7776 {
7777   const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
7778   const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
7779   char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
7780   char *p;
7781   int i, mark;
7782   unsigned char checksum[16];
7783   struct md5_ctx ctx;
7784 
7785   /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
7786      the name filename of the unit.  */
7787 
7788   md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7789   mark = 0;
7790   die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
7791   unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
7792   md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7793 
7794   /* When we this for comp_unit_die () we have a DW_AT_name that might
7795      not start with a letter but with anything valid for filenames and
7796      clean_symbol_name doesn't fix that up.  Prepend 'g' if the first
7797      character is not a letter.  */
7798   sprintf (name, "%s%s.", ISALPHA (*base) ? "" : "g", base);
7799   clean_symbol_name (name);
7800 
7801   p = name + strlen (name);
7802   for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
7803     {
7804       sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
7805       p += 2;
7806     }
7807 
7808   unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
7809 }
7810 
7811 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P.  */
7812 
7813 static int
7814 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
7815 {
7816   switch (die->die_tag)
7817     {
7818     case DW_TAG_array_type:
7819     case DW_TAG_class_type:
7820     case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7821     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7822     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7823     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7824     case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7825     case DW_TAG_string_type:
7826     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7827     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7828     case DW_TAG_union_type:
7829     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7830     case DW_TAG_set_type:
7831     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7832     case DW_TAG_base_type:
7833     case DW_TAG_const_type:
7834     case DW_TAG_file_type:
7835     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7836     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7837     case DW_TAG_typedef:
7838       return 1;
7839     default:
7840       return 0;
7841     }
7842 }
7843 
7844 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
7845    Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
7846    compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
7847    compilations (functions).  */
7848 
7849 static int
7850 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
7851 {
7852   /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
7853      we do for stabs.  The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
7854      objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
7855      put the base types in a different comdat).  jason 8/28/00 */
7856 
7857   if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
7858     return 0;
7859 
7860   if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7861       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7862       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7863       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
7864       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
7865     {
7866       dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
7867 
7868       return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
7869     }
7870 
7871   return is_type_die (c);
7872 }
7873 
7874 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE.  */
7875 
7876 static inline bool
7877 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
7878 {
7879   return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7880 	       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7881 }
7882 
7883 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort.  */
7884 
7885 static inline bool
7886 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
7887 {
7888   return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7889 	       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
7890 	       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit
7891 	       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7892 }
7893 
7894 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE.  */
7895 
7896 static inline bool
7897 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7898 {
7899   return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7900 }
7901 
7902 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE.  */
7903 
7904 static inline bool
7905 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7906 {
7907   return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7908                || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7909 }
7910 
7911 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter.  */
7912 
7913 static inline bool
7914 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7915 {
7916   switch (die->die_tag)
7917     {
7918     case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7919     case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7920     case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7921     case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7922       return true;
7923     default:
7924       return false;
7925     }
7926 }
7927 
7928 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation.  */
7929 
7930 static inline bool
7931 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7932 {
7933   dw_die_ref c;
7934 
7935   if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7936     return false;
7937   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7938   return false;
7939 }
7940 
7941 static char *
7942 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7943 {
7944   char buf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7945 
7946   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7947   return xstrdup (buf);
7948 }
7949 
7950 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration.  */
7951 
7952 static int
7953 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7954 {
7955   dw_attr_node *a;
7956   unsigned ix;
7957 
7958   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7959     if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7960       return 1;
7961 
7962   return 0;
7963 }
7964 
7965 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram.  */
7966 
7967 static int
7968 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7969 {
7970   dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7971 
7972   if (decl == NULL)
7973     decl = die;
7974   return local_scope_p (decl);
7975 }
7976 
7977 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7978    subprogram.  */
7979 
7980 static int
7981 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7982 {
7983   dw_die_ref c;
7984 
7985   if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7986     return 1;
7987   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7988   return 0;
7989 }
7990 
7991 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7992    COMDAT .debug_types section or .debug_info section with DW_UT_*type
7993    unit type.  */
7994 
7995 static int
7996 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7997 {
7998   switch (die->die_tag)
7999     {
8000     case DW_TAG_class_type:
8001     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
8002     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
8003     case DW_TAG_union_type:
8004       /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
8005 	 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions.  */
8006       if (is_declaration_die (die)
8007           || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
8008           || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
8009           || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
8010         return 0;
8011       return 1;
8012     case DW_TAG_array_type:
8013     case DW_TAG_interface_type:
8014     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
8015     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
8016     case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
8017     case DW_TAG_string_type:
8018     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
8019     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
8020     case DW_TAG_set_type:
8021     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
8022     case DW_TAG_base_type:
8023     case DW_TAG_const_type:
8024     case DW_TAG_file_type:
8025     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
8026     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
8027     case DW_TAG_typedef:
8028     default:
8029       return 0;
8030     }
8031 }
8032 
8033 /* Make a clone of DIE.  */
8034 
8035 static dw_die_ref
8036 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
8037 {
8038   dw_die_ref clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
8039   dw_attr_node *a;
8040   unsigned ix;
8041 
8042   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8043     add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
8044 
8045   return clone;
8046 }
8047 
8048 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE.  */
8049 
8050 static dw_die_ref
8051 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
8052 {
8053   dw_die_ref c;
8054   dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
8055 
8056   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
8057 
8058   return clone;
8059 }
8060 
8061 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration.  */
8062 
8063 static dw_die_ref
8064 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
8065 {
8066   dw_die_ref clone;
8067   dw_die_ref decl;
8068   dw_attr_node *a;
8069   unsigned ix;
8070 
8071   /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it.  */
8072   if (is_declaration_die (die))
8073     return clone_die (die);
8074 
8075   /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE.  */
8076   decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8077   if (decl != NULL)
8078     {
8079       clone = clone_die (decl);
8080       if (die->comdat_type_p)
8081 	add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
8082       return clone;
8083     }
8084 
8085   clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
8086 
8087   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8088     {
8089       /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
8090          For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
8091          longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition.  */
8092 
8093       switch (a->dw_attr)
8094         {
8095         case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
8096         case DW_AT_artificial:
8097         case DW_AT_containing_type:
8098         case DW_AT_external:
8099         case DW_AT_name:
8100         case DW_AT_type:
8101         case DW_AT_virtuality:
8102         case DW_AT_linkage_name:
8103         case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
8104           add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
8105           break;
8106         case DW_AT_byte_size:
8107 	case DW_AT_alignment:
8108         default:
8109           break;
8110         }
8111     }
8112 
8113   if (die->comdat_type_p)
8114     add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
8115 
8116   add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
8117   return clone;
8118 }
8119 
8120 
8121 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit.  */
8122 
8123 struct decl_table_entry
8124 {
8125   dw_die_ref orig;
8126   dw_die_ref copy;
8127 };
8128 
8129 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations.  */
8130 
8131 /* Hashtable helpers.  */
8132 
8133 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
8134 {
8135   typedef die_struct *compare_type;
8136   static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
8137   static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
8138 };
8139 
8140 inline hashval_t
8141 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
8142 {
8143   return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
8144 }
8145 
8146 inline bool
8147 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
8148 				const die_struct *entry2)
8149 {
8150   return entry1->orig == entry2;
8151 }
8152 
8153 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
8154 
8155 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
8156    or type unit entry, to a new tree.  Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
8157    a pointer to the copy of DIE.  If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
8158    to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT.  */
8159 
8160 static dw_die_ref
8161 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
8162 		    decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8163 {
8164   dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
8165   dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
8166   dw_die_ref copy;
8167   decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
8168   struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
8169 
8170   /* If DIE refers to a stub unfold that so we get the appropriate
8171      DIE registered as orig in decl_table.  */
8172   if (dw_die_ref c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature))
8173     die = c;
8174 
8175   if (decl_table)
8176     {
8177       /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT.  */
8178       slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
8179 					      INSERT);
8180       if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8181         {
8182           entry = *slot;
8183           return entry->copy;
8184         }
8185 
8186       /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT.  */
8187       entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8188       entry->orig = die;
8189       entry->copy = NULL;
8190       *slot = entry;
8191     }
8192 
8193   if (parent != NULL)
8194     {
8195       dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
8196       if (spec != NULL)
8197         parent = spec;
8198       if (!is_unit_die (parent))
8199         new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
8200     }
8201 
8202   copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
8203   add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
8204 
8205   if (decl_table)
8206     {
8207       /* Record the pointer to the copy.  */
8208       entry->copy = copy;
8209     }
8210 
8211   return copy;
8212 }
8213 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE.  This includes
8214    any surrounding namespace or type declarations.  If the DIE has an
8215    AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
8216    attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
8217    parent of the declaration DIE.  Returns NULL otherwise.  */
8218 
8219 static dw_die_ref
8220 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
8221 {
8222   dw_die_ref decl;
8223   dw_die_ref new_decl;
8224   dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
8225 
8226   decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8227   if (decl == NULL)
8228     decl = die;
8229   else
8230     {
8231       unsigned ix;
8232       dw_die_ref c;
8233       dw_attr_node *a;
8234 
8235       /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
8236          be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE.  */
8237       orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
8238 
8239       /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
8240          declaration DIE so we can forward references later.  */
8241       decl->comdat_type_p = true;
8242       decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8243 
8244       remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
8245 
8246       FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
8247         {
8248           if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
8249               && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
8250               && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
8251             add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
8252         }
8253 
8254       FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
8255     }
8256 
8257   if (decl->die_parent != NULL
8258       && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
8259     {
8260       new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
8261       if (new_decl != NULL)
8262         {
8263           remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
8264           add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
8265         }
8266     }
8267 
8268   return orig_parent;
8269 }
8270 
8271 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
8272    the DIE and add the clone into the tree.  */
8273 
8274 static void
8275 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
8276 {
8277   if (node->new_die != NULL)
8278     return;
8279 
8280   node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
8281 
8282   if (node->parent != NULL)
8283     {
8284       generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
8285       add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
8286     }
8287 }
8288 
8289 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
8290    found in the original tree.  We traverse the tree looking for declaration
8291    DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one.  */
8292 
8293 static void
8294 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
8295 {
8296   skeleton_chain_node node;
8297   dw_die_ref c;
8298   dw_die_ref first;
8299   dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8300   dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8301 
8302   node.parent = parent;
8303 
8304   first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
8305   if (c)
8306     next = c->die_sib;
8307   if (c) do {
8308     if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8309       prev = c;
8310     c = next;
8311     next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8312     node.old_die = c;
8313     node.new_die = NULL;
8314     if (is_declaration_die (c))
8315       {
8316 	if (is_template_instantiation (c))
8317 	  {
8318 	    /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
8319 	       type unit.  Just move the DIE and its children back to
8320 	       the skeleton tree (in the main CU).  */
8321 	    remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
8322 	    add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8323 	    c = prev;
8324 	  }
8325 	else if (c->comdat_type_p)
8326 	  {
8327 	    /* This is the skeleton of earlier break_out_comdat_types
8328 	       type.  Clone the existing DIE, but keep the children
8329 	       under the original (which is in the main CU).  */
8330 	    dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8331 
8332 	    replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8333 	    generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8334 	    add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8335 	    c = clone;
8336 	    continue;
8337 	  }
8338 	else
8339 	  {
8340 	    /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
8341 	       tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
8342 	       all the original's children, where the original came from
8343 	       (which is about to be moved to the type unit).  */
8344 	    dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8345 	    move_all_children (c, clone);
8346 
8347 	    /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
8348 	       it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
8349 	       cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
8350 	       the original.  */
8351 	    remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
8352 
8353 	    replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8354 	    generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8355 	    add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8356 	    node.old_die = clone;
8357 	    node.new_die = c;
8358 	    c = clone;
8359 	  }
8360       }
8361     generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8362   } while (next != NULL);
8363 }
8364 
8365 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up.  */
8366 
8367 static dw_die_ref
8368 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
8369 {
8370   skeleton_chain_node node;
8371 
8372   node.old_die = die;
8373   node.new_die = NULL;
8374   node.parent = NULL;
8375 
8376   /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
8377      and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
8378      at least a declaration in its place.  */
8379   if (die->die_parent != NULL
8380       && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
8381       && !is_template_instantiation (die))
8382     node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
8383 
8384   generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8385   return node.new_die;
8386 }
8387 
8388 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
8389    declaration.  The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
8390    existing references to it follow it to the new location.  If any of the
8391    original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
8392    original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
8393    skeleton tree.  */
8394 
8395 static dw_die_ref
8396 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
8397 				       dw_die_ref prev)
8398 {
8399   dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
8400 
8401   /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE.  If the returned
8402      ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
8403      that DIE.  */
8404   orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
8405 
8406   skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
8407   if (skeleton == NULL)
8408     remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8409   else
8410     {
8411       skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
8412       skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
8413 
8414       /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
8415          the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
8416 	 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
8417 	 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
8418 	 references to it.  */
8419       if (orig_parent != NULL)
8420 	{
8421 	  remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8422 	  add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
8423 	}
8424       else
8425 	replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
8426     }
8427 
8428   return skeleton;
8429 }
8430 
8431 static void
8432 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8433 			       comdat_type_node *type_node,
8434 			       hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
8435 
8436 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies.  Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
8437    procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy.  Continue looking for
8438    DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute.  */
8439 
8440 static dw_die_ref
8441 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
8442 		      comdat_type_node *type_node,
8443 		      hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8444 {
8445   gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
8446 
8447   /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children...  */
8448   gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
8449 
8450   /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location.  */
8451   gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
8452 	      && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
8453 
8454   /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures.  */
8455   bool existed;
8456   dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
8457   if (existed)
8458     return die_copy;
8459 
8460   die_copy = clone_die (die);
8461   add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
8462   copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8463   return die_copy;
8464 }
8465 
8466 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies.  Look for references to DWARF
8467    procedures in DIE's attributes.  */
8468 
8469 static void
8470 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8471 			       comdat_type_node *type_node,
8472 			       hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8473 {
8474   dw_attr_node *a;
8475   unsigned i;
8476 
8477   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
8478     {
8479       dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8480 
8481       if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
8482 	continue;
8483 
8484       for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8485 	{
8486 	  switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
8487 	    {
8488 	    case DW_OP_call2:
8489 	    case DW_OP_call4:
8490 	    case DW_OP_call_ref:
8491 	      gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
8492 			  == dw_val_class_die_ref);
8493 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
8494 	        = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
8495 					type_node,
8496 					copied_dwarf_procs);
8497 
8498 	    default:
8499 	      break;
8500 	    }
8501 	}
8502     }
8503 }
8504 
8505 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
8506    rewrite references to point to the copies.
8507 
8508    References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
8509    children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
8510    mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
8511    twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE.  */
8512 
8513 static void
8514 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
8515 			      comdat_type_node *type_node,
8516 			      hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8517 {
8518   dw_die_ref c;
8519 
8520   copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8521   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
8522 							type_node,
8523 							copied_dwarf_procs));
8524 }
8525 
8526 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types or .debug_info
8527    DW_UT_*type sections for each type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT
8528    section.  */
8529 
8530 static void
8531 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
8532 {
8533   dw_die_ref c;
8534   dw_die_ref first;
8535   dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8536   dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8537   dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
8538 
8539   first = c = die->die_child;
8540   if (c)
8541     next = c->die_sib;
8542   if (c) do {
8543     if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8544       prev = c;
8545     c = next;
8546     next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8547     if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
8548       {
8549         dw_die_ref replacement;
8550 	comdat_type_node *type_node;
8551 
8552         /* Break out nested types into their own type units.  */
8553         break_out_comdat_types (c);
8554 
8555         /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
8556            add it to the list of comdat types.  */
8557         unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
8558         add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
8559                          get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
8560         type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
8561         type_node->root_die = unit;
8562         type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
8563         comdat_type_list = type_node;
8564 
8565         /* Generate the type signature.  */
8566         generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
8567 
8568         /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
8569            declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
8570 	   from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary).  */
8571 	replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
8572 	type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
8573 
8574         /* Add the DIE to the new compunit.  */
8575 	add_child_die (unit, c);
8576 
8577 	/* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
8578 	   expressions.  Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
8579 	   that are not in the same section.  So we must copy DWARF procedures
8580 	   along with this type and then rewrite references to them.  */
8581 	hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
8582 	copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8583 
8584         if (replacement != NULL)
8585           c = replacement;
8586       }
8587     else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
8588              || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
8589              || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
8590              || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
8591       {
8592         /* Look for nested types that can be broken out.  */
8593         break_out_comdat_types (c);
8594       }
8595   } while (next != NULL);
8596 }
8597 
8598 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
8599    Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table.  */
8600 
8601 static dw_die_ref
8602 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8603 {
8604   dw_die_ref c;
8605   dw_die_ref clone;
8606   struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8607   decl_table_entry **slot;
8608 
8609   if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8610     clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
8611   else
8612     clone = clone_die (die);
8613 
8614   slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
8615 					  htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
8616 
8617   /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet.  If it would be there
8618      before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
8619      clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called.  */
8620   gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
8621 
8622   entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8623   entry->orig = die;
8624   entry->copy = clone;
8625   *slot = entry;
8626 
8627   if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
8628     FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
8629 		    add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8630 
8631   return clone;
8632 }
8633 
8634 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
8635    or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
8636    type_unit).  */
8637 
8638 static void
8639 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8640 {
8641   dw_die_ref c;
8642   dw_attr_node *a;
8643   unsigned ix;
8644 
8645   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8646     {
8647       if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8648         {
8649           dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
8650           decl_table_entry **slot;
8651           struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8652 
8653           if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
8654             continue;
8655 
8656           slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
8657 						  htab_hash_pointer (targ),
8658 						  INSERT);
8659 
8660           if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8661             {
8662               /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
8663                  modify the reference to point to the copy.  */
8664               entry = *slot;
8665               a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
8666             }
8667           else
8668             {
8669               dw_die_ref parent = unit;
8670 	      dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
8671 
8672               /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
8673                  Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
8674                  because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
8675                  would no longer be a valid pointer.  */
8676               entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8677               entry->orig = targ;
8678               entry->copy = copy;
8679               *slot = entry;
8680 
8681 	      /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
8682 	         children.  */
8683 	      if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
8684 		{
8685 		  FOR_EACH_CHILD (
8686 		      targ, c,
8687 		      add_child_die (copy,
8688 				     clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8689 		}
8690 
8691               /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
8692                  type unit.  */
8693               mark_dies (copy);
8694 
8695               /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
8696                  into the new type unit.  */
8697               if (targ->die_parent != NULL
8698 		  && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
8699                 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
8700                                              decl_table);
8701 
8702               add_child_die (parent, copy);
8703               a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
8704 
8705               /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked.  If it was
8706                  installed in a previously-added context, it won't
8707                  get visited otherwise.  */
8708               if (parent != unit)
8709 		{
8710 		  /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
8711 		     mark each node along the way, and walk from there.  */
8712 		  parent->die_mark = 1;
8713 		  while (parent->die_parent
8714 		  	 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
8715 		    {
8716 		      parent = parent->die_parent;
8717 		      parent->die_mark = 1;
8718 		    }
8719 		  copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
8720 		}
8721             }
8722         }
8723     }
8724 
8725   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8726 }
8727 
8728 /* Collect skeleton dies in DIE created by break_out_comdat_types already
8729    and record them in DECL_TABLE.  */
8730 
8731 static void
8732 collect_skeleton_dies (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8733 {
8734   dw_die_ref c;
8735 
8736   if (dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_signature))
8737     {
8738       dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
8739       gcc_assert (targ->die_mark == 0 && targ->comdat_type_p);
8740       decl_table_entry **slot
8741         = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
8742 					   htab_hash_pointer (targ),
8743 					   INSERT);
8744       gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
8745       /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been already copied
8746 	 by remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton.  */
8747       decl_table_entry *entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8748       entry->orig = targ;
8749       entry->copy = die;
8750       *slot = entry;
8751     }
8752   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, collect_skeleton_dies (c, decl_table));
8753 }
8754 
8755 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8756    Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8757    out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8758    and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8759    don't have an external reference.  */
8760 
8761 static void
8762 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8763 {
8764   mark_dies (unit);
8765   decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8766   collect_skeleton_dies (unit, &decl_table);
8767   copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8768   unmark_dies (unit);
8769 }
8770 
8771 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8772    effect of speeding up access to siblings.  To save some space,
8773    avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children.  */
8774 
8775 static void
8776 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8777 {
8778   dw_die_ref c;
8779 
8780   if (! die->die_child)
8781     return;
8782 
8783   if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8784     add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8785 
8786   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8787 }
8788 
8789 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children.  */
8790 
8791 static void
8792 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8793 {
8794   dw_die_ref c;
8795   dw_attr_node *a;
8796   unsigned ix;
8797 
8798   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8799     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8800       output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8801 
8802   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8803 }
8804 
8805 /* During assign_location_list_indexes and output_loclists_offset the
8806    current index, after it the number of assigned indexes (i.e. how
8807    large the .debug_loclists* offset table should be).  */
8808 static unsigned int loc_list_idx;
8809 
8810 /* Output all location list offsets for the DIE and its children.  */
8811 
8812 static void
8813 output_loclists_offsets (dw_die_ref die)
8814 {
8815   dw_die_ref c;
8816   dw_attr_node *a;
8817   unsigned ix;
8818 
8819   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8820     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8821       {
8822 	dw_loc_list_ref l = AT_loc_list (a);
8823 	if (l->offset_emitted)
8824 	  continue;
8825 	dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l->ll_symbol,
8826 			      loc_section_label, NULL);
8827 	gcc_assert (l->hash == loc_list_idx);
8828 	loc_list_idx++;
8829 	l->offset_emitted = true;
8830       }
8831 
8832   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_loclists_offsets (c));
8833 }
8834 
8835 /* Recursively set indexes of location lists.  */
8836 
8837 static void
8838 assign_location_list_indexes (dw_die_ref die)
8839 {
8840   dw_die_ref c;
8841   dw_attr_node *a;
8842   unsigned ix;
8843 
8844   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8845     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8846       {
8847 	dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
8848 	if (!list->num_assigned)
8849 	  {
8850 	    list->num_assigned = true;
8851 	    list->hash = loc_list_idx++;
8852 	  }
8853       }
8854 
8855   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_location_list_indexes (c));
8856 }
8857 
8858 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8859    larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8860    even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8861    can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8862    So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8863    make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8864 
8865    This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8866    references.  */
8867 
8868 struct external_ref
8869 {
8870   dw_die_ref type;
8871   dw_die_ref stub;
8872   unsigned n_refs;
8873 };
8874 
8875 /* Hashtable helpers.  */
8876 
8877 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8878 {
8879   static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8880   static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8881 };
8882 
8883 inline hashval_t
8884 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8885 {
8886   dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8887   hashval_t h = 0;
8888 
8889   /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8890      that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic.  */
8891   if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8892     /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash.  */
8893     h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8894   else
8895     {
8896       /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8897 	 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t.  */
8898       comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8899       memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8900     }
8901   return h;
8902 }
8903 
8904 inline bool
8905 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8906 {
8907   return r1->type == r2->type;
8908 }
8909 
8910 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8911 
8912 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE.  */
8913 
8914 static struct external_ref *
8915 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8916 {
8917   struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8918   external_ref **slot;
8919 
8920   ref.type = die;
8921   slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8922   if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8923     return *slot;
8924 
8925   ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8926   ref_p->type = die;
8927   *slot = ref_p;
8928   return ref_p;
8929 }
8930 
8931 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8932 
8933    If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub.  If we see external
8934    references, remember how many we've seen.  */
8935 
8936 static void
8937 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8938 {
8939   dw_die_ref c;
8940   dw_attr_node *a;
8941   unsigned ix;
8942   struct external_ref *ref_p;
8943 
8944   if (is_type_die (die)
8945       && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8946     {
8947       /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references.  */
8948       ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8949       ref_p->stub = die;
8950     }
8951 
8952   /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8953      other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked).  */
8954   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8955     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8956 	&& (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8957 	&& is_type_die (c))
8958       {
8959 	ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8960 	ref_p->n_refs++;
8961       }
8962 
8963   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8964 }
8965 
8966 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below.  SLOT
8967    points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing.  If we don't
8968    already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub.  */
8969 
8970 int
8971 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8972 {
8973   struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8974 
8975   if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8976     {
8977       /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8978 	 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8979 	 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names.  */
8980       dw_die_ref cu = data;
8981       dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8982       dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8983 
8984       if (type->comdat_type_p)
8985 	{
8986 	  /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature.  */
8987 	  stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8988 	  add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8989 	}
8990       else
8991 	{
8992 	  /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name.  */
8993 	  stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8994 	  add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
8995 	}
8996 
8997       stub->die_mark++;
8998       ref_p->stub = stub;
8999     }
9000   return 1;
9001 }
9002 
9003 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
9004    any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
9005    them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table.  This is useful because
9006    references to local DIEs are smaller.  */
9007 
9008 static external_ref_hash_type *
9009 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
9010 {
9011   external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
9012   optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
9013   map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
9014   return map;
9015 }
9016 
9017 /* The following 3 variables are temporaries that are computed only during the
9018    build_abbrev_table call and used and released during the following
9019    optimize_abbrev_table call.  */
9020 
9021 /* First abbrev_id that can be optimized based on usage.  */
9022 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_start;
9023 
9024 /* Maximum abbrev_id of a base type plus one (we can't optimize DIEs with
9025    abbrev_id smaller than this, because they must be already sized
9026    during build_abbrev_table).  */
9027 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_base_type_end;
9028 
9029 /* Vector of usage counts during build_abbrev_table.  Indexed by
9030    abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start.  */
9031 static vec<unsigned int> abbrev_usage_count;
9032 
9033 /* Vector of all DIEs added with die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start.  */
9034 static vec<dw_die_ref> sorted_abbrev_dies;
9035 
9036 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
9037    abbreviation table.  This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
9038    a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry.  The children of each
9039    die are visited recursively.  */
9040 
9041 static void
9042 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
9043 {
9044   unsigned int abbrev_id = 0;
9045   dw_die_ref c;
9046   dw_attr_node *a;
9047   unsigned ix;
9048   dw_die_ref abbrev;
9049 
9050   /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
9051      DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
9052      the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs.  */
9053   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9054     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
9055 	&& (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
9056       {
9057 	struct external_ref *ref_p;
9058 	gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
9059 
9060 	if (is_type_die (c)
9061 	    && (ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c))
9062 	    && ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die
9063 	    && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_signature)
9064 	  change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
9065 	else
9066 	  /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external.  */
9067 	  set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
9068       }
9069 
9070   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
9071     {
9072       dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
9073       unsigned ix;
9074       bool ok = true;
9075 
9076       if (abbrev_id == 0)
9077 	continue;
9078       if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
9079 	continue;
9080       if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
9081 	continue;
9082 
9083       if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
9084 	continue;
9085 
9086       FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
9087 	{
9088 	  abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
9089 	  if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
9090 	      || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
9091 	    {
9092 	      ok = false;
9093 	      break;
9094 	    }
9095 	}
9096       if (ok)
9097 	break;
9098     }
9099 
9100   if (abbrev_id >= vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table))
9101     {
9102       vec_safe_push (abbrev_die_table, die);
9103       if (abbrev_opt_start)
9104 	abbrev_usage_count.safe_push (0);
9105     }
9106   if (abbrev_opt_start && abbrev_id >= abbrev_opt_start)
9107     {
9108       abbrev_usage_count[abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start]++;
9109       sorted_abbrev_dies.safe_push (die);
9110     }
9111 
9112   die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
9113   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
9114 }
9115 
9116 /* Callback function for sorted_abbrev_dies vector sorting.  We sort
9117    by die_abbrev's usage count, from the most commonly used
9118    abbreviation to the least.  */
9119 
9120 static int
9121 die_abbrev_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
9122 {
9123   dw_die_ref die1 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p1;
9124   dw_die_ref die2 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p2;
9125 
9126   gcc_checking_assert (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
9127   gcc_checking_assert (die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
9128 
9129   if (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end
9130       && die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9131     {
9132       if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
9133 	  > abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
9134 	return -1;
9135       if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
9136 	  < abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
9137 	return 1;
9138     }
9139 
9140   /* Stabilize the sort.  */
9141   if (die1->die_abbrev < die2->die_abbrev)
9142     return -1;
9143   if (die1->die_abbrev > die2->die_abbrev)
9144     return 1;
9145 
9146   return 0;
9147 }
9148 
9149 /* Convert dw_val_class_const and dw_val_class_unsigned_const class attributes
9150    of DIEs in between sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id] and abbrev_dies[end_id - 1]
9151    into dw_val_class_const_implicit or
9152    dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit.  */
9153 
9154 static void
9155 optimize_implicit_const (unsigned int first_id, unsigned int end,
9156 			 vec<bool> &implicit_consts)
9157 {
9158   /* It never makes sense if there is just one DIE using the abbreviation.  */
9159   if (end < first_id + 2)
9160     return;
9161 
9162   dw_attr_node *a;
9163   unsigned ix, i;
9164   dw_die_ref die = sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id];
9165   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9166     if (implicit_consts[ix])
9167       {
9168 	enum dw_val_class new_class = dw_val_class_none;
9169 	switch (AT_class (a))
9170 	  {
9171 	  case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9172 	    if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) AT_unsigned (a) < 0)
9173 	      continue;
9174 
9175 	    /* The .debug_abbrev section will grow by
9176 	       size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)) and we avoid the constants
9177 	       in all the DIEs using that abbreviation.  */
9178 	    if (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)) * (end - first_id)
9179 		<= (unsigned) size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)))
9180 	      continue;
9181 
9182 	    new_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit;
9183 	    break;
9184 
9185 	  case dw_val_class_const:
9186 	    new_class = dw_val_class_const_implicit;
9187 	    break;
9188 
9189 	  case dw_val_class_file:
9190 	    new_class = dw_val_class_file_implicit;
9191 	    break;
9192 
9193 	  default:
9194 	    continue;
9195 	  }
9196 	for (i = first_id; i < end; i++)
9197 	  (*sorted_abbrev_dies[i]->die_attr)[ix].dw_attr_val.val_class
9198 	    = new_class;
9199       }
9200 }
9201 
9202 /* Attempt to optimize abbreviation table from abbrev_opt_start
9203    abbreviation above.  */
9204 
9205 static void
9206 optimize_abbrev_table (void)
9207 {
9208   if (abbrev_opt_start
9209       && vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > abbrev_opt_start
9210       && (dwarf_version >= 5 || vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > 127))
9211     {
9212       auto_vec<bool, 32> implicit_consts;
9213       sorted_abbrev_dies.qsort (die_abbrev_cmp);
9214 
9215       unsigned int abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_start - 1;
9216       unsigned int first_id = ~0U;
9217       unsigned int last_abbrev_id = 0;
9218       unsigned int i;
9219       dw_die_ref die;
9220       if (abbrev_opt_base_type_end > abbrev_opt_start)
9221 	abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_base_type_end - 1;
9222       /* Reassign abbreviation ids from abbrev_opt_start above, so that
9223 	 most commonly used abbreviations come first.  */
9224       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (sorted_abbrev_dies, i, die)
9225 	{
9226 	  dw_attr_node *a;
9227 	  unsigned ix;
9228 
9229 	  /* If calc_base_type_die_sizes has been called, the CU and
9230 	     base types after it can't be optimized, because we've already
9231 	     calculated their DIE offsets.  We've sorted them first.  */
9232 	  if (die->die_abbrev < abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9233 	    continue;
9234 	  if (die->die_abbrev != last_abbrev_id)
9235 	    {
9236 	      last_abbrev_id = die->die_abbrev;
9237 	      if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
9238 		optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
9239 	      abbrev_id++;
9240 	      (*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id] = die;
9241 	      if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9242 		{
9243 		  first_id = i;
9244 		  implicit_consts.truncate (0);
9245 
9246 		  FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9247 		    switch (AT_class (a))
9248 		      {
9249 		      case dw_val_class_const:
9250 		      case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9251 		      case dw_val_class_file:
9252 			implicit_consts.safe_push (true);
9253 			break;
9254 		      default:
9255 			implicit_consts.safe_push (false);
9256 			break;
9257 		      }
9258 		}
9259 	    }
9260 	  else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9261 	    {
9262 	      FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9263 		if (!implicit_consts[ix])
9264 		  continue;
9265 		else
9266 		  {
9267 		    dw_attr_node *other_a
9268 		      = &(*(*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id]->die_attr)[ix];
9269 		    if (!dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_attr_val,
9270 					 &other_a->dw_attr_val))
9271 		      implicit_consts[ix] = false;
9272 		  }
9273 	    }
9274 	  die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
9275 	}
9276       gcc_assert (abbrev_id == vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) - 1);
9277       if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
9278 	optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
9279     }
9280 
9281   abbrev_opt_start = 0;
9282   abbrev_opt_base_type_end = 0;
9283   abbrev_usage_count.release ();
9284   sorted_abbrev_dies.release ();
9285 }
9286 
9287 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE.  */
9288 
9289 static int
9290 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
9291 {
9292   int log;
9293 
9294   if (value == 0)
9295     log = 0;
9296   else
9297     log = floor_log2 (value);
9298 
9299   log = log / 8;
9300   log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
9301 
9302   return log;
9303 }
9304 
9305 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
9306    .debug_info section.  */
9307 
9308 static unsigned long
9309 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
9310 {
9311   unsigned long size = 0;
9312   dw_attr_node *a;
9313   unsigned ix;
9314   enum dwarf_form form;
9315 
9316   size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
9317   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9318     {
9319       switch (AT_class (a))
9320 	{
9321 	case dw_val_class_addr:
9322           if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9323             {
9324               gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9325               size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9326             }
9327           else
9328             size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9329 	  break;
9330 	case dw_val_class_offset:
9331 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9332 	  break;
9333 	case dw_val_class_loc:
9334 	  {
9335 	    unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9336 
9337 	    /* Block length.  */
9338 	    if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9339 	      size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
9340 	    else
9341 	      size += constant_size (lsize);
9342 	    size += lsize;
9343 	  }
9344 	  break;
9345 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9346 	case dw_val_class_view_list:
9347 	  if (dwarf_split_debug_info && dwarf_version >= 5)
9348 	    {
9349 	      gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
9350 	      size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash);
9351 	    }
9352           else
9353             size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9354 	  break;
9355 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
9356 	  if (value_format (a) == DW_FORM_rnglistx)
9357 	    {
9358 	      gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9359 	      dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9360 	      size += size_of_uleb128 (r->idx);
9361 	    }
9362 	  else
9363 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9364 	  break;
9365 	case dw_val_class_const:
9366 	  size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9367 	  break;
9368 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9369 	  {
9370 	    int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9371 	    if (dwarf_version == 3
9372 		&& a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9373 		&& csize >= 4)
9374 	      size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
9375 	    else
9376 	      size += csize;
9377 	  }
9378 	  break;
9379 	case dw_val_class_symview:
9380 	  if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xff)
9381 	    size += 1;
9382 	  else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffff)
9383 	    size += 2;
9384 	  else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffffffff)
9385 	    size += 4;
9386 	  else
9387 	    size += 8;
9388 	  break;
9389 	case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9390 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9391 	case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9392 	  /* These occupy no size in the DIE, just an extra sleb128 in
9393 	     .debug_abbrev.  */
9394 	  break;
9395 	case dw_val_class_const_double:
9396 	  size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9397 	  if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9398 	    size++; /* block */
9399 	  break;
9400 	case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9401 	  size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9402 		   * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
9403 	  if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9404 	      * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9405 	    size++; /* block */
9406 	  break;
9407 	case dw_val_class_vec:
9408 	  size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9409 				 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9410 		  + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9411 		    * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9412 	  break;
9413 	case dw_val_class_flag:
9414 	  if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9415 	    /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9416 	       so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used.  If that ever changes,
9417 	       we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9418 	       in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9419 	       DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9420 	       the same abbrev entry.  */
9421 	    gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9422 	  else
9423 	    size += 1;
9424 	  break;
9425 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9426 	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
9427 	    {
9428 	      /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
9429 		 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr.  In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9430 		 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9431 		 it's always sized as an offset.  */
9432 	      if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
9433 		size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9434 	      else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9435 		size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9436 	      else
9437 		size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9438 	    }
9439 	  else
9440 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9441 	  break;
9442 	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9443 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9444 	  break;
9445 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9446           if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9447             {
9448               gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9449               size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9450             }
9451           else
9452             size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9453 	  break;
9454 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9455 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
9456 	case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9457 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9458 	  break;
9459 	case dw_val_class_str:
9460           form = AT_string_form (a);
9461 	  if (form == DW_FORM_strp || form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
9462 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9463 	  else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9464 	    size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9465 	  else
9466 	    size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9467 	  break;
9468 	case dw_val_class_file:
9469 	  size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9470 	  break;
9471 	case dw_val_class_data8:
9472 	  size += 8;
9473 	  break;
9474 	case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9475 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9476 	  break;
9477 	case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9478 	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9479 	  break;
9480 	case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9481 	  size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
9482 	  break;
9483 	case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9484 	    {
9485 	      unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
9486 
9487 	      /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
9488 		 data.  */
9489 	      size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
9490 	    }
9491 	  break;
9492 	default:
9493 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9494 	}
9495     }
9496 
9497   return size;
9498 }
9499 
9500 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE.  Visits the
9501    DIE's children recursively.  Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9502    each time through.  Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9503    die_offset field in each DIE.  */
9504 
9505 static void
9506 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9507 {
9508   dw_die_ref c;
9509 
9510   gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
9511 	      || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
9512   die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9513   next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
9514 
9515   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
9516 
9517   if (die->die_child != NULL)
9518     /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists.  */
9519     next_die_offset += 1;
9520 }
9521 
9522 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
9523    This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
9524    and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
9525    values for the base types.  */
9526 
9527 static void
9528 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
9529 {
9530   unsigned long die_offset = (dwarf_split_debug_info
9531 			      ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
9532 			      : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
9533   unsigned int i;
9534   dw_die_ref base_type;
9535 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9536   dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
9537 #endif
9538 
9539   die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
9540   for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
9541     {
9542 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9543       gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
9544 		  && prev->die_sib == base_type
9545 		  && base_type->die_child == NULL
9546 		  && base_type->die_abbrev);
9547       prev = base_type;
9548 #endif
9549       if (abbrev_opt_start
9550 	  && base_type->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9551 	abbrev_opt_base_type_end = base_type->die_abbrev + 1;
9552       base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
9553       die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
9554     }
9555 }
9556 
9557 /* Set the marks for a die and its children.  We do this so
9558    that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
9559    DIEs in the same CU will be marked.  We used to clear out the offset
9560    and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems.  */
9561 
9562 static void
9563 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9564 {
9565   dw_die_ref c;
9566 
9567   gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
9568 
9569   die->die_mark = 1;
9570   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
9571 }
9572 
9573 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.  */
9574 
9575 static void
9576 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9577 {
9578   dw_die_ref c;
9579 
9580   if (! use_debug_types)
9581     gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
9582 
9583   die->die_mark = 0;
9584   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
9585 }
9586 
9587 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies.  */
9588 
9589 static void
9590 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9591 {
9592   dw_die_ref c;
9593   dw_attr_node *a;
9594   unsigned ix;
9595 
9596   if (!die->die_mark)
9597     return;
9598   die->die_mark = 0;
9599 
9600   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
9601 
9602   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9603     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9604       unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
9605 }
9606 
9607 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file.  It may be
9608    from a pruned a type.  */
9609 
9610 static bool
9611 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
9612 {
9613   /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
9614      gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
9615      enough information to be useful.  */
9616   if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
9617     return false;
9618 
9619   if (table == pubname_table)
9620     {
9621       /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
9622          parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
9623          Don't output them if that is the case.  */
9624       if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
9625           (p->die->die_parent == NULL
9626            || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
9627         return false;
9628 
9629       /* Everything else in the pubname table is included.  */
9630       return true;
9631     }
9632 
9633   /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
9634      pruned.  */
9635   return (p->die->die_offset != 0
9636           || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
9637 }
9638 
9639 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
9640    generated for the compilation unit.  */
9641 
9642 static unsigned long
9643 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9644 {
9645   unsigned long size;
9646   unsigned i;
9647   pubname_entry *p;
9648   int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
9649 
9650   size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
9651   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
9652     if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
9653       size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
9654 
9655   size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9656   return size;
9657 }
9658 
9659 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section.  */
9660 
9661 static unsigned long
9662 size_of_aranges (void)
9663 {
9664   unsigned long size;
9665 
9666   size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
9667 
9668   /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit.  */
9669   if (text_section_used)
9670     size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9671   if (cold_text_section_used)
9672     size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9673   if (have_multiple_function_sections)
9674     {
9675       unsigned fde_idx;
9676       dw_fde_ref fde;
9677 
9678       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
9679 	{
9680 	  if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
9681 	    continue;
9682 	  if (!fde->in_std_section)
9683 	    size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9684 	  if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
9685 	    size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9686 	}
9687     }
9688 
9689   /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table.  */
9690   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9691   return size;
9692 }
9693 
9694 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value.  */
9695 
9696 static enum dwarf_form
9697 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9698 {
9699   switch (AT_class (a))
9700     {
9701     case dw_val_class_addr:
9702       /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr.  */
9703       switch (a->dw_attr)
9704 	{
9705 	case DW_AT_low_pc:
9706 	case DW_AT_high_pc:
9707 	case DW_AT_entry_pc:
9708 	case DW_AT_trampoline:
9709           return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9710                   ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9711 	default:
9712 	  break;
9713 	}
9714       switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9715 	{
9716 	case 1:
9717 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
9718 	case 2:
9719 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
9720 	case 4:
9721 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9722 	case 8:
9723 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
9724 	default:
9725 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9726 	}
9727     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9728     case dw_val_class_view_list:
9729       if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9730 	  && dwarf_version >= 5
9731 	  && AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned)
9732 	return DW_FORM_loclistx;
9733       /* FALLTHRU */
9734     case dw_val_class_range_list:
9735       /* For range lists in DWARF 5, use DW_FORM_rnglistx from .debug_info.dwo
9736 	 but in .debug_info use DW_FORM_sec_offset, which is shorter if we
9737 	 care about sizes of .debug* sections in shared libraries and
9738 	 executables and don't take into account relocations that affect just
9739 	 relocatable objects - for DW_FORM_rnglistx we'd have to emit offset
9740 	 table in the .debug_rnglists section.  */
9741       if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9742 	  && dwarf_version >= 5
9743 	  && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_range_list
9744 	  && rnglist_idx
9745 	  && a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9746 	return DW_FORM_rnglistx;
9747       if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9748 	return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
9749       /* FALLTHRU */
9750     case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9751     case dw_val_class_offset:
9752       switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
9753 	{
9754 	case 4:
9755 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9756 	case 8:
9757 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
9758 	default:
9759 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9760 	}
9761     case dw_val_class_loc:
9762       if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9763 	return DW_FORM_exprloc;
9764       switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
9765 	{
9766 	case 1:
9767 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
9768 	case 2:
9769 	  return DW_FORM_block2;
9770 	case 4:
9771 	  return DW_FORM_block4;
9772 	default:
9773 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9774 	}
9775     case dw_val_class_const:
9776       return DW_FORM_sdata;
9777     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9778       switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
9779 	{
9780 	case 1:
9781 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
9782 	case 2:
9783 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
9784 	case 4:
9785 	  /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
9786 	     DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
9787 	     constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
9788 	     a large constant.  */
9789 	  if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9790 	    return DW_FORM_udata;
9791 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9792 	case 8:
9793 	  if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9794 	    return DW_FORM_udata;
9795 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
9796 	default:
9797 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9798 	}
9799     case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9800     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9801     case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9802       return DW_FORM_implicit_const;
9803     case dw_val_class_const_double:
9804       switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9805 	{
9806 	case 8:
9807 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
9808 	case 16:
9809 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9810 	case 32:
9811 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
9812 	case 64:
9813 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9814 	    return DW_FORM_data16;
9815 	  /* FALLTHRU */
9816 	default:
9817 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
9818 	}
9819     case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9820       switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9821 	{
9822 	case 8:
9823 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
9824 	case 16:
9825 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
9826 	case 32:
9827 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9828 	case 64:
9829 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
9830 	case 128:
9831 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9832 	    return DW_FORM_data16;
9833 	  /* FALLTHRU */
9834 	default:
9835 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
9836 	}
9837     case dw_val_class_symview:
9838       /* ??? We might use uleb128, but then we'd have to compute
9839 	 .debug_info offsets in the assembler.  */
9840       if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xff)
9841 	return DW_FORM_data1;
9842       else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffff)
9843 	return DW_FORM_data2;
9844       else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffffffff)
9845 	return DW_FORM_data4;
9846       else
9847 	return DW_FORM_data8;
9848     case dw_val_class_vec:
9849       switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9850 			     * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
9851 	{
9852 	case 1:
9853 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
9854 	case 2:
9855 	  return DW_FORM_block2;
9856 	case 4:
9857 	  return DW_FORM_block4;
9858 	default:
9859 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9860 	}
9861     case dw_val_class_flag:
9862       if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9863 	{
9864 	  /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9865 	     so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used.  If that ever changes,
9866 	     we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9867 	     in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9868 	     DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9869 	     the same abbrev entry.  */
9870 	  gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9871 	  return DW_FORM_flag_present;
9872 	}
9873       return DW_FORM_flag;
9874     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9875       if (AT_ref_external (a))
9876 	{
9877 	  if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
9878 	    return DW_FORM_ref_sig8;
9879 	  else
9880 	    return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
9881 	}
9882       else
9883 	return DW_FORM_ref;
9884     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9885       return DW_FORM_data;
9886     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9887       return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9888               ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9889     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9890     case dw_val_class_macptr:
9891     case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9892       return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
9893     case dw_val_class_str:
9894       return AT_string_form (a);
9895     case dw_val_class_file:
9896       switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
9897 	{
9898 	case 1:
9899 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
9900 	case 2:
9901 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
9902 	case 4:
9903 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9904 	default:
9905 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9906 	}
9907 
9908     case dw_val_class_data8:
9909       return DW_FORM_data8;
9910 
9911     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9912       switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9913 	{
9914 	case 1:
9915 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
9916 	case 2:
9917 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
9918 	case 4:
9919 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
9920 	case 8:
9921 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
9922 	default:
9923 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9924 	}
9925 
9926     case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9927       return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
9928 	      ? DW_FORM_udata
9929 	      : DW_FORM_sdata);
9930     case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9931       switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
9932 	{
9933 	case 1:
9934 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
9935 	case 2:
9936 	  return DW_FORM_block2;
9937 	case 4:
9938 	  return DW_FORM_block4;
9939 	default:
9940 	  gcc_unreachable ();
9941 	}
9942 
9943     default:
9944       gcc_unreachable ();
9945     }
9946 }
9947 
9948 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value.  */
9949 
9950 static void
9951 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9952 {
9953   enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
9954 
9955   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
9956 }
9957 
9958 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations.  */
9959 
9960 static void
9961 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
9962 {
9963   unsigned ix;
9964   dw_attr_node *a_attr;
9965 
9966   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
9967   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
9968                                dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
9969 
9970   if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
9971     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
9972   else
9973     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
9974 
9975   for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
9976     {
9977       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
9978                                    dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
9979       output_value_format (a_attr);
9980       if (value_format (a_attr) == DW_FORM_implicit_const)
9981 	{
9982 	  if (AT_class (a_attr) == dw_val_class_file_implicit)
9983 	    {
9984 	      int f = maybe_emit_file (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9985 	      const char *filename = a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename;
9986 	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (f, "(%s)", filename);
9987 	    }
9988 	  else
9989 	    dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int, NULL);
9990 	}
9991     }
9992 
9993   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9994   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9995 }
9996 
9997 
9998 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
9999    table.  */
10000 
10001 static void
10002 output_abbrev_section (void)
10003 {
10004   unsigned int abbrev_id;
10005   dw_die_ref abbrev;
10006 
10007   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
10008     if (abbrev_id != 0)
10009       output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev);
10010 
10011   /* Terminate the table.  */
10012   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10013 }
10014 
10015 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
10016    expression.  */
10017 
10018 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
10019 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, var_loc_view vbegin,
10020 	      const char *end, var_loc_view vend,
10021 	      const char *section)
10022 {
10023   dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
10024 
10025   retlist->begin = begin;
10026   retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
10027   retlist->end = end;
10028   retlist->expr = expr;
10029   retlist->section = section;
10030   retlist->vbegin = vbegin;
10031   retlist->vend = vend;
10032 
10033   return retlist;
10034 }
10035 
10036 /* Return true iff there's any nonzero view number in the loc list.
10037 
10038    ??? When views are not enabled, we'll often extend a single range
10039    to the entire function, so that we emit a single location
10040    expression rather than a location list.  With views, even with a
10041    single range, we'll output a list if start or end have a nonzero
10042    view.  If we change this, we may want to stop splitting a single
10043    range in dw_loc_list just because of a nonzero view, even if it
10044    straddles across hot/cold partitions.  */
10045 
10046 static bool
10047 loc_list_has_views (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10048 {
10049   if (!debug_variable_location_views)
10050     return false;
10051 
10052   for (dw_loc_list_ref loc = list;
10053        loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
10054     if (!ZERO_VIEW_P (loc->vbegin) || !ZERO_VIEW_P (loc->vend))
10055       return true;
10056 
10057   return false;
10058 }
10059 
10060 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
10061    hasn't got one yet.  */
10062 
10063 static inline void
10064 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10065 {
10066   gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
10067   list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
10068 
10069   if (!loc_list_has_views (list))
10070     return;
10071 
10072   if (dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ())
10073     {
10074       /* Use the same label_num for the view list.  */
10075       label_num--;
10076       list->vl_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LVUS");
10077     }
10078   else
10079     list->vl_symbol = list->ll_symbol;
10080 }
10081 
10082 /* Generate a symbol for the list, but only if we really want to emit
10083    it as a list.  */
10084 
10085 static inline void
10086 maybe_gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10087 {
10088   if (!list || (!list->dw_loc_next && !loc_list_has_views (list)))
10089     return;
10090 
10091   gen_llsym (list);
10092 }
10093 
10094 /* Determine whether or not to skip loc_list entry CURR.  If SIZEP is
10095    NULL, don't consider size of the location expression.  If we're not
10096    to skip it, and SIZEP is non-null, store the size of CURR->expr's
10097    representation in *SIZEP.  */
10098 
10099 static bool
10100 skip_loc_list_entry (dw_loc_list_ref curr, unsigned long *sizep = NULL)
10101 {
10102   /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address.  */
10103   if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0
10104       && curr->vbegin == curr->vend && !curr->force)
10105     return true;
10106 
10107   if (!sizep)
10108     return false;
10109 
10110   unsigned long size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
10111 
10112   /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor.  We could
10113      perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
10114      in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
10115      in a single range are unlikely very useful.  */
10116   if (dwarf_version < 5 && size > 0xffff)
10117     return true;
10118 
10119   *sizep = size;
10120 
10121   return false;
10122 }
10123 
10124 /* Output a view pair loclist entry for CURR, if it requires one.  */
10125 
10126 static void
10127 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (dw_loc_list_ref curr)
10128 {
10129   if (!dwarf2out_locviews_in_loclist ())
10130     return;
10131 
10132   if (ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vbegin) && ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vend))
10133     return;
10134 
10135 #ifdef DW_LLE_view_pair
10136   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_view_pair, "DW_LLE_view_pair");
10137 
10138   if (dwarf2out_as_locview_support)
10139     {
10140       if (ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vbegin))
10141 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Location view begin");
10142       else
10143 	{
10144 	  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10145 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vbegin);
10146 	  dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label, "Location view begin");
10147 	}
10148 
10149       if (ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vend))
10150 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Location view end");
10151       else
10152 	{
10153 	  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10154 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vend);
10155 	  dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label, "Location view end");
10156 	}
10157     }
10158   else
10159     {
10160       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vbegin, "Location view begin");
10161       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vend, "Location view end");
10162     }
10163 #endif /* DW_LLE_view_pair */
10164 
10165   return;
10166 }
10167 
10168 /* Output the location list given to us.  */
10169 
10170 static void
10171 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
10172 {
10173   int vcount = 0, lcount = 0;
10174 
10175   if (list_head->emitted)
10176     return;
10177   list_head->emitted = true;
10178 
10179   if (list_head->vl_symbol && dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ())
10180     {
10181       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->vl_symbol);
10182 
10183       for (dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head; curr != NULL;
10184 	   curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10185 	{
10186 	  unsigned long size;
10187 
10188 	  if (skip_loc_list_entry (curr, &size))
10189 	    continue;
10190 
10191 	  vcount++;
10192 
10193 	  /* ?? dwarf_split_debug_info?  */
10194 	  if (dwarf2out_as_locview_support)
10195 	    {
10196 	      char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10197 
10198 	      if (!ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vbegin))
10199 		{
10200 		  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vbegin);
10201 		  dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label,
10202 						  "View list begin (%s)",
10203 						  list_head->vl_symbol);
10204 		}
10205 	      else
10206 		dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0,
10207 					     "View list begin (%s)",
10208 					     list_head->vl_symbol);
10209 
10210 	      if (!ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vend))
10211 		{
10212 		  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vend);
10213 		  dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label,
10214 						  "View list end (%s)",
10215 						  list_head->vl_symbol);
10216 		}
10217 	      else
10218 		dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0,
10219 					     "View list end (%s)",
10220 					     list_head->vl_symbol);
10221 	    }
10222 	  else
10223 	    {
10224 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vbegin,
10225 					   "View list begin (%s)",
10226 					   list_head->vl_symbol);
10227 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vend,
10228 					   "View list end (%s)",
10229 					   list_head->vl_symbol);
10230 	    }
10231 	}
10232     }
10233 
10234   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
10235 
10236   const char *last_section = NULL;
10237   const char *base_label = NULL;
10238 
10239   /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression.  */
10240   for (dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head; curr != NULL;
10241        curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10242     {
10243       unsigned long size;
10244 
10245       /* Skip this entry?  If we skip it here, we must skip it in the
10246 	 view list above as well. */
10247       if (skip_loc_list_entry (curr, &size))
10248 	continue;
10249 
10250       lcount++;
10251 
10252       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10253 	{
10254 	  if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10255 	    {
10256 	      dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10257 	      /* For -gsplit-dwarf, emit DW_LLE_starx_length, which has
10258 		 uleb128 index into .debug_addr and uleb128 length.  */
10259 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_startx_length,
10260 				   "DW_LLE_startx_length (%s)",
10261 				   list_head->ll_symbol);
10262 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
10263 					   "Location list range start index "
10264 					   "(%s)", curr->begin);
10265 	      /* FIXME: This will ICE ifndef HAVE_AS_LEB128.
10266 		 For that case we probably need to emit DW_LLE_startx_endx,
10267 		 but we'd need 2 .debug_addr entries rather than just one.  */
10268 	      dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
10269 					    "Location list length (%s)",
10270 					    list_head->ll_symbol);
10271 	    }
10272 	  else if (!have_multiple_function_sections && HAVE_AS_LEB128)
10273 	    {
10274 	      dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10275 	      /* If all code is in .text section, the base address is
10276 		 already provided by the CU attributes.  Use
10277 		 DW_LLE_offset_pair where both addresses are uleb128 encoded
10278 		 offsets against that base.  */
10279 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
10280 				   "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
10281 				   list_head->ll_symbol);
10282 	      dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, curr->section,
10283 					    "Location list begin address (%s)",
10284 					    list_head->ll_symbol);
10285 	      dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->section,
10286 					    "Location list end address (%s)",
10287 					    list_head->ll_symbol);
10288 	    }
10289 	  else if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
10290 	    {
10291 	      /* Otherwise, find out how many consecutive entries could share
10292 		 the same base entry.  If just one, emit DW_LLE_start_length,
10293 		 otherwise emit DW_LLE_base_address for the base address
10294 		 followed by a series of DW_LLE_offset_pair.  */
10295 	      if (last_section == NULL || curr->section != last_section)
10296 		{
10297 		  dw_loc_list_ref curr2;
10298 		  for (curr2 = curr->dw_loc_next; curr2 != NULL;
10299 		       curr2 = curr2->dw_loc_next)
10300 		    {
10301 		      if (strcmp (curr2->begin, curr2->end) == 0
10302 			  && !curr2->force)
10303 			continue;
10304 		      break;
10305 		    }
10306 		  if (curr2 == NULL || curr->section != curr2->section)
10307 		    last_section = NULL;
10308 		  else
10309 		    {
10310 		      last_section = curr->section;
10311 		      base_label = curr->begin;
10312 		      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_base_address,
10313 					   "DW_LLE_base_address (%s)",
10314 					   list_head->ll_symbol);
10315 		      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, base_label,
10316 					   "Base address (%s)",
10317 					   list_head->ll_symbol);
10318 		    }
10319 		}
10320 	      /* Only one entry with the same base address.  Use
10321 		 DW_LLE_start_length with absolute address and uleb128
10322 		 length.  */
10323 	      if (last_section == NULL)
10324 		{
10325 		  dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10326 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_length,
10327 				       "DW_LLE_start_length (%s)",
10328 				       list_head->ll_symbol);
10329 		  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10330 				       "Location list begin address (%s)",
10331 				       list_head->ll_symbol);
10332 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
10333 						"Location list length "
10334 						"(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10335 		}
10336 	      /* Otherwise emit DW_LLE_offset_pair, relative to above emitted
10337 		 DW_LLE_base_address.  */
10338 	      else
10339 		{
10340 		  dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10341 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
10342 				       "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
10343 				       list_head->ll_symbol);
10344 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, base_label,
10345 						"Location list begin address "
10346 						"(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10347 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, base_label,
10348 						"Location list end address "
10349 						"(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10350 		}
10351 	    }
10352 	  /* The assembler does not support .uleb128 directive.  Emit
10353 	     DW_LLE_start_end with a pair of absolute addresses.  */
10354 	  else
10355 	    {
10356 	      dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10357 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_end,
10358 				   "DW_LLE_start_end (%s)",
10359 				   list_head->ll_symbol);
10360 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10361 				   "Location list begin address (%s)",
10362 				   list_head->ll_symbol);
10363 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10364 				   "Location list end address (%s)",
10365 				   list_head->ll_symbol);
10366 	    }
10367 	}
10368       else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10369 	{
10370 	  /* For -gsplit-dwarf -gdwarf-{2,3,4} emit index into .debug_addr
10371 	     and 4 byte length.  */
10372 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
10373 			       "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
10374 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
10375 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
10376 				       "Location list range start index (%s)",
10377 				       curr->begin);
10378 	  /* The length field is 4 bytes.  If we ever need to support
10379 	     an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
10380 	     to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry.  */
10381 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
10382 				"Location list range length (%s)",
10383 				list_head->ll_symbol);
10384 	}
10385       else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10386 	{
10387 	  /* Pair of relative addresses against start of text section.  */
10388 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
10389 				"Location list begin address (%s)",
10390 				list_head->ll_symbol);
10391 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
10392 				"Location list end address (%s)",
10393 				list_head->ll_symbol);
10394 	}
10395       else
10396 	{
10397 	  /* Pair of absolute addresses.  */
10398 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10399 			       "Location list begin address (%s)",
10400 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
10401 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10402 			       "Location list end address (%s)",
10403 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
10404 	}
10405 
10406       /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
10407       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10408 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Location expression size");
10409       else
10410 	{
10411 	  gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
10412 	  dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "Location expression size");
10413 	}
10414 
10415       output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
10416     }
10417 
10418   /* And finally list termination.  */
10419   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10420     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_end_of_list,
10421 			 "DW_LLE_end_of_list (%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10422   else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10423     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
10424 			 "Location list terminator (%s)",
10425 			 list_head->ll_symbol);
10426   else
10427     {
10428       dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10429 			   "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
10430 			   list_head->ll_symbol);
10431       dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10432 			   "Location list terminator end (%s)",
10433 			   list_head->ll_symbol);
10434     }
10435 
10436   gcc_assert (!list_head->vl_symbol
10437 	      || vcount == lcount * (dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute () ? 1 : 0));
10438 }
10439 
10440 /* Output a range_list offset into the .debug_ranges or .debug_rnglists
10441    section.  Emit a relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise,
10442    emit an indirect reference.  */
10443 
10444 static void
10445 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
10446 {
10447   const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10448 
10449   if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
10450     {
10451       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10452 	{
10453 	  dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
10454 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
10455 				 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10456 	}
10457       else
10458 	{
10459 	  char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
10460 	  sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
10461 		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10462 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
10463 				 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10464 	  *p = '\0';
10465 	}
10466     }
10467   else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10468     {
10469       dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
10470       gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
10471       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r->idx, "%s", name);
10472     }
10473   else
10474     dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10475 			 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10476                          "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
10477 }
10478 
10479 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section.  */
10480 
10481 static void
10482 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
10483 {
10484   char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
10485 
10486   gcc_assert (sym);
10487   if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10488     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
10489                            "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10490   else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10491     {
10492       gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
10493       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash, "%s (%s)",
10494 				   dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr),
10495 				   sym);
10496     }
10497   else
10498     dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
10499 			  "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10500 }
10501 
10502 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section.  */
10503 
10504 static void
10505 output_view_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
10506 {
10507   char *sym = (*AT_loc_list_ptr (a))->vl_symbol;
10508 
10509   gcc_assert (sym);
10510   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10511     dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
10512                           "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10513   else
10514     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
10515                            "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10516 }
10517 
10518 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately.  */
10519 
10520 static void
10521 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
10522 {
10523   const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10524 
10525   if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
10526     {
10527       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
10528       return;
10529     }
10530   switch (AT_class (a))
10531     {
10532     case dw_val_class_addr:
10533       dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
10534       break;
10535     case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10536     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10537       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
10538       break;
10539     default:
10540       gcc_unreachable ();
10541     }
10542 }
10543 
10544 /* Output a type signature.  */
10545 
10546 static inline void
10547 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
10548 {
10549   int i;
10550 
10551   for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10552     dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10553 }
10554 
10555 /* Output a discriminant value.  */
10556 
10557 static inline void
10558 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
10559 {
10560   if (discr_value->pos)
10561     dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
10562   else
10563     dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
10564 }
10565 
10566 /* Output the DIE and its attributes.  Called recursively to generate
10567    the definitions of each child DIE.  */
10568 
10569 static void
10570 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10571 {
10572   dw_attr_node *a;
10573   dw_die_ref c;
10574   unsigned long size;
10575   unsigned ix;
10576 
10577   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
10578 			       (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10579 			       dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10580 
10581   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
10582     {
10583       const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10584 
10585       switch (AT_class (a))
10586 	{
10587 	case dw_val_class_addr:
10588           output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10589 	  break;
10590 
10591 	case dw_val_class_offset:
10592 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10593 			       "%s", name);
10594 	  break;
10595 
10596 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
10597           output_range_list_offset (a);
10598 	  break;
10599 
10600 	case dw_val_class_loc:
10601 	  size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10602 
10603 	  /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
10604 	  if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10605 	    dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10606 	  else
10607 	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10608 
10609 	  output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
10610 	  break;
10611 
10612 	case dw_val_class_const:
10613 	  /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10614 	     used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10615 	     extend.  Gdb 5.x does sign extend.  */
10616 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10617 	  break;
10618 
10619 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10620 	  {
10621 	    int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10622 	    if (dwarf_version == 3
10623 		&& a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
10624 		&& csize >= 4)
10625 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10626 	    else
10627 	      dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10628 	  }
10629 	  break;
10630 
10631 	case dw_val_class_symview:
10632 	  {
10633 	    int vsize;
10634 	    if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xff)
10635 	      vsize = 1;
10636 	    else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffff)
10637 	      vsize = 2;
10638 	    else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffffffff)
10639 	      vsize = 4;
10640 	    else
10641 	      vsize = 8;
10642 	    dw2_asm_output_addr (vsize, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_symbolic_view,
10643 				 "%s", name);
10644 	  }
10645 	  break;
10646 
10647 	case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
10648 	  if (flag_debug_asm)
10649 	    fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10650 				   HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ")\n",
10651 		     ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_int (a));
10652 	  break;
10653 
10654 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
10655 	  if (flag_debug_asm)
10656 	    fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10657 				   HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX ")\n",
10658 		     ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_unsigned (a));
10659 	  break;
10660 
10661 	case dw_val_class_const_double:
10662 	  {
10663 	    unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10664 
10665 	    if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10666 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10667 				   HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
10668 				   / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10669 				   NULL);
10670 
10671 	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10672 	      {
10673 		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10674 		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10675 	      }
10676 	    else
10677 	      {
10678 		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10679 		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10680 	      }
10681 
10682 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10683                                  first, "%s", name);
10684 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10685 				 second, NULL);
10686 	  }
10687 	  break;
10688 
10689 	case dw_val_class_wide_int:
10690 	  {
10691 	    int i;
10692 	    int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
10693 	    int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10694 	    if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10695 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
10696 				      * l, NULL);
10697 
10698 	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10699 	      for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10700 		{
10701 		  dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10702 				       "%s", name);
10703 		  name = "";
10704 		}
10705 	    else
10706 	      for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
10707 		{
10708 		  dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10709 				       "%s", name);
10710 		  name = "";
10711 		}
10712 	  }
10713 	  break;
10714 
10715 	case dw_val_class_vec:
10716 	  {
10717 	    unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10718 	    unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10719 	    unsigned int i;
10720 	    unsigned char *p;
10721 
10722 	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10723 				 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10724 	    if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10725 	      {
10726 		elt_size /= 2;
10727 		len *= 2;
10728 	      }
10729 	    for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10730 		 i < len;
10731 		 i++, p += elt_size)
10732 	      dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10733 				   "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10734 	    break;
10735 	  }
10736 
10737 	case dw_val_class_flag:
10738 	  if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10739 	    {
10740 	      /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10741 		 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used.  If that ever changes,
10742 		 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10743 		 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10744 		 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10745 		 the same abbrev entry.  */
10746 	      gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
10747 	      if (flag_debug_asm)
10748 		fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
10749 			 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
10750 	      break;
10751 	    }
10752 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10753 	  break;
10754 
10755 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10756 	  output_loc_list_offset (a);
10757 	  break;
10758 
10759 	case dw_val_class_view_list:
10760 	  output_view_list_offset (a);
10761 	  break;
10762 
10763 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10764 	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
10765 	    {
10766 	      if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
10767 	        {
10768 		  comdat_type_node *type_node
10769 		    = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10770 
10771 	          gcc_assert (type_node);
10772 	          output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10773 	        }
10774 	      else
10775 	        {
10776 		  const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10777 		  int size;
10778 
10779 		  gcc_assert (sym);
10780 		  /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10781 		     length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10782 		     offset.  */
10783 		  if (dwarf_version == 2)
10784 		    size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10785 		  else
10786 		    size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10787 		  /* ???  We cannot unconditionally output die_offset if
10788 		     non-zero - others might create references to those
10789 		     DIEs via symbols.
10790 		     And we do not clear its DIE offset after outputting it
10791 		     (and the label refers to the actual DIEs, not the
10792 		     DWARF CU unit header which is when using label + offset
10793 		     would be the correct thing to do).
10794 		     ???  This is the reason for the with_offset flag.  */
10795 		  if (AT_ref (a)->with_offset)
10796 		    dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10797 					   debug_info_section, "%s", name);
10798 		  else
10799 		    dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10800 					   name);
10801 		}
10802 	    }
10803 	  else
10804 	    {
10805 	      gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10806 	      dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10807 				   "%s", name);
10808 	    }
10809 	  break;
10810 
10811 	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10812 	  {
10813 	    char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10814 
10815 	    ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10816 					 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10817 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10818 				   "%s", name);
10819 	  }
10820 	  break;
10821 
10822 	case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10823 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
10824 	  dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10825 				    AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10826 				    "%s", name);
10827 #else
10828 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10829 				AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10830 				"%s", name);
10831 #endif
10832 	  break;
10833 
10834 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10835 	  output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10836 	  break;
10837 
10838 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10839 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10840 				 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10841 	  break;
10842 
10843 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
10844 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10845 				 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10846 	  break;
10847 
10848 	case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
10849 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10850 				 debug_loc_section, "%s", name);
10851 	  break;
10852 
10853 	case dw_val_class_str:
10854           if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
10855             dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10856                                    a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10857                                    debug_str_section,
10858                                    "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10859 	  else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
10860 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10861 				   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10862 				   debug_line_str_section,
10863 				   "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10864           else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10865             dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
10866                                          "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10867           else
10868 	    dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10869 	  break;
10870 
10871 	case dw_val_class_file:
10872 	  {
10873 	    int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10874 
10875 	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10876 				 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10877 	    break;
10878 	  }
10879 
10880 	case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
10881 	  if (flag_debug_asm)
10882 	    fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s (%d, %s)\n",
10883 		     ASM_COMMENT_START, name,
10884 		     maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file),
10885 		     a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10886 	  break;
10887 
10888 	case dw_val_class_data8:
10889 	  {
10890 	    int i;
10891 
10892 	    for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10893 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10894 				   i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10895 	    break;
10896 	  }
10897 
10898 	case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10899 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10900 				get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
10901 	  break;
10902 
10903 	case dw_val_class_discr_value:
10904 	  output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
10905 	  break;
10906 
10907 	case dw_val_class_discr_list:
10908 	  {
10909 	    dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
10910 	    const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
10911 
10912 	    /* This is a block, so output its length first.  */
10913 	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
10914 				 "%s: block size", name);
10915 
10916 	    for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
10917 	      {
10918 		/* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
10919 		   many LEB128 numbers as required.  */
10920 		if (list->dw_discr_range)
10921 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
10922 				       "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
10923 		else
10924 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
10925 				       "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
10926 
10927 		output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
10928 		if (list->dw_discr_range)
10929 		  output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
10930 	      }
10931 	    break;
10932 	  }
10933 
10934 	default:
10935 	  gcc_unreachable ();
10936 	}
10937     }
10938 
10939   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10940 
10941   /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list.  */
10942   if (die->die_child != NULL)
10943     dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
10944 			 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10945 }
10946 
10947 /* Output the dwarf version number.  */
10948 
10949 static void
10950 output_dwarf_version ()
10951 {
10952   /* ??? For now, if -gdwarf-6 is specified, we output version 5 with
10953      views in loclist.  That will change eventually.  */
10954   if (dwarf_version == 6)
10955     {
10956       static bool once;
10957       if (!once)
10958 	{
10959 	  warning (0,
10960 		   "-gdwarf-6 is output as version 5 with incompatibilities");
10961 	  once = true;
10962 	}
10963       dw2_asm_output_data (2, 5, "DWARF version number");
10964     }
10965   else
10966     dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10967 }
10968 
10969 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10970    .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions.  */
10971 
10972 static void
10973 output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type ut)
10974 {
10975   if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10976     {
10977       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10978 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10979 	  "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10980       dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10981 			   next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10982 			   "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10983     }
10984 
10985   output_dwarf_version ();
10986   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10987     {
10988       const char *name;
10989       switch (ut)
10990 	{
10991 	case DW_UT_compile: name = "DW_UT_compile"; break;
10992 	case DW_UT_type: name = "DW_UT_type"; break;
10993 	case DW_UT_split_compile: name = "DW_UT_split_compile"; break;
10994 	case DW_UT_split_type: name = "DW_UT_split_type"; break;
10995 	default: gcc_unreachable ();
10996 	}
10997       dw2_asm_output_data (1, ut, "%s", name);
10998       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10999     }
11000   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
11001 			 debug_abbrev_section,
11002 			 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
11003   if (dwarf_version < 5)
11004     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11005 }
11006 
11007 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children.  */
11008 
11009 static void
11010 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty,
11011 		  const unsigned char *dwo_id)
11012 {
11013   const char *secname, *oldsym;
11014   char *tmp;
11015 
11016   /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones.  */
11017   if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
11018     return;
11019 
11020   /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
11021      about the compilation unit.  Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
11022      will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm'
11023      will then complain when examining the file.  First mark all the DIEs in
11024      this CU so we know which get local refs.  */
11025   mark_dies (die);
11026 
11027   external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
11028 
11029   /* For now, optimize only the main CU, in order to optimize the rest
11030      we'd need to see all of them earlier.  Leave the rest for post-linking
11031      tools like DWZ.  */
11032   if (die == comp_unit_die ())
11033     abbrev_opt_start = vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table);
11034 
11035   build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
11036 
11037   optimize_abbrev_table ();
11038 
11039   delete extern_map;
11040 
11041   /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets.  */
11042   next_die_offset = (dwo_id
11043 		     ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
11044 		     : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
11045   calc_die_sizes (die);
11046 
11047   oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
11048   if (oldsym && die->comdat_type_p)
11049     {
11050       tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
11051 
11052       sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
11053       secname = tmp;
11054       die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
11055       switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11056     }
11057   else
11058     {
11059       switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
11060       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
11061       info_section_emitted = true;
11062     }
11063 
11064   /* For LTO cross unit DIE refs we want a symbol on the start of the
11065      debuginfo section, not on the CU DIE.  */
11066   if ((flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload) && oldsym)
11067     {
11068       /* ???  No way to get visibility assembled without a decl.  */
11069       tree decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, VAR_DECL,
11070 			      get_identifier (oldsym), char_type_node);
11071       TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = true;
11072       TREE_STATIC (decl) = true;
11073       DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = true;
11074       DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
11075       DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = true;
11076       targetm.asm_out.assemble_visibility (decl, VISIBILITY_HIDDEN);
11077 #ifdef ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
11078       /* We prefer a .weak because that handles duplicates from duplicate
11079          archive members in a graceful way.  */
11080       ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
11081 #else
11082       targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, oldsym);
11083 #endif
11084       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
11085     }
11086 
11087   /* Output debugging information.  */
11088   output_compilation_unit_header (dwo_id
11089 				  ? DW_UT_split_compile : DW_UT_compile);
11090   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11091     {
11092       if (dwo_id != NULL)
11093 	for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11094 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
11095     }
11096   output_die (die);
11097 
11098   /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
11099      output_pubnames.  */
11100   if (oldsym)
11101     {
11102       unmark_dies (die);
11103       die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
11104     }
11105 }
11106 
11107 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
11108    and .debug_pubtypes.  This is configured per-target, but can be
11109    overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options.  */
11110 
11111 static inline bool
11112 want_pubnames (void)
11113 {
11114   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11115       /* Names and types go to the early debug part only.  */
11116       || in_lto_p)
11117     return false;
11118   if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
11119     return debug_generate_pub_sections;
11120   return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
11121 }
11122 
11123 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes.  */
11124 
11125 static void
11126 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
11127 {
11128   if (want_pubnames ())
11129     add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
11130 }
11131 
11132 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE.  */
11133 
11134 static inline void
11135 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
11136                         const char *str)
11137 {
11138   dw_attr_node attr;
11139   struct indirect_string_node *node;
11140 
11141   if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
11142     skeleton_debug_str_hash
11143       = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
11144 
11145   node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
11146   find_string_form (node);
11147   if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
11148     node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
11149 
11150   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
11151   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
11152   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
11153   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
11154   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
11155 }
11156 
11157 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
11158    debug_types.  */
11159 
11160 static void
11161 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
11162 {
11163   const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
11164   const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
11165 
11166   add_skeleton_AT_string (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_dwo_name), dwo_file_name);
11167   if (comp_dir != NULL)
11168     add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
11169   add_AT_pubnames (die);
11170   add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
11171 }
11172 
11173 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file.  */
11174 
11175 static void
11176 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit,
11177 				const unsigned char *dwo_id)
11178 {
11179   /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section.  */
11180   remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
11181   remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
11182 
11183   switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
11184   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
11185 
11186   /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header.  This one differs enough from
11187      a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
11188      header.  */
11189   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11190     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11191 			 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit "
11192 			 "DWARF extension");
11193 
11194   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11195 		       DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
11196                        - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
11197                        + size_of_die (comp_unit),
11198                       "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
11199   output_dwarf_version ();
11200   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11201     {
11202       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_UT_skeleton, "DW_UT_skeleton");
11203       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11204     }
11205   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
11206 			 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section,
11207                          "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
11208   if (dwarf_version < 5)
11209     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11210   else
11211     for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11212       dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
11213 
11214   comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
11215   output_die (comp_unit);
11216 
11217   /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section.  */
11218   switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
11219   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
11220 
11221   output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
11222 
11223   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
11224 }
11225 
11226 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children.  */
11227 
11228 static void
11229 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node,
11230 			 bool early_lto_debug ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11231 {
11232   const char *secname;
11233   char *tmp;
11234   int i;
11235 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11236   tree comdat_key;
11237 #endif
11238 
11239   /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs.  */
11240   mark_dies (node->root_die);
11241 
11242   external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
11243 
11244   build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
11245 
11246   delete extern_map;
11247   extern_map = NULL;
11248 
11249   /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets.  */
11250   next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11251   calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
11252 
11253 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11254   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11255     {
11256       if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
11257 	secname = early_lto_debug ? DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION : DEBUG_INFO_SECTION;
11258       else
11259 	secname = (early_lto_debug
11260 		   ? DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION : DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION);
11261     }
11262   else if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
11263     secname = early_lto_debug ? ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_types" : ".debug_types";
11264   else
11265     secname = (early_lto_debug
11266 	       ? ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_types.dwo" : ".debug_types.dwo");
11267 
11268   tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11269   sprintf (tmp, dwarf_version >= 5 ? "wi." : "wt.");
11270   for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11271     sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11272   comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
11273   targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
11274                                  SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
11275                                  comdat_key);
11276 #else
11277   tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11278   sprintf (tmp, (dwarf_version >= 5
11279 		 ? ".gnu.linkonce.wi." : ".gnu.linkonce.wt."));
11280   for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11281     sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11282   secname = tmp;
11283   switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11284 #endif
11285 
11286   /* Output debugging information.  */
11287   output_compilation_unit_header (dwarf_split_debug_info
11288 				  ? DW_UT_split_type : DW_UT_type);
11289   output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
11290   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
11291 		       "Offset to Type DIE");
11292   output_die (node->root_die);
11293 
11294   unmark_dies (node->root_die);
11295 }
11296 
11297 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl.  */
11298 
11299 static const char *
11300 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
11301 {
11302   if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
11303     return NULL;
11304   return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
11305 }
11306 
11307 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate.  */
11308 
11309 static void
11310 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
11311 {
11312   pubname_entry e;
11313 
11314   e.die = die;
11315   e.name = xstrdup (str);
11316   vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
11317 }
11318 
11319 static void
11320 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11321 {
11322   if (!want_pubnames ())
11323     return;
11324 
11325   /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
11326      just read the enclosing die.  For example, if the consumer is looking at a
11327      class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
11328      looked up the class to find the member.  Either way, searching the class is
11329      faster than searching the index.  */
11330   if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
11331       || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
11332     {
11333       const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11334 
11335       if (name)
11336 	add_pubname_string (name, die);
11337     }
11338 }
11339 
11340 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section.  */
11341 
11342 static void
11343 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
11344 {
11345   pubname_entry e;
11346 
11347   gcc_assert (scope_name);
11348   e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
11349   e.die = die;
11350   vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
11351 }
11352 
11353 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate.  */
11354 
11355 static void
11356 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11357 {
11358   pubname_entry e;
11359 
11360   if (!want_pubnames ())
11361     return;
11362 
11363   if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11364        || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
11365       && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
11366     {
11367       tree scope = NULL;
11368       const char *scope_name = "";
11369       const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
11370       const char *name;
11371 
11372       scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
11373       if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11374         {
11375           scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
11376           if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
11377             scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
11378           else
11379             scope_name = "";
11380 	}
11381 
11382       if (TYPE_P (decl))
11383         name = type_tag (decl);
11384       else
11385         name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
11386 
11387       /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
11388 	 it to the table.  */
11389       if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
11390         {
11391           e.die = die;
11392           e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
11393           vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
11394         }
11395 
11396       /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
11397          enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
11398          enum type meets the criteria above.  So rather than re-check the parent
11399          enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
11400          here.  This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
11401          enums don't have names.  */
11402       if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
11403         {
11404           dw_die_ref c;
11405 
11406           FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
11407         }
11408     }
11409 }
11410 
11411 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table.  */
11412 
11413 static void
11414 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
11415 {
11416   dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
11417   int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
11418 
11419   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
11420 
11421   if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
11422     {
11423       /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
11424          byte.  */
11425       uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
11426       switch (die->die_tag)
11427       {
11428         case DW_TAG_typedef:
11429         case DW_TAG_base_type:
11430         case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
11431           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
11432           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
11433           break;
11434         case DW_TAG_enumerator:
11435           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11436                                           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
11437 	  if (!is_cxx ())
11438 	    GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
11439           break;
11440         case DW_TAG_subprogram:
11441           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11442                                           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
11443           if (!is_ada ())
11444             GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
11445           break;
11446         case DW_TAG_constant:
11447           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11448                                           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
11449           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
11450           break;
11451         case DW_TAG_variable:
11452           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11453                                           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
11454           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
11455           break;
11456         case DW_TAG_namespace:
11457         case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
11458           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
11459           break;
11460         case DW_TAG_class_type:
11461         case DW_TAG_interface_type:
11462         case DW_TAG_structure_type:
11463         case DW_TAG_union_type:
11464         case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
11465           GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
11466 	  if (!is_cxx ())
11467 	    GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
11468           break;
11469         default:
11470           /* An unusual tag.  Leave the flag-byte empty.  */
11471           break;
11472       }
11473       dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
11474                            "GDB-index flags");
11475     }
11476 
11477   dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
11478 }
11479 
11480 
11481 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
11482    visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions.  */
11483 
11484 static void
11485 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
11486 {
11487   unsigned i;
11488   unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
11489   pubname_entry *pub;
11490 
11491   if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11492     {
11493       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11494 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11495 	  "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11496       dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11497 			   "Pub Info Length");
11498     }
11499 
11500   /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version.  */
11501   dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF pubnames/pubtypes version");
11502 
11503   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11504     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
11505                            debug_skeleton_info_section,
11506                            "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11507   else
11508     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11509                            debug_info_section,
11510                            "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11511   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
11512 		       "Compilation Unit Length");
11513 
11514   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
11515     {
11516       if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
11517 	{
11518 	  dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
11519 
11520           /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
11521           if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
11522             gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
11523 
11524 	  /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
11525 	     the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
11526 	     unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
11527 	     the skeleton DIE (if there is one).  */
11528 	  if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
11529 	    {
11530 	      comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
11531 
11532 	      if (type_node != NULL)
11533 	        die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
11534 			      ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
11535 			      : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
11536 	    }
11537 
11538           output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
11539 	}
11540     }
11541 
11542   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11543 }
11544 
11545 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary.  */
11546 
11547 static void
11548 output_pubtables (void)
11549 {
11550   if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
11551     return;
11552 
11553   switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
11554   output_pubnames (pubname_table);
11555   /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
11556      It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
11557      simply won't look for the section.  */
11558   switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
11559   output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
11560 }
11561 
11562 
11563 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
11564    Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
11565    text section generated for this compilation unit.  */
11566 
11567 static void
11568 output_aranges (void)
11569 {
11570   unsigned i;
11571   unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
11572 
11573   if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11574     {
11575       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11576 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11577 	  "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11578       dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
11579 			   "Length of Address Ranges Info");
11580     }
11581 
11582   /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5.  */
11583   dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF aranges version");
11584   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11585     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
11586                            debug_skeleton_info_section,
11587                            "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11588   else
11589     dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11590                            debug_info_section,
11591                            "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11592   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
11593   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
11594 
11595   /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here.  */
11596   if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
11597     {
11598       /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
11599 	 pointer size.  */
11600       dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
11601 			   2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11602       for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
11603 	dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
11604     }
11605 
11606   /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
11607      not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
11608      the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
11609      --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
11610      confused with the terminator.  */
11611   if (text_section_used)
11612     {
11613       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
11614       dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
11615 			    text_section_label, "Length");
11616     }
11617   if (cold_text_section_used)
11618     {
11619       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
11620 			   "Address");
11621       dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
11622 			    cold_text_section_label, "Length");
11623     }
11624 
11625   if (have_multiple_function_sections)
11626     {
11627       unsigned fde_idx;
11628       dw_fde_ref fde;
11629 
11630       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
11631 	{
11632 	  if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
11633 	    continue;
11634 	  if (!fde->in_std_section)
11635 	    {
11636 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
11637 				   "Address");
11638 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
11639 				    fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
11640 	    }
11641 	  if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
11642 	    {
11643 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
11644 				   "Address");
11645 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
11646 				    fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
11647 	    }
11648 	}
11649     }
11650 
11651   /* Output the terminator words.  */
11652   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11653   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11654 }
11655 
11656 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges.  Return its index into
11657    ranges_table vector.  */
11658 
11659 static unsigned int
11660 add_ranges_num (int num, bool maybe_new_sec)
11661 {
11662   dw_ranges r = { NULL, num, 0, maybe_new_sec };
11663   vec_safe_push (ranges_table, r);
11664   return vec_safe_length (ranges_table) - 1;
11665 }
11666 
11667 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11668    range terminator if BLOCK is NULL.  MAYBE_NEW_SEC is true if
11669    this entry might be in a different section from previous range.  */
11670 
11671 static unsigned int
11672 add_ranges (const_tree block, bool maybe_new_sec)
11673 {
11674   return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0, maybe_new_sec);
11675 }
11676 
11677 /* Note that (*rnglist_table)[offset] is either a head of a rnglist
11678    chain, or middle entry of a chain that will be directly referred to.  */
11679 
11680 static void
11681 note_rnglist_head (unsigned int offset)
11682 {
11683   if (dwarf_version < 5 || (*ranges_table)[offset].label)
11684     return;
11685   (*ranges_table)[offset].label = gen_internal_sym ("LLRL");
11686 }
11687 
11688 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
11689    When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
11690    for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
11691    parameter force_direct ensures this behavior.  */
11692 
11693 static void
11694 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11695                       bool *added, bool force_direct)
11696 {
11697   unsigned int in_use = vec_safe_length (ranges_by_label);
11698   unsigned int offset;
11699   dw_ranges_by_label rbl = { begin, end };
11700   vec_safe_push (ranges_by_label, rbl);
11701   offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1, true);
11702   if (!*added)
11703     {
11704       add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
11705       *added = true;
11706       note_rnglist_head (offset);
11707     }
11708 }
11709 
11710 /* Emit .debug_ranges section.  */
11711 
11712 static void
11713 output_ranges (void)
11714 {
11715   unsigned i;
11716   static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11717   const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11718   dw_ranges *r;
11719 
11720   switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11721   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11722   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11723     {
11724       int block_num = r->num;
11725 
11726       if (block_num > 0)
11727 	{
11728 	  char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11729 	  char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11730 
11731 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11732 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11733 
11734 	  /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11735 	     unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11736 	     base of the text section.  */
11737 	  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11738 	    {
11739 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11740 				    text_section_label,
11741 				    fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11742 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11743 				    text_section_label, NULL);
11744 	    }
11745 
11746 	  /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11747 	     which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11748 	     about whether the target supports cross-section
11749 	     arithmetic.  */
11750 	  else
11751 	    {
11752 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11753 				   fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11754 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11755 	    }
11756 
11757 	  fmt = NULL;
11758 	}
11759 
11760       /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label.  */
11761       else if (block_num < 0)
11762 	{
11763 	  int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11764 
11765 	  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11766 	    {
11767 	      gcc_unreachable ();
11768 #if 0
11769 	      /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11770 		 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11771 		 the #if 0 above.  */
11772 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11773 				    (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11774 				    text_section_label,
11775 				    fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11776 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11777 				    (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11778 				    text_section_label, NULL);
11779 #endif
11780 	    }
11781 	  else
11782 	    {
11783 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11784 				   (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11785 				   fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11786 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11787 				   (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11788 				   NULL);
11789 	    }
11790 	}
11791       else
11792 	{
11793 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11794 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11795 	  fmt = start_fmt;
11796 	}
11797     }
11798 }
11799 
11800 /* Non-zero if .debug_line_str should be used for .debug_line section
11801    strings or strings that are likely shareable with those.  */
11802 #define DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR \
11803   (!DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET		\
11804    && (DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) != 0		\
11805    /* FIXME: there is no .debug_line_str.dwo section,		\
11806       for -gsplit-dwarf we should use DW_FORM_strx instead.  */	\
11807    && !dwarf_split_debug_info)
11808 
11809 /* Assign .debug_rnglists indexes.  */
11810 
11811 static void
11812 index_rnglists (void)
11813 {
11814   unsigned i;
11815   dw_ranges *r;
11816 
11817   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11818     if (r->label)
11819       r->idx = rnglist_idx++;
11820 }
11821 
11822 /* Emit .debug_rnglists section.  */
11823 
11824 static void
11825 output_rnglists (unsigned generation)
11826 {
11827   unsigned i;
11828   dw_ranges *r;
11829   char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11830   char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11831   char basebuf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11832 
11833   switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11834   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11835   /* There are up to 4 unique ranges labels per generation.
11836      See also init_sections_and_labels.  */
11837   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
11838 			       2 + generation * 4);
11839   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
11840 			       3 + generation * 4);
11841   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11842     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11843 			 "Initial length escape value indicating "
11844 			 "64-bit DWARF extension");
11845   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11846 			"Length of Range Lists");
11847   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11848   output_dwarf_version ();
11849   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11850   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11851   /* Emit the offset table only for -gsplit-dwarf.  If we don't care
11852      about relocation sizes and primarily care about the size of .debug*
11853      sections in linked shared libraries and executables, then
11854      the offset table plus corresponding DW_FORM_rnglistx uleb128 indexes
11855      into it are usually larger than just DW_FORM_sec_offset offsets
11856      into the .debug_rnglists section.  */
11857   dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? rnglist_idx : 0,
11858 		       "Offset Entry Count");
11859   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11860     {
11861       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_base_label);
11862       FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11863 	if (r->label)
11864 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
11865 				ranges_base_label, NULL);
11866     }
11867 
11868   const char *lab = "";
11869   unsigned int len = vec_safe_length (ranges_table);
11870   const char *base = NULL;
11871   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11872     {
11873       int block_num = r->num;
11874 
11875       if (r->label)
11876 	{
11877 	  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, r->label);
11878 	  lab = r->label;
11879 	}
11880       if (HAVE_AS_LEB128 && (r->label || r->maybe_new_sec))
11881 	base = NULL;
11882       if (block_num > 0)
11883 	{
11884 	  char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11885 	  char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11886 
11887 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11888 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11889 
11890 	  if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11891 	    {
11892 	      /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11893 		 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11894 		 base of the text section.  */
11895 	      if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11896 		{
11897 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11898 				       "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11899 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, text_section_label,
11900 						"Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11901 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, text_section_label,
11902 						"Range end address (%s)", lab);
11903 		  continue;
11904 		}
11905 	      if (base == NULL)
11906 		{
11907 		  dw_ranges *r2 = NULL;
11908 		  if (i < len - 1)
11909 		    r2 = &(*ranges_table)[i + 1];
11910 		  if (r2
11911 		      && r2->num != 0
11912 		      && r2->label == NULL
11913 		      && !r2->maybe_new_sec)
11914 		    {
11915 		      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_base_address,
11916 					   "DW_RLE_base_address (%s)", lab);
11917 		      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11918 					   "Base address (%s)", lab);
11919 		      strcpy (basebuf, blabel);
11920 		      base = basebuf;
11921 		    }
11922 		}
11923 	      if (base)
11924 		{
11925 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11926 				       "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11927 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, base,
11928 						"Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11929 		  dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, base,
11930 						"Range end address (%s)", lab);
11931 		  continue;
11932 		}
11933 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11934 				   "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11935 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11936 				   "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11937 	      dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11938 					    "Range length (%s)", lab);
11939 	    }
11940 	  else
11941 	    {
11942 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11943 				   "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11944 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11945 				   "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11946 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11947 				   "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11948 	    }
11949 	}
11950 
11951       /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label.  */
11952       else if (block_num < 0)
11953 	{
11954 	  int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11955 	  const char *blabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin;
11956 	  const char *elabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end;
11957 
11958 	  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11959 	    gcc_unreachable ();
11960 	  if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11961 	    {
11962 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11963 				   "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11964 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11965 				   "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11966 	      dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11967 					    "Range length (%s)", lab);
11968 	    }
11969 	  else
11970 	    {
11971 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11972 				   "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11973 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11974 				   "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11975 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11976 				   "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11977 	    }
11978 	}
11979       else
11980 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_end_of_list,
11981 			     "DW_RLE_end_of_list (%s)", lab);
11982     }
11983   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11984 }
11985 
11986 /* Data structure containing information about input files.  */
11987 struct file_info
11988 {
11989   const char *path;	/* Complete file name.  */
11990   const char *fname;	/* File name part.  */
11991   int length;		/* Length of entire string.  */
11992   struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx;	/* Index in input file table.  */
11993   int dir_idx;		/* Index in directory table.  */
11994 };
11995 
11996 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11997    files.  */
11998 struct dir_info
11999 {
12000   const char *path;	/* Path including directory name.  */
12001   int length;		/* Path length.  */
12002   int prefix;		/* Index of directory entry which is a prefix.  */
12003   int count;		/* Number of files in this directory.  */
12004   int dir_idx;		/* Index of directory used as base.  */
12005 };
12006 
12007 /* Callback function for file_info comparison.  We sort by looking at
12008    the directories in the path.  */
12009 
12010 static int
12011 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
12012 {
12013   const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
12014   const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
12015   const unsigned char *cp1;
12016   const unsigned char *cp2;
12017 
12018   /* Take care of file names without directories.  We need to make sure that
12019      we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
12020      we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
12021      orders.  So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
12022      1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory.  */
12023   if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
12024     return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
12025 
12026   cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
12027   cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
12028 
12029   while (1)
12030     {
12031       ++cp1;
12032       ++cp2;
12033       /* Reached the end of the first path?  If so, handle like above.  */
12034       if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
12035 	  || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
12036 	return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
12037 		- (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
12038 
12039       /* Character of current path component the same?  */
12040       else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
12041 	return *cp1 - *cp2;
12042     }
12043 }
12044 
12045 struct file_name_acquire_data
12046 {
12047   struct file_info *files;
12048   int used_files;
12049   int max_files;
12050 };
12051 
12052 /* Traversal function for the hash table.  */
12053 
12054 int
12055 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
12056 {
12057   struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
12058   struct file_info *fi;
12059   const char *f;
12060 
12061   gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
12062 
12063   if (! d->emitted_number)
12064     return 1;
12065 
12066   gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
12067 
12068   fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
12069 
12070   /* Skip all leading "./".  */
12071   f = d->filename;
12072   while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
12073     f += 2;
12074 
12075   /* Create a new array entry.  */
12076   fi->path = f;
12077   fi->length = strlen (f);
12078   fi->file_idx = d;
12079 
12080   /* Search for the file name part.  */
12081   f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
12082 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
12083   {
12084     char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
12085 
12086     if (g != NULL)
12087       {
12088 	if (f == NULL || f < g)
12089 	  f = g;
12090       }
12091   }
12092 #endif
12093 
12094   fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
12095   return 1;
12096 }
12097 
12098 /* Helper function for output_file_names.  Emit a FORM encoded
12099    string STR, with assembly comment start ENTRY_KIND and
12100    index IDX */
12101 
12102 static void
12103 output_line_string (enum dwarf_form form, const char *str,
12104 		    const char *entry_kind, unsigned int idx)
12105 {
12106   switch (form)
12107     {
12108     case DW_FORM_string:
12109       dw2_asm_output_nstring (str, -1, "%s: %#x", entry_kind, idx);
12110       break;
12111     case DW_FORM_line_strp:
12112       if (!debug_line_str_hash)
12113 	debug_line_str_hash
12114 	  = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
12115 
12116       struct indirect_string_node *node;
12117       node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_line_str_hash);
12118       set_indirect_string (node);
12119       node->form = form;
12120       dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
12121 			     debug_line_str_section, "%s: %#x: \"%s\"",
12122 			     entry_kind, 0, node->str);
12123       break;
12124     default:
12125       gcc_unreachable ();
12126     }
12127 }
12128 
12129 /* Output the directory table and the file name table.  We try to minimize
12130    the total amount of memory needed.  A heuristic is used to avoid large
12131    slowdowns with many input files.  */
12132 
12133 static void
12134 output_file_names (void)
12135 {
12136   struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
12137   int numfiles;
12138   struct file_info *files;
12139   struct dir_info *dirs;
12140   int *saved;
12141   int *savehere;
12142   int *backmap;
12143   int ndirs;
12144   int idx_offset;
12145   int i;
12146 
12147   if (!last_emitted_file)
12148     {
12149       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12150 	{
12151 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Directory entry format count");
12152 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Directories count");
12153 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "File name entry format count");
12154 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "File names count");
12155 	}
12156       else
12157 	{
12158 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
12159 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12160 	}
12161       return;
12162     }
12163 
12164   numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
12165 
12166   /* Allocate the various arrays we need.  */
12167   files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
12168   dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
12169 
12170   fnad.files = files;
12171   fnad.used_files = 0;
12172   fnad.max_files = numfiles;
12173   file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
12174   gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
12175 
12176   qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
12177 
12178   /* Find all the different directories used.  */
12179   dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
12180   dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
12181   dirs[0].prefix = -1;
12182   dirs[0].count = 1;
12183   dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
12184   files[0].dir_idx = 0;
12185   ndirs = 1;
12186 
12187   for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
12188     if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
12189 	&& memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
12190 		   dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
12191       {
12192 	/* Same directory as last entry.  */
12193 	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
12194 	++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
12195       }
12196     else
12197       {
12198 	int j;
12199 
12200 	/* This is a new directory.  */
12201 	dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
12202 	dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
12203 	dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
12204 	dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
12205 	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
12206 
12207 	/* Search for a prefix.  */
12208 	dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
12209 	for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
12210 	  if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
12211 	      && dirs[j].length > 1
12212 	      && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
12213 		  || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
12214 	      && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
12215 	    dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
12216 
12217 	++ndirs;
12218       }
12219 
12220   /* Now to the actual work.  We have to find a subset of the directories which
12221      allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
12222      with the least amount of characters.  We do not do an exhaustive search
12223      where we would have to check out every combination of every single
12224      possible prefix.  Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
12225      results in most cases and never is much off.  */
12226   saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
12227   savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
12228 
12229   memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
12230   for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
12231     {
12232       int j;
12233       int total;
12234 
12235       /* We can always save some space for the current directory.  But this
12236 	 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory.  */
12237       savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
12238       total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
12239 
12240       for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
12241 	{
12242 	  savehere[j] = 0;
12243 	  if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
12244 	    {
12245 	      /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
12246 		 dirs[j] path.  */
12247 	      int k;
12248 
12249 	      k = dirs[j].prefix;
12250 	      while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
12251 		k = dirs[k].prefix;
12252 
12253 	      if (k == (int) i)
12254 		{
12255 		  /* Yes it is.  We can possibly save some memory by
12256 		     writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
12257 		     dirs[i].  */
12258 		  savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
12259 		  total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
12260 		}
12261 	    }
12262 	}
12263 
12264       /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
12265 	 directory.  */
12266       if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
12267 	{
12268 	  /* It's worthwhile adding.  */
12269 	  for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
12270 	    if (savehere[j] > 0)
12271 	      {
12272 		/* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far.  */
12273 		saved[j] = savehere[j];
12274 
12275 		/* Remember the prefix directory.  */
12276 		dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
12277 	      }
12278 	}
12279     }
12280 
12281   /* Emit the directory name table.  */
12282   idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
12283   enum dwarf_form str_form = DW_FORM_string;
12284   enum dwarf_form idx_form = DW_FORM_udata;
12285   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12286     {
12287       const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
12288       if (comp_dir == NULL)
12289 	comp_dir = "";
12290       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Directory entry format count");
12291       if (DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
12292 	str_form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
12293       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
12294       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
12295 				   get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
12296       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ndirs + idx_offset, "Directories count");
12297       if (str_form == DW_FORM_string)
12298 	{
12299 	  dw2_asm_output_nstring (comp_dir, -1, "Directory Entry: %#x", 0);
12300 	  for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12301 	    dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
12302 				    dirs[i].length
12303 				    - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
12304 				    "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
12305 	}
12306       else
12307 	{
12308 	  output_line_string (str_form, comp_dir, "Directory Entry", 0);
12309 	  for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12310 	    {
12311 	      const char *str
12312 		= ggc_alloc_string (dirs[i].path,
12313 				    dirs[i].length
12314 				    - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR);
12315 	      output_line_string (str_form, str, "Directory Entry",
12316 				  (unsigned) i + idx_offset);
12317 	    }
12318 	}
12319     }
12320   else
12321     {
12322       for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12323 	dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
12324 				dirs[i].length
12325 				- !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
12326 				"Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
12327 
12328       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
12329     }
12330 
12331   /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
12332      used in the debug info generation.  To do this efficiently we
12333      generate a back-mapping of the indices first.  */
12334   backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
12335   for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12336     backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
12337 
12338   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12339     {
12340       const char *filename0 = get_AT_string (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_name);
12341       if (filename0 == NULL)
12342 	filename0 = "";
12343       /* DW_LNCT_directory_index can use DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data1 and
12344 	 DW_FORM_data2.  Choose one based on the number of directories
12345 	 and how much space would they occupy in each encoding.
12346 	 If we have at most 256 directories, all indexes fit into
12347 	 a single byte, so DW_FORM_data1 is most compact (if there
12348 	 are at most 128 directories, DW_FORM_udata would be as
12349 	 compact as that, but not shorter and slower to decode).  */
12350       if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 256)
12351 	idx_form = DW_FORM_data1;
12352       /* If there are more than 65536 directories, we have to use
12353 	 DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data2 can't refer to them.
12354 	 Otherwise, compute what space would occupy if all the indexes
12355 	 used DW_FORM_udata - sum - and compare that to how large would
12356 	 be DW_FORM_data2 encoding, and pick the more efficient one.  */
12357       else if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 65536)
12358 	{
12359 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT sum = 1;
12360 	  for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12361 	    {
12362 	      int file_idx = backmap[i];
12363 	      int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
12364 	      sum += size_of_uleb128 (dir_idx);
12365 	    }
12366 	  if (sum >= HOST_WIDE_INT_UC (2) * (numfiles + 1))
12367 	    idx_form = DW_FORM_data2;
12368 	}
12369 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12370       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 4, "File name entry format count");
12371 #else
12372       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "File name entry format count");
12373 #endif
12374       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
12375       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
12376 				   get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
12377       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_directory_index,
12378 				   "DW_LNCT_directory_index");
12379       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (idx_form, "%s",
12380 				   get_DW_FORM_name (idx_form));
12381 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12382       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_timestamp, "DW_LNCT_timestamp");
12383       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
12384       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_size, "DW_LNCT_size");
12385       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
12386 #endif
12387       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (numfiles + 1, "File names count");
12388 
12389       output_line_string (str_form, filename0, "File Entry", 0);
12390 
12391       /* Include directory index.  */
12392       if (idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
12393 	dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
12394 			     0, NULL);
12395       else
12396 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12397 
12398 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12399       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12400       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12401 #endif
12402     }
12403 
12404   /* Now write all the file names.  */
12405   for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12406     {
12407       int file_idx = backmap[i];
12408       int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
12409 
12410 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12411 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
12412 
12413       /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
12414          but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly.  */
12415 
12416       int ver;
12417       long long cdt;
12418       long siz;
12419       int maxfilelen = (strlen (files[file_idx].path)
12420 			+ dirs[dir_idx].length
12421 			+ MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1);
12422       char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
12423 
12424       vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
12425       snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
12426 	        files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
12427 
12428       output_line_string (str_form, filebuf, "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
12429 
12430       /* Include directory index.  */
12431       if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
12432 	dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
12433 			     dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12434       else
12435 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12436 
12437       /* Modification time.  */
12438       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
12439 							 &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
12440 				   ? cdt : 0, NULL);
12441 
12442       /* File length in bytes.  */
12443       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
12444 							 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
12445 				   ? siz : 0, NULL);
12446 #else
12447       output_line_string (str_form,
12448 			  files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length,
12449 			  "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
12450 
12451       /* Include directory index.  */
12452       if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
12453 	dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
12454 			     dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12455       else
12456 	dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12457 
12458       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12459 	continue;
12460 
12461       /* Modification time.  */
12462       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12463 
12464       /* File length in bytes.  */
12465       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12466 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12467     }
12468 
12469   if (dwarf_version < 5)
12470     dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12471 }
12472 
12473 
12474 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section.  */
12475 
12476 static void
12477 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
12478 {
12479   char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12480   unsigned int current_line = 1;
12481   bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
12482   dw_line_info_entry *ent, *prev_addr;
12483   size_t i;
12484   unsigned int view;
12485 
12486   view = 0;
12487 
12488   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
12489     {
12490       switch (ent->opcode)
12491 	{
12492 	case LI_set_address:
12493 	  /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
12494 	     must always use the most general form.  GCC does not know the
12495 	     address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc.  Many
12496 	     ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
12497 	     on the address range.  We could perhaps use length attributes
12498 	     to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc.  */
12499 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
12500 
12501 	  view = 0;
12502 
12503 	  /* This can handle any delta.  This takes
12504 	     4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes.  */
12505 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s%s", line_label,
12506 			       debug_variable_location_views
12507 			       ? ", reset view to 0" : "");
12508 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12509 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12510 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12511 
12512 	  prev_addr = ent;
12513 	  break;
12514 
12515 	case LI_adv_address:
12516 	  {
12517 	    ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
12518 	    char prev_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12519 	    ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (prev_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, prev_addr->val);
12520 
12521 	    view++;
12522 
12523 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc, "fixed advance PC, increment view to %i", view);
12524 	    dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_label,
12525 				  "from %s to %s", prev_label, line_label);
12526 
12527 	    prev_addr = ent;
12528 	    break;
12529 	  }
12530 
12531 	case LI_set_line:
12532 	  if (ent->val == current_line)
12533 	    {
12534 	      /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn.  */
12535 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
12536 				   "copy line %u", current_line);
12537 	    }
12538 	  else
12539 	    {
12540 	      int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
12541 	      int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12542 
12543 	      current_line = ent->val;
12544 	      if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12545 		{
12546 		  /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
12547 		     definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
12548 		     This takes 1 byte.  */
12549 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12550 				       "line %u", current_line);
12551 		}
12552 	      else
12553 		{
12554 		  /* This can handle any delta.  This takes at least 4 bytes,
12555 		     depending on the value being encoded.  */
12556 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12557 				       "advance to line %u", current_line);
12558 		  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12559 		  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
12560 		}
12561 	    }
12562 	  break;
12563 
12564 	case LI_set_file:
12565 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
12566 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
12567 	  break;
12568 
12569 	case LI_set_column:
12570 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
12571 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
12572 	  break;
12573 
12574 	case LI_negate_stmt:
12575 	  current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
12576 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
12577 			       "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
12578 	  break;
12579 
12580 	case LI_set_prologue_end:
12581 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
12582 			       "set prologue end");
12583 	  break;
12584 
12585 	case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
12586 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
12587 			       "set epilogue begin");
12588 	  break;
12589 
12590 	case LI_set_discriminator:
12591 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
12592 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
12593 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
12594 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
12595 	  break;
12596 	}
12597     }
12598 
12599   /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table.  */
12600   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
12601   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12602   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12603   dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
12604 
12605   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
12606   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12607   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12608 }
12609 
12610 /* Output the source line number correspondence information.  This
12611    information goes into the .debug_line section.  */
12612 
12613 static void
12614 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
12615 {
12616   static unsigned int generation;
12617   char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12618   char p1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], p2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12619   bool saw_one = false;
12620   int opc;
12621 
12622   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, generation);
12623   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, generation);
12624   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, generation);
12625   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, generation++);
12626 
12627   if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12628     {
12629       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12630 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12631 	  "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12632       dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
12633 			    "Length of Source Line Info");
12634     }
12635 
12636   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
12637 
12638   output_dwarf_version ();
12639   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12640     {
12641       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
12642       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
12643     }
12644   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
12645   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
12646 
12647   /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
12648      In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
12649      purposes only.  Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
12650      a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
12651      source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
12652      DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands.  Accordingly, we fix
12653      this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
12654      and don't let the target override.  */
12655   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
12656 
12657   if (dwarf_version >= 4)
12658     dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12659 			 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12660   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12661 		       "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12662   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12663 		       "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12664   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12665 		       "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12666   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12667 		       "Special Opcode Base");
12668 
12669   for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12670     {
12671       int n_op_args;
12672       switch (opc)
12673 	{
12674 	case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12675 	case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12676 	case DW_LNS_set_file:
12677 	case DW_LNS_set_column:
12678 	case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12679 	case DW_LNS_set_isa:
12680 	  n_op_args = 1;
12681 	  break;
12682 	default:
12683 	  n_op_args = 0;
12684 	  break;
12685 	}
12686 
12687       dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12688 			   opc, n_op_args);
12689     }
12690 
12691   /* Write out the information about the files we use.  */
12692   output_file_names ();
12693   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12694   if (prologue_only)
12695     {
12696       /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info.  */
12697       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12698       return;
12699     }
12700 
12701   if (separate_line_info)
12702     {
12703       dw_line_info_table *table;
12704       size_t i;
12705 
12706       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
12707 	if (table->in_use)
12708 	  {
12709 	    output_one_line_info_table (table);
12710 	    saw_one = true;
12711 	  }
12712     }
12713   if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
12714     {
12715       output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
12716       saw_one = true;
12717     }
12718 
12719   /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
12720      sequences.  Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
12721      sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
12722      Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
12723      choosing .text since that section is always present.  */
12724   if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
12725     output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
12726 
12727   /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info.  */
12728   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12729 }
12730 
12731 /* Return true if DW_AT_endianity should be emitted according to REVERSE.  */
12732 
12733 static inline bool
12734 need_endianity_attribute_p (bool reverse)
12735 {
12736   return reverse && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict);
12737 }
12738 
12739 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12740    a DIE that describes the given type.  REVERSE is true if the type is
12741    to be interpreted in the reverse storage order wrt the target order.
12742 
12743    This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12744    Dwarf base (fundamental) types.  */
12745 
12746 static dw_die_ref
12747 base_type_die (tree type, bool reverse)
12748 {
12749   dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12750   enum dwarf_type encoding;
12751   bool fpt_used = false;
12752   struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
12753   tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
12754 
12755   /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12756      use the base type.  See subrange_type_for_debug_p.  */
12757   if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12758     type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12759 
12760   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12761     {
12762     case INTEGER_TYPE:
12763       if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12764 	  && TYPE_NAME (type)
12765 	  && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12766 	  && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12767 	  && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12768 	{
12769 	  const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12770 	  if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12771 	      || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12772 	    {
12773 	      encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12774 	      break;
12775 	    }
12776 	}
12777       if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12778 	  && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
12779 	{
12780 	  memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
12781 	  if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
12782 	    {
12783 	      fpt_used = true;
12784 	      encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12785 			  ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
12786 			  : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
12787 	      break;
12788 	    }
12789 	}
12790       if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12791 	{
12792 	  if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12793 	    encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12794 	  else
12795 	    encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12796 	}
12797       else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12798 	encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12799       else
12800 	encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12801 
12802       if (!dwarf_strict
12803 	  && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12804 	type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12805       break;
12806 
12807     case REAL_TYPE:
12808       if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12809 	{
12810 	  if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12811 	    encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12812 	  else
12813 	    encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12814 	}
12815       else
12816 	encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12817       break;
12818 
12819     case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12820       if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12821 	encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12822       else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12823 	encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12824       else
12825 	encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12826       break;
12827 
12828       /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12829 	 a user defined type for it.  */
12830     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12831       if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12832 	encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12833       else
12834 	encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12835       break;
12836 
12837     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12838       /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type.  */
12839       encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12840       break;
12841 
12842     default:
12843       /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types.  */
12844       gcc_unreachable ();
12845     }
12846 
12847   base_type_result = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_base_type);
12848 
12849   add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12850 		   int_size_in_bytes (type));
12851   add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12852 
12853   if (need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse))
12854     add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_endianity,
12855 		     BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? DW_END_little : DW_END_big);
12856 
12857   add_alignment_attribute (base_type_result, type);
12858 
12859   if (fpt_used)
12860     {
12861       switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
12862 	{
12863 	case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
12864 	  add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
12865 		      fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
12866 	  break;
12867 
12868 	case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
12869 	  add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
12870 		      fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
12871 	  break;
12872 
12873 	case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
12874 	  /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
12875 	     yet.  */
12876 	  if (!dwarf_strict)
12877 	    {
12878 	      /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant.  */
12879 	      const dw_die_ref scale_factor
12880 		= new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
12881 
12882 	      add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
12883 			       fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
12884 	      add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
12885 			  fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
12886 
12887 	      add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
12888 	    }
12889 	  break;
12890 
12891 	default:
12892 	  gcc_unreachable ();
12893 	}
12894     }
12895 
12896   if (type_bias)
12897     add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
12898 		     dw_scalar_form_constant
12899 		     | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12900 		     | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12901 		     NULL);
12902 
12903   return base_type_result;
12904 }
12905 
12906 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
12907    named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise.  */
12908 
12909 static inline bool
12910 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
12911 {
12912   if (is_cxx ())
12913     {
12914       tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12915       if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
12916 	  || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
12917 	return true;
12918     }
12919   return false;
12920 }
12921 
12922 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12923    given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type.  Otherwise return null.  */
12924 
12925 static inline int
12926 is_base_type (tree type)
12927 {
12928   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12929     {
12930     case INTEGER_TYPE:
12931     case REAL_TYPE:
12932     case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12933     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12934     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12935     case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
12936       return 1;
12937 
12938     case VOID_TYPE:
12939     case ARRAY_TYPE:
12940     case RECORD_TYPE:
12941     case UNION_TYPE:
12942     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12943     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12944     case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12945     case METHOD_TYPE:
12946     case POINTER_TYPE:
12947     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12948     case NULLPTR_TYPE:
12949     case OFFSET_TYPE:
12950     case LANG_TYPE:
12951     case VECTOR_TYPE:
12952       return 0;
12953 
12954     default:
12955       if (is_cxx_auto (type))
12956 	return 0;
12957       gcc_unreachable ();
12958     }
12959 
12960   return 0;
12961 }
12962 
12963 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12964    node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12965    return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12966    else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12967    ERROR_MARK node.  */
12968 
12969 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12970 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12971 {
12972   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12973     return BITS_PER_WORD;
12974   else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12975     return 0;
12976   else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
12977     return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12978   else
12979     return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12980 }
12981 
12982 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI.  */
12983 
12984 static inline offset_int
12985 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12986 {
12987   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12988     return BITS_PER_WORD;
12989   else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12990     return 0;
12991   else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12992     return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12993   else
12994     return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12995 }
12996 
12997 /*  Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12998     to a DIE that describes the given type.  */
12999 
13000 static dw_die_ref
13001 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
13002 		   dw_die_ref context_die)
13003 {
13004   dw_die_ref subrange_die;
13005   const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
13006 
13007   if (context_die == NULL)
13008     context_die = comp_unit_die ();
13009 
13010   subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
13011 
13012   if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
13013     {
13014       /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
13015 	 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type.  */
13016       add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
13017     }
13018 
13019   add_alignment_attribute (subrange_die, type);
13020 
13021   if (low)
13022     add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
13023   if (high)
13024     add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
13025   if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
13026     add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
13027 		     dw_scalar_form_constant
13028 		     | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
13029 		     | dw_scalar_form_reference,
13030 		     NULL);
13031 
13032   return subrange_die;
13033 }
13034 
13035 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
13036    the decl node.  This will normally be augmented with the
13037    cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute.  */
13038 
13039 static int
13040 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
13041 {
13042   return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
13043 	   /* The C++ front-end correctly marks reference-typed
13044 	      variables as readonly, but from a language (and debug
13045 	      info) standpoint they are not const-qualified.  */
13046 	   && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != REFERENCE_TYPE
13047 	   ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
13048 	  | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
13049 	     ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
13050 }
13051 
13052 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
13053    of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers.  Ignore all
13054    qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK.  */
13055 
13056 static int
13057 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
13058 {
13059   tree t;
13060   int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
13061 
13062   type_quals &= qual_mask;
13063   max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
13064 
13065   for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
13066        t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
13067     {
13068       int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
13069 
13070       if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
13071 	  && check_base_type (t, type))
13072 	{
13073 	  int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
13074 
13075 	  if (rank > best_rank)
13076 	    {
13077 	      best_rank = rank;
13078 	      best_qual = q;
13079 	    }
13080 	}
13081     }
13082 
13083   return best_qual;
13084 }
13085 
13086 struct dwarf_qual_info_t { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
13087 static const dwarf_qual_info_t dwarf_qual_info[] =
13088 {
13089   { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
13090   { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
13091   { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
13092   { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type }
13093 };
13094 static const unsigned int dwarf_qual_info_size
13095   = sizeof (dwarf_qual_info) / sizeof (dwarf_qual_info[0]);
13096 
13097 /* If DIE is a qualified DIE of some base DIE with the same parent,
13098    return the base DIE, otherwise return NULL.  Set MASK to the
13099    qualifiers added compared to the returned DIE.  */
13100 
13101 static dw_die_ref
13102 qualified_die_p (dw_die_ref die, int *mask, unsigned int depth)
13103 {
13104   unsigned int i;
13105   for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
13106     if (die->die_tag == dwarf_qual_info[i].t)
13107       break;
13108   if (i == dwarf_qual_info_size)
13109     return NULL;
13110   if (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) != 1)
13111     return NULL;
13112   dw_die_ref type = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_type);
13113   if (type == NULL || type->die_parent != die->die_parent)
13114     return NULL;
13115   *mask |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
13116   if (depth)
13117     {
13118       dw_die_ref ret = qualified_die_p (type, mask, depth - 1);
13119       if (ret)
13120 	return ret;
13121     }
13122   return type;
13123 }
13124 
13125 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
13126    entry that chains the modifiers specified by CV_QUALS in front of the
13127    given type.  REVERSE is true if the type is to be interpreted in the
13128    reverse storage order wrt the target order.  */
13129 
13130 static dw_die_ref
13131 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, bool reverse,
13132 		   dw_die_ref context_die)
13133 {
13134   enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
13135   dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
13136   dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
13137   tree item_type = NULL;
13138   tree qualified_type;
13139   tree name, low, high;
13140   dw_die_ref mod_scope;
13141   /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled.  */
13142   const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
13143 			    | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC |
13144 			    ENCODE_QUAL_ADDR_SPACE(~0U));
13145   const bool reverse_base_type
13146     = need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse) && is_base_type (type);
13147 
13148   if (code == ERROR_MARK)
13149     return NULL;
13150 
13151   if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
13152     {
13153       tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
13154 
13155       if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
13156 	return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, reverse, context_die);
13157     }
13158 
13159   cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
13160 
13161   /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
13162      tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
13163      to handle it.  */
13164   if (dwarf_version < 3)
13165     cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
13166 
13167   /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5.  */
13168   if (dwarf_version < 5)
13169     cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
13170 
13171   /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
13172      this type.  */
13173   qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
13174 
13175   if (qualified_type == sizetype)
13176     {
13177       /* Try not to expose the internal sizetype type's name.  */
13178       if (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
13179 	  && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
13180 	{
13181 	  tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
13182 
13183 	  gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
13184 			       && (TYPE_PRECISION (t)
13185 				   == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type))
13186 			       && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
13187 				   == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type)));
13188 	  qualified_type = t;
13189 	}
13190       else if (qualified_type == sizetype
13191 	       && TREE_CODE (sizetype) == TREE_CODE (size_type_node)
13192 	       && TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) == TYPE_PRECISION (size_type_node)
13193 	       && TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype) == TYPE_UNSIGNED (size_type_node))
13194 	qualified_type = size_type_node;
13195       if (type == sizetype)
13196 	type = qualified_type;
13197     }
13198 
13199   /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists.  */
13200   if (qualified_type)
13201     {
13202       mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
13203 
13204       /* DW_AT_endianity doesn't come from a qualifier on the type, so it is
13205 	 dealt with specially: the DIE with the attribute, if it exists, is
13206 	 placed immediately after the regular DIE for the same base type.  */
13207       if (mod_type_die
13208 	  && (!reverse_base_type
13209 	      || ((mod_type_die = mod_type_die->die_sib) != NULL
13210 		  && get_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_endianity))))
13211 	return mod_type_die;
13212     }
13213 
13214   name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
13215 
13216   /* Handle C typedef types.  */
13217   if (name
13218       && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
13219       && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
13220       && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
13221     {
13222       tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
13223 
13224       /* Skip the typedef for base types with DW_AT_endianity, no big deal.  */
13225       if (qualified_type == dtype && !reverse_base_type)
13226 	{
13227 	  tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
13228 
13229 	  /* Typedef variants that have an abstract origin don't get their own
13230 	     type DIE (see gen_typedef_die), so fall back on the ultimate
13231 	     abstract origin instead.  */
13232 	  if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
13233 	    return modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (origin), cv_quals, reverse,
13234 				      context_die);
13235 
13236 	  /* For a named type, use the typedef.  */
13237 	  gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
13238 	  return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
13239 	}
13240       else
13241 	{
13242 	  int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
13243 	  dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
13244 	  if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
13245 	      || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
13246 	    /* cv-unqualified version of named type.  Just use
13247 	       the unnamed type to which it refers.  */
13248 	    return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name), cv_quals,
13249 				      reverse, context_die);
13250 	  /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through.  */
13251 	}
13252     }
13253 
13254   mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
13255 
13256   if (cv_quals)
13257     {
13258       int sub_quals = 0, first_quals = 0;
13259       unsigned i;
13260       dw_die_ref first = NULL, last = NULL;
13261 
13262       /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
13263 	 this one.  Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
13264 	 qualifiers.  */
13265       sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
13266 						  cv_qual_mask);
13267       if (sub_quals && use_debug_types)
13268 	{
13269 	  bool needed = false;
13270 	  /* If emitting type units, make sure the order of qualifiers
13271 	     is canonical.  Thus, start from unqualified type if
13272 	     an earlier qualifier is missing in sub_quals, but some later
13273 	     one is present there.  */
13274 	  for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
13275 	    if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
13276 	      needed = true;
13277 	    else if (needed && (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals))
13278 	      {
13279 		sub_quals = 0;
13280 		break;
13281 	      }
13282 	}
13283       mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, reverse, context_die);
13284       if (mod_scope && mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_parent == mod_scope)
13285 	{
13286 	  /* As not all intermediate qualified DIEs have corresponding
13287 	     tree types, ensure that qualified DIEs in the same scope
13288 	     as their DW_AT_type are emitted after their DW_AT_type,
13289 	     only with other qualified DIEs for the same type possibly
13290 	     in between them.  Determine the range of such qualified
13291 	     DIEs now (first being the base type, last being corresponding
13292 	     last qualified DIE for it).  */
13293 	  unsigned int count = 0;
13294 	  first = qualified_die_p (mod_type_die, &first_quals,
13295 				   dwarf_qual_info_size);
13296 	  if (first == NULL)
13297 	    first = mod_type_die;
13298 	  gcc_assert ((first_quals & ~sub_quals) == 0);
13299 	  for (count = 0, last = first;
13300 	       count < (1U << dwarf_qual_info_size);
13301 	       count++, last = last->die_sib)
13302 	    {
13303 	      int quals = 0;
13304 	      if (last == mod_scope->die_child)
13305 		break;
13306 	      if (qualified_die_p (last->die_sib, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size)
13307 		  != first)
13308 		break;
13309 	    }
13310 	}
13311 
13312       for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
13313 	if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
13314 	  {
13315 	    dw_die_ref d;
13316 	    if (first && first != last)
13317 	      {
13318 		for (d = first->die_sib; ; d = d->die_sib)
13319 		  {
13320 		    int quals = 0;
13321 		    qualified_die_p (d, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size);
13322 		    if (quals == (first_quals | dwarf_qual_info[i].q))
13323 		      break;
13324 		    if (d == last)
13325 		      {
13326 			d = NULL;
13327 			break;
13328 		      }
13329 		  }
13330 		if (d)
13331 		  {
13332 		    mod_type_die = d;
13333 		    continue;
13334 		  }
13335 	      }
13336 	    if (first)
13337 	      {
13338 		d = new_die_raw (dwarf_qual_info[i].t);
13339 		add_child_die_after (mod_scope, d, last);
13340 		last = d;
13341 	      }
13342 	    else
13343 	      d = new_die (dwarf_qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
13344 	    if (mod_type_die)
13345 	      add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
13346 	    mod_type_die = d;
13347 	    first_quals |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
13348 	  }
13349     }
13350   else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
13351     {
13352       dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
13353       if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
13354 	{
13355 	  if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
13356 	    tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
13357 	  else
13358 	    tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
13359 	}
13360       mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
13361 
13362       add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
13363 		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
13364       add_alignment_attribute (mod_type_die, type);
13365       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13366 
13367       addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
13368       if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
13369 	{
13370 	  int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
13371 	  if (action >= 0)
13372 	    {
13373 	      /* Positive values indicate an address_class.  */
13374 	      add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
13375 	    }
13376 	  else
13377 	    {
13378 	      /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg.  */
13379 	      dw_loc_descr_ref d
13380 		= one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13381 	      add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
13382 	    }
13383 	}
13384     }
13385   else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
13386 	   && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
13387 	   && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
13388     {
13389       tree bias = NULL_TREE;
13390       if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
13391 	bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
13392       mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
13393       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13394     }
13395   else if (is_base_type (type))
13396     {
13397       mod_type_die = base_type_die (type, reverse);
13398 
13399       /* The DIE with DW_AT_endianity is placed right after the naked DIE.  */
13400       if (reverse_base_type)
13401 	{
13402 	  dw_die_ref after_die
13403 	    = modified_type_die (type, cv_quals, false, context_die);
13404 	  add_child_die_after (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die, after_die);
13405 	}
13406       else
13407 	add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die);
13408 
13409       add_pubtype (type, mod_type_die);
13410     }
13411   else
13412     {
13413       gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13414 
13415       /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
13416 	 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
13417 	 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
13418 	 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
13419 	 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
13420 	 ..._TYPE node.  */
13421       if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
13422 	  || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
13423 	{
13424 	  /* For function/method types, can't just use type_main_variant here,
13425 	     because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
13426 	     but try to canonicalize.  */
13427 	  tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
13428 	  for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
13429 	    if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
13430 		&& check_base_type (t, main)
13431 		&& check_lang_type (t, type))
13432 	      return lookup_type_die (t);
13433 	  return lookup_type_die (type);
13434 	}
13435       else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
13436 	       && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
13437 	return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
13438       else
13439 	/* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
13440 	   not the main variant.  */
13441 	return lookup_type_die (type);
13442     }
13443 
13444   /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE.  For those,
13445      don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
13446      user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
13447      Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
13448      if the base type already has the same name.  */
13449   if (name
13450       && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
13451 	   && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
13452 	       || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
13453 	  || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
13454 	      && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
13455 	      && DECL_NAME (name))))
13456     {
13457       if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
13458 	/* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
13459 	   but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
13460 	   useful source coordinates anyway.  */
13461 	name = DECL_NAME (name);
13462       add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
13463     }
13464   /* This probably indicates a bug.  */
13465   else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
13466     {
13467       name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
13468       add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
13469 			  name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
13470     }
13471 
13472   if (qualified_type && !reverse_base_type)
13473     equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
13474 
13475   if (item_type)
13476     /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
13477        this is a recursive type.  This ensures that the modified_type_die
13478        recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive.  Recursive
13479        types are possible in Ada.  */
13480     sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
13481 				 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
13482 				 reverse,
13483 				 context_die);
13484 
13485   if (sub_die != NULL)
13486     add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
13487 
13488   add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
13489   if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
13490     add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
13491 
13492   return mod_type_die;
13493 }
13494 
13495 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
13496    T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
13497    See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more.  */
13498 
13499 static void
13500 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
13501 {
13502   tree parms, args;
13503   int parms_num, i;
13504   dw_die_ref die = NULL;
13505   int non_default;
13506 
13507   if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
13508     return;
13509 
13510   if (TYPE_P (t))
13511     die = lookup_type_die (t);
13512   else if (DECL_P (t))
13513     die = lookup_decl_die (t);
13514 
13515   gcc_assert (die);
13516 
13517   parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
13518   if (!parms)
13519     /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
13520        or function. End of story.  */
13521     return;
13522 
13523   parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
13524   args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
13525   if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
13526     non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
13527   else
13528     non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
13529   for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
13530     {
13531       tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
13532       dw_die_ref parm_die;
13533 
13534       parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
13535       arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
13536       arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
13537       gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
13538 
13539       if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
13540 	{
13541 	  /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
13542 	     emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
13543 	     by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
13544 	     pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
13545 	     an argument pack.  */
13546 	  if (arg_pack_elems)
13547 	    parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
13548 						    arg_pack_elems,
13549 						    die);
13550 	  else
13551 	    parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
13552 					      true /* emit name */, die);
13553 	  if (i >= non_default)
13554 	    add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
13555 	}
13556     }
13557 }
13558 
13559 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
13560    the representation of a generic type parameter.
13561    For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
13562    ARG is the argument to PARM.
13563    EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
13564    name of the PARM.
13565    PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
13566    as a child node.  */
13567 
13568 static dw_die_ref
13569 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
13570 		       bool emit_name_p,
13571 		       dw_die_ref parent_die)
13572 {
13573   dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
13574   const char *name = NULL;
13575 
13576   if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
13577     return NULL;
13578 
13579   /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
13580      type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
13581      generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
13582      and arguments.  */
13583   if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13584     /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter  */
13585     tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
13586   else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
13587     /* PARM is a type generic parameter.  */
13588     tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
13589   else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
13590     /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
13591        Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
13592        DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
13593        parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
13594        name of the template template argument.  */
13595     tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
13596 			parent_die, parm);
13597   else
13598     gcc_unreachable ();
13599 
13600   if (tmpl_die)
13601     {
13602       tree tmpl_type;
13603 
13604       /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
13605          emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
13606 	 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
13607 	 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
13608 	 the die.  */
13609       if (emit_name_p)
13610 	{
13611 	  name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
13612 	  gcc_assert (name);
13613 	  add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
13614 	}
13615 
13616       if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
13617 	{
13618 	  /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
13619 	     TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
13620 	     to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
13621 	     If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
13622 	     child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG.  */
13623 	  tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
13624 	  add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
13625 			      (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
13626 			       ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
13627 			      false, parent_die);
13628 	}
13629       else
13630 	{
13631 	  /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
13632 	     a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
13633 	     parameter in C++ and arg is a template.  */
13634 
13635 	  /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
13636 	     to the name of the argument.  */
13637 	  name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
13638 	  if (name)
13639 	    add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
13640 	}
13641 
13642       if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13643 	/* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
13644 	   DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
13645 	   attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
13646 	   of ARG.
13647 	   We must be careful here:
13648 	   The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
13649 	   We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
13650 	   type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
13651 	   know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
13652 	   emitted after cgraph computations.
13653 	   So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
13654 	   after cgraph is ready.  */
13655 	append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
13656     }
13657 
13658   return tmpl_die;
13659 }
13660 
13661 /* Generate and return a  DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
13662    PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
13663    will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE.  */
13664 
13665 static dw_die_ref
13666 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
13667 			     tree parm_pack_args,
13668 			     dw_die_ref parent_die)
13669 {
13670   dw_die_ref die;
13671   int j;
13672 
13673   gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
13674 
13675   die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
13676   add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
13677   for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13678     generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13679 			   TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13680 			   false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13681 			   die);
13682   return die;
13683 }
13684 
13685 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13686    an enumerated type.  */
13687 
13688 static inline int
13689 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13690 {
13691   return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13692 }
13693 
13694 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node.  */
13695 
13696 static unsigned int
13697 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13698 {
13699   unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13700 
13701   gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13702 
13703 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13704   if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13705     {
13706       int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13707       if (leaf_reg != -1)
13708 	regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13709     }
13710 #endif
13711 
13712   regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13713   gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
13714   return regno;
13715 }
13716 
13717 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13718    DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13719    doesn't end with DW_OP_piece.  */
13720 
13721 static void
13722 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13723 {
13724   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13725 
13726   if (*list_head != NULL)
13727     {
13728       /* Find the end of the chain.  */
13729       for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13730 	;
13731 
13732       if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13733 	loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13734     }
13735 }
13736 
13737 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13738    zero if there is none.  */
13739 
13740 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13741 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13742 {
13743   rtx regs;
13744 
13745   if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13746     return 0;
13747 
13748   /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13749      post-prologue local stack frame.  We do this by *not* running
13750      register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13751      argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13752      Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case.  */
13753   if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13754       && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13755     {
13756       dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13757 
13758       if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13759 	{
13760 	  result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
13761 				       initialized);
13762 	  if (result)
13763 	    add_loc_descr (&result,
13764 			   new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13765 	}
13766       return result;
13767     }
13768 
13769   regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13770 
13771   if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
13772     return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13773   else
13774     {
13775       unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13776       if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13777 	return 0;
13778       return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
13779     }
13780 }
13781 
13782 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13783    a given hard register number.  */
13784 
13785 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13786 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13787 {
13788   dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13789 
13790   if (regno <= 31)
13791     reg_loc_descr
13792       = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13793   else
13794     reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13795 
13796   if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13797     add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13798 
13799   return reg_loc_descr;
13800 }
13801 
13802 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13803    designates a value that spans more than one register.  */
13804 
13805 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13806 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13807 			     enum var_init_status initialized)
13808 {
13809   int size, i;
13810   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13811 
13812   /* Simple, contiguous registers.  */
13813   if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13814     {
13815       unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
13816       int nregs;
13817 
13818 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13819       if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13820 	{
13821 	  int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13822 	  if (leaf_reg != -1)
13823 	    reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13824 	}
13825 #endif
13826 
13827       gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13828       nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
13829 
13830       /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces.  */
13831       if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)).is_constant (&size))
13832 	return NULL;
13833       size /= nregs;
13834 
13835       loc_result = NULL;
13836       while (nregs--)
13837 	{
13838 	  dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13839 
13840 	  t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13841 				      VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13842 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13843 	  add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13844 	  ++reg;
13845 	}
13846       return loc_result;
13847     }
13848 
13849   /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations.  */
13850 
13851   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13852 
13853   /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces.  */
13854   if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0))).is_constant (&size))
13855     return NULL;
13856   loc_result = NULL;
13857 
13858   for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13859     {
13860       dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13861 
13862       t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13863 				  VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13864       add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13865       add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13866     }
13867 
13868   if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13869     add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13870   return loc_result;
13871 }
13872 
13873 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13874 
13875 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
13876    as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
13877    and DW_OP_shl.  */
13878 
13879 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13880 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13881 {
13882   dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
13883   add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13884   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13885   return ret;
13886 }
13887 
13888 /* Return a location descriptor that designates constant POLY_I.  */
13889 
13890 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13891 int_loc_descriptor (poly_int64 poly_i)
13892 {
13893   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13894 
13895   HOST_WIDE_INT i;
13896   if (!poly_i.is_constant (&i))
13897     {
13898       /* Create location descriptions for the non-constant part and
13899 	 add any constant offset at the end.  */
13900       dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL;
13901       HOST_WIDE_INT constant = poly_i.coeffs[0];
13902       for (unsigned int j = 1; j < NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS; ++j)
13903 	{
13904 	  HOST_WIDE_INT coeff = poly_i.coeffs[j];
13905 	  if (coeff != 0)
13906 	    {
13907 	      dw_loc_descr_ref start = ret;
13908 	      unsigned int factor;
13909 	      int bias;
13910 	      unsigned int regno = targetm.dwarf_poly_indeterminate_value
13911 		(j, &factor, &bias);
13912 
13913 	      /* Add COEFF * ((REGNO / FACTOR) - BIAS) to the value:
13914 		 add COEFF * (REGNO / FACTOR) now and subtract
13915 		 COEFF * BIAS from the final constant part.  */
13916 	      constant -= coeff * bias;
13917 	      add_loc_descr (&ret, new_reg_loc_descr (regno, 0));
13918 	      if (coeff % factor == 0)
13919 		coeff /= factor;
13920 	      else
13921 		{
13922 		  int amount = exact_log2 (factor);
13923 		  gcc_assert (amount >= 0);
13924 		  add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (amount));
13925 		  add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13926 		}
13927 	      if (coeff != 1)
13928 		{
13929 		  add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (coeff));
13930 		  add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13931 		}
13932 	      if (start)
13933 		add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13934 	    }
13935 	}
13936       loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, constant);
13937       return ret;
13938     }
13939 
13940   /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13941      defaulting to the LEB encoding.  */
13942   if (i >= 0)
13943     {
13944       int clz = clz_hwi (i);
13945       int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13946       if (i <= 31)
13947 	op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13948       else if (i <= 0xff)
13949 	op = DW_OP_const1u;
13950       else if (i <= 0xffff)
13951 	op = DW_OP_const2u;
13952       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13953 	       && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13954 	/* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
13955 	   DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13956 	   while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes.  */
13957 	return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
13958       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13959 	       && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13960 	/* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13961 	   while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes.  */
13962 	return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13963 
13964       else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13965 	       && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13966 		  <= 4)
13967 	{
13968 	  /* As i >= 2**31, the double cast above will yield a negative number.
13969 	     Since wrapping is defined in DWARF expressions we can output big
13970 	     positive integers as small negative ones, regardless of the size
13971 	     of host wide ints.
13972 
13973 	     Here, since the evaluator will handle 32-bit values and since i >=
13974 	     2**31, we know it's going to be interpreted as a negative literal:
13975 	     store it this way if we can do better than 5 bytes this way.  */
13976 	  return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13977 	}
13978       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13979 	op = DW_OP_const4u;
13980 
13981       /* Past this point, i >= 0x100000000 and thus DW_OP_constu will take at
13982 	 least 6 bytes: see if we can do better before falling back to it.  */
13983       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13984 	       && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13985 	/* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes.  */
13986 	return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13987       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13988 	       && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
13989 		  >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13990 	/* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
13991 	   DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes.  */
13992 	return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
13993       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13994 	       && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13995 	       && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
13996 	/* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes.  */
13997 	return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
13998       else
13999 	op = DW_OP_constu;
14000     }
14001   else
14002     {
14003       if (i >= -0x80)
14004 	op = DW_OP_const1s;
14005       else if (i >= -0x8000)
14006 	op = DW_OP_const2s;
14007       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
14008 	{
14009 	  if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
14010 	    {
14011 	      dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
14012 	      add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14013 	      return ret;
14014 	    }
14015 	  op = DW_OP_const4s;
14016 	}
14017       else
14018 	{
14019 	  if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
14020 	      < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
14021 	    {
14022 	      dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
14023 	      add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14024 	      return ret;
14025 	    }
14026 	  op = DW_OP_consts;
14027 	}
14028     }
14029 
14030   return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
14031 }
14032 
14033 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants.  */
14034 
14035 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14036 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
14037 {
14038   const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
14039   const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
14040     = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
14041 
14042   /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling.  */
14043   if (i <= max_int)
14044     return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
14045 
14046   /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
14047      HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
14048          max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
14049 
14050      Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
14051      whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
14052      wrapping, we know that:
14053          x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14054 	   = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
14055      So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
14056      small negative integers.  Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
14057      the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
14058      DW_OP_const4s.  */
14059   if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14060       && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
14061 	  || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
14062     {
14063       const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
14064 
14065       /* Now, -1 <  first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
14066 	 i.e.  0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT).  */
14067       const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
14068         = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
14069 
14070       /* So we finally have:
14071 	      -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
14072 	 i.e.  min (HOST_WIDE_INT)     <= second_shift <  0.  */
14073       return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
14074     }
14075 
14076   /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation.  */
14077   return new_loc_descr
14078      ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
14079       ? DW_OP_const4u
14080       : DW_OP_const8u,
14081       i, 0);
14082 }
14083 
14084 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
14085    comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
14086    entry and a is the second one).  The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
14087    LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR.  */
14088 
14089 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14090 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
14091 {
14092   enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
14093   dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
14094 
14095   switch (kind)
14096     {
14097     case LT_EXPR:
14098       op = DW_OP_lt;
14099       break;
14100     case LE_EXPR:
14101       op = DW_OP_le;
14102       break;
14103     case GT_EXPR:
14104       op = DW_OP_gt;
14105       break;
14106     case GE_EXPR:
14107       op = DW_OP_ge;
14108       break;
14109     default:
14110       gcc_unreachable ();
14111     }
14112 
14113   bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14114   jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14115 
14116   /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers.  It is nevertheless
14117      possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
14118      three cases:
14119 
14120        1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
14121 	  return: a OP(signed) b;
14122 
14123        2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
14124 	  is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
14125 	  are flipped.
14126 
14127      So first, compare the sign of the two operands.  */
14128   ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
14129   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14130   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
14131   /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
14132      the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
14133      zero.  */
14134   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
14135   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
14136   add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14137 
14138   /* We are in case 1.  At this point, we know both operands have the same
14139      sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison.  */
14140   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14141   add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
14142 
14143   /* We are in case 2.  Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
14144      so we have to flip the signed comparison.  */
14145   flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
14146   tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
14147   bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14148   bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14149   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14150 
14151   /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join.  */
14152   tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14153   jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14154   jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14155   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14156 
14157   return ret;
14158 }
14159 
14160 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
14161    them).  Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails.  */
14162 
14163 static dw_loc_list_ref
14164 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
14165 			       enum tree_code kind)
14166 {
14167   if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
14168     return NULL;
14169 
14170   add_loc_list (&left, right);
14171   if (left == NULL)
14172     return NULL;
14173 
14174   add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
14175   return left;
14176 }
14177 
14178 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
14179    without actually allocating it.  */
14180 
14181 static unsigned long
14182 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
14183 {
14184   return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
14185 	 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
14186 	 + 1;
14187 }
14188 
14189 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
14190    actually allocating it.  */
14191 
14192 static unsigned long
14193 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
14194 {
14195   unsigned long s;
14196 
14197   if (i >= 0)
14198     {
14199       int clz, ctz;
14200       if (i <= 31)
14201 	return 1;
14202       else if (i <= 0xff)
14203 	return 2;
14204       else if (i <= 0xffff)
14205 	return 3;
14206       clz = clz_hwi (i);
14207       ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
14208       if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
14209 	  && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14210 	return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14211 						    - clz - 5);
14212       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
14213 	       && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14214 	return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14215 						    - clz - 8);
14216       else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
14217 	       && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
14218 		  <= 4)
14219 	return size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
14220       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
14221 	return 5;
14222       s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
14223       if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
14224 	  && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14225 	return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14226 						    - clz - 8);
14227       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
14228 	       && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14229 	return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14230 						    - clz - 16);
14231       else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
14232 	       && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14233 	       && s > 6)
14234 	return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14235 						    - clz - 32);
14236       else
14237 	return 1 + s;
14238     }
14239   else
14240     {
14241       if (i >= -0x80)
14242 	return 2;
14243       else if (i >= -0x8000)
14244 	return 3;
14245       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
14246 	{
14247 	  if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
14248 	    {
14249 	      s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
14250 	      if (s < 5)
14251 		return s;
14252 	    }
14253 	  return 5;
14254 	}
14255       else
14256 	{
14257 	  unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
14258 	  if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
14259 	    {
14260 	      s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
14261 	      if (s < r)
14262 		return s;
14263 	    }
14264 	  return r;
14265 	}
14266     }
14267 }
14268 
14269 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
14270    This can appear only as toplevel expression.  */
14271 
14272 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14273 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
14274 {
14275   int litsize;
14276   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
14277 
14278   if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14279     return NULL;
14280 
14281   litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
14282   /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
14283      is more compact.  For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
14284      litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
14285      and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
14286      1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size.  */
14287   if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
14288     {
14289       loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
14290       add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
14291 		     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14292       return loc_result;
14293     }
14294 
14295   loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14296 			      size, 0);
14297   loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
14298   loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
14299   return loc_result;
14300 }
14301 
14302 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location.  */
14303 
14304 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14305 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, poly_int64 offset,
14306 		 enum var_init_status initialized)
14307 {
14308   unsigned int regno;
14309   dw_loc_descr_ref result;
14310   dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
14311 
14312   /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
14313      post-prologue local stack frame.  We do this by *not* running
14314      register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
14315      argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.  */
14316   if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
14317     {
14318       rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
14319 		  ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
14320 		  : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
14321 
14322       if (elim != reg)
14323 	{
14324 	  elim = strip_offset_and_add (elim, &offset);
14325 	  gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
14326 		       && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
14327 			   || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
14328 	              || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
14329 				  ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
14330 				  : stack_pointer_rtx));
14331 
14332 	  /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
14333 	     pointer + offset to access stack variables.  If stack
14334 	     is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
14335 	     access stack variables.  */
14336 	  if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
14337 	      && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
14338 	    {
14339 	      int base_reg
14340 		= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
14341 				      ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
14342 				      : REGNO (elim));
14343 	      return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
14344 	    }
14345 
14346 	  gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
14347 	  offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
14348 	  HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
14349 	  if (offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
14350 	    return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, const_offset, 0);
14351 	  else
14352 	    {
14353 	      dw_loc_descr_ref ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, 0, 0);
14354 	      loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, offset);
14355 	      return ret;
14356 	    }
14357 	}
14358     }
14359 
14360   regno = REGNO (reg);
14361 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
14362   if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
14363     {
14364       int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
14365       if (leaf_reg != -1)
14366 	regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
14367     }
14368 #endif
14369   regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
14370 
14371   HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
14372   if (!optimize && fde
14373       && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno)
14374       && offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
14375     {
14376       /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
14377 	 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
14378 	 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
14379 	 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
14380 	 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
14381 	 else in other part of the routine.  */
14382       return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, const_offset, 0);
14383     }
14384 
14385   result = new_reg_loc_descr (regno, offset);
14386 
14387   if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14388     add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14389 
14390   return result;
14391 }
14392 
14393 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation.  */
14394 
14395 static inline int
14396 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
14397 {
14398   return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
14399 	  && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14400 	       && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
14401 	       && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
14402 }
14403 
14404 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
14405    failed.  */
14406 
14407 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14408 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
14409 {
14410   tree base;
14411   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
14412 
14413   if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
14414     return NULL;
14415 
14416   base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
14417   if (base == NULL
14418       || !VAR_P (base)
14419       || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
14420     return NULL;
14421 
14422   loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
14423   if (loc_result == NULL)
14424     return NULL;
14425 
14426   if (maybe_ne (MEM_OFFSET (mem), 0))
14427     loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
14428 
14429   return loc_result;
14430 }
14431 
14432 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
14433    expression.  */
14434 
14435 static void
14436 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
14437 {
14438   if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
14439     {
14440       fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
14441       if (expr)
14442 	print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
14443       if (rtl)
14444 	{
14445 	  fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
14446 	  print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
14447 	}
14448       fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
14449     }
14450 }
14451 
14452 /* True if handling a former CONST by mem_loc_descriptor piecewise.  */
14453 
14454 static bool in_const_p;
14455 
14456 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output.  */
14457 
14458 static bool
14459 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
14460 {
14461   if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
14462     {
14463       if (GET_CODE (rtl) != UNSPEC)
14464 	{
14465 	  expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14466 			    "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
14467 	  return false;
14468 	}
14469 
14470       /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, and
14471 	 the target hook doesn't explicitly allow it in debug info, assume
14472 	 we can't express it in the debug info.  */
14473       /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
14474 	 delegitimize.  Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
14475 	 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
14476 	 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization.  */
14477       if (flag_checking
14478 	  && !in_const_p
14479 	  && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
14480 	      || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
14481 	      || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
14482 	inform (current_function_decl
14483 		? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
14484 		: UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
14485 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
14486 		"non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
14487 		((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
14488 		 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
14489 		XINT (rtl, 1));
14490 #else
14491 		"non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
14492 		XINT (rtl, 1));
14493 #endif
14494       expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14495 			"UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
14496       return false;
14497     }
14498 
14499   if (CONST_POLY_INT_P (rtl))
14500     return false;
14501 
14502   /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
14503      of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
14504      We should really identify / validate expressions
14505      enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
14506      targets and only handle legitimate cases here.  */
14507   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14508     {
14509     case SYMBOL_REF:
14510       break;
14511     case NOT:
14512     case NEG:
14513       return false;
14514     case PLUS:
14515       {
14516 	/* Make sure SYMBOL_REFs/UNSPECs are at most in one of the
14517 	   operands.  */
14518 	subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
14519 	bool first = false;
14520 	FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
14521 	  if (SYMBOL_REF_P (*iter)
14522 	      || LABEL_P (*iter)
14523 	      || GET_CODE (*iter) == UNSPEC)
14524 	    {
14525 	      first = true;
14526 	      break;
14527 	    }
14528 	if (!first)
14529 	  return true;
14530 	FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 1), ALL)
14531 	  if (SYMBOL_REF_P (*iter)
14532 	      || LABEL_P (*iter)
14533 	      || GET_CODE (*iter) == UNSPEC)
14534 	    return false;
14535 	return true;
14536       }
14537     case MINUS:
14538       {
14539 	/* Disallow negation of SYMBOL_REFs or UNSPECs when they
14540 	   appear in the second operand of MINUS.  */
14541 	subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
14542 	FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 1), ALL)
14543 	  if (SYMBOL_REF_P (*iter)
14544 	      || LABEL_P (*iter)
14545 	      || GET_CODE (*iter) == UNSPEC)
14546 	    return false;
14547 	return true;
14548       }
14549     default:
14550       return true;
14551     }
14552 
14553   if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
14554     {
14555       bool marked;
14556       get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
14557       /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
14558 	 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.  */
14559       if (!marked)
14560 	{
14561 	  expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14562 			    "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
14563 	  return false;
14564 	}
14565     }
14566 
14567   if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
14568     return false;
14569 
14570   /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
14571      the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
14572      and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
14573      dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway.  Hidden symbols, guaranteed
14574      to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine.  */
14575   if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
14576     {
14577       tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
14578 
14579       if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
14580 	{
14581 	  expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14582 			    "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
14583 	  return false;
14584 	}
14585     }
14586 
14587   return true;
14588 }
14589 
14590 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
14591    DW_AT_const_value.  TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
14592    non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it.  */
14593 
14594 static bool
14595 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
14596 {
14597   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
14598     return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
14599 
14600   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
14601     {
14602       subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
14603       FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
14604 	if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
14605 	  return false;
14606       return true;
14607     }
14608 
14609   return true;
14610 }
14611 
14612 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
14613    if possible, NULL otherwise.  */
14614 
14615 static dw_die_ref
14616 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
14617 {
14618   dw_die_ref type_die;
14619   tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
14620 
14621   if (type == NULL)
14622     return NULL;
14623   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
14624     {
14625     case INTEGER_TYPE:
14626     case REAL_TYPE:
14627       break;
14628     default:
14629       return NULL;
14630     }
14631   type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
14632   if (!type_die)
14633     type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
14634 				  comp_unit_die ());
14635   if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
14636     return NULL;
14637   return type_die;
14638 }
14639 
14640 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
14641    type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
14642    DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped.  Return NULL if the conversion is not
14643    possible.  */
14644 
14645 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14646 convert_descriptor_to_mode (scalar_int_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
14647 {
14648   machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
14649   dw_die_ref type_die;
14650   dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14651 
14652   if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14653     {
14654       add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0));
14655       return op;
14656     }
14657   type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
14658   if (type_die == NULL)
14659     return NULL;
14660   cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14661   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14662   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14663   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14664   add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
14665   return op;
14666 }
14667 
14668 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1.  */
14669 
14670 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14671 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
14672 			dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14673 {
14674   dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
14675   add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14676   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14677   if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
14678     {
14679       add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
14680       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
14681     }
14682   return ret;
14683 }
14684 
14685 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
14686    comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
14687    and in which OP_MODE is bigger than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE.  */
14688 
14689 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14690 scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (enum dwarf_location_atom op,
14691 			      scalar_int_mode op_mode,
14692 			      dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14693 {
14694   dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
14695   dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14696 
14697   if (type_die == NULL)
14698     return NULL;
14699   cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14700   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14701   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14702   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14703   add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14704   cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14705   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14706   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14707   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14708   add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14709   return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14710 }
14711 
14712 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
14713    comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
14714    and in which OP_MODE is smaller than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE.  */
14715 
14716 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14717 scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14718 				scalar_int_mode op_mode,
14719 				dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14720 {
14721   int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14722   /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
14723      there is no need to do the fancy shifting up.  */
14724   if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
14725     {
14726       dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14727       for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14728 	;
14729       for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14730 	;
14731       /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
14732 	 whether they are zero extended or not.  */
14733       if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
14734 	    && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14735 	   || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14736 	       && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14737 		  == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
14738 	  && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
14739 	       && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14740 	      || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14741 		  && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14742 		     == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
14743 	return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14744 
14745       /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
14746 	 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
14747 	 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
14748 	 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
14749 	 or
14750 	 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
14751 	 DW_OP_{eq,ne}.  Pick whatever is shorter.  */
14752       if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14753 	  && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14754 	  && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
14755 	      + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
14756 	      >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
14757 		 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14758 					       & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
14759 	{
14760 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
14761 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14762 	  op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14763 				    & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
14764 	  return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14765 	}
14766     }
14767   add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14768   add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14769   if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14770     op1 = int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
14771   else
14772     {
14773       add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14774       add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14775     }
14776   return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14777 }
14778 
14779 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL.  */
14780 
14781 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14782 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14783 			 machine_mode mem_mode)
14784 {
14785   machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14786   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14787 
14788   if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14789     op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14790   if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14791     return NULL;
14792 
14793   scalar_int_mode int_op_mode;
14794   if (dwarf_strict
14795       && dwarf_version < 5
14796       && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode)
14797 	  || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14798     return NULL;
14799 
14800   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14801 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14802   op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14803 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14804 
14805   if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14806     return NULL;
14807 
14808   if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode))
14809     {
14810       if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14811 	return scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (op, rtl, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14812 
14813       if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14814 	return scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (op, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14815     }
14816   return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14817 }
14818 
14819 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL.  */
14820 
14821 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14822 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14823 			 machine_mode mem_mode)
14824 {
14825   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14826 
14827   machine_mode test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14828   if (test_op_mode == VOIDmode)
14829     test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14830 
14831   scalar_int_mode op_mode;
14832   if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (test_op_mode, &op_mode))
14833     return NULL;
14834 
14835   if (dwarf_strict
14836       && dwarf_version < 5
14837       && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14838     return NULL;
14839 
14840   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14841 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14842   op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14843 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14844 
14845   if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14846     return NULL;
14847 
14848   if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14849     {
14850       HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
14851       dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14852       for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14853 	;
14854       for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14855 	;
14856       if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14857 	op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
14858       /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again.  */
14859       else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14860 	       || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14861 	{
14862 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14863 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14864 	}
14865       if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14866 	op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
14867       /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again.  */
14868       else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14869 	       || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14870 	{
14871 	  add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14872 	  add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14873 	}
14874     }
14875   else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14876     {
14877       HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14878       bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14879       add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14880       if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14881 	op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14882 				  + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14883       else
14884 	add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14885 					    bias, 0));
14886     }
14887   return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14888 }
14889 
14890 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}.  */
14891 
14892 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14893 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14894 		       machine_mode mem_mode)
14895 {
14896   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14897   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
14898   dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14899 
14900   scalar_int_mode int_mode;
14901   if (dwarf_strict
14902       && dwarf_version < 5
14903       && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14904 	  || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14905     return NULL;
14906 
14907   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14908 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14909   op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14910 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14911 
14912   if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14913     return NULL;
14914 
14915   add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14916   add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14917   add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14918   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14919     {
14920       /* Checked by the caller.  */
14921       int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
14922       if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14923 	{
14924 	  HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (int_mode);
14925 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14926 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14927 	  add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14928 	  add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14929 	}
14930       else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14931 	{
14932 	  HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14933 	  bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14934 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14935 	  add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14936 	}
14937     }
14938   else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14939 	   && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14940     {
14941       int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14942       add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14943       add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14944       add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14945       add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14946     }
14947   else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14948 	   && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14949     {
14950       dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 0);
14951       dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14952       if (type_die == NULL)
14953 	return NULL;
14954       cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14955       cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14956       cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14957       cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14958       add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14959       cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14960       cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14961       cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14962       cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14963       add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14964     }
14965 
14966   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14967     op = DW_OP_lt;
14968   else
14969     op = DW_OP_gt;
14970   ret = op0;
14971   add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14972   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14973   bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14974   add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14975   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14976   drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14977   add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
14978   bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14979   bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14980   if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
14981       && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14982       && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14983     ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, ret);
14984   return ret;
14985 }
14986 
14987 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor.  Perform OP binary op,
14988    but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
14989    convert back to unsigned.  */
14990 
14991 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14992 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
14993 	     scalar_int_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
14994 {
14995   dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
14996 
14997   if (type_die == NULL)
14998     return NULL;
14999   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15000 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15001   op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15002 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15003   if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
15004     return NULL;
15005   cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15006   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15007   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15008   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15009   add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15010   cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15011   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15012   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15013   cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15014   add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
15015   add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
15016   add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15017   return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
15018 }
15019 
15020 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
15021    const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
15022    const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
15023    and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
15024    for the mode):
15025        DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
15026    L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
15027    L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
15028        DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
15029    L3: DW_OP_drop
15030    L4: DW_OP_nop
15031 
15032    CTZ is similar:
15033        DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
15034    L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
15035    L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
15036        DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
15037    L3: DW_OP_drop
15038    L4: DW_OP_nop
15039 
15040    FFS is similar:
15041        DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
15042    L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
15043    L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
15044        DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
15045    L3: DW_OP_drop
15046    L4: DW_OP_nop  */
15047 
15048 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15049 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15050 		    machine_mode mem_mode)
15051 {
15052   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
15053   HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
15054   dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
15055   dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
15056   dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
15057   dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
15058   rtx msb;
15059 
15060   if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
15061     return NULL;
15062 
15063   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15064 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15065   if (op0 == NULL)
15066     return NULL;
15067   ret = op0;
15068   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
15069     {
15070       if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
15071 	valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
15072     }
15073   else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
15074     valv = 0;
15075   else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
15076     valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
15077   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
15078   l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15079   add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
15080   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
15081   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
15082 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15083   if (tmp == NULL)
15084     return NULL;
15085   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15086   l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15087   add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
15088   l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
15089 				? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
15090 				mode, mem_mode,
15091 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15092   if (l1label == NULL)
15093     return NULL;
15094   add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
15095   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15096   l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15097   add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
15098   if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
15099     msb = const1_rtx;
15100   else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15101     msb = GEN_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U
15102 		   << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
15103   else
15104     msb = immed_wide_int_const
15105       (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
15106 			    GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
15107   if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
15108     tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
15109 			 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
15110 			 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
15111   else
15112     tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
15113 			      VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15114   if (tmp == NULL)
15115     return NULL;
15116   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15117   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15118   l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15119   add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
15120   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15121 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15122   if (tmp == NULL)
15123     return NULL;
15124   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15125   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
15126 				      ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15127   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15128   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
15129   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15130   l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15131   add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
15132   l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15133   add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
15134   l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
15135   add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
15136   l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15137   l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
15138   l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15139   l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
15140   l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15141   l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
15142   l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15143   l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
15144   return ret;
15145 }
15146 
15147 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
15148    const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
15149        const0 DW_OP_swap
15150    L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
15151        DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
15152    L2: DW_OP_drop
15153 
15154    PARITY is similar:
15155    L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
15156        DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
15157    L2: DW_OP_drop  */
15158 
15159 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15160 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15161 			 machine_mode mem_mode)
15162 {
15163   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
15164   dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
15165   dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
15166 
15167   if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
15168     return NULL;
15169 
15170   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15171 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15172   if (op0 == NULL)
15173     return NULL;
15174   ret = op0;
15175   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15176 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15177   if (tmp == NULL)
15178     return NULL;
15179   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15180   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15181   l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15182   add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
15183   l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15184   add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
15185   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
15186   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
15187   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15188 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15189   if (tmp == NULL)
15190     return NULL;
15191   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15192   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15193   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
15194 				      ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
15195   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15196   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15197 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15198   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15199   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15200   l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15201   add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
15202   l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15203   add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
15204   l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15205   l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
15206   l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15207   l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
15208   return ret;
15209 }
15210 
15211 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
15212        constS const0
15213    L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
15214        const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
15215        DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
15216        DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
15217    L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop  */
15218 
15219 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15220 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15221 		      machine_mode mem_mode)
15222 {
15223   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
15224   dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
15225   dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
15226 
15227   if (BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
15228       || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
15229 	  && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
15230     return NULL;
15231 
15232   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15233 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15234   if (op0 == NULL)
15235     return NULL;
15236 
15237   ret = op0;
15238   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
15239 			    mode, mem_mode,
15240 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15241   if (tmp == NULL)
15242     return NULL;
15243   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15244   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15245 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15246   if (tmp == NULL)
15247     return NULL;
15248   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15249   l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
15250   add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
15251   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
15252 			    mode, mem_mode,
15253 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15254   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15255   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
15256   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15257   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15258   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
15259 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15260   if (tmp == NULL)
15261     return NULL;
15262   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15263   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15264   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
15265   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15266   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
15267   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15268   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
15269   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15270 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15271   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15272   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
15273   l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15274   add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
15275   tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
15276 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15277   add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15278   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15279   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15280   l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15281   add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
15282   l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15283   add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
15284   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15285   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
15286   l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15287   l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
15288   l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15289   l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
15290   return ret;
15291 }
15292 
15293 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
15294    DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
15295    [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
15296    DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
15297 
15298    ROTATERT is similar:
15299    DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
15300    DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
15301    [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or  */
15302 
15303 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15304 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15305 		       machine_mode mem_mode)
15306 {
15307   rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15308   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
15309   int i;
15310 
15311   if (is_narrower_int_mode (GET_MODE (rtlop1), mode))
15312     rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
15313   op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15314 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15315   op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
15316 			    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15317   if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
15318     return NULL;
15319   if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15320     for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
15321       {
15322 	if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15323 	  mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
15324 					mode, mem_mode,
15325 					VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15326 	else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15327 	  mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
15328 				   ? DW_OP_const4u
15329 				   : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
15330 				   ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
15331 				   GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
15332 	else
15333 	  mask[i] = NULL;
15334 	if (mask[i] == NULL)
15335 	  return NULL;
15336 	add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15337       }
15338   ret = op0;
15339   add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
15340   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15341   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15342   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
15343     {
15344       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
15345       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15346 					  GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
15347     }
15348   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15349   if (mask[0] != NULL)
15350     add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
15351   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
15352   if (mask[1] != NULL)
15353     {
15354       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15355       add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
15356       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15357     }
15358   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
15359     {
15360       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
15361       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15362 					  GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
15363     }
15364   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15365   add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
15366   return ret;
15367 }
15368 
15369 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor.  Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
15370    for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL.  */
15371 
15372 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15373 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
15374 {
15375   dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
15376   dw_die_ref ref;
15377 
15378   if (dwarf_strict)
15379     return NULL;
15380   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
15381   /* With LTO during LTRANS we get the late DIE that refers to the early
15382      DIE, thus we add another indirection here.  This seems to confuse
15383      gdb enough to make gcc.dg/guality/pr68860-1.c FAIL with LTO.  */
15384   ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
15385   ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
15386   if (ref)
15387     {
15388       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15389       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
15390       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15391     }
15392   else
15393     {
15394       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
15395       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
15396     }
15397   return ret;
15398 }
15399 
15400 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
15401    (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
15402    mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
15403    hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
15404 
15405    When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
15406    the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
15407    equivalent.  This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
15408    it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
15409 
15410    MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
15411 
15412    MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
15413    autoincrement addressing modes.
15414 
15415    Return 0 if we can't represent the location.  */
15416 
15417 dw_loc_descr_ref
15418 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
15419 		    machine_mode mem_mode,
15420 		    enum var_init_status initialized)
15421 {
15422   dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
15423   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15424   dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
15425   rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
15426   poly_int64 offset;
15427 
15428   if (mode == VOIDmode)
15429     mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15430 
15431   /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
15432      description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
15433      actually within the array.  That's *not* necessarily the same as the
15434      zeroth element of the array.  */
15435 
15436   rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15437 
15438   if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
15439     return NULL;
15440 
15441   scalar_int_mode int_mode, inner_mode, op1_mode;
15442   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15443     {
15444     case POST_INC:
15445     case POST_DEC:
15446     case POST_MODIFY:
15447       return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
15448 
15449     case SUBREG:
15450       /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
15451 	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
15452 	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
15453 	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
15454 	 contains the given subreg.  */
15455       if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
15456 	break;
15457       inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
15458       /* FALLTHRU */
15459     case TRUNCATE:
15460       if (inner == NULL_RTX)
15461         inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15462       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15463 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
15464 	  && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15465 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15466 	      || (int_mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
15467 #endif
15468 	     )
15469 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15470 	{
15471 	  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
15472 					       inner_mode,
15473 					       mem_mode, initialized);
15474 	  break;
15475 	}
15476       if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15477 	break;
15478       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15479 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
15480 	  ? GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
15481 	  : known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))))
15482 	{
15483 	  dw_die_ref type_die;
15484 	  dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15485 
15486 	  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
15487 					       GET_MODE (inner),
15488 					       mem_mode, initialized);
15489 	  if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
15490 	    break;
15491 	  type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15492 	  if (type_die == NULL)
15493 	    {
15494 	      mem_loc_result = NULL;
15495 	      break;
15496 	    }
15497 	  if (maybe_ne (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))))
15498 	    cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15499 	  else
15500 	    cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_reinterpret), 0, 0);
15501 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15502 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15503 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15504 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15505 	  if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15506 	      && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15507 	    {
15508 	      /* Convert it to untyped afterwards.  */
15509 	      cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15510 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15511 	    }
15512 	}
15513       break;
15514 
15515     case REG:
15516       if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15517 	  || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15518 	      && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
15519 	      && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
15520 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15521 	      && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
15522 #endif
15523 	      ))
15524 	{
15525 	  dw_die_ref type_die;
15526 	  unsigned int dbx_regnum;
15527 
15528 	  if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15529 	    break;
15530 	  if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
15531 	    break;
15532 	  type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15533 	  if (type_die == NULL)
15534 	    break;
15535 
15536 	  dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
15537 	  if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
15538 	    break;
15539 	  mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_regval_type),
15540 					  dbx_regnum, 0);
15541 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15542 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15543 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15544 	  break;
15545 	}
15546       /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
15547 	 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
15548 	 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
15549 	 a "base register".  This distinction is not based in any way upon
15550 	 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
15551 	 belongs to.  This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
15552 	 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
15553 	 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
15554 	 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
15555 	 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg).  This may look deceptively like
15556 	 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
15557 	 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
15558 	 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG.  */
15559       if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
15560 	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15561       else if (stack_realign_drap
15562 	       && crtl->drap_reg
15563 	       && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
15564 	       && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
15565 	{
15566 	  /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
15567 	     out, use DRAP instead.  */
15568 	  mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
15569 					    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15570 	}
15571       break;
15572 
15573     case SIGN_EXTEND:
15574     case ZERO_EXTEND:
15575       if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15576 	  || !is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode))
15577 	break;
15578       op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
15579 				mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15580       if (op0 == 0)
15581 	break;
15582       else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
15583 	       && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15584 	       && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15585 	       /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
15586 		  to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
15587 		  masking.  */
15588 	       && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= 4)
15589 	{
15590 	  mem_loc_result = op0;
15591 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15592 			 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (inner_mode)));
15593 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15594 	}
15595       else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15596 	{
15597 	  int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode);
15598 	  shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
15599 	  if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
15600 	    op = DW_OP_shra;
15601 	  else
15602 	    op = DW_OP_shr;
15603 	  mem_loc_result = op0;
15604 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
15605 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15606 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
15607 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15608 	}
15609       else if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15610 	{
15611 	  dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
15612 	  dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15613 
15614 	  type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (inner_mode,
15615 					  GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
15616 	  if (type_die1 == NULL)
15617 	    break;
15618 	  type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
15619 	  if (type_die2 == NULL)
15620 	    break;
15621 	  mem_loc_result = op0;
15622 	  cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15623 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15624 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
15625 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15626 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15627 	  cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15628 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15629 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
15630 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15631 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15632 	}
15633       break;
15634 
15635     case MEM:
15636       {
15637 	rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15638 	if (new_rtl != rtl)
15639 	  {
15640 	    mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
15641 						 initialized);
15642 	    if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
15643 	      return mem_loc_result;
15644 	  }
15645       }
15646       mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15647 					   get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
15648 					   VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15649       if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
15650 	mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
15651       if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
15652 	{
15653 	  if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15654 	      || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15655 	    {
15656 	      dw_die_ref type_die;
15657 	      dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
15658 	      HOST_WIDE_INT size;
15659 
15660 	      if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15661 		return NULL;
15662 	      if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
15663 		return NULL;
15664 	      type_die
15665 		= base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15666 	      if (type_die == NULL)
15667 		return NULL;
15668 	      deref = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_deref_type), size, 0);
15669 	      deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15670 	      deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15671 	      deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15672 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
15673 	    }
15674 	  else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15675 	    add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
15676 	  else
15677 	    add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15678 			   new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
15679 					  GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0));
15680 	}
15681       break;
15682 
15683     case LO_SUM:
15684       return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
15685 
15686     case LABEL_REF:
15687       /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
15688 	 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
15689 	 pool.  */
15690     case CONST:
15691     case SYMBOL_REF:
15692     case UNSPEC:
15693       if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15694 	  || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15695 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15696 	      && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
15697 #endif
15698 	      ))
15699 	break;
15700 
15701       if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
15702 	{
15703 	  /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
15704 	     can't express it in the debug info.  This can happen e.g. with some
15705 	     TLS UNSPECs.  Allow UNSPECs formerly from CONST that the backend
15706 	     approves.  */
15707 	  bool not_ok = false;
15708 
15709 	  if (!in_const_p)
15710 	    break;
15711 
15712 	  subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
15713 	  FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, rtl, ALL)
15714 	    if (*iter != rtl && !CONSTANT_P (*iter))
15715 	      {
15716 		not_ok = true;
15717 		break;
15718 	      }
15719 
15720 	  if (not_ok)
15721 	    break;
15722 
15723 	  FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, rtl, ALL)
15724 	    if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
15725 	      {
15726 		not_ok = true;
15727 		break;
15728 	      }
15729 
15730 	  if (not_ok)
15731 	    break;
15732 
15733 	  rtl = gen_rtx_CONST (GET_MODE (rtl), rtl);
15734 	  goto symref;
15735 	}
15736 
15737       if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
15738 	  && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
15739 	{
15740 	  dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15741 
15742 	  /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data.  */
15743 	  if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15744 	    break;
15745 
15746           temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
15747 
15748 	  /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
15749 	     DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12.  */
15750 	  mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr ((dwarf_version >= 5
15751 					   ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
15752 					   : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address),
15753 					  0, 0);
15754 	  add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
15755 
15756 	  break;
15757 	}
15758 
15759       if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15760 	{
15761 	  if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
15762 	    switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15763 	      {
15764 	      case NOT:
15765 		op = DW_OP_not;
15766 		goto try_const_unop;
15767 	      case NEG:
15768 		op = DW_OP_neg;
15769 		goto try_const_unop;
15770 	      try_const_unop:
15771 		rtx arg;
15772 		arg = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
15773 		if (!CONSTANT_P (arg))
15774 		  arg = gen_rtx_CONST (int_mode, arg);
15775 		op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (arg, int_mode, mem_mode,
15776 					  initialized);
15777 		if (op0)
15778 		  {
15779 		    mem_loc_result = op0;
15780 		    add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15781 		  }
15782 		break;
15783 	      default:
15784 		{
15785 		  bool save_in_const_p = in_const_p;
15786 		  in_const_p = true;
15787 		  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode,
15788 						       mem_mode, initialized);
15789 		  in_const_p = save_in_const_p;
15790 		}
15791 		break;
15792 	      }
15793 	  break;
15794 	}
15795 
15796     symref:
15797       mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15798       vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
15799       break;
15800 
15801     case CONCAT:
15802     case CONCATN:
15803     case VAR_LOCATION:
15804     case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
15805       expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
15806 			"CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
15807       return 0;
15808 
15809     case ENTRY_VALUE:
15810       if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15811 	return NULL;
15812       if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
15813 	{
15814 	  if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15815 	      || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15816 	    op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15817 				      VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15818 	  else
15819 	    {
15820               unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
15821 	      if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
15822 		return NULL;
15823 	      op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
15824 					    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15825 	    }
15826 	}
15827       else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
15828 	       && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
15829 	{
15830 	  op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15831 				    VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15832 	  if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
15833 	    return NULL;
15834 	}
15835       else
15836 	gcc_unreachable ();
15837       if (op0 == NULL)
15838 	return NULL;
15839       mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_entry_value), 0, 0);
15840       mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15841       mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
15842       break;
15843 
15844     case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
15845       mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
15846       break;
15847 
15848     case PRE_MODIFY:
15849       /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
15850 	 PLUS code below.  */
15851       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15852       goto plus;
15853 
15854     case PRE_INC:
15855     case PRE_DEC:
15856       /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
15857 	 below.  */
15858       rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
15859 			  gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
15860 					? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
15861 					: -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
15862 					mode));
15863 
15864       /* fall through */
15865 
15866     case PLUS:
15867     plus:
15868       if (is_based_loc (rtl)
15869 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15870 	  && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15871 	      || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
15872 	      || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx))
15873 	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15874 					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
15875 					  VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15876       else
15877 	{
15878 	  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15879 					       VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15880 	  if (mem_loc_result == 0)
15881 	    break;
15882 
15883 	  if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15884 	      && (GET_MODE_SIZE (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode))
15885 		  <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15886 	    loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15887 	  else
15888 	    {
15889 	      op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15890 					VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15891 	      if (op1 == 0)
15892 		return NULL;
15893 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15894 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15895 			     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15896 	    }
15897 	}
15898       break;
15899 
15900     /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
15901        be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift.  */
15902     case MINUS:
15903       op = DW_OP_minus;
15904       goto do_binop;
15905 
15906     case MULT:
15907       op = DW_OP_mul;
15908       goto do_binop;
15909 
15910     case DIV:
15911       if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15912 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15913 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15914 	{
15915 	  mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15916 					base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15917 					int_mode, mem_mode);
15918 	  break;
15919 	}
15920       op = DW_OP_div;
15921       goto do_binop;
15922 
15923     case UMOD:
15924       op = DW_OP_mod;
15925       goto do_binop;
15926 
15927     case ASHIFT:
15928       op = DW_OP_shl;
15929       goto do_shift;
15930 
15931     case ASHIFTRT:
15932       op = DW_OP_shra;
15933       goto do_shift;
15934 
15935     case LSHIFTRT:
15936       op = DW_OP_shr;
15937       goto do_shift;
15938 
15939     do_shift:
15940       if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15941 	break;
15942       op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode, mem_mode,
15943 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15944       {
15945 	rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15946 	if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (rtlop1), &op1_mode)
15947 	    && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op1_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode))
15948 	  rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (int_mode, rtlop1);
15949 	op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, int_mode, mem_mode,
15950 				  VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15951       }
15952 
15953       if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15954 	break;
15955 
15956       mem_loc_result = op0;
15957       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15958       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15959       break;
15960 
15961     case AND:
15962       op = DW_OP_and;
15963       goto do_binop;
15964 
15965     case IOR:
15966       op = DW_OP_or;
15967       goto do_binop;
15968 
15969     case XOR:
15970       op = DW_OP_xor;
15971       goto do_binop;
15972 
15973     do_binop:
15974       op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15975 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15976       op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15977 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15978 
15979       if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15980 	break;
15981 
15982       mem_loc_result = op0;
15983       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15984       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15985       break;
15986 
15987     case MOD:
15988       if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15989 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15990 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15991 	{
15992 	  mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
15993 					base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15994 					int_mode, mem_mode);
15995 	  break;
15996 	}
15997 
15998       op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15999 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16000       op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
16001 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16002 
16003       if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
16004 	break;
16005 
16006       mem_loc_result = op0;
16007       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
16008       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16009       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16010       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
16011       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
16012       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
16013       break;
16014 
16015     case UDIV:
16016       if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16017 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16018 	{
16019 	  if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16020 	    {
16021 	      op = DW_OP_div;
16022 	      goto do_binop;
16023 	    }
16024 	  mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
16025 					base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1),
16026 					int_mode, mem_mode);
16027 	}
16028       break;
16029 
16030     case NOT:
16031       op = DW_OP_not;
16032       goto do_unop;
16033 
16034     case ABS:
16035       op = DW_OP_abs;
16036       goto do_unop;
16037 
16038     case NEG:
16039       op = DW_OP_neg;
16040       goto do_unop;
16041 
16042     do_unop:
16043       op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
16044 				VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16045 
16046       if (op0 == 0)
16047 	break;
16048 
16049       mem_loc_result = op0;
16050       add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16051       break;
16052 
16053     case CONST_INT:
16054       if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16055 	  || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16056 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
16057 	  || (int_mode == Pmode
16058 	      && mem_mode != VOIDmode
16059 	      && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
16060 #endif
16061 	  )
16062 	{
16063 	  mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
16064 	  break;
16065 	}
16066       if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16067 	  && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
16068 	      || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
16069 	{
16070 	  dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
16071 	  scalar_int_mode amode;
16072 	  if (type_die == NULL)
16073 	    return NULL;
16074 	  if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
16075 	      && (int_mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0)
16076 		  .exists (&amode))
16077 	      && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
16078 	      /* const DW_OP_convert <XXX> vs.
16079 		 DW_OP_const_type <XXX, 1, const>.  */
16080 	      && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
16081 		 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode))
16082 	    {
16083 	      mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
16084 	      op0 = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
16085 	      op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16086 	      op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16087 	      op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16088 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
16089 	      return mem_loc_result;
16090 	    }
16091 	  mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0,
16092 					  INTVAL (rtl));
16093 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16094 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16095 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16096 	  if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
16097 	    mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
16098 	  else
16099 	    {
16100 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
16101 		= dw_val_class_const_double;
16102 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
16103 		= double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
16104 	    }
16105 	}
16106       break;
16107 
16108     case CONST_DOUBLE:
16109       if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16110 	{
16111 	  dw_die_ref type_die;
16112 
16113 	  /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
16114 	     CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
16115 	     or a floating-point constant.  If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
16116 	     the value is always a floating point constant.
16117 
16118 	     When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
16119 	     the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
16120 	     We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks.  */
16121 	  if (mode == VOIDmode
16122 	      || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
16123 		  && maybe_ne (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
16124 			       HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT)))
16125 	    break;
16126 	  type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
16127 	  if (type_die == NULL)
16128 	    return NULL;
16129 	  mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
16130 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16131 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16132 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16133 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
16134 	  if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
16135 	    {
16136 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
16137 		= dw_val_class_const_double;
16138 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
16139 		= rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
16140 	    }
16141 	  else
16142 #endif
16143 	    {
16144 	      scalar_float_mode float_mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (mode);
16145 	      unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (float_mode);
16146 	      unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
16147 
16148 	      insert_float (rtl, array);
16149 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16150 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
16151 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
16152 	      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16153 	    }
16154 	}
16155       break;
16156 
16157     case CONST_WIDE_INT:
16158       if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16159 	{
16160 	  dw_die_ref type_die;
16161 
16162 	  type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
16163 	  if (type_die == NULL)
16164 	    return NULL;
16165 	  mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
16166 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16167 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16168 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16169 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
16170 	    = dw_val_class_wide_int;
16171 	  mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
16172 	  *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, mode);
16173 	}
16174       break;
16175 
16176     case CONST_POLY_INT:
16177       mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (rtx_to_poly_int64 (rtl));
16178       break;
16179 
16180     case EQ:
16181       mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
16182       break;
16183 
16184     case GE:
16185       mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
16186       break;
16187 
16188     case GT:
16189       mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
16190       break;
16191 
16192     case LE:
16193       mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
16194       break;
16195 
16196     case LT:
16197       mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
16198       break;
16199 
16200     case NE:
16201       mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
16202       break;
16203 
16204     case GEU:
16205       mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
16206       break;
16207 
16208     case GTU:
16209       mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
16210       break;
16211 
16212     case LEU:
16213       mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
16214       break;
16215 
16216     case LTU:
16217       mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
16218       break;
16219 
16220     case UMIN:
16221     case UMAX:
16222       if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
16223 	break;
16224       /* FALLTHRU */
16225     case SMIN:
16226     case SMAX:
16227       mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
16228       break;
16229 
16230     case ZERO_EXTRACT:
16231     case SIGN_EXTRACT:
16232       if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
16233 	  && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
16234 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16235 	  && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode)
16236 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16237 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16238 	  && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
16239 	      + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
16240 	      <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode)))
16241 	{
16242 	  int shift, size;
16243 	  op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
16244 				    mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16245 	  if (op0 == 0)
16246 	    break;
16247 	  if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
16248 	    op = DW_OP_shra;
16249 	  else
16250 	    op = DW_OP_shr;
16251 	  mem_loc_result = op0;
16252 	  size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
16253 	  shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
16254 	  if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16255 	    shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - shift - size;
16256 	  if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16257 	    {
16258 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
16259 			     int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16260 						 - shift - size));
16261 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
16262 	    }
16263 	  if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16264 	    {
16265 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
16266 			     int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
16267 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16268 	    }
16269 	}
16270       break;
16271 
16272     case IF_THEN_ELSE:
16273       {
16274 	dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
16275 	op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
16276 				  GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
16277 				  ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
16278 				  mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16279 	op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
16280 				  VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16281 	op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
16282 				  VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16283 	if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
16284 	  break;
16285 
16286 	mem_loc_result = op1;
16287 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
16288 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
16289 	bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
16290 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
16291 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
16292 	drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
16293 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
16294 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16295 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
16296       }
16297       break;
16298 
16299     case FLOAT_EXTEND:
16300     case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
16301     case FLOAT:
16302     case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
16303     case FIX:
16304     case UNSIGNED_FIX:
16305       if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16306 	{
16307 	  dw_die_ref type_die;
16308 	  dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
16309 
16310 	  op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
16311 				    mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16312 	  if (op0 == NULL)
16313 	    break;
16314 	  if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &int_mode)
16315 	      && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
16316 		  || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
16317 	    {
16318 	      type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode,
16319 					     GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
16320 	      if (type_die == NULL)
16321 		break;
16322 	      cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
16323 	      cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16324 	      cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16325 	      cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16326 	      add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
16327 	    }
16328 	  type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
16329 	  if (type_die == NULL)
16330 	    break;
16331 	  cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
16332 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16333 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16334 	  cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16335 	  add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
16336 	  if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16337 	      && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
16338 		  || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
16339 	    {
16340 	      op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, op0);
16341 	      if (op0 == NULL)
16342 		break;
16343 	    }
16344 	  mem_loc_result = op0;
16345 	}
16346       break;
16347 
16348     case CLZ:
16349     case CTZ:
16350     case FFS:
16351       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16352 	mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16353       break;
16354 
16355     case POPCOUNT:
16356     case PARITY:
16357       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16358 	mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16359       break;
16360 
16361     case BSWAP:
16362       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16363 	mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16364       break;
16365 
16366     case ROTATE:
16367     case ROTATERT:
16368       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16369 	mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16370       break;
16371 
16372     case COMPARE:
16373       /* In theory, we could implement the above.  */
16374       /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
16375 	 natively.  */
16376     case SS_MULT:
16377     case US_MULT:
16378     case SS_DIV:
16379     case US_DIV:
16380     case SS_PLUS:
16381     case US_PLUS:
16382     case SS_MINUS:
16383     case US_MINUS:
16384     case SS_NEG:
16385     case US_NEG:
16386     case SS_ABS:
16387     case SS_ASHIFT:
16388     case US_ASHIFT:
16389     case SS_TRUNCATE:
16390     case US_TRUNCATE:
16391     case UNORDERED:
16392     case ORDERED:
16393     case UNEQ:
16394     case UNGE:
16395     case UNGT:
16396     case UNLE:
16397     case UNLT:
16398     case LTGT:
16399     case FRACT_CONVERT:
16400     case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
16401     case SAT_FRACT:
16402     case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
16403     case SQRT:
16404     case ASM_OPERANDS:
16405     case VEC_MERGE:
16406     case VEC_SELECT:
16407     case VEC_CONCAT:
16408     case VEC_DUPLICATE:
16409     case VEC_SERIES:
16410     case HIGH:
16411     case FMA:
16412     case STRICT_LOW_PART:
16413     case CONST_VECTOR:
16414     case CONST_FIXED:
16415     case CLRSB:
16416     case CLOBBER:
16417       break;
16418 
16419     case CONST_STRING:
16420       resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
16421       goto symref;
16422 
16423     /* RTL sequences inside PARALLEL record a series of DWARF operations for
16424        the expression.  An UNSPEC rtx represents a raw DWARF operation,
16425        new_loc_descr is called for it to build the operation directly.
16426        Otherwise mem_loc_descriptor is called recursively.  */
16427     case PARALLEL:
16428       {
16429 	int index = 0;
16430 	dw_loc_descr_ref exp_result = NULL;
16431 
16432 	for (; index < XVECLEN (rtl, 0); index++)
16433 	  {
16434 	    rtx elem = XVECEXP (rtl, 0, index);
16435 	    if (GET_CODE (elem) == UNSPEC)
16436 	      {
16437 		/* Each DWARF operation UNSPEC contain two operands, if
16438 		   one operand is not used for the operation, const0_rtx is
16439 		   passed.  */
16440 		gcc_assert (XVECLEN (elem, 0) == 2);
16441 
16442 		HOST_WIDE_INT dw_op = XINT (elem, 1);
16443 		HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 0));
16444 		HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 1));
16445 		exp_result
16446 		  = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) dw_op, oprnd1,
16447 				   oprnd2);
16448 	      }
16449 	    else
16450 	      exp_result
16451 		= mem_loc_descriptor (elem, mode, mem_mode,
16452 				      VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16453 
16454 	    if (!mem_loc_result)
16455 	      mem_loc_result = exp_result;
16456 	    else
16457 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, exp_result);
16458 	  }
16459 
16460 	break;
16461       }
16462 
16463     default:
16464       if (flag_checking)
16465 	{
16466 	  print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
16467 	  gcc_unreachable ();
16468 	}
16469       break;
16470     }
16471 
16472   if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
16473     add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
16474 
16475   return mem_loc_result;
16476 }
16477 
16478 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
16479    This is typically a complex variable.  */
16480 
16481 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16482 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
16483 {
16484   /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces.  */
16485   unsigned int size0, size1;
16486   if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)).is_constant (&size0)
16487       || !GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)).is_constant (&size1))
16488     return 0;
16489 
16490   dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
16491   dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
16492     = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16493   dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
16494     = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16495 
16496   if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
16497     return 0;
16498 
16499   cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
16500   add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, size0);
16501 
16502   add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
16503   add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, size1);
16504 
16505   if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
16506     add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
16507 
16508   return cc_loc_result;
16509 }
16510 
16511 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
16512    locations.  */
16513 
16514 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16515 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
16516 {
16517   unsigned int i;
16518   dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
16519   unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
16520   unsigned int size;
16521 
16522   for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
16523     {
16524       dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
16525       rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
16526 
16527       /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces.  */
16528       if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)).is_constant (&size))
16529 	return NULL;
16530 
16531       ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16532       if (ref == NULL)
16533 	return NULL;
16534 
16535       add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
16536       add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, size);
16537     }
16538 
16539   if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
16540     add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
16541 
16542   return cc_loc_result;
16543 }
16544 
16545 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor.  Return DW_OP_implicit_pointer
16546    for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL.  */
16547 
16548 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16549 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16550 {
16551   dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
16552   dw_die_ref ref;
16553 
16554   if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
16555     return NULL;
16556   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
16557 	      || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
16558 	      || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
16559   ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
16560   ret = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
16561   ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
16562   if (ref)
16563     {
16564       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16565       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
16566       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16567     }
16568   else
16569     {
16570       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
16571       ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
16572     }
16573   return ret;
16574 }
16575 
16576 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
16577    which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location.  For a
16578    register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number.  For a
16579    memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
16580    generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
16581 
16582    MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
16583    .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
16584    allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
16585 
16586    If we don't know how to describe it, return 0.  */
16587 
16588 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16589 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
16590 		enum var_init_status initialized)
16591 {
16592   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
16593   scalar_int_mode int_mode;
16594 
16595   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
16596     {
16597     case SUBREG:
16598       /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
16599 	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
16600 	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
16601 	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
16602 	 contains the given subreg.  */
16603       if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
16604 	loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
16605 				     GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
16606       else
16607 	goto do_default;
16608       break;
16609 
16610     case REG:
16611       loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
16612       break;
16613 
16614     case MEM:
16615       loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
16616 				       GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
16617       if (loc_result == NULL)
16618 	loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
16619       if (loc_result == NULL)
16620 	{
16621 	  rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
16622 	  if (new_rtl != rtl)
16623 	    loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
16624 	}
16625       break;
16626 
16627     case CONCAT:
16628       loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
16629 					  initialized);
16630       break;
16631 
16632     case CONCATN:
16633       loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
16634       break;
16635 
16636     case VAR_LOCATION:
16637       /* Single part.  */
16638       if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
16639 	{
16640 	  rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
16641 	  if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16642 	    loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
16643 	  loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
16644 	  break;
16645 	}
16646 
16647       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
16648       /* FALLTHRU */
16649 
16650     case PARALLEL:
16651       {
16652 	rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
16653 	int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
16654 	machine_mode mode;
16655 	int i, size;
16656 
16657 	/* Create the first one, so we have something to add to.  */
16658 	loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
16659 				     VOIDmode, initialized);
16660 	if (loc_result == NULL)
16661 	  return NULL;
16662 	mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
16663 	/* At present we only track constant-sized pieces.  */
16664 	if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
16665 	  return NULL;
16666 	add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
16667 	for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
16668 	  {
16669 	    dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
16670 
16671 	    temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
16672 				   VOIDmode, initialized);
16673 	    if (temp == NULL)
16674 	      return NULL;
16675 	    add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
16676 	    mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
16677 	    /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces.  */
16678 	    if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
16679 	      return NULL;
16680 	    add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
16681 	  }
16682       }
16683       break;
16684 
16685     case CONST_INT:
16686       if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
16687 	{
16688 	  int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
16689 	  loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode),
16690 						      INTVAL (rtl));
16691 	}
16692       break;
16693 
16694     case CONST_DOUBLE:
16695       if (mode == VOIDmode)
16696 	mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16697 
16698       if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16699 	{
16700 	  gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
16701 
16702 	  /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
16703 	     or a floating-point constant.  A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
16704 	     the constant requires more than one word in order to be
16705 	     adequately represented.  We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks.  */
16706 	  scalar_mode smode = as_a <scalar_mode> (mode);
16707 	  loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16708 				      GET_MODE_SIZE (smode), 0);
16709 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
16710 	  if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (smode))
16711 	    {
16712 	      loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
16713 	      loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
16714 	        = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
16715 	    }
16716 	  else
16717 #endif
16718 	    {
16719 	      unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (smode);
16720 	      unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
16721 
16722 	      insert_float (rtl, array);
16723 	      loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16724 	      loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
16725 	      loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
16726 	      loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16727 	    }
16728 	}
16729       break;
16730 
16731     case CONST_WIDE_INT:
16732       if (mode == VOIDmode)
16733 	mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16734 
16735       if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16736 	{
16737 	  int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
16738 	  loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16739 				      GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0);
16740 	  loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
16741 	  loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
16742 	  *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, int_mode);
16743 	}
16744       break;
16745 
16746     case CONST_VECTOR:
16747       if (mode == VOIDmode)
16748 	mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16749 
16750       if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16751 	{
16752 	  unsigned int length;
16753 	  if (!CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl).is_constant (&length))
16754 	    return NULL;
16755 
16756 	  unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
16757 	  unsigned char *array
16758 	    = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
16759 	  unsigned int i;
16760 	  unsigned char *p;
16761 	  machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
16762 
16763 	  gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
16764 	  switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
16765 	    {
16766 	    case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
16767 	      for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16768 		{
16769 		  rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16770 		  insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
16771 		}
16772 	      break;
16773 
16774 	    case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
16775 	      for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16776 		{
16777 		  rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16778 		  insert_float (elt, p);
16779 		}
16780 	      break;
16781 
16782 	    default:
16783 	      gcc_unreachable ();
16784 	    }
16785 
16786 	  loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16787 				      length * elt_size, 0);
16788 	  loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16789 	  loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
16790 	  loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
16791 	  loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16792 	}
16793       break;
16794 
16795     case CONST:
16796       if (mode == VOIDmode
16797 	  || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16798 	  || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16799 	  || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
16800 	{
16801 	  loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
16802 	  break;
16803 	}
16804       /* FALLTHROUGH */
16805     case SYMBOL_REF:
16806       if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16807 	break;
16808       /* FALLTHROUGH */
16809     case LABEL_REF:
16810       if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16811 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16812 	  && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16813 	{
16814          loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
16815 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16816 	  vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
16817 	}
16818       break;
16819 
16820     case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
16821       loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
16822       break;
16823 
16824     case PLUS:
16825       if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
16826 	  && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
16827 	{
16828 	  loc_result
16829 	    = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
16830 	  break;
16831 	}
16832       /* FALLTHRU */
16833     do_default:
16834     default:
16835       if ((is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16836 	   && GET_MODE (rtl) == int_mode
16837 	   && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16838 	   && dwarf_version >= 4)
16839 	  || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
16840 	{
16841 	  /* Value expression.  */
16842 	  loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16843 	  if (loc_result)
16844 	    add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
16845 			   new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16846 	}
16847       break;
16848     }
16849 
16850   return loc_result;
16851 }
16852 
16853 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
16854    address ranges where a given location is valid.
16855    1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
16856    2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
16857    3. Otherwise, use the text section.
16858    XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice.  */
16859 
16860 static const char *
16861 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
16862 {
16863   const char *secname;
16864 
16865   if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
16866       && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
16867       && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
16868     secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
16869   else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
16870     {
16871       if (in_cold_section_p)
16872 	{
16873 	  section *sec = current_function_section ();
16874 	  if (sec->common.flags & SECTION_NAMED)
16875 	    return sec->named.name;
16876 	}
16877       secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
16878     }
16879   else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
16880     secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
16881   else
16882     secname = text_section_label;
16883 
16884   return secname;
16885 }
16886 
16887 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL.  */
16888 
16889 static bool
16890 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
16891 {
16892   return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
16893   	   || VAR_P (decl))
16894 	  && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
16895 }
16896 
16897 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list.  Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16898    for VARLOC.  */
16899 
16900 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16901 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
16902 	       enum var_init_status initialized)
16903 {
16904   int have_address = 0;
16905   dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16906   machine_mode mode;
16907 
16908   if (want_address != 2)
16909     {
16910       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
16911       /* Single part.  */
16912       if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16913 	{
16914 	  varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16915 	  if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16916 	    varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16917 	  mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
16918 	  if (MEM_P (varloc))
16919 	    {
16920 	      rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16921 	      descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
16922 					  mode, initialized);
16923 	      if (descr)
16924 		have_address = 1;
16925 	      else
16926 		{
16927 		  rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
16928 		  if (x != varloc)
16929 		    descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
16930 						initialized);
16931 		}
16932 	    }
16933 	  else
16934 	    descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16935 	}
16936       else
16937 	return 0;
16938     }
16939   else
16940     {
16941       if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
16942 	mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
16943       else
16944 	mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
16945       descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
16946       have_address = 1;
16947     }
16948 
16949   if (!descr)
16950     return 0;
16951 
16952   if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16953       && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16954     {
16955       if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16956 	{
16957 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16958 			    "DWARF address size mismatch");
16959 	  return 0;
16960 	}
16961       add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16962       have_address = 1;
16963     }
16964   /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address.  */
16965   if (want_address && !have_address)
16966     {
16967       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16968 			"Want address and only have value");
16969       return 0;
16970     }
16971 
16972   /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference.  */
16973   if (!want_address && have_address)
16974     {
16975       HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16976       enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16977 
16978       if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16979 	{
16980 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16981 			    "DWARF address size mismatch");
16982 	  return 0;
16983 	}
16984       else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16985 	op = DW_OP_deref;
16986       else
16987 	op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16988 
16989       add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16990     }
16991 
16992   return descr;
16993 }
16994 
16995 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
16996    if it is not possible.  */
16997 
16998 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16999 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
17000 {
17001   if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
17002     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
17003   else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17004     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
17005   else
17006     return NULL;
17007 }
17008 
17009 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list.  Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
17010    for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA.  */
17011 
17012 static dw_loc_descr_ref
17013 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
17014 {
17015   rtx p;
17016   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
17017   dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
17018   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
17019   rtx varloc;
17020   enum var_init_status initialized;
17021 
17022   if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
17023       || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
17024     return NULL;
17025 
17026   decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
17027   descr = NULL;
17028   descr_tail = &descr;
17029 
17030   for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
17031     {
17032       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
17033       rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
17034       dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
17035       dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
17036       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
17037 
17038       if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
17039 	  || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
17040 	{
17041 	  padsize += bitsize;
17042 	  continue;
17043 	}
17044       initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
17045       varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
17046       cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
17047       if (cur_descr == NULL)
17048 	{
17049 	  padsize += bitsize;
17050 	  continue;
17051 	}
17052 
17053       /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
17054 	 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
17055 	 to bitsize.  Otherwise we can't embed it.  */
17056       for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
17057 	   tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
17058 	if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
17059 	  {
17060 	    opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
17061 		      * BITS_PER_UNIT;
17062 	    last = *tail;
17063 	  }
17064 	else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
17065 	  {
17066 	    opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
17067 	    last = *tail;
17068 	  }
17069 
17070       if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
17071 	{
17072 	  padsize += bitsize;
17073 	  /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
17074 	     addr_table entries it uses.  */
17075 	  remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
17076 	  continue;
17077 	}
17078 
17079       /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
17080 	 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out.  */
17081       if (padsize)
17082 	{
17083 	  if (padsize > decl_size)
17084 	    {
17085 	      remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
17086 	      goto discard_descr;
17087 	    }
17088 	  decl_size -= padsize;
17089 	  *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
17090 	  if (*descr_tail == NULL)
17091 	    {
17092 	      remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
17093 	      goto discard_descr;
17094 	    }
17095 	  descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17096 	  padsize = 0;
17097 	}
17098       *descr_tail = cur_descr;
17099       descr_tail = tail;
17100       if (bitsize > decl_size)
17101 	goto discard_descr;
17102       decl_size -= bitsize;
17103       if (last == NULL)
17104 	{
17105 	  HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
17106 	  if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
17107 	      && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
17108 	    {
17109 	      varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
17110 	      if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
17111 		varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
17112 	    }
17113 	  do
17114 	    {
17115 	      if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
17116 		  || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
17117 		  || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
17118 		varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
17119 	      else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
17120 		varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
17121 	      else
17122 		break;
17123 	    }
17124 	  while (1);
17125 	  /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
17126 	     or implicit location descriptions and empty location
17127 	     descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
17128 	     adjustment.  */
17129 	  if (MEM_P (varloc))
17130 	    {
17131 	      unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize;
17132 	      if (!poly_uint64 (MEM_SIZE (varloc)).is_constant (&memsize))
17133 		goto discard_descr;
17134 	      memsize *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
17135 	      if (memsize != bitsize)
17136 		{
17137 		  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
17138 		      && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
17139 		    goto discard_descr;
17140 		  if (memsize < bitsize)
17141 		    goto discard_descr;
17142 		  if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
17143 		    offset = memsize - bitsize;
17144 		}
17145 	    }
17146 
17147 	  *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
17148 	  if (*descr_tail == NULL)
17149 	    goto discard_descr;
17150 	  descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17151 	}
17152     }
17153 
17154   /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
17155      the decl.  */
17156   if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
17157     {
17158       *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
17159       if (*descr_tail == NULL)
17160 	goto discard_descr;
17161     }
17162   return descr;
17163 
17164 discard_descr:
17165   /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses.  */
17166   remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
17167   return NULL;
17168 }
17169 
17170 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
17171    DECL.  WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
17172    function.  */
17173 
17174 static dw_loc_list_ref
17175 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
17176 {
17177   const char *endname, *secname;
17178   var_loc_view endview;
17179   rtx varloc;
17180   enum var_init_status initialized;
17181   struct var_loc_node *node;
17182   dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
17183   char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17184   dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
17185   dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
17186 
17187   /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
17188      actually construct the list of locations.
17189      The first location information is what is passed to the
17190      function that creates the location list, and the remaining
17191      locations just get added on to that list.
17192      Note that we only know the start address for a location
17193      (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
17194      the range [current location start, next location start].
17195      This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
17196      a range of [last location start, end of function label].  */
17197 
17198   if (cfun && crtl->has_bb_partition)
17199     {
17200       bool save_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
17201       in_cold_section_p = first_function_block_is_cold;
17202       if (loc_list->last_before_switch == NULL)
17203 	in_cold_section_p = !in_cold_section_p;
17204       secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
17205       in_cold_section_p = save_in_cold_section_p;
17206     }
17207   else
17208     secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
17209 
17210   for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
17211     {
17212       bool range_across_switch = false;
17213       if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
17214 	  || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
17215 	{
17216 	  if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
17217 	    {
17218 	      descr = NULL;
17219 	      /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
17220 		 inside DWARF expressions.  */
17221 	      if (want_address == 2)
17222 		descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
17223 	    }
17224 	  else
17225 	    {
17226 	      initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
17227 	      varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
17228 	      descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
17229 	    }
17230 	  if (descr)
17231 	    {
17232 	      /* If section switch happens in between node->label
17233 		 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
17234 		 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
17235 		 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
17236 		 of first partition and second one starting at the
17237 		 beginning of second partition.  */
17238 	      if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
17239 		  && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next
17240 		      /* If we are to emit a view number, we will emit
17241 			 a loclist rather than a single location
17242 			 expression for the entire function (see
17243 			 loc_list_has_views), so we have to split the
17244 			 range that straddles across partitions.  */
17245 		      || !ZERO_VIEW_P (node->view))
17246 		  && current_function_decl)
17247 		{
17248 		  endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
17249 		  endview = 0;
17250 		  range_across_switch = true;
17251 		}
17252 	      /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
17253 		 NODE->NEXT->LABEL.  */
17254 	      else if (node->next)
17255 		endname = node->next->label, endview = node->next->view;
17256 	      /* If the variable has a location at the last label
17257 		 it keeps its location until the end of function.  */
17258 	      else if (!current_function_decl)
17259 		endname = text_end_label, endview = 0;
17260 	      else
17261 		{
17262 		  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
17263 					       current_function_funcdef_no);
17264 		  endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
17265 		  endview = 0;
17266 		}
17267 
17268 	      *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, node->view,
17269 				     endname, endview, secname);
17270 	      if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
17271 		  && node == loc_list->first
17272 		  && NOTE_P (node->loc)
17273 		  && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
17274 		(*listp)->force = true;
17275 	      listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
17276 	    }
17277 	}
17278 
17279       if (cfun
17280 	  && crtl->has_bb_partition
17281 	  && node == loc_list->last_before_switch)
17282 	{
17283 	  bool save_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
17284 	  in_cold_section_p = !first_function_block_is_cold;
17285 	  secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
17286 	  in_cold_section_p = save_in_cold_section_p;
17287 	}
17288 
17289       if (range_across_switch)
17290 	{
17291 	  if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
17292 	    descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
17293 	  else
17294 	    {
17295 	      initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
17296 	      varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
17297 	      descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
17298 				     initialized);
17299 	    }
17300 	  gcc_assert (descr);
17301 	  /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
17302 	     NODE->NEXT->LABEL.  */
17303 	  if (node->next)
17304 	    endname = node->next->label, endview = node->next->view;
17305 	  else
17306 	    endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end, endview = 0;
17307 	  *listp = new_loc_list (descr, cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin, 0,
17308 				 endname, endview, secname);
17309 	  listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
17310 	}
17311     }
17312 
17313   /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
17314      expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
17315      location entry in the first place.  If some entries were not
17316      representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
17317      applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
17318      available.  */
17319   if (list && loc_list->first->next)
17320     gen_llsym (list);
17321   else
17322     maybe_gen_llsym (list);
17323 
17324   return list;
17325 }
17326 
17327 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
17328    as location description.   */
17329 
17330 static bool
17331 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
17332 {
17333   gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
17334   return !list->ll_symbol;
17335 }
17336 
17337 /* Duplicate a single element of location list.  */
17338 
17339 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
17340 copy_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
17341 {
17342   dw_loc_descr_ref copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
17343   memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
17344   return copy;
17345 }
17346 
17347 /* To each location in list LIST append loc descr REF.  */
17348 
17349 static void
17350 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
17351 {
17352   dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
17353   add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
17354   list = list->dw_loc_next;
17355   while (list)
17356     {
17357       copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
17358       add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
17359       while (copy->dw_loc_next)
17360 	copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
17361       list = list->dw_loc_next;
17362     }
17363 }
17364 
17365 /* To each location in list LIST prepend loc descr REF.  */
17366 
17367 static void
17368 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
17369 {
17370   dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
17371   dw_loc_descr_ref ref_end = list->expr;
17372   add_loc_descr (&ref, list->expr);
17373   list->expr = ref;
17374   list = list->dw_loc_next;
17375   while (list)
17376     {
17377       dw_loc_descr_ref end = list->expr;
17378       list->expr = copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
17379       while (copy->dw_loc_next != ref_end)
17380 	copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
17381       copy->dw_loc_next = end;
17382       list = list->dw_loc_next;
17383     }
17384 }
17385 
17386 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
17387    produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
17388    to expression in RET on each position in program.
17389    Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
17390 
17391    TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
17392    element.  General case would involve sorting the lists in program order
17393    and merging them that will need some additional work.
17394    Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
17395    structures.  */
17396 
17397 static void
17398 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
17399 {
17400   if (!list)
17401     return;
17402   if (!*ret)
17403     {
17404       *ret = list;
17405       return;
17406     }
17407   if (!list->dw_loc_next)
17408     {
17409       add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
17410       return;
17411     }
17412   if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
17413     {
17414       prepend_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
17415       *ret = list;
17416       return;
17417     }
17418   expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
17419 		    "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
17420 		    " location lists.\n");
17421   *ret = NULL;
17422   return;
17423 }
17424 
17425 /* LOC is constant expression.  Try a luck, look it up in constant
17426    pool and return its loc_descr of its address.  */
17427 
17428 static dw_loc_descr_ref
17429 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
17430 {
17431   /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted.  */
17432   rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
17433 
17434   if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
17435     {
17436       gcc_assert (!rtl);
17437       return 0;
17438     }
17439   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
17440 
17441   /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
17442      of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
17443      populated.  */
17444   if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
17445     {
17446       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17447 			"CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
17448       return 0;
17449     }
17450   return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
17451 			     GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17452 }
17453 
17454 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
17455    by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
17456    it into simple arithmetics.
17457 
17458    See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT.  */
17459 
17460 static dw_loc_list_ref
17461 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
17462 						   loc_descr_context *context)
17463 {
17464   tree obj, offset;
17465   poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
17466   machine_mode mode;
17467   int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17468   dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
17469 
17470   obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
17471 			     &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17472 			     &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
17473   STRIP_NOPS (obj);
17474   if (!multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos))
17475     {
17476       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
17477       return 0;
17478     }
17479   if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
17480     {
17481       expansion_failed (obj,
17482 			NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
17483       return 0;
17484     }
17485   if (!offset && known_eq (bitpos, 0))
17486     list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
17487 				   context);
17488   else if (toplev
17489 	   && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
17490 	   && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
17491     {
17492       list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
17493       if (!list_ret)
17494 	return 0;
17495       if (offset)
17496 	{
17497 	  /* Variable offset.  */
17498 	  list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
17499 	  if (list_ret1 == 0)
17500 	    return 0;
17501 	  add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17502 	  if (!list_ret)
17503 	    return 0;
17504 	  add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17505 				 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
17506 	}
17507       HOST_WIDE_INT value;
17508       if (bytepos.is_constant (&value) && value > 0)
17509 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17510 			       new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, value, 0));
17511       else if (maybe_ne (bytepos, 0))
17512 	loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
17513       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17514 			     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
17515     }
17516   return list_ret;
17517 }
17518 
17519 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
17520    all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one.  Insert in NOPS all
17521    operations that are skipped.  */
17522 
17523 static void
17524 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
17525 			  hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
17526 {
17527   while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
17528     {
17529       nops.add (loc);
17530       loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
17531     }
17532 }
17533 
17534 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
17535    P.  */
17536 
17537 bool
17538 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17539 {
17540   ggc_free (loc);
17541   return true;
17542 }
17543 
17544 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
17545    finishes LOC.  */
17546 
17547 static void
17548 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
17549 {
17550   if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
17551     return;
17552 
17553   /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove.  */
17554   hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
17555 
17556   /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
17557      operations list.  */
17558   loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
17559 
17560   for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
17561     {
17562       /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
17563 	 labels.  */
17564       if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
17565 	loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
17566       if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
17567 	loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
17568 
17569       /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
17570 	 iteration.  */
17571       if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
17572 	loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
17573       cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
17574     }
17575 
17576   nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
17577 }
17578 
17579 
17580 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
17581 
17582 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation.  */
17583 struct loc_descr_context
17584 {
17585   /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
17586      NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
17587      description.  This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes.  */
17588   tree context_type;
17589   /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
17590      DW_OP_push_object_address operation.  */
17591   tree base_decl;
17592   /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
17593      we are not generating a DWARF procedure.  */
17594   struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
17595   /* True if integral PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for the first argument passed
17596      by consumer.  Used for DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes.  */
17597   bool placeholder_arg;
17598   /* True if PLACEHOLDER_EXPR has been seen.  */
17599   bool placeholder_seen;
17600 };
17601 
17602 /* DWARF procedures generation
17603 
17604    DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
17605    things such as sizes or offsets.  Such computations can have redundant parts
17606    that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
17607    information.  This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
17608 
17609    Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
17610    already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
17611    big and complex types.  Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
17612    arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
17613    return statement with arithmetic expressions.  This is the only kind of
17614    function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
17615 
17616    DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
17617    to define some calling convention for them to interact.  Let's say that:
17618 
17619    - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
17620      all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
17621      procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
17622 
17623    - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
17624      on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
17625 
17626    - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
17627      single stack slot.
17628 
17629    - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
17630      procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
17631      the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
17632      procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
17633      returns.  */
17634 
17635 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure.  */
17636 struct dwarf_procedure_info
17637 {
17638   /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
17639      currently translated.  */
17640   tree fndecl;
17641   /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes.  */
17642   unsigned args_count;
17643 };
17644 
17645 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure.  Add
17646    LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute.  If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
17647    equate it to this DIE.  */
17648 
17649 static dw_die_ref
17650 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
17651 		    dw_die_ref parent_die)
17652 {
17653   dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
17654 
17655   if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
17656       || location == NULL)
17657     return NULL;
17658 
17659   dwarf_proc_die = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, parent_die, fndecl);
17660   if (fndecl)
17661     equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
17662   add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
17663   return dwarf_proc_die;
17664 }
17665 
17666 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
17667    type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
17668    aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack.  */
17669 
17670 static bool
17671 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
17672 {
17673   return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
17674 	   || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
17675 	   || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
17676 	  && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
17677 }
17678 
17679 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking: do the same but stop when coming across
17680    visited nodes.  For each node we visit, register in FRAME_OFFSETS the frame
17681    offset *before* evaluating the corresponding operation.  */
17682 
17683 static bool
17684 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17685 			struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
17686 			hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> &frame_offsets)
17687 {
17688   /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
17689   unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
17690   dw_loc_descr_ref l;
17691 
17692   for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
17693     {
17694       bool existed;
17695       unsigned &l_frame_offset = frame_offsets.get_or_insert (l, &existed);
17696 
17697       /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore.  */
17698       if (existed)
17699 	{
17700 	  /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
17701 	     flow comes from.  */
17702 	  gcc_assert ((unsigned) l_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
17703 	  break;
17704 	}
17705       l_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
17706 
17707       /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
17708 	 offset. */
17709       if (l->frame_offset_rel)
17710 	{
17711 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off;
17712 	  switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17713 	    {
17714 	    case DW_OP_pick:
17715 	      off = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
17716 	      break;
17717 	    case DW_OP_dup:
17718 	      off = 0;
17719 	      break;
17720 	    case DW_OP_over:
17721 	      off = 1;
17722 	      break;
17723 	    default:
17724 	      gcc_unreachable ();
17725 	    }
17726 	  /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
17727 	     incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
17728 	     right-to-left.  Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
17729 	     this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
17730 	     one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
17731 	     one, etc.).
17732 
17733 	     The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
17734 	     and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
17735 	       frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
17736 	  off += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
17737 
17738 	  /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)...  */
17739 	  if (off > 255)
17740 	    return false;
17741 
17742 	  if (off == 0)
17743 	    {
17744 	      l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_dup;
17745 	      l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
17746 	    }
17747 	  else if (off == 1)
17748 	    {
17749 	      l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_over;
17750 	      l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
17751 	    }
17752 	  else
17753 	    {
17754 	      l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_pick;
17755 	      l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = off;
17756 	    }
17757 	}
17758 
17759       /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
17760 	 on the stack.  */
17761       switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17762 	{
17763 	case DW_OP_deref:
17764 	case DW_OP_swap:
17765 	case DW_OP_rot:
17766 	case DW_OP_abs:
17767 	case DW_OP_neg:
17768 	case DW_OP_not:
17769 	case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
17770 	case DW_OP_skip:
17771 	case DW_OP_reg0:
17772 	case DW_OP_reg1:
17773 	case DW_OP_reg2:
17774 	case DW_OP_reg3:
17775 	case DW_OP_reg4:
17776 	case DW_OP_reg5:
17777 	case DW_OP_reg6:
17778 	case DW_OP_reg7:
17779 	case DW_OP_reg8:
17780 	case DW_OP_reg9:
17781 	case DW_OP_reg10:
17782 	case DW_OP_reg11:
17783 	case DW_OP_reg12:
17784 	case DW_OP_reg13:
17785 	case DW_OP_reg14:
17786 	case DW_OP_reg15:
17787 	case DW_OP_reg16:
17788 	case DW_OP_reg17:
17789 	case DW_OP_reg18:
17790 	case DW_OP_reg19:
17791 	case DW_OP_reg20:
17792 	case DW_OP_reg21:
17793 	case DW_OP_reg22:
17794 	case DW_OP_reg23:
17795 	case DW_OP_reg24:
17796 	case DW_OP_reg25:
17797 	case DW_OP_reg26:
17798 	case DW_OP_reg27:
17799 	case DW_OP_reg28:
17800 	case DW_OP_reg29:
17801 	case DW_OP_reg30:
17802 	case DW_OP_reg31:
17803 	case DW_OP_bregx:
17804 	case DW_OP_piece:
17805 	case DW_OP_deref_size:
17806 	case DW_OP_nop:
17807 	case DW_OP_bit_piece:
17808 	case DW_OP_implicit_value:
17809 	case DW_OP_stack_value:
17810 	  break;
17811 
17812 	case DW_OP_addr:
17813 	case DW_OP_const1u:
17814 	case DW_OP_const1s:
17815 	case DW_OP_const2u:
17816 	case DW_OP_const2s:
17817 	case DW_OP_const4u:
17818 	case DW_OP_const4s:
17819 	case DW_OP_const8u:
17820 	case DW_OP_const8s:
17821 	case DW_OP_constu:
17822 	case DW_OP_consts:
17823 	case DW_OP_dup:
17824 	case DW_OP_over:
17825 	case DW_OP_pick:
17826 	case DW_OP_lit0:
17827 	case DW_OP_lit1:
17828 	case DW_OP_lit2:
17829 	case DW_OP_lit3:
17830 	case DW_OP_lit4:
17831 	case DW_OP_lit5:
17832 	case DW_OP_lit6:
17833 	case DW_OP_lit7:
17834 	case DW_OP_lit8:
17835 	case DW_OP_lit9:
17836 	case DW_OP_lit10:
17837 	case DW_OP_lit11:
17838 	case DW_OP_lit12:
17839 	case DW_OP_lit13:
17840 	case DW_OP_lit14:
17841 	case DW_OP_lit15:
17842 	case DW_OP_lit16:
17843 	case DW_OP_lit17:
17844 	case DW_OP_lit18:
17845 	case DW_OP_lit19:
17846 	case DW_OP_lit20:
17847 	case DW_OP_lit21:
17848 	case DW_OP_lit22:
17849 	case DW_OP_lit23:
17850 	case DW_OP_lit24:
17851 	case DW_OP_lit25:
17852 	case DW_OP_lit26:
17853 	case DW_OP_lit27:
17854 	case DW_OP_lit28:
17855 	case DW_OP_lit29:
17856 	case DW_OP_lit30:
17857 	case DW_OP_lit31:
17858 	case DW_OP_breg0:
17859 	case DW_OP_breg1:
17860 	case DW_OP_breg2:
17861 	case DW_OP_breg3:
17862 	case DW_OP_breg4:
17863 	case DW_OP_breg5:
17864 	case DW_OP_breg6:
17865 	case DW_OP_breg7:
17866 	case DW_OP_breg8:
17867 	case DW_OP_breg9:
17868 	case DW_OP_breg10:
17869 	case DW_OP_breg11:
17870 	case DW_OP_breg12:
17871 	case DW_OP_breg13:
17872 	case DW_OP_breg14:
17873 	case DW_OP_breg15:
17874 	case DW_OP_breg16:
17875 	case DW_OP_breg17:
17876 	case DW_OP_breg18:
17877 	case DW_OP_breg19:
17878 	case DW_OP_breg20:
17879 	case DW_OP_breg21:
17880 	case DW_OP_breg22:
17881 	case DW_OP_breg23:
17882 	case DW_OP_breg24:
17883 	case DW_OP_breg25:
17884 	case DW_OP_breg26:
17885 	case DW_OP_breg27:
17886 	case DW_OP_breg28:
17887 	case DW_OP_breg29:
17888 	case DW_OP_breg30:
17889 	case DW_OP_breg31:
17890 	case DW_OP_fbreg:
17891 	case DW_OP_push_object_address:
17892 	case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
17893 	case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
17894 	  ++frame_offset_;
17895 	  break;
17896 
17897 	case DW_OP_drop:
17898 	case DW_OP_xderef:
17899 	case DW_OP_and:
17900 	case DW_OP_div:
17901 	case DW_OP_minus:
17902 	case DW_OP_mod:
17903 	case DW_OP_mul:
17904 	case DW_OP_or:
17905 	case DW_OP_plus:
17906 	case DW_OP_shl:
17907 	case DW_OP_shr:
17908 	case DW_OP_shra:
17909 	case DW_OP_xor:
17910 	case DW_OP_bra:
17911 	case DW_OP_eq:
17912 	case DW_OP_ge:
17913 	case DW_OP_gt:
17914 	case DW_OP_le:
17915 	case DW_OP_lt:
17916 	case DW_OP_ne:
17917 	case DW_OP_regx:
17918 	case DW_OP_xderef_size:
17919 	  --frame_offset_;
17920 	  break;
17921 
17922 	case DW_OP_call2:
17923 	case DW_OP_call4:
17924 	case DW_OP_call_ref:
17925 	  {
17926 	    dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
17927 	    int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
17928 
17929 	    if (stack_usage == NULL)
17930 	      return false;
17931 	    frame_offset_ += *stack_usage;
17932 	    break;
17933 	  }
17934 
17935 	case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
17936 	case DW_OP_entry_value:
17937 	case DW_OP_const_type:
17938 	case DW_OP_regval_type:
17939 	case DW_OP_deref_type:
17940 	case DW_OP_convert:
17941 	case DW_OP_reinterpret:
17942 	case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
17943 	case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
17944 	case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
17945 	case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
17946 	case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
17947 	case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
17948 	case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
17949 	case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
17950 	case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
17951 	case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
17952 	case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
17953 	case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
17954 	  /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
17955 	     size functions, so assume they will not appear here.  */
17956 	  /* Fall through...  */
17957 
17958 	default:
17959 	  gcc_unreachable ();
17960 	}
17961 
17962       /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls).  */
17963       switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17964 	{
17965 	case DW_OP_bra:
17966 	  if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
17967 				       frame_offsets))
17968 	    return false;
17969 	  /* Fall through. */
17970 
17971 	case DW_OP_skip:
17972 	  l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
17973 	  break;
17974 
17975 	case DW_OP_stack_value:
17976 	  return true;
17977 
17978 	default:
17979 	  l = l->dw_loc_next;
17980 	  break;
17981 	}
17982     }
17983 
17984   return true;
17985 }
17986 
17987 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
17988    operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
17989    target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI).  INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame
17990    offset *before* LOC is executed.  Return if all relocations were
17991    successful.  */
17992 
17993 static bool
17994 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17995 		      struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
17996 {
17997   /* Associate to all visited operations the frame offset *before* evaluating
17998      this operation.  */
17999   hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> frame_offsets;
18000 
18001   return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi,
18002 				 frame_offsets);
18003 }
18004 
18005 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
18006    Return NULL if it is not possible.  */
18007 
18008 static dw_die_ref
18009 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
18010 {
18011   struct loc_descr_context ctx;
18012   struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
18013   dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
18014   tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
18015   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
18016 
18017   tree cursor;
18018   unsigned i;
18019 
18020   /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
18021      declaration.  */
18022   dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
18023   if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
18024     return dwarf_proc_die;
18025 
18026   /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard.  */
18027   if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
18028     return NULL;
18029 
18030   /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
18031      supported type and that takes arguments with supported types.  Note that
18032      there is no point translating functions that return nothing.  */
18033   if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
18034       || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
18035       || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
18036     return NULL;
18037 
18038   for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
18039        cursor != NULL_TREE;
18040        cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
18041     if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
18042       return NULL;
18043 
18044   /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)).  */
18045   if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
18046     return NULL;
18047   tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
18048   if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
18049       || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
18050     return NULL;
18051   tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
18052 
18053   /* Try to translate the body expression itself.  Note that this will probably
18054      cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle.  This is very
18055      unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
18056      the moment.  */
18057   ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
18058   ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
18059   ctx.dpi = &dpi;
18060   ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
18061   ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
18062   dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
18063   dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
18064   loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
18065   if (!loc_body)
18066     return NULL;
18067 
18068   /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
18069      stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
18070      Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame.  */
18071   epilogue = NULL;
18072   for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
18073     {
18074       dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
18075       op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
18076       op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
18077       epilogue = op_couple;
18078     }
18079   add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
18080   if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
18081     return NULL;
18082 
18083   /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
18084      because they are considered useful.  Now there is an epilogue, they are
18085      not anymore, so give it another try.   */
18086   loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
18087 
18088   /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
18089      a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here.  It's unlikely,
18090      though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
18091      not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE.  */
18092   dwarf_proc_die
18093     = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
18094 			  get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
18095 
18096   /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
18097      returns one stack slot.  */
18098   dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
18099 
18100   return dwarf_proc_die;
18101 }
18102 
18103 
18104 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
18105    If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
18106    If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
18107    if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
18108      will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
18109      to refer to register values).
18110 
18111    CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
18112    generation.  Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
18113    referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address.  If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
18114    will not be generated.
18115 
18116    Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
18117    DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
18118 
18119    If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
18120    and dpi fields were null.  */
18121 
18122 static dw_loc_list_ref
18123 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
18124 		      struct loc_descr_context *context)
18125 {
18126   dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
18127   dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
18128   int have_address = 0;
18129   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
18130 
18131   /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
18132      extending the values properly.  Hopefully this won't be a real
18133      problem...  */
18134 
18135   if (context != NULL
18136       && context->base_decl == loc
18137       && want_address == 0)
18138     {
18139       if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18140 	return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
18141 			     NULL, 0, NULL, 0, NULL);
18142       else
18143 	return NULL;
18144     }
18145 
18146   switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
18147     {
18148     case ERROR_MARK:
18149       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
18150       return 0;
18151 
18152     case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
18153       /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
18154 	 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
18155          operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
18156          that the context allows.  */
18157       if (context != NULL
18158           && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
18159 	  && want_address >= 1)
18160 	{
18161 	  if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18162 	    {
18163 	      ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
18164 	      have_address = 1;
18165 	      break;
18166 	    }
18167 	  else
18168 	    return NULL;
18169 	}
18170       /* For DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes, PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for
18171 	 the single argument passed by consumer.  */
18172       else if (context != NULL
18173 	       && context->placeholder_arg
18174 	       && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
18175 	       && want_address == 0)
18176 	{
18177 	  ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 0, 0);
18178 	  ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
18179 	  context->placeholder_seen = true;
18180 	  break;
18181 	}
18182       else
18183 	expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18184 			  "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
18185       break;
18186 
18187     case CALL_EXPR:
18188 	{
18189 	  const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
18190 	  tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
18191 	  int i;
18192 	  dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
18193 
18194 	  if (callee == NULL_TREE)
18195 	    goto call_expansion_failed;
18196 
18197 	  /* We handle only functions that return an integer.  */
18198 	  if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
18199 	    goto call_expansion_failed;
18200 
18201 	  dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
18202 	  if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
18203 	    goto call_expansion_failed;
18204 
18205 	  /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
18206 	     be the top-most one on the stack.  */
18207 	  for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
18208 	    {
18209 	      dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
18210 	        = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
18211 					    context);
18212 
18213 	      if (loc_descr == NULL)
18214 		goto call_expansion_failed;
18215 
18216 	      add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
18217 	    }
18218 
18219 	  ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
18220 	  ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
18221 	  ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
18222 	  ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
18223 	  add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18224 	  break;
18225 
18226 	call_expansion_failed:
18227 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
18228 	  /* There are no opcodes for these operations.  */
18229 	  return 0;
18230 	}
18231 
18232     case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
18233     case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
18234     case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
18235     case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
18236       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
18237       /* There are no opcodes for these operations.  */
18238       return 0;
18239 
18240     case ADDR_EXPR:
18241       /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
18242          e.g. for &this->field.  */
18243       if (want_address)
18244 	{
18245 	  list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
18246 		       (loc, want_address == 2, context);
18247 	  if (list_ret)
18248 	    have_address = 1;
18249 	  else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
18250 	  	   && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
18251 	    have_address = 1;
18252 	}
18253         /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address.  */
18254       if (!list_ret && !ret)
18255         list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
18256       else
18257 	{
18258 	  if (want_address)
18259 	    expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
18260 	  return NULL;
18261 	}
18262       break;
18263 
18264     case VAR_DECL:
18265       if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
18266 	{
18267 	  rtx rtl;
18268          enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
18269          enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
18270 
18271 	  if (targetm.have_tls)
18272 	    {
18273 	      /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
18274 		 data.  */
18275 	      if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
18276 		return 0;
18277 
18278 	       /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
18279 	     	  can only look up addresses of objects in the current
18280 	     	  module.  We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
18281 		  wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
18282 		  info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
18283 		  operand shouldn't be.  */
18284 	      if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
18285 		return 0;
18286 	      dtprel = dtprel_true;
18287 	      /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
18288 		 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12.  */
18289 	      tls_op = (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
18290 			: DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address);
18291 	    }
18292 	  else
18293 	    {
18294 	      if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
18295 		  || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18296 		return 0;
18297 	      /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
18298 		 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
18299 		 no longer appear in gimple code.  We used the control
18300 		 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here.  */
18301 	      loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
18302               tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
18303 	    }
18304 
18305 	  rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
18306 	  if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
18307 	    return 0;
18308 
18309 	  if (!MEM_P (rtl))
18310 	    return 0;
18311 	  rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
18312 	  if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
18313 	    return 0;
18314 
18315           ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
18316           ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
18317 	  add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18318 
18319 	  have_address = 1;
18320 	  break;
18321 	}
18322       /* FALLTHRU */
18323 
18324     case PARM_DECL:
18325       if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
18326 	  && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
18327 	{
18328 	  /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
18329 	     one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
18330 	     the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
18331 	     with the stack frame size.  */
18332 	  unsigned i = 0;
18333 	  tree cursor;
18334 
18335 	  for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
18336 	       cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
18337 	       cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
18338 	    ;
18339 	  /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
18340 	     must belong to the current function.  */
18341 	  gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
18342 
18343 	  ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
18344 	  ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
18345 	  break;
18346 	}
18347       /* FALLTHRU */
18348 
18349     case RESULT_DECL:
18350       if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
18351 	return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
18352 				     want_address, context);
18353       /* FALLTHRU */
18354 
18355     case FUNCTION_DECL:
18356       {
18357 	rtx rtl;
18358 	var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
18359 
18360 	if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
18361 	  {
18362 	    list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
18363 	    have_address = want_address != 0;
18364 	    break;
18365 	  }
18366 	rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
18367 	if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
18368 	  {
18369 	    if (TREE_CODE (loc) != FUNCTION_DECL
18370 		&& early_dwarf
18371 		&& current_function_decl
18372 		&& want_address != 1
18373 		&& ! DECL_IGNORED_P (loc)
18374 		&& (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
18375 		    || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18376 		&& DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == current_function_decl
18377 		&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18378 		    <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
18379 	      {
18380 		dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (loc);
18381 		ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_variable_value, 0, 0);
18382 		if (ref)
18383 		  {
18384 		    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
18385 		    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
18386 		    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
18387 		  }
18388 		else
18389 		  {
18390 		    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
18391 		    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = loc;
18392 		  }
18393 		break;
18394 	      }
18395 	    expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
18396 	    return 0;
18397 	  }
18398 	else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
18399 	  {
18400 	    HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
18401 	    if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18402 	      val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
18403 	    ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
18404 	  }
18405 	else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
18406 	  {
18407 	    expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
18408 	    return 0;
18409 	  }
18410 	else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
18411           ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
18412 	else
18413 	  {
18414 	    machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
18415 
18416 	    /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level.  */
18417 	    if (want_address == 2)
18418 	      {
18419 		ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
18420 				      VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18421 		have_address = 1;
18422 	      }
18423 	    else
18424 	      {
18425 		mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
18426 		mem_mode = VOIDmode;
18427 		if (MEM_P (rtl))
18428 		  {
18429 		    mem_mode = mode;
18430 		    mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
18431 		    rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
18432 		    have_address = 1;
18433 		  }
18434 		ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
18435 					  VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18436 	      }
18437 	    if (!ret)
18438 	      expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
18439 				"failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
18440 	  }
18441       }
18442       break;
18443 
18444     case MEM_REF:
18445       if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
18446 	{
18447 	  have_address = 1;
18448 	  goto do_plus;
18449 	}
18450       /* Fallthru.  */
18451     case INDIRECT_REF:
18452       list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18453       have_address = 1;
18454       break;
18455 
18456     case TARGET_MEM_REF:
18457     case SSA_NAME:
18458     case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
18459       return NULL;
18460 
18461     case COMPOUND_EXPR:
18462       return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
18463 				   context);
18464 
18465     CASE_CONVERT:
18466     case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18467     case SAVE_EXPR:
18468     case MODIFY_EXPR:
18469     case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
18470       return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
18471 				   context);
18472 
18473     case COMPONENT_REF:
18474     case BIT_FIELD_REF:
18475     case ARRAY_REF:
18476     case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
18477     case REALPART_EXPR:
18478     case IMAGPART_EXPR:
18479       {
18480 	tree obj, offset;
18481 	poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
18482 	machine_mode mode;
18483 	int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
18484 
18485 	obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
18486 				   &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
18487 
18488 	gcc_assert (obj != loc);
18489 
18490 	list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
18491 					 want_address == 2
18492 					 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
18493 					 && !offset ? 2 : 1,
18494 					 context);
18495 	/* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
18496 	   for nonzero bitpos.  */
18497 	if (list_ret == 0)
18498 	  return 0;
18499 	if (!multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
18500 	    || !multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
18501 	  {
18502 	    expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18503 			      "bitfield access");
18504 	    return 0;
18505 	  }
18506 
18507 	if (offset != NULL_TREE)
18508 	  {
18509 	    /* Variable offset.  */
18510 	    list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
18511 	    if (list_ret1 == 0)
18512 	      return 0;
18513 	    add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18514 	    if (!list_ret)
18515 	      return 0;
18516 	    add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
18517 	  }
18518 
18519 	HOST_WIDE_INT value;
18520 	if (bytepos.is_constant (&value) && value > 0)
18521 	  add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
18522 							  value, 0));
18523 	else if (maybe_ne (bytepos, 0))
18524 	  loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
18525 
18526 	have_address = 1;
18527 	break;
18528       }
18529 
18530     case INTEGER_CST:
18531       if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
18532 	  && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
18533 	have_address = 1;
18534       else if (want_address == 2
18535 	       && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
18536 	       && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
18537 	       		   (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
18538 	       		    tree_to_shwi (loc))))
18539 	have_address = 1;
18540       else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
18541 	ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
18542       else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
18543 	ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
18544       else
18545 	{
18546 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18547 			    "Integer operand is not host integer");
18548 	  return 0;
18549 	}
18550       break;
18551 
18552     case CONSTRUCTOR:
18553     case REAL_CST:
18554     case STRING_CST:
18555     case COMPLEX_CST:
18556       if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
18557 	have_address = 1;
18558       else if (TREE_CODE (loc) == CONSTRUCTOR)
18559 	{
18560 	  tree type = TREE_TYPE (loc);
18561 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
18562 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
18563 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
18564 	  constructor_elt *ce;
18565 
18566 	  if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
18567 	    {
18568 	      /* This is very limited, but it's enough to output
18569 		 pointers to member functions, as long as the
18570 		 referenced function is defined in the current
18571 		 translation unit.  */
18572 	      FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (loc), cnt, ce)
18573 		{
18574 		  tree val = ce->value;
18575 
18576 		  tree field = ce->index;
18577 
18578 		  if (val)
18579 		    STRIP_NOPS (val);
18580 
18581 		  if (!field || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
18582 		    {
18583 		      expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18584 					"bitfield in record type constructor");
18585 		      size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
18586 		      ret = NULL;
18587 		      break;
18588 		    }
18589 
18590 		  HOST_WIDE_INT fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
18591 		  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT pos = int_byte_position (field);
18592 		  gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
18593 		  if (pos < offset)
18594 		    {
18595 		      expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18596 					"out-of-order fields in record constructor");
18597 		      size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
18598 		      ret = NULL;
18599 		      break;
18600 		    }
18601 		  if (pos > offset)
18602 		    {
18603 		      ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, pos - offset, 0);
18604 		      add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18605 		      offset = pos;
18606 		    }
18607 		  if (val && fieldsize != 0)
18608 		    {
18609 		      ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, want_address, context);
18610 		      if (!ret1)
18611 			{
18612 			  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18613 					    "unsupported expression in field");
18614 			  size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
18615 			  ret = NULL;
18616 			  break;
18617 			}
18618 		      add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18619 		    }
18620 		  if (fieldsize)
18621 		    {
18622 		      ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, fieldsize, 0);
18623 		      add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18624 		      offset = pos + fieldsize;
18625 		    }
18626 		}
18627 
18628 	      if (offset != size)
18629 		{
18630 		  ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size - offset, 0);
18631 		  add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18632 		  offset = size;
18633 		}
18634 
18635 	      have_address = !!want_address;
18636 	    }
18637 	  else
18638 	    expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18639 			      "constructor of non-record type");
18640 	}
18641       else
18642       /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor.  */
18643 	expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18644 			  "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
18645       break;
18646 
18647     case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
18648     case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
18649     case BIT_AND_EXPR:
18650       op = DW_OP_and;
18651       goto do_binop;
18652 
18653     case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
18654     case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
18655       op = DW_OP_xor;
18656       goto do_binop;
18657 
18658     case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
18659     case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
18660     case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
18661       op = DW_OP_or;
18662       goto do_binop;
18663 
18664     case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
18665     case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
18666     case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
18667     case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
18668     case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
18669       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18670 	return 0;
18671       op = DW_OP_div;
18672       goto do_binop;
18673 
18674     case MINUS_EXPR:
18675       op = DW_OP_minus;
18676       goto do_binop;
18677 
18678     case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
18679     case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
18680     case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
18681     case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
18682       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18683 	{
18684 	  op = DW_OP_mod;
18685 	  goto do_binop;
18686 	}
18687       list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18688       list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18689       if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
18690 	return 0;
18691 
18692       add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18693       if (list_ret == 0)
18694 	return 0;
18695       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
18696       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
18697       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
18698       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
18699       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
18700       break;
18701 
18702     case MULT_EXPR:
18703       op = DW_OP_mul;
18704       goto do_binop;
18705 
18706     case LSHIFT_EXPR:
18707       op = DW_OP_shl;
18708       goto do_binop;
18709 
18710     case RSHIFT_EXPR:
18711       op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
18712       goto do_binop;
18713 
18714     case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
18715     case PLUS_EXPR:
18716     do_plus:
18717       if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
18718 	{
18719 	  /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
18720 	     smarter to encode their opposite.  The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
18721 	     takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend.  On the
18722 	     other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
18723 	     bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
18724 	     of the addend.  So let's choose the smallest representation.  */
18725 	  const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
18726 	  offset_int wi_addend;
18727 	  HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
18728 	  dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
18729 
18730 	  list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18731 	  if (list_ret == 0)
18732 	    return 0;
18733 
18734 	  /* Try to get the literal to push.  It is the opposite of the addend,
18735 	     so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
18736 	     the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number.  */
18737 	  wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
18738 	  wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
18739 	  shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
18740 	  loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
18741 			? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
18742 			: NULL;
18743 
18744 	  if (loc_naddend != NULL
18745 	      && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
18746 	          > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
18747 	    {
18748 	      add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
18749 	      add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18750 				     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
18751 	    }
18752 	  else
18753 	    {
18754 	      for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
18755 		{
18756 		  loc_naddend = loc_cur;
18757 		  loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
18758 		  ggc_free (loc_naddend);
18759 		}
18760 	      loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
18761 	    }
18762 	  break;
18763 	}
18764 
18765       op = DW_OP_plus;
18766       goto do_binop;
18767 
18768     case LE_EXPR:
18769       op = DW_OP_le;
18770       goto do_comp_binop;
18771 
18772     case GE_EXPR:
18773       op = DW_OP_ge;
18774       goto do_comp_binop;
18775 
18776     case LT_EXPR:
18777       op = DW_OP_lt;
18778       goto do_comp_binop;
18779 
18780     case GT_EXPR:
18781       op = DW_OP_gt;
18782       goto do_comp_binop;
18783 
18784     do_comp_binop:
18785       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
18786 	{
18787 	  list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18788 	  list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18789 	  list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
18790 						    TREE_CODE (loc));
18791 	  break;
18792 	}
18793       else
18794 	goto do_binop;
18795 
18796     case EQ_EXPR:
18797       op = DW_OP_eq;
18798       goto do_binop;
18799 
18800     case NE_EXPR:
18801       op = DW_OP_ne;
18802       goto do_binop;
18803 
18804     do_binop:
18805       list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18806       list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18807       if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
18808 	return 0;
18809 
18810       add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18811       if (list_ret == 0)
18812 	return 0;
18813       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18814       break;
18815 
18816     case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
18817     case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
18818       op = DW_OP_not;
18819       goto do_unop;
18820 
18821     case ABS_EXPR:
18822       op = DW_OP_abs;
18823       goto do_unop;
18824 
18825     case NEGATE_EXPR:
18826       op = DW_OP_neg;
18827       goto do_unop;
18828 
18829     do_unop:
18830       list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18831       if (list_ret == 0)
18832 	return 0;
18833 
18834       add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18835       break;
18836 
18837     case MIN_EXPR:
18838     case MAX_EXPR:
18839       {
18840 	const enum tree_code code =
18841 	  TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
18842 
18843 	loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
18844 		      build2 (code, integer_type_node,
18845 			      TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
18846 		      TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
18847       }
18848 
18849       /* fall through */
18850 
18851     case COND_EXPR:
18852       {
18853 	dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
18854 	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18855 	dw_loc_list_ref rhs
18856 	  = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
18857 	dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
18858 
18859 	list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18860 	if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
18861 	  return 0;
18862 
18863 	bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
18864 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
18865 
18866 	add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
18867 	jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
18868 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
18869 
18870 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
18871 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
18872 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
18873 
18874 	/* ??? Need a node to point the skip at.  Use a nop.  */
18875 	tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
18876 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
18877 	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
18878 	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
18879       }
18880       break;
18881 
18882     case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
18883       return 0;
18884 
18885     default:
18886       /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown.  This comes
18887 	 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR.  */
18888       if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
18889 	  >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
18890 	{
18891 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18892 			    "language specific tree node");
18893 	  return 0;
18894 	}
18895 
18896       /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
18897 	 these explicitly.  We forgot one.  */
18898       if (flag_checking)
18899 	gcc_unreachable ();
18900 
18901       /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
18902 	 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash.  */
18903       return NULL;
18904     }
18905 
18906   if (!ret && !list_ret)
18907     return 0;
18908 
18909   if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
18910       && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
18911     {
18912       if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18913 	{
18914 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18915 			    "DWARF address size mismatch");
18916 	  return 0;
18917 	}
18918       if (ret)
18919 	add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18920       else
18921 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18922 			       new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18923       have_address = 1;
18924     }
18925   /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address.  */
18926   if (want_address && !have_address)
18927     {
18928       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18929 			"Want address and only have value");
18930       return 0;
18931     }
18932 
18933   gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
18934 
18935   /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference.  */
18936   if (!want_address && have_address)
18937     {
18938       HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
18939 
18940       if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
18941 	{
18942 	  expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18943 			    "DWARF address size mismatch");
18944 	  return 0;
18945 	}
18946       else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18947 	op = DW_OP_deref;
18948       else
18949 	op = DW_OP_deref_size;
18950 
18951       if (ret)
18952 	add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18953       else
18954 	add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18955     }
18956   if (ret)
18957     list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, 0, NULL, 0, NULL);
18958 
18959   return list_ret;
18960 }
18961 
18962 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
18963    expressions.  */
18964 
18965 static dw_loc_list_ref
18966 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18967 		    struct loc_descr_context *context)
18968 {
18969   dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
18970 
18971   for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
18972        loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
18973     loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
18974   return result;
18975 }
18976 
18977 /* Same as above but return only single location expression.  */
18978 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18979 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18980 			  struct loc_descr_context *context)
18981 {
18982   dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
18983   if (!ret)
18984     return NULL;
18985   if (ret->dw_loc_next)
18986     {
18987       expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18988 			"Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
18989       return NULL;
18990     }
18991   return ret->expr;
18992 }
18993 
18994 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
18995    which is not less than the value itself.  */
18996 
18997 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
18998 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
18999 {
19000   return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
19001 }
19002 
19003 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
19004    pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
19005    `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
19006    ERROR_MARK node.  */
19007 
19008 static inline tree
19009 field_type (const_tree decl)
19010 {
19011   tree type;
19012 
19013   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
19014     return integer_type_node;
19015 
19016   type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
19017   if (type == NULL_TREE)
19018     type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19019 
19020   return type;
19021 }
19022 
19023 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
19024    it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
19025    be an ERROR_MARK node.  */
19026 
19027 static inline unsigned
19028 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
19029 {
19030   return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
19031 }
19032 
19033 static inline unsigned
19034 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
19035 {
19036   return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
19037 }
19038 
19039 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN.  */
19040 
19041 static inline offset_int
19042 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
19043 {
19044   return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
19045 }
19046 
19047 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes.  If possible, return NULL and store the
19048    size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE.  Otherwise, if possible, return a
19049    DWARF expression that computes the size.  Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
19050    if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms.  */
19051 
19052 static dw_loc_descr_ref
19053 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
19054 {
19055   tree tree_size;
19056   struct loc_descr_context ctx;
19057 
19058   /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible.  */
19059   *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
19060   if (*cst_size != -1)
19061     return NULL;
19062 
19063   ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
19064   ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
19065   ctx.dpi = NULL;
19066   ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
19067   ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
19068 
19069   type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
19070   tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
19071   return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
19072 	  ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
19073 	  : NULL);
19074 }
19075 
19076 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing.  */
19077 struct vlr_context
19078 {
19079   /* Root RECORD_TYPE.  It is needed to generate data member location
19080      descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
19081      variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
19082      QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes.  Each time such a structure is passed to a
19083      function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null.  */
19084   tree struct_type;
19085   /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
19086      QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
19087      this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units).  For
19088      regular records, it must be NULL_TREE.  */
19089   tree variant_part_offset;
19090 };
19091 
19092 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
19093    addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
19094    possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
19095    returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
19096 
19097    Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
19098    that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
19099    ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
19100 
19101    CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.  */
19102 
19103 static dw_loc_descr_ref
19104 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
19105 		   HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
19106 {
19107   tree tree_result;
19108   dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
19109 
19110   *cst_offset = 0;
19111 
19112   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
19113     return NULL;
19114   else
19115     gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
19116 
19117   /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
19118      case.  */
19119   if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
19120     return NULL;
19121 
19122 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
19123   /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases.  Now, we handle
19124      properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
19125      matter.  */
19126   if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
19127       && TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) == INTEGER_CST)
19128     {
19129       offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
19130       offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
19131       offset_int bitpos_int;
19132       tree type;
19133       tree field_size_tree;
19134       offset_int deepest_bitpos;
19135       offset_int field_size_in_bits;
19136       unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
19137       unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
19138       offset_int type_size_in_bits;
19139 
19140       bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
19141       type = field_type (decl);
19142       type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
19143       type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
19144 
19145       field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
19146 
19147       /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
19148 	 a flexible array member.  */
19149       if (!field_size_tree)
19150 	field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
19151 
19152       /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size.  */
19153       if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
19154 	field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
19155       else
19156 	field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
19157 
19158       decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
19159 
19160       /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
19161 	 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
19162 	 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
19163 	 bit-field.  Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
19164 	 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
19165 	 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
19166 	 some cases.  For example, handling the following structure type
19167 	 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
19168 	 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
19169 
19170 	 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
19171 
19172 	 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
19173 	 in such cases.  When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
19174 	 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above.  It decides to
19175 	 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
19176 	 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
19177 	 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
19178 	 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
19179 	 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
19180 	 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
19181 	 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
19182 	 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
19183 
19184 	 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
19185 	 each object of the structure type shown above.  When looking
19186 	 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
19187 	 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
19188 	 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
19189 	 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
19190 	 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
19191 	 within that selected 64 bit field.  (As it turns out, for the
19192 	 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
19193 	 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
19194 	 structure type.)
19195 
19196 	 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
19197 	 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
19198 	 must have believed that the containing object started (within
19199 	 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
19200 	 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
19201 	 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
19202 	 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well).  */
19203 
19204       /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
19205 	 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field.  */
19206       deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
19207 
19208       /* This is the tricky part.  Use some fancy footwork to deduce
19209 	 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
19210 	 be.  */
19211       object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
19212 
19213       /* Round up to type_align by default.  This works best for
19214 	 bitfields.  */
19215       object_offset_in_bits
19216 	= round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
19217 
19218       if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
19219 	{
19220 	  object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
19221 
19222 	  /* Round up to decl_align instead.  */
19223 	  object_offset_in_bits
19224 	    = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
19225 	}
19226 
19227       object_offset_in_bytes
19228 	= wi::lrshift (object_offset_in_bits, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
19229       if (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE)
19230 	{
19231 	  *cst_offset = object_offset_in_bytes.to_shwi ();
19232 	  return NULL;
19233 	}
19234       tree_result = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, object_offset_in_bytes);
19235     }
19236   else
19237 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
19238     tree_result = byte_position (decl);
19239 
19240   if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
19241     tree_result = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
19242 			       ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result);
19243 
19244   /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
19245      constant rather than a DWARF expression.  */
19246   if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
19247     {
19248       *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
19249       return NULL;
19250     }
19251   struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
19252     ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
19253     NULL_TREE,	      /* base_decl */
19254     NULL,	      /* dpi */
19255     false,	      /* placeholder_arg */
19256     false	      /* placeholder_seen */
19257   };
19258   loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
19259 
19260   /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
19261      multiple elements.  */
19262   if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
19263     return NULL;
19264   else
19265     return loc_result->expr;
19266 }
19267 
19268 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
19269    associated with them.  */
19270 
19271 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
19272 
19273    This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
19274    whole parameters.  Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
19275    generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below.  */
19276 
19277 static inline void
19278 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
19279 			     dw_loc_list_ref descr)
19280 {
19281   bool check_no_locviews = true;
19282   if (descr == 0)
19283     return;
19284   if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
19285     add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
19286   else
19287     {
19288       add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
19289       gcc_assert (descr->ll_symbol);
19290       if (attr_kind == DW_AT_location && descr->vl_symbol
19291 	  && dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ())
19292 	{
19293 	  add_AT_view_list (die, DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
19294 	  check_no_locviews = false;
19295 	}
19296     }
19297 
19298   if (check_no_locviews)
19299     gcc_assert (!get_AT (die, DW_AT_GNU_locviews));
19300 }
19301 
19302 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed.  */
19303 
19304 static void
19305 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
19306 {
19307   /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
19308      children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public.  In DWARF2
19309      the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public.  */
19310   if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
19311     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
19312   else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
19313     {
19314       if (dwarf_version == 2
19315 	  || die->die_parent == NULL
19316 	  || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
19317 	add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
19318     }
19319   else if (dwarf_version > 2
19320 	   && die->die_parent
19321 	   && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
19322     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
19323 }
19324 
19325 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
19326    struct and union types.  In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
19327    represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
19328    descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
19329    byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
19330    the "containing object" for the bit-field.  (See the `field_byte_offset'
19331    function above).
19332 
19333    For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
19334    (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
19335    type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
19336    declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
19337    DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this).  Note that it is the size (in
19338    bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
19339    DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.  (See the
19340    `byte_size_attribute' function below.)  It is also used when calculating the
19341    value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute.  (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
19342    function below.)
19343 
19344    CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.  */
19345 
19346 static void
19347 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
19348 				    tree decl,
19349 				    struct vlr_context *ctx)
19350 {
19351   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
19352   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
19353 
19354   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
19355     {
19356       /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class.  */
19357       if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
19358 	{
19359 	  /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
19360 	     aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
19361 	     type.  We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
19362 	     vtable.  The following dwarf expression means
19363 
19364 	       BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
19365 
19366 	     This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course.  */
19367 
19368 	  dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
19369 
19370 	  /* Make a copy of the object address.  */
19371 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
19372 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19373 
19374 	  /* Extract the vtable address.  */
19375 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
19376 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19377 
19378 	  /* Calculate the address of the offset.  */
19379 	  offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
19380 	  gcc_assert (offset < 0);
19381 
19382 	  tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
19383 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19384 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
19385 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19386 
19387 	  /* Extract the offset.  */
19388 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
19389 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19390 
19391 	  /* Add it to the object address.  */
19392 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
19393 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19394 	}
19395       else
19396 	offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
19397     }
19398   else
19399     {
19400       loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
19401 
19402       /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
19403 	 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
19404 	 moment.  */
19405       if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
19406 	{
19407 	  loc_descr = NULL;
19408 	  offset = 0;
19409 	}
19410 
19411       /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
19412 	 stack.  Compute the field offset and add it to this base address.  */
19413       else if (loc_descr != NULL)
19414 	add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
19415     }
19416 
19417   if (! loc_descr)
19418     {
19419       /* While DW_AT_data_bit_offset has been added already in DWARF4,
19420 	 e.g. GDB only added support to it in November 2016.  For DWARF5
19421 	 we need newer debug info consumers anyway.  We might change this
19422 	 to dwarf_version >= 4 once most consumers catched up.  */
19423       if (dwarf_version >= 5
19424 	  && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
19425 	  && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
19426 	{
19427 	  tree off = bit_position (decl);
19428 	  if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (off) && get_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_size))
19429 	    {
19430 	      remove_AT (die, DW_AT_byte_size);
19431 	      remove_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_offset);
19432 	      add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_bit_offset, tree_to_uhwi (off));
19433 	      return;
19434 	    }
19435 	}
19436       if (dwarf_version > 2)
19437 	{
19438 	  /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
19439 	  if (offset < 0)
19440 	    add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
19441 	  else
19442 	    add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
19443 	  return;
19444 	}
19445       else
19446 	{
19447 	  enum dwarf_location_atom op;
19448 
19449 	  /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
19450 	     address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
19451 	     field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst.  */
19452 	  op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
19453 	  loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
19454 	}
19455     }
19456 
19457   add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
19458 }
19459 
19460 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array.  */
19461 
19462 static void
19463 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
19464 {
19465   while (size != 0)
19466     {
19467       *dest++ = val & 0xff;
19468       val >>= 8;
19469       --size;
19470     }
19471 }
19472 
19473 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array.  Inverse of insert_int.  */
19474 
19475 static HOST_WIDE_INT
19476 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
19477 {
19478   HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
19479 
19480   src += size;
19481   while (size != 0)
19482     {
19483       val <<= 8;
19484       val |= *--src & 0xff;
19485       --size;
19486     }
19487   return val;
19488 }
19489 
19490 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array.  */
19491 
19492 static void
19493 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
19494 {
19495   int i;
19496 
19497   if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
19498     {
19499       insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
19500       return;
19501     }
19502 
19503   /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes.  */
19504   gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
19505 
19506   int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
19507 
19508   if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
19509     for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
19510       {
19511 	insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
19512 	dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
19513       }
19514   else
19515     for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
19516       {
19517 	insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
19518 	dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
19519       }
19520 }
19521 
19522 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array.  */
19523 
19524 static void
19525 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
19526 {
19527   long val[4];
19528   int i;
19529   scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
19530 
19531   real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), mode);
19532 
19533   /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long.  Pack them.  */
19534   for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4; i++)
19535     {
19536       insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
19537       array += 4;
19538     }
19539 }
19540 
19541 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
19542    does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register.  These
19543    things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
19544    to an inlined function.  They can also arise in C++ where declared
19545    constants do not necessarily get memory "homes".  */
19546 
19547 static bool
19548 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
19549 {
19550   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
19551     {
19552     case CONST_INT:
19553       {
19554 	HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
19555 
19556 	if (val < 0)
19557 	  add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
19558 	else
19559 	  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
19560       }
19561       return true;
19562 
19563     case CONST_WIDE_INT:
19564       {
19565 	wide_int w1 = rtx_mode_t (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
19566 	unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
19567 				 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
19568 	wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
19569 	add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
19570       }
19571       return true;
19572 
19573     case CONST_DOUBLE:
19574       /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
19575 	 floating-point constant.  A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
19576 	 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
19577 	 represented.  */
19578       if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
19579 	  && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (rtl)))
19580 	add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
19581 		       CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
19582       else
19583 	{
19584 	  scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
19585 	  unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
19586 	  unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
19587 
19588 	  insert_float (rtl, array);
19589 	  add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
19590 	}
19591       return true;
19592 
19593     case CONST_VECTOR:
19594       {
19595 	unsigned int length;
19596 	if (!CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl).is_constant (&length))
19597 	  return false;
19598 
19599 	machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
19600 	unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
19601 	unsigned char *array
19602 	  = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
19603 	unsigned int i;
19604 	unsigned char *p;
19605 	machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
19606 
19607 	switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
19608 	  {
19609 	  case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
19610 	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
19611 	      {
19612 		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
19613 		insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
19614 	      }
19615 	    break;
19616 
19617 	  case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
19618 	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
19619 	      {
19620 		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
19621 		insert_float (elt, p);
19622 	      }
19623 	    break;
19624 
19625 	  default:
19626 	    gcc_unreachable ();
19627 	  }
19628 
19629 	add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
19630       }
19631       return true;
19632 
19633     case CONST_STRING:
19634       if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19635 	{
19636 	  dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
19637 	  resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
19638 	rtl_addr:
19639           loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
19640 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
19641 	  add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
19642 	  vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
19643 	  return true;
19644 	}
19645       return false;
19646 
19647     case CONST:
19648       if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
19649 	return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
19650       /* FALLTHROUGH */
19651     case SYMBOL_REF:
19652       if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
19653 	return false;
19654       /* FALLTHROUGH */
19655     case LABEL_REF:
19656       if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19657 	goto rtl_addr;
19658       return false;
19659 
19660     case PLUS:
19661       /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
19662 	 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
19663 	 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
19664 	 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
19665 	 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
19666 	 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)).  This is not
19667 	 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
19668 	 of the (artificial) local variable either.  Rather, it represents the
19669 	 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
19670 	 lifetime.  We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
19671 	 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing.  */
19672       return false;
19673 
19674     case HIGH:
19675     case CONST_FIXED:
19676       return false;
19677 
19678     case MEM:
19679       if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
19680 	  && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
19681 	  && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
19682 	{
19683 	  add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
19684 	  return true;
19685 	}
19686       return false;
19687 
19688     default:
19689       /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here.  */
19690       gcc_unreachable ();
19691     }
19692   return false;
19693 }
19694 
19695 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
19696    or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
19697    output).  */
19698 static tree
19699 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
19700 		     void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
19701 {
19702   if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
19703     *walk_subtrees = 0;
19704 
19705   if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
19706       && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
19707     return *tp;
19708   /* ???  The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
19709      putting gcc_unreachable here falls over.  See PR31899.  For now
19710      be conservative.  */
19711   else if (!symtab->global_info_ready && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (*tp))
19712     return *tp;
19713   else if (VAR_P (*tp))
19714     {
19715       varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
19716       if (!node || !node->definition)
19717 	return *tp;
19718     }
19719   else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
19720 	   && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
19721     {
19722       /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
19723          optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
19724 	 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
19725 	 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted.  */
19726       if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
19727 	return *tp;
19728     }
19729   else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
19730     return *tp;
19731 
19732   return NULL_TREE;
19733 }
19734 
19735 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
19736    for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call.  */
19737 
19738 static rtx
19739 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
19740 {
19741   rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
19742 
19743   STRIP_NOPS (init);
19744 
19745   /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
19746      zeros, build CONST_STRING.  */
19747   if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19748     {
19749       tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
19750       tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
19751       scalar_int_mode mode;
19752 
19753       if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
19754 	  && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
19755 	  && domain
19756 	  && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
19757 	  && TREE_CODE (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)) == INTEGER_CST
19758 	  && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
19759 	  && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
19760 			       TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
19761 	  && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
19762 	      == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
19763 	{
19764 	  rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
19765 				      ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
19766 	  rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
19767 	  MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
19768 	}
19769     }
19770   /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
19771      CONCAT: FIXME!  */
19772   else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
19773 	   || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
19774 	       && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
19775 	   || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
19776     ;
19777   /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
19778      FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too.  */
19779   else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
19780 	   && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
19781     ;
19782   /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
19783      immediate RTL constant, expand it now.  We must be careful not to
19784      reference variables which won't be output.  */
19785   else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
19786 	   && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
19787     {
19788       /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
19789 	 possible.  */
19790       if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19791 	switch (TREE_CODE (init))
19792 	  {
19793 	  case VECTOR_CST:
19794 	    break;
19795 	  case CONSTRUCTOR:
19796 	    if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
19797 	      {
19798 		vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
19799 		bool constant_p = true;
19800 		tree value;
19801 		unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
19802 
19803 		/* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
19804 		   elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
19805 		   belong into VECTOR_CST nodes.  */
19806 		FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
19807 		  if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
19808 		    {
19809 		      constant_p = false;
19810 		      break;
19811 		    }
19812 
19813 		if (constant_p)
19814 		  {
19815 		    init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
19816 		    break;
19817 		  }
19818 	      }
19819 	    /* FALLTHRU */
19820 
19821 	  default:
19822 	    return NULL;
19823 	  }
19824 
19825       rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
19826 
19827       /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate.  */
19828       gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
19829     }
19830 
19831   return rtl;
19832 }
19833 
19834 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location.  */
19835 
19836 static rtx
19837 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
19838 {
19839   rtx rtl;
19840 
19841   /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
19842      (as far as the debugger is concerned).  We only have a couple of
19843      choices.  GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
19844 
19845      DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
19846      activation of the function.  If optimization is enabled however, this
19847      could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg.  Both of those cases indicate
19848      that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
19849      generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
19850      activation.  That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
19851      referenced within the function.
19852 
19853      We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
19854      non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
19855      a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
19856      where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
19857 
19858      Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
19859      a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases.  In cases
19860      where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
19861      we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
19862      declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
19863      points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
19864 
19865      In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
19866      we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
19867      because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
19868      type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself.  Thus,
19869      if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
19870      such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
19871      `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
19872      `double'.  That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
19873      output at debug-time.
19874 
19875      So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
19876      in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl).  There
19877      are a couple of exceptions however.  On little-endian machines we can
19878      get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
19879      not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
19880      an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
19881      when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
19882      parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'.  In such cases,
19883      TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
19884      be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
19885      passed `int' value.  If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
19886      a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
19887      the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
19888 
19889      Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
19890      parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
19891      end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue).  We'll do that as best
19892      as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
19893      sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
19894      debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
19895      value rather than the value which was originally passed in.  This happens
19896      rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
19897      I'd like to fix it.
19898 
19899      A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
19900      any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
19901      type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
19902      to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
19903      "active location" for each parameter.  This additional set of attributes
19904      could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
19905      sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
19906      This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
19907      parameters which are never referenced.  This really shouldn't be
19908      happening.  All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
19909      DECL_INCOMING_RTL values.  FIXME.  */
19910 
19911   /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better.  */
19912   rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19913 
19914   /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
19915      constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
19916      fixed registers.  */
19917   if (! reload_completed)
19918     {
19919       if (rtl
19920 	  && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
19921 	      || (MEM_P (rtl)
19922 	          && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
19923 	      || (REG_P (rtl)
19924 	          && VAR_P (decl)
19925 		  && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
19926 	{
19927 	  rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19928 	  return rtl;
19929 	}
19930       rtl = NULL_RTX;
19931     }
19932   else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
19933     {
19934       if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19935 	  || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
19936 	  || (MEM_P (rtl)
19937 	      && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19938 	      && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
19939 	      && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19940 	      && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
19941 	{
19942 	  tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19943 	  tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
19944 	  machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
19945 	  machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
19946 
19947 	  /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
19948 	     Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
19949 	     all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below.  */
19950 	  if (dmode == pmode)
19951 	    rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19952 	  else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
19953 		   && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
19954 		   && known_le (GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode), GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode))
19955 		   && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19956 	    {
19957 	      rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19958 	      if (REG_P (inc))
19959 		rtl = inc;
19960 	      else if (MEM_P (inc))
19961 		{
19962 		  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
19963 		    rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
19964 					     GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19965 					     - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
19966 		  else
19967 		    rtl = inc;
19968 		}
19969 	    }
19970 	}
19971 
19972       /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
19973 	 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
19974 	 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl.  */
19975       /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
19976 	 we reach the big endian correction code there.  It isn't clear if all
19977 	 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
19978 	 thing to do.  */
19979       else if (MEM_P (rtl)
19980 	       && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
19981 	       && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19982 	       /* Not passed in memory.  */
19983 	       && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19984 	       /* Not passed by invisible reference.  */
19985 	       && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19986 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
19987 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
19988 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
19989 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
19990 #endif
19991 		     )
19992 	       /* Big endian correction check.  */
19993 	       && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
19994 	       && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
19995 	       && known_lt (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))),
19996 			    UNITS_PER_WORD))
19997 	{
19998 	  machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19999 	  poly_int64 offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
20000 			       - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
20001 
20002 	  rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20003 			     plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
20004 	}
20005     }
20006   else if (VAR_P (decl)
20007 	   && rtl
20008 	   && MEM_P (rtl)
20009 	   && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20010     {
20011       machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
20012       poly_int64 offset = byte_lowpart_offset (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20013 					       GET_MODE (rtl));
20014 
20015       /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
20016 	 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
20017 	 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
20018 	 fact we are not.  We need to adjust the offset of the
20019 	 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
20020 	 else gdb will not be able to display it.  */
20021       if (maybe_ne (offset, 0))
20022 	rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20023 			   plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
20024     }
20025 
20026   /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
20027      and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
20028      C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do.  */
20029   if (!rtl && VAR_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
20030     rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
20031 
20032   if (rtl)
20033     rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
20034 
20035   /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
20036      reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
20037      code, and thus is not emitted.  */
20038   if (rtl)
20039     rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
20040 
20041   /* Try harder to get a rtl.  If this symbol ends up not being emitted
20042      in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
20043      it.  */
20044   if (rtl == NULL_RTX
20045       && !(early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
20046       && VAR_P (decl)
20047       && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
20048       && TREE_STATIC (decl)
20049       && DECL_NAME (decl)
20050       && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
20051       && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
20052     {
20053       rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
20054       if (!MEM_P (rtl)
20055 	  || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
20056 	  || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
20057 	rtl = NULL_RTX;
20058     }
20059 
20060   return rtl;
20061 }
20062 
20063 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol.  If not, NULL_TREE is
20064    returned.  If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
20065    value is the offset into the common block for the symbol.  */
20066 
20067 static tree
20068 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
20069 {
20070   tree val_expr, cvar;
20071   machine_mode mode;
20072   poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
20073   tree offset;
20074   HOST_WIDE_INT cbitpos;
20075   int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
20076 
20077   /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
20078      it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
20079      is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
20080      be handled as such.  */
20081   if (!VAR_P (decl)
20082       || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
20083       || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
20084       || !is_fortran ())
20085     return NULL_TREE;
20086 
20087   val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
20088   if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
20089     return NULL_TREE;
20090 
20091   cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
20092 			      &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
20093 
20094   if (cvar == NULL_TREE
20095       || !VAR_P (cvar)
20096       || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
20097       || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar)
20098       /* We don't expect to have to cope with variable offsets,
20099 	 since at present all static data must have a constant size.  */
20100       || !bitpos.is_constant (&cbitpos))
20101     return NULL_TREE;
20102 
20103   *value = 0;
20104   if (offset != NULL)
20105     {
20106       if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
20107 	return NULL_TREE;
20108       *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
20109     }
20110   if (cbitpos != 0)
20111     *value += cbitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
20112 
20113   return cvar;
20114 }
20115 
20116 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
20117    data attribute for a variable or a parameter.  We generate the
20118    DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
20119    or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
20120    register.  This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
20121    actual argument in a call to an inline function.  (It's possible that
20122    these things can crop up in other ways also.)  Note that one type of
20123    constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
20124    pointer.  This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
20125    function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
20126 
20127    CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
20128    so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
20129    This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
20130    since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined.  */
20131 
20132 static bool
20133 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
20134 {
20135   rtx rtl;
20136   dw_loc_list_ref list;
20137   var_loc_list *loc_list;
20138   cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
20139 
20140   if (early_dwarf)
20141     return false;
20142 
20143   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
20144     return false;
20145 
20146   if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
20147       || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
20148     return true;
20149 
20150   gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
20151 	      || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
20152 
20153   /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
20154      the location.  */
20155 
20156   rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
20157   if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
20158       && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
20159     return true;
20160 
20161   /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
20162      a constant value.  That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
20163      rather than expanding constant value equivalent.  */
20164   loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
20165   if (loc_list
20166       && loc_list->first
20167       && loc_list->first->next == NULL
20168       && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
20169       && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
20170       && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
20171     {
20172       struct var_loc_node *node;
20173 
20174       node = loc_list->first;
20175       rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
20176       if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
20177 	rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
20178       if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
20179 	  && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
20180 	 return true;
20181     }
20182   /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
20183      list several times.  See if we've already cached the contents.  */
20184   list = NULL;
20185   if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
20186     cache_p = false;
20187   if (cache_p)
20188     {
20189       cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
20190       if (cache)
20191 	list = cache->loc_list;
20192     }
20193   if (list == NULL)
20194     {
20195       list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
20196 				 NULL);
20197       /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
20198 	 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements.  */
20199       if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
20200 	{
20201 	  cached_dw_loc_list **slot
20202 	    = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
20203 							     DECL_UID (decl),
20204 							     INSERT);
20205 	  cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
20206 	  cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
20207 	  cache->loc_list = list;
20208 	  *slot = cache;
20209 	}
20210     }
20211   if (list)
20212     {
20213       add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
20214       return true;
20215     }
20216   /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
20217      try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL.  */
20218   return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
20219 }
20220 
20221 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute.  Natively encode
20222    initializer INIT into an array.  Return true if successful.  */
20223 
20224 static bool
20225 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
20226 {
20227   tree type;
20228 
20229   if (init == NULL_TREE)
20230     return false;
20231 
20232   STRIP_NOPS (init);
20233   switch (TREE_CODE (init))
20234     {
20235     case STRING_CST:
20236       type = TREE_TYPE (init);
20237       if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
20238 	{
20239 	  tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
20240 	  scalar_int_mode mode;
20241 
20242 	  if (!is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
20243 	      || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
20244 	    return false;
20245 	  if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
20246 	    return false;
20247 	  if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
20248 	    {
20249 	      memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
20250 		      TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
20251 	      memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
20252 		      '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
20253 	    }
20254 	  else
20255 	    memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
20256 	  return true;
20257 	}
20258       return false;
20259     case CONSTRUCTOR:
20260       type = TREE_TYPE (init);
20261       if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
20262 	return false;
20263       if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
20264 	{
20265 	  HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
20266 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
20267 	  int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
20268 	  constructor_elt *ce;
20269 
20270 	  if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
20271 	      || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
20272 	    return false;
20273 
20274 	  fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
20275 	  if (fieldsize <= 0)
20276 	    return false;
20277 
20278 	  min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
20279 	  memset (array, '\0', size);
20280 	  FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
20281 	    {
20282 	      tree val = ce->value;
20283 	      tree index = ce->index;
20284 	      int pos = curpos;
20285 	      if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
20286 		pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
20287 		      * fieldsize;
20288 	      else if (index)
20289 		pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
20290 
20291 	      if (val)
20292 		{
20293 		  STRIP_NOPS (val);
20294 		  if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
20295 		    return false;
20296 		}
20297 	      curpos = pos + fieldsize;
20298 	      if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
20299 		{
20300 		  int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
20301 			      - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
20302 		  while (count-- > 0)
20303 		    {
20304 		      if (val)
20305 			memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
20306 		      curpos += fieldsize;
20307 		    }
20308 		}
20309 	      gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
20310 	    }
20311 	  return true;
20312 	}
20313       else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
20314 	       || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
20315 	{
20316 	  tree field = NULL_TREE;
20317 	  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
20318 	  constructor_elt *ce;
20319 
20320 	  if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
20321 	    return false;
20322 
20323 	  if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
20324 	    field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
20325 
20326 	  FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
20327 	    {
20328 	      tree val = ce->value;
20329 	      int pos, fieldsize;
20330 
20331 	      if (ce->index != 0)
20332 		field = ce->index;
20333 
20334 	      if (val)
20335 		STRIP_NOPS (val);
20336 
20337 	      if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
20338 		return false;
20339 
20340 	      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
20341 		  && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
20342 		  && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
20343 		return false;
20344 	      else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
20345 		       || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
20346 		return false;
20347 	      fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
20348 	      pos = int_byte_position (field);
20349 	      gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
20350 	      if (val && fieldsize != 0
20351 		  && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
20352 		return false;
20353 	    }
20354 	  return true;
20355 	}
20356       return false;
20357     case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20358     case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
20359       return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
20360     default:
20361       return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
20362     }
20363 }
20364 
20365 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
20366    attribute is the const value T.  */
20367 
20368 static bool
20369 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
20370 {
20371   tree init;
20372   tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
20373   rtx rtl;
20374 
20375   if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
20376     return false;
20377 
20378   init = t;
20379   gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
20380 
20381   if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST)
20382     {
20383       if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (init))
20384 	{
20385 	  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_uhwi (init));
20386 	  return true;
20387 	}
20388       if (tree_fits_shwi_p (init))
20389 	{
20390 	  add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_shwi (init));
20391 	  return true;
20392 	}
20393     }
20394   if (! early_dwarf)
20395     {
20396       rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
20397       if (rtl)
20398 	return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
20399     }
20400   /* If the host and target are sane, try harder.  */
20401   if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
20402       && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
20403     {
20404       HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
20405       if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
20406 	{
20407 	  unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
20408 
20409 	  if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
20410 	    {
20411 	      add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
20412 	      return true;
20413 	    }
20414 	  ggc_free (array);
20415 	}
20416     }
20417   return false;
20418 }
20419 
20420 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
20421    attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
20422    variable with static storage duration
20423    (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL).  */
20424 
20425 static bool
20426 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
20427 {
20428 
20429   if (!decl
20430       || (!VAR_P (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
20431       || (VAR_P (decl) && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
20432     return false;
20433 
20434   if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
20435       && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
20436       && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
20437     /* OK */;
20438   else
20439     return false;
20440 
20441   /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one.  */
20442   if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
20443     return false;
20444 
20445   return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
20446 }
20447 
20448 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
20449    location list.  This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
20450    a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
20451    DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
20452    expressions.  */
20453 
20454 static dw_loc_list_ref
20455 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
20456 {
20457   int ix;
20458   dw_fde_ref fde;
20459   dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
20460   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
20461   dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
20462   const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
20463   dw_cfa_location remember;
20464 
20465   fde = cfun->fde;
20466   gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
20467 
20468   section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
20469   list_tail = &list;
20470   list = NULL;
20471 
20472   memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
20473   next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
20474   remember = next_cfa;
20475 
20476   start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
20477 
20478   /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
20479      advance opcodes.  */
20480   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
20481     lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
20482 
20483   last_cfa = next_cfa;
20484   last_label = start_label;
20485 
20486   if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
20487     {
20488       /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
20489 	 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition.  */
20490       *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20491 				 fde->dw_fde_begin, 0, fde->dw_fde_end, 0, section);
20492       list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20493       start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
20494     }
20495 
20496   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
20497     {
20498       switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
20499 	{
20500 	case DW_CFA_set_loc:
20501 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
20502 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
20503 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
20504 	  if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
20505 	    {
20506 	      *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20507 					 start_label, 0, last_label, 0, section);
20508 
20509 	      list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20510 	      last_cfa = next_cfa;
20511 	      start_label = last_label;
20512 	    }
20513 	  last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
20514 	  break;
20515 
20516 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
20517 	  /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this.  */
20518 	  gcc_unreachable ();
20519 
20520 	default:
20521 	  lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
20522 	  break;
20523 	}
20524       if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
20525 	{
20526 	  if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
20527 	    {
20528 	      *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20529 					 start_label, 0, last_label, 0, section);
20530 
20531 	      list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20532 	      last_cfa = next_cfa;
20533 	      start_label = last_label;
20534 	    }
20535 	  *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20536 				     start_label, 0, fde->dw_fde_end, 0, section);
20537 	  list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20538 	  start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
20539 	}
20540     }
20541 
20542   if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
20543     {
20544       *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20545 				 start_label, 0, last_label, 0, section);
20546       list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20547       start_label = last_label;
20548     }
20549 
20550   *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
20551 			     start_label, 0,
20552 			     fde->dw_fde_second_begin
20553 			     ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end, 0,
20554 			     section);
20555 
20556   maybe_gen_llsym (list);
20557 
20558   return list;
20559 }
20560 
20561 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
20562    frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
20563    frame_pointer_fb_offset.  OFFSET is added to the displacement
20564    before the latter is negated.  */
20565 
20566 static void
20567 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (poly_int64 offset)
20568 {
20569   rtx reg, elim;
20570 
20571 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
20572   reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
20573   offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
20574 #else
20575   reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
20576   offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
20577 #endif
20578 
20579   elim = (ira_use_lra_p
20580 	  ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
20581 	  : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
20582   elim = strip_offset_and_add (elim, &offset);
20583 
20584   frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
20585 
20586   /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
20587      in which to eliminate.  This is because it's stack pointer isn't
20588      directly accessible as a register within the ISA.  To work around
20589      this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
20590      frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either.  */
20591   frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
20592     = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
20593 	&& (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
20594 	    || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
20595        || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
20596 		   ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
20597 		   : stack_pointer_rtx));
20598 }
20599 
20600 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
20601    the value of the attribute.  */
20602 
20603 static void
20604 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
20605 {
20606   if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
20607     {
20608       if (demangle_name_func)
20609 	name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
20610 
20611       add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
20612     }
20613 }
20614 
20615 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
20616    DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
20617    of TYPE accordingly.
20618 
20619    ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
20620    regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system.  */
20621 
20622 static void
20623 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
20624 				     dw_die_ref context_die)
20625 {
20626   tree dtype;
20627   dw_die_ref dtype_die;
20628 
20629   if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
20630     return;
20631 
20632   dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
20633   if (!dtype)
20634     return;
20635 
20636   dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
20637   if (!dtype_die)
20638     {
20639       gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
20640       dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
20641       gcc_assert (dtype_die);
20642     }
20643 
20644   add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
20645 }
20646 
20647 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir.  */
20648 
20649 static const char *
20650 comp_dir_string (void)
20651 {
20652   const char *wd;
20653   char *wd1;
20654   static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
20655 
20656   if (cached_wd != NULL)
20657     return cached_wd;
20658 
20659   wd = get_src_pwd ();
20660   if (wd == NULL)
20661     return NULL;
20662 
20663   if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
20664     {
20665       int wdlen;
20666 
20667       wdlen = strlen (wd);
20668       wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
20669       strcpy (wd1, wd);
20670       wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
20671       wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
20672       wd = wd1;
20673     }
20674 
20675   cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
20676   return cached_wd;
20677 }
20678 
20679 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE.  */
20680 
20681 static void
20682 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
20683 {
20684   const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
20685   if (wd != NULL)
20686     add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
20687 }
20688 
20689 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
20690    pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
20691    to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE.  See
20692    loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT.  */
20693 
20694 static void
20695 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
20696 		 int forms, struct loc_descr_context *context)
20697 {
20698   dw_die_ref context_die, decl_die;
20699   dw_loc_list_ref list;
20700   bool strip_conversions = true;
20701   bool placeholder_seen = false;
20702 
20703   while (strip_conversions)
20704     switch (TREE_CODE (value))
20705       {
20706       case ERROR_MARK:
20707       case SAVE_EXPR:
20708 	return;
20709 
20710       CASE_CONVERT:
20711       case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20712 	value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
20713 	break;
20714 
20715       default:
20716 	strip_conversions = false;
20717 	break;
20718       }
20719 
20720   /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant.  */
20721   if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
20722       && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
20723     {
20724       unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
20725 
20726       /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
20727 	 a constant value.  We need to choose a form based on
20728 	 whether the type is signed or unsigned.  We cannot just
20729 	 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
20730 	 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
20731 	 DW_FORM_data[1248]).  Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
20732 	 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
20733 	 for signed types.  This is needed only for
20734 	 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
20735 	 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
20736 	 regardless of the underlying type.  */
20737       if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
20738 	  || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
20739 	{
20740 	  if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
20741 	    add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
20742 	  else
20743 	    add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
20744 	}
20745       else
20746 	/* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
20747 	   the precision of its type.  The precision and signedness
20748 	   of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
20749 	   unambiguously.  */
20750 	add_AT_wide (die, attr, wi::to_wide (value));
20751       return;
20752     }
20753 
20754   /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
20755      another DIE.  */
20756   if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
20757     {
20758       tree decl = NULL_TREE;
20759 
20760       /* Some type attributes reference an outer type.  For instance, the upper
20761 	 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
20762 	 Ada).  */
20763       if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
20764 	  && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
20765 	  && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
20766 	decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
20767 
20768       else if (VAR_P (value)
20769 	       || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
20770 	       || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
20771 	decl = value;
20772 
20773       if (decl != NULL_TREE)
20774 	{
20775 	  dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20776 
20777 	  /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
20778 	     first?  Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
20779 	     the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
20780 	     the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
20781 	     later parameter.  */
20782 	  if (decl_die != NULL)
20783 	    {
20784 	      add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
20785 	      return;
20786 	    }
20787 	}
20788     }
20789 
20790   /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
20791      value.  Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted.  */
20792   if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
20793     return;
20794 
20795   list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
20796   if (context && context->placeholder_arg)
20797     {
20798       placeholder_seen = context->placeholder_seen;
20799       context->placeholder_seen = false;
20800     }
20801   if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
20802     {
20803       /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
20804 	 a DWARF expression rather than location description.  For that
20805 	 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed.  */
20806       dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
20807       if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
20808 	{
20809 	  if (placeholder_seen)
20810 	    {
20811 	      struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
20812 	      dpi.fndecl = NULL_TREE;
20813 	      dpi.args_count = 1;
20814 	      if (!resolve_args_picking (list2->expr, 1, &dpi))
20815 		return;
20816 	    }
20817 	  add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
20818 	  return;
20819 	}
20820     }
20821 
20822   /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
20823      outputting this as a reference... still if permitted.  */
20824   if (list == NULL
20825       || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0
20826       || placeholder_seen)
20827     return;
20828 
20829   if (current_function_decl == 0)
20830     context_die = comp_unit_die ();
20831   else
20832     context_die = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
20833 
20834   decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, value);
20835   add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20836   add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false,
20837 		      context_die);
20838   add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
20839   add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
20840 }
20841 
20842 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
20843    default.  */
20844 
20845 static int
20846 lower_bound_default (void)
20847 {
20848   switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
20849     {
20850     case DW_LANG_C:
20851     case DW_LANG_C89:
20852     case DW_LANG_C99:
20853     case DW_LANG_C11:
20854     case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
20855     case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
20856     case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
20857     case DW_LANG_ObjC:
20858     case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
20859       return 0;
20860     case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
20861     case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
20862     case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
20863     case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
20864     case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
20865       return 1;
20866     case DW_LANG_UPC:
20867     case DW_LANG_D:
20868     case DW_LANG_Python:
20869       return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
20870     case DW_LANG_Ada95:
20871     case DW_LANG_Ada83:
20872     case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
20873     case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
20874     case DW_LANG_Modula2:
20875     case DW_LANG_PLI:
20876       return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
20877     default:
20878       return -1;
20879     }
20880 }
20881 
20882 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
20883    a representation for that bound.  */
20884 
20885 static void
20886 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
20887 		tree bound, struct loc_descr_context *context)
20888 {
20889   int dflt;
20890 
20891   while (1)
20892     switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
20893       {
20894       /* Strip all conversions.  */
20895       CASE_CONVERT:
20896       case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20897 	bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
20898 	break;
20899 
20900       /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes.  Lower bounds
20901 	 are even omitted when they are the default.  */
20902       case INTEGER_CST:
20903 	/* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
20904 	   attribute.  */
20905 	if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
20906 	    && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
20907 	    && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
20908 	    && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
20909 	  return;
20910 
20911 	/* FALLTHRU */
20912 
20913       default:
20914 	/* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
20915 	   encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
20916 	   for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
20917 	   magic in such a case.  */
20918 	if (is_ada ()
20919 	    && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20920 	    && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
20921 	  return;
20922 
20923 	add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
20924 			 dw_scalar_form_constant
20925 			 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
20926 			 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
20927 			 context);
20928 	return;
20929       }
20930 }
20931 
20932 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
20933    possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
20934    Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
20935    includes information about the element type of the given array type.
20936 
20937    This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
20938    available.  */
20939 
20940 static void
20941 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
20942 {
20943   unsigned dimension_number;
20944   tree lower, upper;
20945   dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
20946 
20947   for (dimension_number = 0;
20948        TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
20949        type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
20950     {
20951       tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
20952 
20953       if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
20954 	break;
20955 
20956       /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
20957 	 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds.  Handle all three forms
20958 	 here.  */
20959 
20960       /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
20961 	 available.
20962 
20963          For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
20964          various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
20965          iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
20966          DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
20967          Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
20968          the current dimension.  At this point we should have as many
20969          DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
20970          array.  */
20971       dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
20972       if (child)
20973 	while (1)
20974 	  {
20975 	    child = child->die_sib;
20976 	    if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20977 	      subrange_die = child;
20978 	    if (child == type_die->die_child)
20979 	      {
20980 		/* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time.  */
20981 		child = NULL;
20982 		break;
20983 	      }
20984 	    if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20985 	      break;
20986 	  }
20987       if (!subrange_die)
20988 	subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
20989 
20990       if (domain)
20991 	{
20992 	  /* We have an array type with specified bounds.  */
20993 	  lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
20994 	  upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
20995 
20996 	  /* Define the index type.  */
20997 	  if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
20998 	      && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
20999 	    {
21000 	      /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type.  Ignore the
21001 		 TREE_TYPE field.  We can't emit debug info for this
21002 		 because it is an unnamed integral type.  */
21003 	      if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
21004 		  && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
21005 		  && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
21006 		  && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
21007 		;
21008 	      else
21009 		add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
21010 				    TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, type_die);
21011 	    }
21012 
21013 	  /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
21014 	     but it does have a lower bound.  This happens with Fortran
21015 	       dimension arr(N:*)
21016 	     Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
21017 	     to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
21018 	     bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope.  */
21019 
21020 	  if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
21021 	    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
21022 	  if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
21023 	    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
21024 	}
21025 
21026       /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length.  The
21027 	 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
21028 	 bounds.  */
21029     }
21030 }
21031 
21032 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size.  */
21033 
21034 static void
21035 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
21036 {
21037   dw_die_ref decl_die;
21038   HOST_WIDE_INT size;
21039   dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
21040 
21041   switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
21042     {
21043     case ERROR_MARK:
21044       size = 0;
21045       break;
21046     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
21047     case RECORD_TYPE:
21048     case UNION_TYPE:
21049     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
21050       if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
21051 	  && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
21052 	{
21053 	  add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
21054 	  return;
21055 	}
21056       size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
21057       break;
21058     case FIELD_DECL:
21059       /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
21060 	 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
21061 	 object of the *declared* type of the member itself.  This is true
21062 	 even for bit-fields.  */
21063       size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
21064       break;
21065     default:
21066       gcc_unreachable ();
21067     }
21068 
21069   /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
21070      At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
21071      though.  */
21072   if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21073       && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
21074       && size_expr != NULL)
21075     add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
21076 
21077   /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point.  If it is, that
21078      indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
21079      that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it.  */
21080   if (size >= 0)
21081     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21082 }
21083 
21084 /* Add a DW_AT_alignment attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's non-default
21085    alignment.  */
21086 
21087 static void
21088 add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
21089 {
21090   if (dwarf_version < 5 && dwarf_strict)
21091     return;
21092 
21093   unsigned align;
21094 
21095   if (DECL_P (tree_node))
21096     {
21097       if (!DECL_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
21098 	return;
21099 
21100       align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
21101     }
21102   else if (TYPE_P (tree_node))
21103     {
21104       if (!TYPE_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
21105 	return;
21106 
21107       align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
21108     }
21109   else
21110     gcc_unreachable ();
21111 
21112   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_alignment, align);
21113 }
21114 
21115 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
21116    which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
21117    "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
21118    bit-field itself.
21119 
21120    For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
21121    (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
21122    type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
21123    declared type of the individual bit-field itself.  The determination of the
21124    exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
21125    complicated.  It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
21126 
21127    CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
21128 
21129    Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
21130    which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
21131    (See `byte_size_attribute' above).  */
21132 
21133 static inline void
21134 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
21135 {
21136   HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
21137   tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
21138   HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
21139   HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
21140   HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
21141   HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
21142 
21143   field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
21144 
21145   /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
21146   gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
21147 
21148   /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
21149      encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
21150      whatsoever.  Likewise for variable or too large size.  */
21151   if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
21152       || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
21153     return;
21154 
21155   bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
21156 
21157   /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
21158      highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
21159      the bit-field itself.  Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
21160      is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
21161      below must take account of these differences.  */
21162   highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
21163   highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
21164 
21165   if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
21166     {
21167       highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
21168       highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
21169         simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
21170     }
21171 
21172   bit_offset
21173     = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
21174        ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
21175        : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
21176 
21177   if (bit_offset < 0)
21178     add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
21179   else
21180     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
21181 }
21182 
21183 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
21184    which specifies the length in bits of the given field.  */
21185 
21186 static inline void
21187 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21188 {
21189   /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
21190   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
21191 	      && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
21192 
21193   if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
21194     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
21195 }
21196 
21197 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
21198    attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function.  */
21199 
21200 static inline void
21201 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
21202 {
21203   switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
21204     {
21205     case DW_LANG_C:
21206     case DW_LANG_C89:
21207     case DW_LANG_C99:
21208     case DW_LANG_C11:
21209     case DW_LANG_ObjC:
21210       if (prototype_p (func_type))
21211 	add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
21212       break;
21213     default:
21214       break;
21215     }
21216 }
21217 
21218 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE.  The DIE is found
21219    by looking in the type declaration, the object declaration equate table or
21220    the block mapping.  */
21221 
21222 static inline dw_die_ref
21223 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
21224 {
21225   dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
21226 
21227   if (DECL_P (origin))
21228     {
21229       dw_die_ref c;
21230       origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
21231       /* "Unwrap" the decls DIE which we put in the imported unit context.
21232          We are looking for the abstract copy here.  */
21233       if (in_lto_p
21234 	  && origin_die
21235 	  && (c = get_AT_ref (origin_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21236 	  /* ???  Identify this better.  */
21237 	  && c->with_offset)
21238 	origin_die = c;
21239     }
21240   else if (TYPE_P (origin))
21241     origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
21242   else if (TREE_CODE (origin) == BLOCK)
21243     origin_die = BLOCK_DIE (origin);
21244 
21245   /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
21246      trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
21247      languages).  For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
21248      output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases.  Rather
21249      than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
21250      have variables without a proper abstract origin.  In the future, when all
21251      functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
21252      here.  */
21253 
21254   if (origin_die)
21255     add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
21256   return origin_die;
21257 }
21258 
21259 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute.  */
21260 
21261 static inline void
21262 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
21263 {
21264   if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
21265     {
21266       add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
21267 
21268       if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
21269 	add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
21270 		    new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
21271 				   tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
21272 				   0));
21273 
21274       /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally.  */
21275       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
21276 	  && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
21277 	add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
21278 			lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
21279     }
21280 }
21281 
21282 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
21283    given decl.  This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
21284    standardized it.  */
21285 
21286 static void
21287 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21288 {
21289   const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
21290 
21291   /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'.  */
21292   if (name[0] == '*')
21293     name = &name[1];
21294 
21295   if (dwarf_version >= 4)
21296     add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
21297   else
21298     add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
21299 }
21300 
21301 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl.  */
21302 
21303 static void
21304 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21305 {
21306   expanded_location s;
21307 
21308   if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
21309     return;
21310   s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
21311   add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
21312   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
21313   if (debug_column_info && s.column)
21314     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
21315 }
21316 
21317 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl.  */
21318 
21319 static void
21320 add_linkage_name_raw (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21321 {
21322   /* Defer until we have an assembler name set.  */
21323   if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
21324     {
21325       limbo_die_node *asm_name;
21326 
21327       asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
21328       asm_name->die = die;
21329       asm_name->created_for = decl;
21330       asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
21331       deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
21332     }
21333   else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
21334     add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
21335 }
21336 
21337 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl if desired.  */
21338 
21339 static void
21340 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21341 {
21342   if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
21343       && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
21344       && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
21345       && !(VAR_P (decl) && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
21346       && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
21347     add_linkage_name_raw (die, decl);
21348 }
21349 
21350 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
21351    given decl, but only if it actually has a name.  */
21352 
21353 static void
21354 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
21355 				    bool no_linkage_name)
21356 {
21357   tree decl_name;
21358 
21359   decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
21360   if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
21361     {
21362       const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
21363       if (name)
21364 	add_name_attribute (die, name);
21365       if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21366 	add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
21367 
21368       if (!no_linkage_name)
21369 	add_linkage_name (die, decl);
21370     }
21371 
21372 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
21373   /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL.  This may be different
21374      from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
21375   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
21376     {
21377       add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
21378                   XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
21379       vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
21380     }
21381 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
21382 }
21383 
21384 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE.  */
21385 
21386 static void
21387 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
21388 {
21389   dw_attr_node attr;
21390 
21391   attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
21392   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
21393   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
21394   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
21395   if (value->pos)
21396     attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
21397   else
21398     attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
21399   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
21400 }
21401 
21402 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE.  */
21403 
21404 static void
21405 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
21406 {
21407   dw_attr_node attr;
21408 
21409   attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
21410   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
21411   attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
21412   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
21413   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
21414 }
21415 
21416 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
21417 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
21418 {
21419   return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
21420 }
21421 
21422 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
21423 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
21424 
21425 void
21426 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
21427 {
21428   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21429   dw_die_ref die;
21430 
21431   /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die.  */
21432   die = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_subprogram);
21433   add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
21434   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
21435 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
21436   add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
21437 
21438   /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die ().  */
21439   die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
21440   if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
21441     {
21442       die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
21443       comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
21444     }
21445   else
21446     {
21447       die->die_sib = die;
21448       comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
21449     }
21450 }
21451 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
21452 
21453 /* Push a new declaration scope.  */
21454 
21455 static void
21456 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
21457 {
21458   vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
21459 }
21460 
21461 /* Pop a declaration scope.  */
21462 
21463 static inline void
21464 pop_decl_scope (void)
21465 {
21466   decl_scope_table->pop ();
21467 }
21468 
21469 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below.  */
21470 
21471 static tree
21472 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21473 {
21474   if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
21475     *walk_subtrees = 0;
21476   else
21477     {
21478       tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
21479       if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
21480 	return *tp;
21481     }
21482   return NULL_TREE;
21483 }
21484 
21485 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
21486    non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE.  */
21487 
21488 static tree
21489 uses_local_type (tree type)
21490 {
21491   tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
21492   return used;
21493 }
21494 
21495 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
21496    Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
21497    scope.  Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
21498    containing scope.  All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
21499    the current active scope.  */
21500 
21501 static dw_die_ref
21502 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
21503 {
21504   dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
21505   tree containing_scope;
21506 
21507   /* Non-types always go in the current scope.  */
21508   gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
21509 
21510   /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
21511      it refers to.  */
21512   if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
21513     containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
21514   else
21515     containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
21516 
21517   /* Use the containing namespace if there is one.  */
21518   if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
21519     {
21520       if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
21521 	/* OK */;
21522       else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21523 	context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
21524       else
21525 	containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
21526     }
21527 
21528   /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend.  They mean that
21529      a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
21530      that isn't useful to DWARF.  */
21531   if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
21532     containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
21533 
21534   if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
21535     {
21536       /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
21537 	 to function-local DIEs from outside the function.  */
21538       if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
21539 	scope_die = context_die;
21540       else
21541 	scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
21542     }
21543   else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
21544     {
21545       /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE.  */
21546       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21547 	scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
21548       else
21549 	{
21550 	  scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
21551 	  if (scope_die == NULL)
21552 	    scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
21553 	}
21554     }
21555   else
21556     scope_die = context_die;
21557 
21558   return scope_die;
21559 }
21560 
21561 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function.  */
21562 
21563 static inline int
21564 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
21565 {
21566   for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
21567     if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
21568 	|| context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
21569       return 1;
21570 
21571   return 0;
21572 }
21573 
21574 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class.  */
21575 
21576 static inline int
21577 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
21578 {
21579   return (context_die
21580 	  && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
21581 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
21582 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
21583 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
21584 }
21585 
21586 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
21587    whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration.  */
21588 
21589 static inline int
21590 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
21591 {
21592   return (class_scope_p (context_die)
21593 	  || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
21594 }
21595 
21596 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute.  This
21597    routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
21598    by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
21599    adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die.  */
21600 
21601 static void
21602 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
21603 		    bool reverse, dw_die_ref context_die)
21604 {
21605   enum tree_code code  = TREE_CODE (type);
21606   dw_die_ref type_die  = NULL;
21607 
21608   /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
21609      or fixed-point type, use the inner type.  This is because we have no
21610      support for unnamed types in base_type_die.  This can happen if this is
21611      an Ada subrange type.  Correct solution is emit a subrange type die.  */
21612   if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
21613       && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
21614     type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
21615 
21616   if (code == ERROR_MARK
21617       /* Handle a special case.  For functions whose return type is void, we
21618 	 generate *no* type attribute.  (Note that no object may have type
21619 	 `void', so this only applies to function return types).  */
21620       || code == VOID_TYPE)
21621     return;
21622 
21623   type_die = modified_type_die (type,
21624 				cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS (type),
21625 				reverse,
21626 				context_die);
21627 
21628   if (type_die != NULL)
21629     add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
21630 }
21631 
21632 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
21633    function call type.  */
21634 static void
21635 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
21636 {
21637   enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
21638 
21639   value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
21640 	   targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
21641 
21642   if (is_fortran ()
21643       && id_equal (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl), "MAIN__"))
21644     {
21645       /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
21646 	entry point.  DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
21647 	to describe functions' calling conventions.  However, lacking a
21648 	better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
21649 	a long time, following existing custom.  Now, DWARF 4 has
21650 	DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
21651 	rely on the old way, which we thus keep.  */
21652       value = DW_CC_program;
21653 
21654       if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
21655 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
21656     }
21657 
21658   /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
21659      is not DW_CC_normal.  */
21660   if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
21661     add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
21662 }
21663 
21664 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
21665    a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
21666    was declared without a tag.  */
21667 
21668 static const char *
21669 type_tag (const_tree type)
21670 {
21671   const char *name = 0;
21672 
21673   if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
21674     {
21675       tree t = 0;
21676 
21677       /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name.  */
21678       if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
21679 	  && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
21680 	t = TYPE_NAME (type);
21681 
21682       /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
21683 	 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
21684 	 involved.  */
21685       else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
21686 	       && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21687 	{
21688 	  /* We want to be extra verbose.  Don't call dwarf_name if
21689 	     DECL_NAME isn't set.  The default hook for decl_printable_name
21690 	     doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
21691 	     0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like.  */
21692 	  if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
21693 	      && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21694 	    name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
21695 	}
21696 
21697       /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one.  */
21698       if (!name && t != 0)
21699 	name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
21700     }
21701 
21702   return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
21703 }
21704 
21705 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
21706    for bit field types.  */
21707 
21708 static inline tree
21709 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
21710 {
21711   return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
21712 	  ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
21713 }
21714 
21715 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
21716    from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
21717 
21718 #if 0
21719 static const char *
21720 decl_start_label (tree decl)
21721 {
21722   rtx x;
21723   const char *fnname;
21724 
21725   x = DECL_RTL (decl);
21726   gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
21727 
21728   x = XEXP (x, 0);
21729   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
21730 
21731   fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
21732   return fnname;
21733 }
21734 #endif
21735 
21736 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
21737    may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
21738    info.  Return TRUE if this is one of those cases.  */
21739 static bool
21740 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
21741 {
21742   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
21743       && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21744       && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
21745     {
21746       dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21747       if (!array_die)
21748 	return false;
21749       add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
21750       return true;
21751     }
21752   return false;
21753 }
21754 
21755 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
21756    the compilation unit.  Debugging information is collected by walking
21757    the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl().  */
21758 
21759 static void
21760 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21761 {
21762   dw_die_ref array_die;
21763 
21764   /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
21765      dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
21766      We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
21767      subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info.  The draft Dwarf specification
21768      say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
21769      there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
21770      array.  We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
21771      actual representation, which is especially important against the language
21772      flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size.  */
21773 
21774   bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
21775 
21776   if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
21777     return;
21778 
21779   dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21780   tree element_type;
21781 
21782   /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
21783      DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute).  */
21784   if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
21785       && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21786       && is_fortran ()
21787       && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
21788     {
21789       HOST_WIDE_INT size;
21790 
21791       array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
21792       add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21793       equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21794       size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
21795       if (size >= 0)
21796 	add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21797       /* ???  We can't annotate types late, but for LTO we may not
21798 	 generate a location early either (gfortran.dg/save_6.f90).  */
21799       else if (! (early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
21800 	       && TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
21801 	       && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE)
21802 	{
21803 	  tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
21804 	  tree rszdecl = szdecl;
21805 
21806 	  size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
21807 	  if (!DECL_P (szdecl))
21808 	    {
21809 	      if (TREE_CODE (szdecl) == INDIRECT_REF
21810 		  && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0)))
21811 		{
21812 		  rszdecl = TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0);
21813 		  if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (rszdecl))
21814 		      != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
21815 		    size = 0;
21816 		}
21817 	      else
21818 		size = 0;
21819 	    }
21820 	  if (size > 0)
21821 	    {
21822 	      dw_loc_list_ref loc
21823 		= loc_list_from_tree (rszdecl, szdecl == rszdecl ? 2 : 0,
21824 				      NULL);
21825 	      if (loc)
21826 		{
21827 		  add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length,
21828 					       loc);
21829 		  if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
21830 		    add_AT_unsigned (array_die, dwarf_version >= 5
21831 						? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
21832 						: DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21833 		}
21834 	    }
21835 	}
21836       return;
21837     }
21838 
21839   array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
21840   add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21841   equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21842 
21843   if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
21844     add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
21845 
21846   /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering.  */
21847   if (is_fortran ()
21848       && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21849       && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
21850       && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
21851     add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21852 
21853 #if 0
21854   /* We default the array ordering.  Debuggers will probably do the right
21855      things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present.  It's not even an issue
21856      until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway.  If a debugger
21857      is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
21858      then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in.  (But if
21859      and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
21860      for multidimensional arrays.  */
21861   add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21862 #endif
21863 
21864   if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
21865     {
21866       /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds.  */
21867       dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
21868       add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
21869       add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21870 		      size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
21871     }
21872   else
21873     add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
21874 
21875   /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
21876      emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already.  */
21877   element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
21878   if (collapse_nested_arrays)
21879     while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
21880       {
21881 	if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
21882 	  break;
21883 	element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
21884       }
21885 
21886   add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21887 		      TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21888 		      && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21889 		      context_die);
21890 
21891   add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21892   if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
21893     add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21894 
21895   if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21896     add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21897 
21898   add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21899 }
21900 
21901 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
21902    are filled into *info by a langhook.  */
21903 
21904 static void
21905 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
21906 			  dw_die_ref context_die)
21907 {
21908   const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21909   const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
21910   struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL,
21911 				       false, false };
21912   enum dwarf_tag subrange_tag = DW_TAG_subrange_type;
21913   int dim;
21914 
21915   add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21916   equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21917 
21918   if (info->ndimensions > 1)
21919     switch (info->ordering)
21920       {
21921       case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
21922 	add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21923 	break;
21924       case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
21925 	add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21926 	break;
21927       default:
21928 	break;
21929       }
21930 
21931   if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21932     {
21933       if (info->data_location)
21934 	add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
21935 			 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21936       if (info->associated)
21937 	add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
21938 			 dw_scalar_form_constant
21939 			 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21940 			 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21941       if (info->allocated)
21942 	add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
21943 			 dw_scalar_form_constant
21944 			 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21945 			 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21946       if (info->stride)
21947 	{
21948 	  const enum dwarf_attribute attr
21949 	    = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
21950 	  const int forms
21951 	    = (info->stride_in_bits)
21952 	      ? dw_scalar_form_constant
21953 	      : (dw_scalar_form_constant
21954 		 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21955 		 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
21956 
21957 	  add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
21958 	}
21959     }
21960   if (dwarf_version >= 5)
21961     {
21962       if (info->rank)
21963 	{
21964 	  add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_rank, info->rank,
21965 			   dw_scalar_form_constant
21966 			   | dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21967 	  subrange_tag = DW_TAG_generic_subrange;
21968 	  context.placeholder_arg = true;
21969 	}
21970     }
21971 
21972   add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21973 
21974   for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
21975     {
21976       dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (subrange_tag, array_die, NULL);
21977 
21978       if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
21979 	add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
21980 			    info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21981 			    false, context_die);
21982       if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
21983 	add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
21984 			info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
21985       if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
21986 	add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21987 			info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
21988       if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
21989 	add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
21990 			 info->dimen[dim].stride,
21991 			 dw_scalar_form_constant
21992 			 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21993 			 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
21994 			 &context);
21995     }
21996 
21997   gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
21998   add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21999 		      TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
22000 		      && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
22001 		      context_die);
22002 
22003   if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
22004     add_pubtype (type, array_die);
22005 
22006   add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
22007 }
22008 
22009 #if 0
22010 static void
22011 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22012 {
22013   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22014   dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
22015 
22016   if (origin != NULL)
22017     add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
22018   else
22019     {
22020       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
22021       add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22022 			  TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22023     }
22024 
22025   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
22026     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
22027   else
22028     add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
22029 }
22030 #endif
22031 
22032 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
22033    emit full debugging info for them.  */
22034 
22035 static void
22036 retry_incomplete_types (void)
22037 {
22038   set_early_dwarf s;
22039   int i;
22040 
22041   for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
22042     if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
22043       gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
22044   vec_safe_truncate (incomplete_types, 0);
22045 }
22046 
22047 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type.  */
22048 
22049 static enum dwarf_tag
22050 record_type_tag (tree type)
22051 {
22052   if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
22053     return DW_TAG_structure_type;
22054 
22055   switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
22056     {
22057     case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
22058       return DW_TAG_structure_type;
22059 
22060     case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
22061       return DW_TAG_class_type;
22062 
22063     case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
22064       if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22065 	return DW_TAG_interface_type;
22066       return DW_TAG_structure_type;
22067 
22068     default:
22069       gcc_unreachable ();
22070     }
22071 }
22072 
22073 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type.  Note that these DIEs
22074    include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
22075    enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
22076    DIE.  */
22077 
22078 static dw_die_ref
22079 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22080 {
22081   dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
22082   dw_die_ref orig_type_die = type_die;
22083 
22084   if (type_die == NULL)
22085     {
22086       type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
22087 			  scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
22088       equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22089       add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
22090       if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
22091 	  && ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
22092 	add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
22093       if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type) && TYPE_SIZE (type))
22094 	add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22095       if (!dwarf_strict)
22096 	add_AT_unsigned (type_die, DW_AT_encoding,
22097 			 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
22098 			 ? DW_ATE_unsigned
22099 			 : DW_ATE_signed);
22100     }
22101   else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type) || ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
22102     return type_die;
22103   else
22104     remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22105 
22106   /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types.  If the
22107      given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
22108      attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute.  */
22109   if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
22110     {
22111       tree link;
22112 
22113       if (!ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
22114 	TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22115       if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_byte_size))
22116 	add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
22117       if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_alignment))
22118 	add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
22119       if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22120 	  && (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_type)))
22121 	{
22122 	  tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
22123 	  add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22124 			      context_die);
22125 	}
22126       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
22127 	{
22128 	  if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_decl_file))
22129 	    add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22130 	  if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_accessibility))
22131 	    add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22132 	}
22133 
22134       /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
22135 	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
22136       if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
22137 	add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
22138 
22139       for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
22140 	   link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
22141 	{
22142 	  dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
22143 	  tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
22144 
22145 	  gcc_assert (!ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type));
22146 	  add_name_attribute (enum_die,
22147 			      IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
22148 
22149 	  if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
22150 	    value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
22151 
22152 	  if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
22153 	      <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
22154 	    {
22155 	      /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
22156 		 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
22157 		 the value.  Only when the actual value is negative
22158 		 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
22159 		 form that can represent negative values.  */
22160 	      HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
22161 	      if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
22162 		add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
22163 				 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
22164 	      else
22165 		add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
22166 	    }
22167 	  else
22168 	    /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT.  Handle
22169 	       that here.  TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
22170 	       signed/unsigned double tags for all cases.  */
22171 	    add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, wi::to_wide (value));
22172 	}
22173 
22174       add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
22175       if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type)
22176 	  && (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_artificial)))
22177 	add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22178     }
22179   else
22180     add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22181 
22182   add_pubtype (type, type_die);
22183 
22184   return type_die;
22185 }
22186 
22187 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
22188    represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
22189    type.
22190 
22191    Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
22192    ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
22193    represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
22194    node.  If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
22195    DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof).  If
22196    it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
22197    DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
22198    argument type of some subprogram type.
22199    If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
22200    are emitted.  */
22201 
22202 static dw_die_ref
22203 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
22204 			  dw_die_ref context_die)
22205 {
22206   tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
22207   tree ultimate_origin;
22208   dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
22209 
22210   if (DECL_P (node_or_origin))
22211     {
22212       parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
22213 
22214       /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
22215 	 thing.
22216 	 ???  When in LTO the DIE parent is the "abstract" copy and the
22217 	 context_die is the specification "copy".  But this whole block
22218 	 should eventually be no longer needed.  */
22219       if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die && !in_lto_p)
22220 	{
22221 	  if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
22222 	    {
22223 	      /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
22224 		 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
22225 		 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin.  */
22226 	      parm_die = NULL;
22227 	    }
22228 	  else
22229 	    gcc_unreachable ();
22230 	}
22231 
22232       if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
22233 	{
22234 	  /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
22235 	     we would have added below.  If any attributes are
22236 	     missing, fall through to add them.  */
22237 	  if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
22238 	      && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
22239 	      && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
22240 	    /* We are missing  location info, and are about to add it.  */
22241 	    ;
22242 	  else
22243 	    {
22244 	      add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
22245 	      return parm_die;
22246 	    }
22247 	}
22248     }
22249 
22250   /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
22251      concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
22252      DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin.  */
22253   bool reusing_die;
22254   if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
22255     reusing_die = true;
22256   else
22257     {
22258       parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
22259       reusing_die = false;
22260     }
22261 
22262   switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
22263     {
22264     case tcc_declaration:
22265       ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
22266       if (node || ultimate_origin)
22267 	origin = ultimate_origin;
22268 
22269       if (reusing_die)
22270 	goto add_location;
22271 
22272       if (origin != NULL)
22273 	add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
22274       else if (emit_name_p)
22275 	add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
22276       if (origin == NULL
22277 	  || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
22278 	      && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
22279 					   decl_function_context
22280 							    (node_or_origin))))
22281 	{
22282 	  tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
22283 	  if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
22284 	    add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
22285 				TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
22286 				false, context_die);
22287 	  else
22288 	    add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
22289 				decl_quals (node_or_origin),
22290 				false, context_die);
22291 	}
22292       if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
22293 	add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22294     add_location:
22295       if (node && node != origin)
22296         equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
22297       if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
22298 	add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
22299 					       node == NULL);
22300 
22301       break;
22302 
22303     case tcc_type:
22304       /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node.  */
22305       add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22306 			  context_die);
22307       break;
22308 
22309     default:
22310       gcc_unreachable ();
22311     }
22312 
22313   return parm_die;
22314 }
22315 
22316 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
22317    children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
22318    parameter pack.
22319 
22320    PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
22321    PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
22322    must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
22323    SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
22324    If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
22325    following the last one for which a DIE was generated.  */
22326 
22327 static dw_die_ref
22328 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die  (tree parm_pack,
22329 				tree pack_arg,
22330 				dw_die_ref subr_die,
22331 				tree *next_arg)
22332 {
22333   tree arg;
22334   dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
22335 
22336   gcc_assert (parm_pack
22337 	      && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
22338 	      && subr_die);
22339 
22340   parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
22341   add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
22342 
22343   for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
22344     {
22345       if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
22346 								 parm_pack))
22347 	break;
22348       gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
22349 				false /* Don't emit name attribute.  */,
22350 				parm_pack_die);
22351     }
22352   if (next_arg)
22353     *next_arg = arg;
22354   return parm_pack_die;
22355 }
22356 
22357 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
22358    at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list.  */
22359 
22360 static void
22361 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22362 {
22363   new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
22364 }
22365 
22366 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
22367    DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
22368    parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
22369    those which appear as part of a function *definition*).  */
22370 
22371 static void
22372 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22373 {
22374   tree link;
22375   tree formal_type = NULL;
22376   tree first_parm_type;
22377   tree arg;
22378 
22379   if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22380     {
22381       arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
22382       function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
22383     }
22384   else
22385     arg = NULL_TREE;
22386 
22387   first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
22388 
22389   /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
22390      DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one.  */
22391   for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
22392     {
22393       dw_die_ref parm_die;
22394 
22395       formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
22396       if (formal_type == void_type_node)
22397 	break;
22398 
22399       /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself.  */
22400       if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
22401 	{
22402 	  parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
22403 					       true /* Emit name attribute.  */,
22404 					       context_die);
22405 	  if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
22406 	      && link == first_parm_type)
22407 	    {
22408 	      add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22409 	      if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22410 		add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
22411 	    }
22412 	  else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
22413 	    add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22414 	}
22415 
22416       link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
22417       if (arg)
22418 	arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
22419     }
22420 
22421   /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
22422      DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list.  */
22423   if (formal_type != void_type_node)
22424     gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
22425 
22426   /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
22427      and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary).  */
22428   for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
22429        link && TREE_VALUE (link);
22430        link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
22431     gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
22432 }
22433 
22434 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
22435    die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
22436    to the member declaration nested within TYPE.  If we're trying to
22437    generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
22438    trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand.  */
22439 
22440 static void
22441 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
22442 {
22443   gen_type_die (type, context_die);
22444 
22445   /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
22446      emitted the member decl for this function.  Emit it now.  */
22447   if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
22448       && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
22449       && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
22450     {
22451       dw_die_ref type_die;
22452       gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
22453 
22454       push_decl_scope (type);
22455       type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
22456       if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22457 	gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
22458       else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
22459 	{
22460 	  /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
22461 	     C++ anonymous unions and structs.  */
22462 	  if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
22463 	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
22464 	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
22465 	    {
22466 	      struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
22467 		DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
22468 		NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
22469 	      };
22470 	      gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
22471 	      gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
22472 	    }
22473 	}
22474       else
22475 	gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
22476 
22477       pop_decl_scope ();
22478     }
22479 }
22480 
22481 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
22482   with their set_block_* pairing functions.  */
22483 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
22484 
22485 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
22486    given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
22487    that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
22488    own (abstract) origin.  Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
22489    the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
22490    it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
22491    therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
22492    still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
22493    values to point to themselves.  */
22494 
22495 static void
22496 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
22497 {
22498   if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
22499     {
22500       BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
22501 
22502       {
22503 	tree local_decl;
22504 
22505 	for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
22506 	     local_decl != NULL_TREE;
22507 	     local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
22508 	  /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
22509 	     of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec.  */
22510 	  if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
22511 	      && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
22512 	    set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
22513       }
22514 
22515       {
22516 	tree subblock;
22517 
22518 	for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
22519 	     subblock != NULL_TREE;
22520 	     subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
22521 	  set_block_origin_self (subblock);	/* Recurse.  */
22522       }
22523     }
22524 }
22525 
22526 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
22527    the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
22528    node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
22529    node represents its own (abstract) origin.  Additionally, if the
22530    DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
22531    the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
22532    each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
22533    DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
22534    set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
22535    point to themselves.  */
22536 
22537 static void
22538 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
22539 {
22540   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
22541     {
22542       DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
22543       if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22544 	{
22545 	  tree arg;
22546 
22547 	  for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
22548 	    DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
22549 	  if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
22550 	      && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
22551 	    set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
22552 	}
22553     }
22554 }
22555 
22556 /* Mark the early DIE for DECL as the abstract instance.  */
22557 
22558 static void
22559 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
22560 {
22561   dw_die_ref old_die;
22562 
22563   /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone.  */
22564   decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
22565 
22566   if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
22567     return;
22568 
22569   old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22570   /* With early debug we always have an old DIE unless we are in LTO
22571      and the user did not compile but only link with debug.  */
22572   if (in_lto_p && ! old_die)
22573     return;
22574   gcc_assert (old_die != NULL);
22575   if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline)
22576       || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
22577     /* We've already generated the abstract instance.  */
22578     return;
22579 
22580   /* Go ahead and put DW_AT_inline on the DIE.  */
22581   if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
22582     {
22583       if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
22584 	add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
22585       else
22586 	add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
22587     }
22588   else
22589     {
22590       if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
22591 	add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
22592       else
22593 	add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
22594     }
22595 
22596   if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
22597       && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
22598     add_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22599 
22600   set_decl_origin_self (decl);
22601 }
22602 
22603 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
22604    htab_traverse.
22605 
22606    Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
22607    marked as unused by prune_unused_types.  */
22608 
22609 bool
22610 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
22611 {
22612   dw_die_ref die;
22613 
22614   die = lookup_type_die (type);
22615   if (die != NULL)
22616     die->die_perennial_p = 1;
22617   return true;
22618 }
22619 
22620 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
22621    through htab_traverse.
22622 
22623    Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
22624    marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
22625    only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted.  */
22626 
22627 int
22628 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
22629 					  void *)
22630 {
22631   struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
22632   dw_die_ref die;
22633 
22634   entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
22635   gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
22636 	      && entry->var_decl != NULL);
22637   die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
22638   if (die)
22639     {
22640       /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
22641          If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE.  */
22642       varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
22643       if (node && node->definition)
22644 	{
22645 	  die->die_perennial_p = 1;
22646 	  /* Keep the parent DIEs as well.  */
22647 	  while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
22648 	    die->die_perennial_p = 1;
22649 	}
22650     }
22651   return 1;
22652 }
22653 
22654 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial.  */
22655 
22656 static void
22657 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
22658 {
22659   if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
22660     fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
22661 }
22662 
22663 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial.  */
22664 
22665 static void
22666 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
22667 {
22668   if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
22669     types_used_by_vars_hash
22670       ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
22671 }
22672 
22673 /* Generate a DW_TAG_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
22674    for CA_LOC call arg loc node.  */
22675 
22676 static dw_die_ref
22677 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
22678 		   struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
22679 {
22680   dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
22681   tree block = ca_loc->block;
22682 
22683   while (block
22684 	 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
22685 	 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
22686     {
22687       stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
22688       if (stmt_die)
22689 	break;
22690       block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
22691     }
22692   if (stmt_die == NULL)
22693     stmt_die = subr_die;
22694   die = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site), stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
22695   add_AT_lbl_id (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_return_pc), ca_loc->label);
22696   if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
22697     add_AT_flag (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_tail_call), 1);
22698   if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
22699     {
22700       dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
22701       if (tdie)
22702 	add_AT_die_ref (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), tdie);
22703       else
22704 	add_AT_addr (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), ca_loc->symbol_ref,
22705 		     false);
22706     }
22707   return die;
22708 }
22709 
22710 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
22711    block-local).  */
22712 
22713 static void
22714 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22715 {
22716   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22717   dw_die_ref subr_die;
22718   dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22719 
22720   /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
22721      the debug process.  For example, for func() in this code:
22722 
22723 	namespace S
22724 	{
22725 	  void func() { ... }
22726 	}
22727 
22728      ...we get called 4 times.  Twice in early debug and twice in
22729      late debug:
22730 
22731      Early debug
22732      -----------
22733 
22734        1. Once while generating func() within the namespace.  This is
22735           the declaration.  The declaration bit below is set, as the
22736           context is the namespace.
22737 
22738 	  A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
22739 
22740        2. Once for func() itself.  This is the specification.  The
22741           declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
22742 
22743 	  We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
22744 	  DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
22745 
22746      Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
22747      -------------------------------------
22748 
22749        3. Once generating func() within the namespace.  This is also the
22750           declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
22751           as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
22752           annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
22753           info is enough.
22754 
22755        4. Once for func() itself.  As in (2), this is the specification,
22756           but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
22757           it with the location information that should now be available.
22758 
22759      For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
22760      are also called a multiple times:
22761 
22762         class Base
22763 	{
22764 	public:
22765 	  Base ();	  // constructor declaration (1)
22766 	};
22767 
22768 	Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
22769 
22770     Early debug
22771     -----------
22772 
22773        1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
22774           member of the Base class.  This is done via
22775           rest_of_type_compilation.
22776 
22777 	  This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
22778 	  DW_AT_declaration.
22779 
22780        2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
22781           while generating the abstract instance of the base
22782           constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
22783           debug of reachable functions.
22784 
22785 	  Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
22786 	  we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
22787 	  in (1).
22788 
22789        3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
22790           an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
22791 	  (2).
22792 
22793     Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
22794     -----------------------------------
22795 
22796        4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
22797           DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3).  This time,
22798           we will just annotate the location information now
22799           available.
22800   */
22801   int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
22802 		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
22803 
22804   /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
22805      additional information.  */
22806   if (old_die && declaration)
22807     return;
22808 
22809   /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
22810      might need to retrofit the declaration into its class.  */
22811   if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
22812       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22813       && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
22814       && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22815     old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
22816 
22817   /* A concrete instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin.  */
22818   if (origin != NULL)
22819     {
22820       gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
22821 
22822       /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
22823 	 inline function.  */
22824       if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
22825 	add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
22826 
22827       if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
22828 	{
22829 	  /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
22830 	     cached version.  */
22831 	  subr_die = old_die;
22832 	}
22833       else
22834 	{
22835 	  subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22836 	  add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
22837 	  /*  This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
22838 	      Let's emit linkage name attribute for it.  This helps
22839 	      debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
22840 	      constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
22841 	      K::K".  */
22842 	  add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
22843 	}
22844     }
22845   /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation.  Reuse as
22846      much as possible.  */
22847   else if (old_die)
22848     {
22849       if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
22850 	  /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
22851 	     case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
22852 	     It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case.  */
22853 	  && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22854 	{
22855 	  /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
22856 	     something we have already output.  */
22857 	  if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
22858 	      || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
22859 	    return;
22860 
22861 	  /* If we have no location information, this must be a
22862 	     partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
22863 	     Fall through and generate it.  */
22864 	}
22865 
22866       /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
22867 	 maybe use the old DIE.  We always want the DIE for this function
22868 	 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
22869 	 debugger can find it.  We also need to do this for abstract
22870 	 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
22871 	 to have the same parent.  For local class methods, this doesn't
22872 	 apply; we just use the old DIE.  */
22873       expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
22874       struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
22875       if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
22876 	   /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
22877 	      following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
22878 	      building libgfortran:
22879 
22880 		 module some_m
22881 		 contains
22882 		    logical function funky (FLAG)
22883 		      funky = .true.
22884 		   end function
22885 		 end module
22886 	   */
22887 	   || (old_die->die_parent
22888 	       && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
22889 	   || context_die == NULL)
22890 	   && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
22891 	       /* The location attributes may be in the abstract origin
22892 		  which in the case of LTO might be not available to
22893 		  look at.  */
22894 	       || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
22895 	       || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
22896 		   && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
22897 		       == (unsigned) s.line)
22898 		   && (!debug_column_info
22899 		       || s.column == 0
22900 		       || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22901 			   == (unsigned) s.column)))))
22902 	{
22903 	  subr_die = old_die;
22904 
22905 	  /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
22906 	     parameters so they can be augmented with location
22907 	     information later.  Unless this was a declaration, in
22908 	     which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
22909 	     them further down.  */
22910 	  if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
22911 	    {
22912 
22913 	      remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
22914 	      remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
22915 	    }
22916 	}
22917       /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
22918 	 declaration.  */
22919       else
22920 	{
22921 	  subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22922 	  add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
22923           add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22924 	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
22925 	    add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
22926 	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
22927 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
22928 	  if (debug_column_info
22929 	      && s.column
22930 	      && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22931 		  != (unsigned) s.column))
22932 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22933 
22934 	  /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
22935 	     emit the real type on the definition die.  */
22936 	  if (is_cxx () && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22937 	    {
22938 	      dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
22939 	      if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
22940 		add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22941 				    TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22942 	    }
22943 
22944 	  /* When we process the method declaration, we haven't seen
22945 	     the out-of-class defaulted definition yet, so we have to
22946 	     recheck now.  */
22947 	  if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || ! dwarf_strict)
22948 	      && !get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted))
22949 	    {
22950 	      int defaulted
22951 		= lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22952 							 DW_AT_defaulted);
22953 	      if (defaulted != -1)
22954 		{
22955 		  /* Other values must have been handled before.  */
22956 		  gcc_assert (defaulted == DW_DEFAULTED_out_of_class);
22957 		  add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22958 		}
22959 	    }
22960 	}
22961     }
22962   /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else.  */
22963   else
22964     {
22965       subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22966 
22967       if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22968 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22969 
22970       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
22971       add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22972       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22973 	{
22974 	  add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
22975 	  add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22976 			      TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22977 	}
22978 
22979       add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22980       if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22981 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22982 
22983       if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
22984 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
22985 
22986       add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22987 
22988       add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22989     }
22990 
22991   /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
22992      DIE.  */
22993   if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
22994     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
22995 
22996   if (declaration)
22997     {
22998       if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22999 	{
23000 	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23001 
23002 	  /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
23003 	     a DW_AT_explicit attribute.  */
23004 	  if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23005 	      && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
23006 							DW_AT_explicit) == 1)
23007 	    add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
23008 
23009 	  /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
23010 	     a DW_AT_deleted attribute.  */
23011 	  if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23012 	      && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
23013 							DW_AT_deleted) == 1)
23014 	    add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_deleted, 1);
23015 
23016 	  /* If this is a C++11 defaulted special function member then
23017 	     generate a DW_AT_defaulted attribute.  */
23018 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23019 	    {
23020 	      int defaulted
23021 		= lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
23022 							 DW_AT_defaulted);
23023 	      if (defaulted != -1)
23024 		add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
23025 	    }
23026 
23027 	  /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with & ref-qualifier
23028 	     then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute.  */
23029 	  if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23030 	      && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
23031 							DW_AT_reference) == 1)
23032 	    add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
23033 
23034 	  /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with &&
23035 	     ref-qualifier then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute.  */
23036 	  if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23037 	      && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
23038 							DW_AT_rvalue_reference)
23039 		 == 1)
23040 	    add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
23041 	}
23042     }
23043   /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
23044      the DIE with it.  */
23045   else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
23046     {
23047       HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
23048 
23049       struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
23050 
23051       if (!crtl->has_bb_partition)
23052 	{
23053 	  dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
23054 	  if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
23055 	    {
23056 	      /* We have already generated the labels.  */
23057              add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
23058                                  fde->dw_fde_end, false);
23059 	    }
23060 	  else
23061 	    {
23062 	      /* Create start/end labels and add the range.  */
23063 	      char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23064 	      char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23065 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
23066 					   current_function_funcdef_no);
23067 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
23068 					   current_function_funcdef_no);
23069              add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
23070                                  false);
23071 	    }
23072 
23073 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
23074       /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
23075 	 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
23076 	 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
23077 	 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
23078 	 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
23079 	 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
23080 	 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
23081 	 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
23082 	 cannot properly determine where this point is.  Similarly for a
23083 	 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
23084 	 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use.  */
23085 
23086       {
23087         if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
23088           add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
23089 	    fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
23090 
23091         if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
23092           add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
23093 	    fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
23094       }
23095 #endif
23096 
23097 	}
23098       else
23099 	{
23100 	  /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges.  */
23101 	  dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
23102 
23103 	  if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
23104 	    {
23105 	      if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23106 		{
23107 		  /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
23108 		     addresses.  Use the actual code range for the initial
23109 		     section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
23110 		     alignment offset.  */
23111 		  bool range_list_added = false;
23112 		  add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
23113 					fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
23114 					false);
23115 		  add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
23116 					fde->dw_fde_second_end,
23117 					&range_list_added, false);
23118 		  if (range_list_added)
23119 		    add_ranges (NULL);
23120 		}
23121 	      else
23122 		{
23123 		  /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
23124 		     a work-around.  First, emit the pub name for the segment
23125 		     containing the function label.  Then make and emit a
23126 		     simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
23127 		     name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_.  We use the same
23128 		     linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
23129 		     sections when given "b foo".  */
23130 		  const char *name = NULL;
23131 		  tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
23132 		  dw_die_ref seg_die;
23133 
23134 		  /* Do the 'primary' section.   */
23135 		  add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
23136                                       fde->dw_fde_end, false);
23137 
23138 		  /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section.  */
23139 		  seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
23140 				     subr_die->die_parent, decl);
23141 
23142 		  if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23143 		    add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23144 
23145 		  if (decl_name != NULL
23146 		      && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
23147 		    {
23148 		      name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
23149 		      if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23150 			add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
23151 
23152 		      add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
23153 		    }
23154 		  gcc_assert (name != NULL);
23155 		  add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
23156 		  if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23157 		    add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23158 
23159 		  name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
23160 		  add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
23161                                       fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
23162 		  add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
23163 		  if (want_pubnames ())
23164 		    add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
23165 		}
23166 	    }
23167 	  else
23168            add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
23169                                false);
23170 	}
23171 
23172       cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
23173 
23174       /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA.  This is more
23175 	 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
23176 	 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
23177 	 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
23178 	 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
23179 	 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
23180 	 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
23181 	 function.  */
23182       if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
23183 	{
23184 	  dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
23185 	  add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
23186 	}
23187       else
23188 	{
23189 	  dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
23190 	  if (list->dw_loc_next)
23191 	    add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
23192 	  else
23193 	    add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
23194 	}
23195 
23196       /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
23197 	 the CFA.  The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
23198 	 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
23199 	 debugger about.  We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
23200 	 by this displacement.  */
23201       compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
23202 
23203       if (fun->static_chain_decl)
23204 	{
23205 	  /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
23206 	     address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base.  The machinery
23207 	     in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
23208 	     last field of the FRAME record.  */
23209 	  const tree frame_type
23210 	    = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
23211 	  const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
23212 
23213 	  tree fb_expr
23214 	    = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
23215 	  fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
23216 			    fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
23217 
23218 	  add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
23219 				       loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
23220 	}
23221 
23222       resolve_variable_values ();
23223     }
23224 
23225   /* Generate child dies for template paramaters.  */
23226   if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23227     gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
23228 
23229   /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
23230      (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
23231      for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
23232      `...' at the end of the formal parameter list.  In order to find out if
23233      there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
23234      associated with the FUNCTION_DECL.  This will be a node of type
23235      FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
23236      FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
23237      an ellipsis at the end.  */
23238 
23239   /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
23240      need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
23241      its formal parameters.  */
23242   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23243     ;
23244   else if (declaration)
23245     gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
23246   else
23247     {
23248       /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters.  */
23249       tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
23250       tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
23251 	? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
23252       tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
23253 				? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
23254 				: NULL;
23255 
23256       /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
23257 	 emit their relevant DIEs.
23258 
23259 	 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
23260 	 as well as it being a normal function.
23261 
23262 	 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
23263 	 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
23264 	 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
23265 	 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
23266 	 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
23267 	 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
23268 	 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
23269 	 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
23270 	 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
23271 	 children DIE.
23272 
23273 	 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL.  */
23274       while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
23275 	{
23276 	  if (generic_decl_parm
23277 	      && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
23278 	    gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
23279 					   parm, subr_die,
23280 					   &parm);
23281 	  else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
23282 	    {
23283 	      dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
23284 
23285 	      if (early_dwarf
23286 		  && parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
23287 		  && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
23288 		  && parm_die
23289 		  && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23290 		add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
23291 
23292 	      parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
23293 	    }
23294 	  else if (parm)
23295 	    parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
23296 
23297 	  if (generic_decl_parm)
23298 	    generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
23299 	}
23300 
23301       /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
23302 	 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
23303 	 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
23304 	 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
23305 	 definition).  This just means that we have no info about the
23306 	 parameters at all.  */
23307       if (early_dwarf)
23308 	{
23309 	  if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
23310 	    {
23311 	      /* This is the prototyped case, check for....  */
23312 	      if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
23313 		gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
23314 	    }
23315 	  else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
23316 	    gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
23317 	}
23318     }
23319 
23320   if (subr_die != old_die)
23321     /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested.  */
23322     add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
23323 
23324   /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
23325      (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
23326 
23327      OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
23328      a function.  This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
23329      for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
23330      parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
23331      end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
23332      the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
23333      DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
23334 
23335      The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
23336      the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
23337      for those in decls_for_scope.  Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
23338      a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
23339      and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
23340      constructor function.  */
23341   tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
23342   if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
23343     {
23344       int call_site_note_count = 0;
23345       int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
23346 
23347       /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value.  */
23348       if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
23349 	gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
23350 
23351       /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
23352 	 DIEs for the locals.  The second time, we fill in the
23353 	 location info.  */
23354       decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
23355 
23356       if (call_arg_locations && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
23357 	{
23358 	  struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
23359 	  for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
23360 	    {
23361 	      dw_die_ref die = NULL;
23362 	      rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
23363 	      rtx arg, next_arg;
23364 
23365 	      for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
23366 			  ? XEXP (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note, 0)
23367 			  : NULL_RTX);
23368 		   arg; arg = next_arg)
23369 		{
23370 		  dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
23371 		  machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
23372 		  dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
23373 
23374 		  next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
23375 		  if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23376 		      && next_arg
23377 		      && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
23378 		      && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
23379 		      && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23380 			 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
23381 		    next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
23382 		  if (mode == VOIDmode)
23383 		    {
23384 		      mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
23385 		      if (mode == VOIDmode)
23386 			mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
23387 		    }
23388 		  if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
23389 		    continue;
23390 		  /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
23391 		     have no static information: we cannot generate both
23392 		     DW_AT_call_origin and DW_AT_call_target
23393 		     attributes.  */
23394 		  if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
23395 		    {
23396 		      if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
23397 			{
23398 			  tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
23399 			  continue;
23400 			}
23401 		      else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
23402 			       && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
23403 			{
23404 			  tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
23405 			  continue;
23406 			}
23407 		    }
23408 		  reg = NULL;
23409 		  if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
23410 		    reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
23411 					      VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23412 		  else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
23413 		    {
23414 		      rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
23415 		      reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
23416 						get_address_mode (mem),
23417 						GET_MODE (mem),
23418 						VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23419 		    }
23420 		  else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23421 			   == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
23422 		    {
23423 		      tree tdecl
23424 			= DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
23425 		      tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
23426 		      if (tdie == NULL)
23427 			continue;
23428 		    }
23429 		  else
23430 		    continue;
23431 		  if (reg == NULL
23432 		      && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23433 			 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
23434 		    continue;
23435 		  val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
23436 					    VOIDmode,
23437 					    VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23438 		  if (val == NULL)
23439 		    continue;
23440 		  if (die == NULL)
23441 		    die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
23442 		  cdie = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site_parameter), die,
23443 				  NULL_TREE);
23444 		  if (reg != NULL)
23445 		    add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
23446 		  else if (tdie != NULL)
23447 		    add_AT_die_ref (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_parameter),
23448 				    tdie);
23449 		  add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_value), val);
23450 		  if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
23451 		    {
23452 		      mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
23453 		      if (mode == VOIDmode)
23454 			mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
23455 		      val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
23456 							    0), 1),
23457 						mode, VOIDmode,
23458 						VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23459 		      if (val != NULL)
23460 			add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_data_value),
23461 				    val);
23462 		    }
23463 		}
23464 	      if (die == NULL
23465 		  && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
23466 		die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
23467 	      if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
23468 		{
23469 		  dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
23470 
23471 		  if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
23472 		    tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
23473 					       GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
23474 					       ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
23475 					       VOIDmode,
23476 					       VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23477 		  if (tval)
23478 		    add_AT_loc (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target), tval);
23479 		  else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
23480 		    {
23481 		      tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
23482 						 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
23483 						 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
23484 						 VOIDmode,
23485 						 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23486 		      if (tval)
23487 			add_AT_loc (die,
23488 				    dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target_clobbered),
23489 				    tval);
23490 		    }
23491 		}
23492 	      if (die != NULL)
23493 		{
23494 		  call_site_note_count++;
23495 		  if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
23496 		    tail_call_site_note_count++;
23497 		}
23498 	    }
23499 	}
23500       call_arg_locations = NULL;
23501       call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
23502       if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
23503 	  && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
23504 	  && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
23505 	{
23506 	  if (call_site_count >= 0
23507 	      && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
23508 	    add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_calls), 1);
23509 	  else
23510 	    add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls), 1);
23511 	}
23512       call_site_count = -1;
23513       tail_call_site_count = -1;
23514     }
23515 
23516   /* Mark used types after we have created DIEs for the functions scopes.  */
23517   premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
23518 }
23519 
23520 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct).  */
23521 
23522 hashval_t
23523 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
23524 {
23525   return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
23526 }
23527 
23528 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
23529    as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y.  */
23530 
23531 bool
23532 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
23533 {
23534   return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
23535 }
23536 
23537 /* Hold information about markers for inlined entry points.  */
23538 struct GTY ((for_user)) inline_entry_data
23539 {
23540   /* The block that's the inlined_function_outer_scope for an inlined
23541      function.  */
23542   tree block;
23543 
23544   /* The label at the inlined entry point.  */
23545   const char *label_pfx;
23546   unsigned int label_num;
23547 
23548   /* The view number to be used as the inlined entry point.  */
23549   var_loc_view view;
23550 };
23551 
23552 struct inline_entry_data_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash <inline_entry_data>
23553 {
23554   typedef tree compare_type;
23555   static inline hashval_t hash (const inline_entry_data *);
23556   static inline bool equal (const inline_entry_data *, const_tree);
23557 };
23558 
23559 /* Hash table routines for inline_entry_data.  */
23560 
23561 inline hashval_t
23562 inline_entry_data_hasher::hash (const inline_entry_data *data)
23563 {
23564   return htab_hash_pointer (data->block);
23565 }
23566 
23567 inline bool
23568 inline_entry_data_hasher::equal (const inline_entry_data *data,
23569 				 const_tree block)
23570 {
23571   return data->block == block;
23572 }
23573 
23574 /* Inlined entry points pending DIE creation in this compilation unit.  */
23575 
23576 static GTY(()) hash_table<inline_entry_data_hasher> *inline_entry_data_table;
23577 
23578 
23579 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
23580    OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification.  DECLARATION is
23581    true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
23582    class/namespace scoped declaration.
23583 
23584    The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
23585    variable, both of which are declarations.  We want to avoid
23586    considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
23587    DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration.  */
23588 static inline bool
23589 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
23590 {
23591   return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
23592 	  && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
23593 }
23594 
23595 /* Return true if DECL is a local static.  */
23596 
23597 static inline bool
23598 local_function_static (tree decl)
23599 {
23600   gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl));
23601   return TREE_STATIC (decl)
23602     && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
23603     && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
23604 }
23605 
23606 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
23607    Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null.  */
23608 
23609 static void
23610 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
23611 {
23612   HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
23613   tree com_decl;
23614   tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
23615   tree ultimate_origin;
23616   dw_die_ref var_die;
23617   dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
23618   bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
23619 		      || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
23620   bool specialization_p = false;
23621   bool no_linkage_name = false;
23622 
23623   /* While C++ inline static data members have definitions inside of the
23624      class, force the first DIE to be a declaration, then let gen_member_die
23625      reparent it to the class context and call gen_variable_die again
23626      to create the outside of the class DIE for the definition.  */
23627   if (!declaration
23628       && old_die == NULL
23629       && decl
23630       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
23631       && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
23632       && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl, DW_AT_inline) != -1)
23633     {
23634       declaration = true;
23635       if (dwarf_version < 5)
23636 	no_linkage_name = true;
23637     }
23638 
23639   ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
23640   if (decl || ultimate_origin)
23641     origin = ultimate_origin;
23642   com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
23643 
23644   /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
23645      of a data member.  */
23646   if (com_decl)
23647     {
23648       dw_die_ref com_die;
23649       dw_loc_list_ref loc = NULL;
23650       die_node com_die_arg;
23651 
23652       var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
23653       if (var_die)
23654 	{
23655 	  if (! early_dwarf && get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
23656 	    {
23657 	      loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
23658 	      if (loc)
23659 		{
23660 		  if (off)
23661 		    {
23662 		      /* Optimize the common case.  */
23663 		      if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
23664 			  && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
23665 			  && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
23666 			  && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
23667 			     == SYMBOL_REF)
23668 			{
23669 			  rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
23670 			  loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
23671 			    = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
23672 			}
23673 		      else
23674 			loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
23675 		    }
23676 		  add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23677 		  remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
23678 		}
23679 	    }
23680 	  return;
23681 	}
23682 
23683       if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
23684 	common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
23685 
23686       com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
23687       com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
23688       com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
23689       if (! early_dwarf)
23690 	loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
23691       if (com_die == NULL)
23692 	{
23693 	  const char *cnam
23694 	    = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
23695 	  die_node **slot;
23696 
23697 	  com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
23698 	  add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
23699 	  if (loc)
23700 	    {
23701 	      add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23702 	      /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
23703 		 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable.  */
23704 	      loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
23705 	    }
23706 	  else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
23707 	    add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23708 	  if (want_pubnames ())
23709 	    add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
23710 	  com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
23711 	  slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
23712 	  *slot = com_die;
23713 	}
23714       else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
23715 	{
23716 	  add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23717 	  loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
23718 	  remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
23719 	}
23720       var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
23721       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl_or_origin);
23722       add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
23723 			  decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
23724 			  context_die);
23725       add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
23726       add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23727       if (loc)
23728 	{
23729 	  if (off)
23730 	    {
23731 	      /* Optimize the common case.  */
23732 	      if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
23733                   && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
23734 		  && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
23735 		  && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
23736 		{
23737 		  rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
23738 		  loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
23739 		    = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
23740 		}
23741 	      else
23742 		loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
23743 	    }
23744 	  add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23745 	}
23746       else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
23747 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23748       if (decl)
23749 	equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
23750       return;
23751     }
23752 
23753   if (old_die)
23754     {
23755       if (declaration)
23756 	{
23757 	  /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
23758 	     further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
23759 	     the second pass.  */
23760 	  return;
23761 	}
23762       else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
23763 	       && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
23764 	{
23765 	  /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
23766 	     DW_AT_specification.  */
23767 	}
23768       else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
23769 	{
23770 	  /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
23771 	     new DIE that will get annotated with
23772 	     DW_AT_abstract_origin.  */
23773 	  gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
23774 	}
23775       else
23776 	{
23777 	  /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
23778 	     Skip to where we fill the location bits.  */
23779 	  var_die = old_die;
23780 
23781 	  /* ???  In LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
23782 	     modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
23783 	     references to them.  Thus we dumped them again.  Also add a
23784 	     reference to them but beware of -g0 compile and -g link
23785 	     in which case the reference will be already present.  */
23786 	  tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
23787 	  if (in_lto_p
23788 	      && ! get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_type)
23789 	      && variably_modified_type_p
23790 		   (type, decl_function_context (decl_or_origin)))
23791 	    {
23792 	      if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23793 		add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
23794 				    TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
23795 	      else
23796 		add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
23797 				    false, context_die);
23798 	    }
23799 
23800 	  goto gen_variable_die_location;
23801 	}
23802     }
23803 
23804   /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
23805      to have DW_TAG_member tag in DWARF{3,4} and we emit it for compatibility
23806      also in DWARF2; the specification should still be DW_TAG_variable
23807      referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE.  */
23808   if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die) && dwarf_version < 5)
23809     var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
23810   else
23811     var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
23812 
23813   if (origin != NULL)
23814     add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
23815 
23816   /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
23817      static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
23818 
23819      ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
23820      copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
23821      sharing them.
23822 
23823      ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.  */
23824   else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
23825     {
23826       /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static.  */
23827       add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
23828       specialization_p = true;
23829       if (DECL_NAME (decl))
23830 	{
23831 	  expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
23832 	  struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
23833 
23834 	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
23835 	    add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
23836 
23837 	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
23838 	    add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
23839 
23840 	  if (debug_column_info
23841 	      && s.column
23842 	      && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
23843 		  != (unsigned) s.column))
23844 	    add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
23845 
23846 	  if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
23847 	    add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
23848 	}
23849     }
23850   else
23851     add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl, no_linkage_name);
23852 
23853   if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
23854       || (origin != NULL
23855 	  && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
23856 	  && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
23857 				       decl_function_context
23858 							(decl_or_origin))))
23859     {
23860       tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
23861 
23862       if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23863 	add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23864 			    context_die);
23865       else
23866 	add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
23867 			    context_die);
23868     }
23869 
23870   if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
23871     {
23872       if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23873 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23874 
23875       if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23876 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23877 
23878       add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
23879 
23880       add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
23881     }
23882 
23883   if (declaration)
23884     add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23885 
23886   if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23887 	       || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
23888     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
23889 
23890  gen_variable_die_location:
23891   if (! declaration
23892       && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
23893 	  /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
23894 	     so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
23895 	     already set.  */
23896 	  || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin)
23897 	      && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
23898 	      && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin))))
23899     {
23900       if (early_dwarf)
23901 	add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
23902       else
23903 	add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
23904 					       decl == NULL);
23905     }
23906   else
23907     tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
23908 
23909   if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
23910       && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
23911 						DW_AT_const_expr) == 1
23912       && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr)
23913       && !specialization_p)
23914     add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr, 1);
23915 
23916   if (!dwarf_strict)
23917     {
23918       int inl = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
23919 						       DW_AT_inline);
23920       if (inl != -1
23921 	  && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_inline)
23922 	  && !specialization_p)
23923 	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_inline, inl);
23924     }
23925 }
23926 
23927 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant.  */
23928 
23929 static void
23930 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23931 {
23932   dw_die_ref const_die;
23933   tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
23934 
23935   const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23936   if (const_die)
23937     return;
23938 
23939   const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
23940   equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
23941   add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
23942   add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false, context_die);
23943   if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23944     add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23945   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23946     add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23947   tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
23948 }
23949 
23950 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier.  */
23951 
23952 static void
23953 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23954 {
23955   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
23956   dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23957   rtx insn;
23958   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23959 
23960   if (!lbl_die)
23961     {
23962       lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
23963       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23964 
23965       if (origin != NULL)
23966 	add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
23967       else
23968 	add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
23969     }
23970 
23971   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
23972     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23973   else if (! early_dwarf)
23974     {
23975       insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
23976 
23977       /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
23978 	 eliminated because of various optimizations.  We still emit them
23979 	 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them.  */
23980       if (insn
23981 	  && (LABEL_P (insn)
23982 	      || ((NOTE_P (insn)
23983 	           && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
23984 	{
23985 	  /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
23986 	     (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
23987 	     represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
23988 	     the user.  This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
23989 	     it if it ever does happen.  */
23990 	  gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
23991 
23992 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23993           add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23994 	}
23995       else if (insn
23996 	       && NOTE_P (insn)
23997 	       && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
23998 	       && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
23999 	{
24000 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
24001           add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
24002 	}
24003     }
24004 }
24005 
24006 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die.  Add source coordinate
24007    attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
24008    function was called from.  This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes.  */
24009 
24010 static inline void
24011 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
24012 {
24013   /* We can end up with BUILTINS_LOCATION here.  */
24014   if (RESERVED_LOCATION_P (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt)))
24015     return;
24016 
24017   expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
24018 
24019   if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
24020     {
24021       add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
24022       add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
24023       if (debug_column_info && s.column)
24024 	add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_column, s.column);
24025     }
24026 }
24027 
24028 
24029 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
24030    Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT.  */
24031 
24032 static inline void
24033 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
24034 {
24035   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24036 
24037   if (inline_entry_data **iedp
24038       = !inline_entry_data_table ? NULL
24039       : inline_entry_data_table->find_slot_with_hash (stmt,
24040 						      htab_hash_pointer (stmt),
24041 						      NO_INSERT))
24042     {
24043       inline_entry_data *ied = *iedp;
24044       gcc_assert (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_MARKER_INSNS);
24045       gcc_assert (debug_inline_points);
24046       gcc_assert (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt));
24047 
24048       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, ied->label_pfx, ied->label_num);
24049       add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
24050 
24051       if (debug_variable_location_views && !ZERO_VIEW_P (ied->view)
24052 	  && !dwarf_strict)
24053 	{
24054 	  if (!output_asm_line_debug_info ())
24055 	    add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_GNU_entry_view, ied->view);
24056 	  else
24057 	    {
24058 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", ied->view);
24059 	      /* FIXME: this will resolve to a small number.  Could we
24060 		 possibly emit smaller data?  Ideally we'd emit a
24061 		 uleb128, but that would make the size of DIEs
24062 		 impossible for the compiler to compute, since it's
24063 		 the assembler that computes the value of the view
24064 		 label in this case.  Ideally, we'd have a single form
24065 		 encompassing both the address and the view, and
24066 		 indirecting them through a table might make things
24067 		 easier, but even that would be more wasteful,
24068 		 space-wise, than what we have now.  */
24069 	      add_AT_symview (die, DW_AT_GNU_entry_view, label);
24070 	    }
24071 	}
24072 
24073       inline_entry_data_table->clear_slot (iedp);
24074     }
24075 
24076   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
24077       && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
24078     {
24079       tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
24080       dw_die_ref pdie;
24081       dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
24082 
24083       if (!debug_inline_points && inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
24084 	{
24085 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
24086 				       BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
24087           add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
24088 	}
24089 
24090       /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
24091 	 lists.  If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
24092 	 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
24093 	 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
24094 	 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range.  */
24095       for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
24096 	   BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
24097 	   chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
24098 	{
24099 	  dw_attr_node *new_attr;
24100 
24101 	  pdie = pdie->die_parent;
24102 	  if (pdie == NULL)
24103 	    break;
24104 	  if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
24105 	    break;
24106 	  new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
24107 	  if (new_attr == NULL
24108 	      || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
24109 	    break;
24110 	  attr = new_attr;
24111 	  superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
24112 	}
24113       if (attr != NULL
24114 	  && ((*ranges_table)[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset].num
24115 	      == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
24116 	  && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
24117 	{
24118 	  unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset;
24119 	  unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
24120 	  for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
24121 	       chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
24122 	    {
24123 	      ++supercnt;
24124 	      gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt].num
24125 				   == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
24126 	    }
24127 	  gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
24128 	  for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
24129 	       chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
24130 	    ++thiscnt;
24131 	  gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
24132 	  add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, off + supercnt - thiscnt,
24133 			     false);
24134 	  note_rnglist_head (off + supercnt - thiscnt);
24135 	  return;
24136 	}
24137 
24138       unsigned int offset = add_ranges (stmt, true);
24139       add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, false);
24140       note_rnglist_head (offset);
24141 
24142       bool prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (stmt);
24143       chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
24144       do
24145 	{
24146 	  add_ranges (chain, prev_in_cold != BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain));
24147 	  prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain);
24148 	  chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
24149 	}
24150       while (chain);
24151       add_ranges (NULL);
24152     }
24153   else
24154     {
24155       char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24156       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
24157 				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
24158       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
24159 				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
24160       add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
24161     }
24162 }
24163 
24164 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block.  */
24165 
24166 static void
24167 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24168 {
24169   dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
24170   dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
24171   if (!old_die)
24172     {
24173       stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
24174       BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
24175     }
24176 
24177   if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24178     {
24179       if (old_die)
24180 	{
24181 	  /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
24182 	     need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
24183 	     function.  */
24184 	  if (flag_checking)
24185 	    for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
24186 	      if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
24187 		  || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
24188 		{
24189 		  gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
24190 		  break;
24191 		}
24192 	  return;
24193 	}
24194     }
24195   else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
24196     {
24197       /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
24198 	 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to.  */
24199       if (old_die)
24200 	{
24201 	  stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
24202 	  BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
24203 	  old_die = NULL;
24204 	}
24205 
24206       tree origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
24207       if (origin != NULL_TREE && origin != stmt)
24208 	add_abstract_origin_attribute (stmt_die, origin);
24209     }
24210 
24211   if (old_die)
24212     stmt_die = old_die;
24213 
24214   /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
24215      should have the instruction range for this block.  If so, set the
24216      high/low attributes.  */
24217   if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
24218     {
24219       gcc_assert (stmt_die);
24220       add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
24221     }
24222 
24223   decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
24224 }
24225 
24226 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram.  */
24227 
24228 static void
24229 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24230 {
24231   tree decl;
24232 
24233   /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
24234      be abstract.  */
24235   gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
24236 
24237   decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
24238 
24239   /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable.  */
24240   gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
24241 		       || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
24242 
24243   if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24244     {
24245       dw_die_ref subr_die
24246 	= new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
24247 
24248       if (call_arg_locations || debug_inline_points)
24249 	BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
24250       add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
24251       if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
24252         add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
24253       add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
24254 
24255       decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
24256     }
24257 }
24258 
24259 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure.  CTX is required: see
24260    the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.  */
24261 
24262 static void
24263 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
24264 {
24265   dw_die_ref decl_die;
24266 
24267   if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
24268     return;
24269 
24270   decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
24271   add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
24272   add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl), decl_quals (decl),
24273 		      TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)),
24274 		      context_die);
24275 
24276   if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
24277     {
24278       add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24279       add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24280       add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
24281     }
24282 
24283   add_alignment_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24284 
24285   /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
24286      of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
24287      trees.  */
24288   gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
24289 	      || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
24290   if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
24291     add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
24292 
24293   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
24294     add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
24295 
24296   add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24297 
24298   /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on.  */
24299   equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
24300 }
24301 
24302 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type.  TYPE can be an
24303    OFFSET_TYPE, for a pointer to data member, or a RECORD_TYPE, for a
24304    pointer to member function.  */
24305 
24306 static void
24307 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24308 {
24309   if (lookup_type_die (type))
24310     return;
24311 
24312   dw_die_ref ptr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
24313 				scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
24314 
24315   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
24316   add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
24317 		  lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
24318   add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24319 		      context_die);
24320   add_alignment_attribute (ptr_die, type);
24321 
24322   if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
24323       && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != METHOD_TYPE)
24324     {
24325       dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
24326       add_AT_loc (ptr_die, DW_AT_use_location, op);
24327     }
24328 }
24329 
24330 static char *producer_string;
24331 
24332 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
24333    if -grecord-gcc-switches.  */
24334 
24335 static char *
24336 gen_producer_string (void)
24337 {
24338   size_t j;
24339   auto_vec<const char *> switches;
24340   const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
24341   char *producer, *tail;
24342   const char *p;
24343   size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
24344   size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
24345 
24346   for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
24347     switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
24348       {
24349       case OPT_o:
24350       case OPT_d:
24351       case OPT_dumpbase:
24352       case OPT_dumpdir:
24353       case OPT_auxbase:
24354       case OPT_auxbase_strip:
24355       case OPT_quiet:
24356       case OPT_version:
24357       case OPT_v:
24358       case OPT_w:
24359       case OPT_L:
24360       case OPT_D:
24361       case OPT_I:
24362       case OPT_U:
24363       case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
24364       case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
24365       case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
24366       case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
24367       case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
24368       case OPT__output_pch_:
24369       case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
24370       case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
24371       case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
24372       case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
24373       case OPT_fverbose_asm:
24374       case OPT____:
24375       case OPT__sysroot_:
24376       case OPT_nostdinc:
24377       case OPT_nostdinc__:
24378       case OPT_fpreprocessed:
24379       case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
24380       case OPT_fresolution_:
24381       case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
24382       case OPT_fmacro_prefix_map_:
24383       case OPT_ffile_prefix_map_:
24384       case OPT_fcompare_debug:
24385 	/* Ignore these.  */
24386 	continue;
24387       default:
24388         if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
24389 	    & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
24390 	  continue;
24391         gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
24392 			     == '-');
24393         switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
24394 	  {
24395 	  case 'M':
24396 	  case 'i':
24397 	  case 'W':
24398 	    continue;
24399 	  case 'f':
24400 	    if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
24401 			 "dump", 4) == 0)
24402 	      continue;
24403 	    break;
24404 	  default:
24405 	    break;
24406 	  }
24407 	switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
24408 	len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
24409 	break;
24410       }
24411 
24412   producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
24413   tail = producer;
24414   sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
24415   tail += plen;
24416 
24417   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
24418     {
24419       len = strlen (p);
24420       *tail = ' ';
24421       memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
24422       tail += len + 1;
24423     }
24424 
24425   *tail = '\0';
24426   return producer;
24427 }
24428 
24429 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
24430    C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case.  Used for merging
24431    LTO translation unit languages.  */
24432 static const char *
24433 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
24434 {
24435   if (strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang2) == 0)
24436     return "GNU C++17";
24437   if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
24438     return "GNU C++14";
24439   if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
24440     return "GNU C++11";
24441   if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
24442     return "GNU C++98";
24443 
24444   if (strcmp ("GNU C17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C17", lang2) == 0)
24445     return "GNU C17";
24446   if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
24447     return "GNU C11";
24448   if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
24449     return "GNU C99";
24450   if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
24451     return "GNU C89";
24452 
24453   gcc_unreachable ();
24454 }
24455 
24456 
24457 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit.  */
24458 
24459 static dw_die_ref
24460 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
24461 {
24462   dw_die_ref die;
24463   const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
24464   int language;
24465 
24466   die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
24467 
24468   if (filename)
24469     {
24470       add_name_attribute (die, filename);
24471       /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>.  */
24472       if (filename[0] != '<')
24473 	add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
24474     }
24475 
24476   add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
24477 
24478   /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
24479      from the global list of translation units.  */
24480   if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
24481     {
24482       unsigned i;
24483       tree t;
24484       const char *common_lang = NULL;
24485 
24486       FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
24487 	{
24488 	  if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
24489 	    continue;
24490 	  if (!common_lang)
24491 	    common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
24492 	  else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
24493 	    ;
24494 	  else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
24495 		    && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
24496 	    /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case.  */
24497 	    common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
24498 					      TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
24499 	  else
24500 	    {
24501 	      /* Fall back to C.  */
24502 	      common_lang = NULL;
24503 	      break;
24504 	    }
24505 	}
24506 
24507       if (common_lang)
24508 	language_string = common_lang;
24509     }
24510 
24511   language = DW_LANG_C;
24512   if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
24513       && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
24514     {
24515       language = DW_LANG_C89;
24516       if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
24517 	{
24518 	  if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
24519 	    language = DW_LANG_C99;
24520 
24521 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
24522 	    if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0
24523 		|| strcmp (language_string, "GNU C17") == 0)
24524 	      language = DW_LANG_C11;
24525 	}
24526     }
24527   else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
24528     {
24529       language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
24530       if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
24531 	{
24532 	  if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
24533 	    language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
24534 	  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
24535 	    language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
24536 	  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++17") == 0)
24537 	    /* For now.  */
24538 	    language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
24539 	}
24540     }
24541   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
24542     language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
24543   else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
24544     {
24545       if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
24546 	language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
24547       else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
24548 	{
24549 	  language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
24550 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
24551 	    {
24552 	      if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
24553 		language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
24554 	      else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
24555 		language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
24556 	    }
24557 	}
24558       else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
24559 	language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
24560       else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
24561 	language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
24562       else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24563 	{
24564 	  if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
24565 	    language = DW_LANG_Go;
24566 	}
24567     }
24568   /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works.  */
24569   else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
24570     language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
24571 
24572   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
24573 
24574   switch (language)
24575     {
24576     case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
24577     case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
24578     case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
24579     case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
24580     case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
24581       /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
24582 	 lowercases everything.  */
24583       add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
24584       break;
24585     default:
24586       /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified.  */
24587       break;
24588     }
24589   return die;
24590 }
24591 
24592 /* Generate the DIE for a base class.  */
24593 
24594 static void
24595 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
24596 		     dw_die_ref context_die)
24597 {
24598   dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
24599   struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
24600 
24601   add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24602 		      context_die);
24603   add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
24604 
24605   if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
24606     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
24607 
24608   /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
24609      children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public.  In DWARF2
24610      the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private.  */
24611   if (access == access_public_node)
24612     {
24613       if (dwarf_version == 2
24614 	  || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
24615       add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
24616     }
24617   else if (access == access_protected_node)
24618     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
24619   else if (dwarf_version > 2
24620 	   && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
24621     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
24622 }
24623 
24624 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
24625    structure.  */
24626 static bool
24627 is_variant_part (tree decl)
24628 {
24629   return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
24630 	  && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
24631 }
24632 
24633 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE.  If it is,
24634    return the FIELD_DECL.  Return NULL_TREE otherwise.  */
24635 
24636 static tree
24637 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
24638 {
24639   bool continue_stripping = true;
24640   while (continue_stripping)
24641     switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
24642       {
24643       CASE_CONVERT:
24644 	operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
24645 	break;
24646       default:
24647 	continue_stripping = false;
24648 	break;
24649       }
24650 
24651   /* Match field access to members of struct_type only.  */
24652   if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
24653       && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
24654       && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
24655       && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
24656     return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
24657   else
24658     return NULL_TREE;
24659 }
24660 
24661 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
24662    integer constant (either signed or unsigned).  If so, store it into DEST and
24663    return true.  Return false otherwise. */
24664 
24665 static bool
24666 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
24667 {
24668   tree discr_type = TREE_TYPE (src);
24669 
24670   if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
24671     {
24672       tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (discr_type);
24673       if (debug_type != NULL)
24674 	discr_type = debug_type;
24675     }
24676 
24677   if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (discr_type))
24678     return false;
24679 
24680   /* Signedness can vary between the original type and the debug type. This
24681      can happen for character types in Ada for instance: the character type
24682      used for code generation can be signed, to be compatible with the C one,
24683      but from a debugger point of view, it must be unsigned.  */
24684   bool is_orig_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
24685   bool is_debug_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (discr_type);
24686 
24687   if (is_orig_unsigned != is_debug_unsigned)
24688     src = fold_convert (discr_type, src);
24689 
24690   if (!(is_debug_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
24691     return false;
24692 
24693   dest->pos = is_debug_unsigned;
24694   if (is_debug_unsigned)
24695     dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
24696   else
24697     dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
24698 
24699   return true;
24700 }
24701 
24702 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
24703    FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part.  If unsuccessful,
24704    store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL.  Otherwise:
24705 
24706      - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
24707        part to *DISCR_DECL
24708 
24709      - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
24710        represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
24711 
24712      - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
24713        the above array.
24714 
24715    Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
24716    successful), it is up to the caller to free the array.  */
24717 
24718 static void
24719 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
24720 			tree struct_type,
24721 			tree *discr_decl,
24722 			dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
24723 			unsigned *discr_lists_length)
24724 {
24725   tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
24726   tree variant;
24727   dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
24728   unsigned i;
24729 
24730   /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part.  */
24731   *discr_lists_length = 0;
24732   for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
24733        variant != NULL_TREE;
24734        variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
24735     ++*discr_lists_length;
24736 
24737   *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24738   *discr_lists_p
24739     = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
24740 				     sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
24741   discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
24742 
24743   /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
24744      of them.  This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
24745      do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing.  */
24746   for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
24747        variant != NULL_TREE;
24748        variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
24749     {
24750       tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
24751 
24752       /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
24753 	 it.  */
24754       if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
24755 	/* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
24756 	   previous variants rejected.  Don't output any matching value for
24757 	   this one.  */
24758 	continue;
24759 
24760       /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
24761 	 possibility: single values or ranges.  */
24762       while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
24763 	{
24764 	  tree next_round_match_expr;
24765 	  tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
24766 	  dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
24767 
24768 	  /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
24769 	     TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions.  Process the current possibility and
24770 	     continue with the rest at next iteration.  */
24771 	  if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
24772 	    {
24773 	      next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
24774 	      match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
24775 	    }
24776 	  else
24777 	    next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
24778 
24779 	  if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
24780 	    /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
24781 	       one.  */
24782 	    ;
24783 
24784 	  else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
24785 	    {
24786 	      /* We are matching:  <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
24787 		 This sub-expression matches a single value.  */
24788 	      tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
24789 
24790 	      candidate_discr
24791 	       = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
24792 					     struct_type);
24793 
24794 	      new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
24795 	      if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
24796 				    &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
24797 		goto abort;
24798 	      new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
24799 	    }
24800 
24801 	  else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
24802 	    {
24803 	      /* We are matching:
24804 		   <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
24805 		   && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
24806 		 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
24807 		 two matched integer constants.  Note that comparisons can be
24808 		 inclusive or exclusive.  */
24809 	      tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
24810 	      tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
24811 	      bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
24812 	      tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
24813 	      tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
24814 
24815 	      /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
24816 		 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
24817 		 to increment or decrement it.  */
24818 	      if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
24819 		lower_cst_included = true;
24820 	      else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
24821 		lower_cst_included = false;
24822 	      else
24823 		goto abort;
24824 
24825 	      if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
24826 		upper_cst_included = true;
24827 	      else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
24828 		upper_cst_included = false;
24829 	      else
24830 		goto abort;
24831 
24832 	      /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
24833 		 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
24834 		 operand.  */
24835 	      candidate_discr_1
24836 	        = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
24837 					      struct_type);
24838 	      candidate_discr_2
24839 	        = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
24840 					      struct_type);
24841 	      if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
24842 		candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
24843 	      else
24844 		goto abort;
24845 
24846 	      /* Extract bounds from both.  */
24847 	      new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
24848 	      lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
24849 	      upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
24850 
24851 	      if (!lower_cst_included)
24852 		lower_cst
24853 		  = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), lower_cst,
24854 				 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1));
24855 	      if (!upper_cst_included)
24856 		upper_cst
24857 		  = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), upper_cst,
24858 				 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1));
24859 
24860 	      if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
24861 				    &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
24862 		  || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
24863 				       &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
24864 		goto abort;
24865 
24866 	      new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
24867 	    }
24868 
24869 	  else
24870 	    /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
24871 	       matching discriminant values.  Abort everything.  */
24872 	    goto abort;
24873 
24874 	  /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
24875 	     far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything.  */
24876 	  if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
24877 	      || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
24878 	    goto abort;
24879 	  else
24880 	    *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
24881 
24882 	  if (new_node != NULL)
24883 	    {
24884 	      new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
24885 	      discr_lists[i] = new_node;
24886 	    }
24887 	  match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
24888 	}
24889     }
24890 
24891   /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
24892      in.  */
24893   return;
24894 
24895 abort:
24896   /* Clean all data structure and return no result.  */
24897   free (*discr_lists_p);
24898   *discr_lists_p = NULL;
24899   *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24900 }
24901 
24902 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
24903    of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type.  This new DIE is emitted as the next child
24904    under CONTEXT_DIE.
24905 
24906    Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
24907    QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter.  The members for
24908    this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
24909    has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute.  The discriminant and the discriminant
24910    values are inferred from these attributes.
24911 
24912    In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
24913    to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
24914    offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
24915    This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
24916    must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
24917    describe in DWARF.  */
24918 
24919 static void
24920 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
24921 		  dw_die_ref context_die)
24922 {
24923   const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
24924   tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
24925   struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
24926     vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
24927     NULL_TREE,		  /* base_decl */
24928     NULL,		  /* dpi */
24929     false,		  /* placeholder_arg */
24930     false		  /* placeholder_seen */
24931   };
24932 
24933   /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
24934      NULL_TREE if there is no such field.  */
24935   tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24936   dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
24937   unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
24938   unsigned i;
24939 
24940   dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
24941   dw_die_ref variant_part_die
24942     = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
24943 
24944   equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
24945 
24946   analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
24947 			  &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
24948 
24949   if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
24950     {
24951       dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
24952 
24953       if (discr_die)
24954 	add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
24955       else
24956 	/* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
24957 	   discrimimant information in the output.  */
24958 	discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24959     }
24960 
24961   /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
24962      create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
24963      expressions for it for each member.  */
24964   if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
24965       && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
24966     {
24967       const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
24968         = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
24969 		      build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24970 					   NULL_TREE));
24971       const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
24972       const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
24973         = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
24974 
24975       dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
24976 					   dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
24977       if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
24978 	variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
24979     }
24980 
24981   /* Output DIEs for all variants.  */
24982   i = 0;
24983   for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
24984        variant != NULL_TREE;
24985        variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
24986     {
24987       tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
24988       dw_die_ref variant_die;
24989 
24990       /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
24991 	 encoded as structures.  Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
24992 	 under these records.  */
24993       gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
24994 
24995       variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
24996       equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
24997 
24998       /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any.  */
24999       if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
25000 	/* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
25001 	   probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
25002 	   output any discriminant value/list attribute.  */
25003 	;
25004       else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
25005 	       && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
25006 	/* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
25007 	   list.  */
25008 	add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
25009       else
25010 	add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
25011 
25012       for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
25013 	   member != NULL_TREE;
25014 	   member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
25015 	{
25016 	  struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
25017 	    vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
25018 	    NULL		  /* variant_part_offset */
25019 	  };
25020 	  if (is_variant_part (member))
25021 	    {
25022 	      /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
25023 		 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address.  On the
25024 		 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
25025 		 nested-most variant part.  So we have to sum offsets each time
25026 		 we recurse.  */
25027 
25028 	      vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
25029 		= fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
25030 			       variant_part_offset, byte_position (member));
25031 	      gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
25032 	    }
25033 	  else
25034 	    {
25035 	      vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
25036 	      gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
25037 	    }
25038 	}
25039     }
25040 
25041   free (discr_lists);
25042 }
25043 
25044 /* Generate a DIE for a class member.  */
25045 
25046 static void
25047 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
25048 {
25049   tree member;
25050   tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
25051 
25052   gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
25053 
25054   /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
25055      members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
25056      members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
25057      DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
25058      function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
25059      types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
25060      for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
25061      members of this (containing) type themselves.  The g++ front- end can
25062      force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
25063      type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
25064      the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type.  */
25065 
25066   /* First output info about the base classes.  */
25067   if (binfo && early_dwarf)
25068     {
25069       vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
25070       int i;
25071       tree base;
25072 
25073       for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
25074 	gen_inheritance_die (base,
25075 			     (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
25076 			     type,
25077 			     context_die);
25078     }
25079 
25080   /* Now output info about the data members and type members.  */
25081   for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
25082     {
25083       struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
25084       bool static_inline_p
25085 	= (TREE_STATIC (member)
25086 	   && (lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (member, DW_AT_inline)
25087 	       != -1));
25088 
25089       /* Ignore clones.  */
25090       if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
25091 	continue;
25092 
25093       /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
25094 	 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
25095 	 may have already been defined.  Don't define them again, but
25096 	 do put them in the right order.  */
25097 
25098       if (dw_die_ref child = lookup_decl_die (member))
25099 	{
25100 	  /* Handle inline static data members, which only have in-class
25101 	     declarations.  */
25102 	  dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
25103 	  if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
25104 	      && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ())
25105 	    {
25106 	      ref = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
25107 	      /* For C++17 inline static data members followed by redundant
25108 		 out of class redeclaration, we might get here with
25109 		 child being the DIE created for the out of class
25110 		 redeclaration and with its DW_AT_specification being
25111 		 the DIE created for in-class definition.  We want to
25112 		 reparent the latter, and don't want to create another
25113 		 DIE with DW_AT_specification in that case, because
25114 		 we already have one.  */
25115 	      if (ref
25116 		  && static_inline_p
25117 		  && ref->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
25118 		  && ref->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
25119 		  && get_AT (ref, DW_AT_specification) == NULL)
25120 		{
25121 		  child = ref;
25122 		  ref = NULL;
25123 		  static_inline_p = false;
25124 		}
25125 	    }
25126 
25127 	  if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
25128 	      && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
25129 	      && ref == NULL)
25130 	    {
25131 	      reparent_child (child, context_die);
25132 	      if (dwarf_version < 5)
25133 		child->die_tag = DW_TAG_member;
25134 	    }
25135 	  else
25136 	    splice_child_die (context_die, child);
25137 	}
25138 
25139       /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
25140 	 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
25141 	 conflict in our mappings.  */
25142       else if (is_variant_part (member)
25143 	       && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
25144 	{
25145 	  vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
25146 	  gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
25147 	}
25148       else
25149 	{
25150 	  vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
25151 	  gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
25152 	}
25153 
25154       /* For C++ inline static data members emit immediately a DW_TAG_variable
25155 	 DIE that will refer to that DW_TAG_member/DW_TAG_variable through
25156 	 DW_AT_specification.  */
25157       if (static_inline_p)
25158 	{
25159 	  int old_extern = DECL_EXTERNAL (member);
25160 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = 0;
25161 	  gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, comp_unit_die ());
25162 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = old_extern;
25163 	}
25164     }
25165 }
25166 
25167 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type.  If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
25168    is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
25169    member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs.  */
25170 
25171 static void
25172 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
25173 				enum debug_info_usage usage)
25174 {
25175   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25176     {
25177       /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
25178 	 still incomplete.  */
25179       if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
25180 	for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
25181 	     member;
25182 	     member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
25183 	  fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
25184       return;
25185     }
25186 
25187   dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25188   dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
25189   int nested = 0;
25190   int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
25191 		  && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
25192 		      || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
25193   int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
25194   complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
25195 
25196   if (type_die && ! complete)
25197     return;
25198 
25199   if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
25200       && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25201 	  || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
25202     nested = 1;
25203 
25204   scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
25205 
25206   /* Generate child dies for template paramaters.  */
25207   if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25208     schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
25209 
25210   if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
25211     /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class.  */
25212     {
25213       dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
25214 
25215       type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
25216 			  ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
25217 			  scope_die, type);
25218       equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
25219       if (old_die)
25220 	add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
25221       else
25222 	add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
25223     }
25224   else
25225     remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
25226 
25227   /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
25228      then give a list of members.  */
25229   if (complete && !ns_decl)
25230     {
25231       /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
25232 	 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself.  */
25233       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25234       add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
25235       add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
25236       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
25237 	{
25238 	  add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
25239 	  add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
25240 	}
25241 
25242       /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
25243 	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
25244       if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
25245 	add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
25246 
25247       push_decl_scope (type);
25248       gen_member_die (type, type_die);
25249       pop_decl_scope ();
25250 
25251       add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
25252       if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
25253 	add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
25254 
25255       /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in.  */
25256       if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
25257 	{
25258 	  tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
25259 
25260 	  gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
25261 	  add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
25262 			  lookup_type_die (vtype));
25263 	}
25264     }
25265   else
25266     {
25267       add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25268 
25269       /* We don't need to do this for function-local types.  */
25270       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
25271 	  && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
25272 	vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
25273     }
25274 
25275   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
25276     add_pubtype (type, type_die);
25277 }
25278 
25279 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_.  */
25280 
25281 static void
25282 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
25283 {
25284   tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
25285   dw_die_ref subr_die
25286     = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
25287 	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
25288 
25289   equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
25290   add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
25291   add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
25292 		      context_die);
25293   add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, type);
25294   gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
25295 
25296   if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
25297     add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
25298   if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25299       && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type, DW_AT_reference) != -1)
25300     add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
25301   if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25302       && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type,
25303 						DW_AT_rvalue_reference) != -1)
25304     add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
25305 }
25306 
25307 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition.  */
25308 
25309 static void
25310 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
25311 {
25312   dw_die_ref type_die;
25313   tree type;
25314 
25315   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
25316     {
25317       if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
25318 	fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
25319       return;
25320     }
25321 
25322   /* As we avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs (see decl_ultimate_origin
25323      checks in process_scope_var and modified_type_die), this should be called
25324      only for original types.  */
25325   gcc_assert (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == NULL
25326 	      || decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == decl);
25327 
25328   TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
25329   type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
25330 
25331   add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
25332   if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
25333     {
25334       type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
25335       if (type == error_mark_node)
25336 	return;
25337 
25338       gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
25339       equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
25340     }
25341   else
25342     {
25343       type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
25344       if (type == error_mark_node)
25345 	return;
25346 
25347       if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
25348 	{
25349 	  /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
25350 	     an anonymous type, e.g:
25351 		 typedef struct {...} foo;
25352 	     In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
25353 	     type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
25354 	     TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
25355 	     the C++ FE.
25356 
25357 	     TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
25358 	     DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
25359 	     DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
25360 	     generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
25361 	     called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
25362 	     anonymous struct DIE.  */
25363 	  if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25364 	    gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25365 
25366 	  /* This is a GNU Extension.  We are adding a
25367 	     DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
25368 	     anonymous struct TYPE.  The value of that attribute
25369 	     is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
25370 	     struct.  This greatly eases the work of consumers of
25371 	     this debug info.  */
25372 	  add_linkage_name_raw (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
25373 	}
25374     }
25375 
25376   add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), false,
25377 		      context_die);
25378 
25379   if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
25380     /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
25381        TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
25382        created.  */
25383     equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
25384 
25385   add_alignment_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
25386 
25387   add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
25388 
25389   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
25390     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
25391 
25392   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
25393     add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
25394 }
25395 
25396 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type.  */
25397 
25398 static void
25399 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
25400 		     dw_die_ref context_die,
25401 		     enum debug_info_usage usage)
25402 {
25403   int need_pop;
25404 
25405   if (type == NULL_TREE
25406       || !is_tagged_type (type))
25407     return;
25408 
25409   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25410     need_pop = 0;
25411   /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
25412      out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too.  This does not apply
25413      to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
25414      the containing class as they are generated.  FIXME: This hurts the
25415      idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
25416      what set of template instantiations we'll get.  */
25417   else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
25418       && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25419       && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
25420     {
25421       gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
25422 
25423       if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25424 	return;
25425 
25426       /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub.  */
25427       push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25428       context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25429       need_pop = 1;
25430     }
25431   else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
25432 	   && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
25433     {
25434       /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
25435 	 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
25436 	 decls_for_scope.  */
25437       context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25438       /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
25439 	 specification.  */
25440       if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
25441 	context_die = NULL;
25442       need_pop = 0;
25443     }
25444   else
25445     {
25446       context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
25447       need_pop = 0;
25448     }
25449 
25450   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
25451     {
25452       /* This might have been written out by the call to
25453 	 declare_in_namespace.  */
25454       if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25455 	gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
25456     }
25457   else
25458     gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
25459 
25460   if (need_pop)
25461     pop_decl_scope ();
25462 
25463   /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
25464      it up if it is ever completed.  gen_*_type_die will set it for us
25465      when appropriate.  */
25466 }
25467 
25468 /* Generate a type description DIE.  */
25469 
25470 static void
25471 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
25472 			 enum debug_info_usage usage)
25473 {
25474   struct array_descr_info info;
25475 
25476   if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
25477     return;
25478 
25479   if (flag_checking && type)
25480      verify_type (type);
25481 
25482   if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
25483       && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
25484       && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
25485       && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
25486     /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
25487        info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
25488        This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
25489        type.  */
25490     type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
25491 
25492   /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
25493      for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of.  */
25494   if (typedef_variant_p (type))
25495     {
25496       if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25497 	return;
25498 
25499       tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
25500       tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
25501       if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
25502 	{
25503 	  gen_decl_die (origin, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25504 	  return;
25505 	}
25506 
25507       /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type.  */
25508       gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type);
25509 
25510       /* Give typedefs the right scope.  */
25511       context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
25512 
25513       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25514 
25515       gen_decl_die (name, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25516       return;
25517     }
25518 
25519   /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
25520      generate debug info for the typedef.  */
25521   if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
25522     {
25523       /* Give typedefs the right scope.  */
25524       context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
25525 
25526       gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
25527       return;
25528     }
25529 
25530   if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
25531     {
25532       tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
25533 
25534       if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
25535 	{
25536 	  gen_type_die_with_usage (debug_type, context_die, usage);
25537 	  return;
25538 	}
25539     }
25540 
25541   /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
25542      of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
25543      get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
25544      now.  (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
25545      cloned type itself.  Similarly function/method types can contain extra
25546      ref-qualification).  */
25547   if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
25548       || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
25549     {
25550       /* For function/method types, can't use type_main_variant here,
25551 	 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
25552 	 but try to canonicalize.  */
25553       tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
25554       for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
25555 	if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
25556 	    && check_base_type (t, main)
25557 	    && check_lang_type (t, type))
25558 	  {
25559 	    type = t;
25560 	    break;
25561 	  }
25562     }
25563   else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
25564 	   && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
25565     type = type_main_variant (type);
25566 
25567   /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first.  */
25568   if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
25569       && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
25570     {
25571       memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
25572       if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
25573 	{
25574 	  /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension.  */
25575 	  gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
25576 		      && (info.ndimensions
25577 			  <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
25578 	  gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
25579 	  TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25580 	  return;
25581 	}
25582     }
25583 
25584   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25585     {
25586       /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
25587 	 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN.  For such types, fall through to
25588 	 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
25589 	 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes.  */
25590       if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
25591 	   && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
25592 	   && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
25593 	   && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
25594 	  || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
25595 	return;
25596     }
25597 
25598   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
25599     {
25600     case ERROR_MARK:
25601       break;
25602 
25603     case POINTER_TYPE:
25604     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
25605       /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type.  This
25606 	 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
25607 	 type is recursive.  Recursive types are possible in Ada.  */
25608       /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
25609 	 statement.  */
25610       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25611 
25612       /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
25613 	 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type.  */
25614       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25615 			       DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
25616       break;
25617 
25618     case OFFSET_TYPE:
25619       /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
25620 	 Output a description of the relevant class type.  */
25621       gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
25622 			       DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
25623 
25624       /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to.  */
25625       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25626 			       DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
25627 
25628       /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
25629 	 itself.  */
25630       gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
25631       break;
25632 
25633     case FUNCTION_TYPE:
25634       /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
25635       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25636 			       DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25637       gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
25638       break;
25639 
25640     case METHOD_TYPE:
25641       /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
25642       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25643 			       DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25644       gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
25645       break;
25646 
25647     case ARRAY_TYPE:
25648     case VECTOR_TYPE:
25649       gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
25650       break;
25651 
25652     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
25653     case RECORD_TYPE:
25654     case UNION_TYPE:
25655     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
25656       gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
25657       return;
25658 
25659     case VOID_TYPE:
25660     case INTEGER_TYPE:
25661     case REAL_TYPE:
25662     case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
25663     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
25664     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
25665     case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
25666       /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types.  */
25667       break;
25668 
25669     case NULLPTR_TYPE:
25670     case LANG_TYPE:
25671       /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type.  */
25672       {
25673         dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25674         if (type_die == NULL)
25675           {
25676 	    tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
25677             type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
25678 				type);
25679             add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25680             equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
25681           }
25682       }
25683       break;
25684 
25685     default:
25686       if (is_cxx_auto (type))
25687 	{
25688 	  tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
25689 	  dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
25690 			     ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
25691 	  if (!*die)
25692 	    {
25693 	      *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
25694 			      comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
25695 	      add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25696 	    }
25697 	  equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
25698 	  break;
25699 	}
25700       gcc_unreachable ();
25701     }
25702 
25703   TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25704 }
25705 
25706 static void
25707 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
25708 {
25709   if (type != error_mark_node)
25710     {
25711       gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25712       if (flag_checking)
25713 	{
25714 	  dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
25715 	  if (die)
25716 	    check_die (die);
25717 	}
25718     }
25719 }
25720 
25721 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
25722    things which are local to the given block.  */
25723 
25724 static void
25725 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
25726 {
25727   int must_output_die = 0;
25728   bool inlined_func;
25729 
25730   /* Ignore blocks that are NULL.  */
25731   if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
25732     return;
25733 
25734   inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
25735 
25736   /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
25737      process the variables, since they will have been done by the
25738      origin block.  Do process subblocks.  */
25739   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
25740     {
25741       tree sub;
25742 
25743       for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
25744 	gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
25745 
25746       return;
25747     }
25748 
25749   /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
25750      block.  */
25751   if (inlined_func)
25752     /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented.  We
25753        generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them.  (See below.) */
25754     must_output_die = 1;
25755   else
25756     {
25757       /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
25758 	 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for.  */
25759       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25760 	/* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
25761 	   as being a "significant" one.  */
25762 	must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
25763 			    || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
25764 			   && (TREE_USED (stmt)
25765 			       || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
25766 			       || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
25767       else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
25768 		|| TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
25769 		|| BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
25770       	       && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
25771 	must_output_die = 1;
25772     }
25773 
25774   /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
25775      DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
25776      all.  Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
25777      needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
25778      that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
25779      local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
25780      instances and local (nested) function definitions.  */
25781   if (must_output_die)
25782     {
25783       if (inlined_func)
25784 	{
25785 	  /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
25786 	     indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
25787 	     That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
25788 	     the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
25789 	     precisely to prevent us from emitting any
25790 	     DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
25791 	     of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
25792 	     not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
25793 
25794 	     Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
25795 	     for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
25796 	     the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
25797 	     to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE.  */
25798 	  if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
25799 	    gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
25800 	}
25801       else
25802 	gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
25803     }
25804   else
25805     decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
25806 }
25807 
25808 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
25809    block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE.  */
25810 static void
25811 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
25812 {
25813   dw_die_ref die;
25814   tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
25815 
25816   if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25817     die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
25818   else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL)
25819     {
25820       if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
25821 	die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
25822       else
25823 	die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
25824       /* Avoid re-creating the DIE late if it was optimized as unused early.  */
25825       if (! die && ! early_dwarf)
25826 	return;
25827     }
25828   else
25829     die = NULL;
25830 
25831   /* Avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs and concrete static variables that
25832      will only be pruned later.  */
25833   if ((origin || decl_ultimate_origin (decl))
25834       && (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
25835 	  || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin) && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin))))
25836     {
25837       origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
25838       if (decl && VAR_P (decl) && die != NULL)
25839 	{
25840 	  die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
25841 	  if (die != NULL)
25842 	    equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
25843 	}
25844       return;
25845     }
25846 
25847   if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
25848     add_child_die (context_die, die);
25849   else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
25850     {
25851       if (early_dwarf)
25852 	dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
25853 					     stmt, context_die);
25854     }
25855   else
25856     {
25857       if (decl && DECL_P (decl))
25858 	{
25859 	  die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25860 
25861 	  /* Early created DIEs do not have a parent as the decls refer
25862 	     to the function as DECL_CONTEXT rather than the BLOCK.  */
25863 	  if (die && die->die_parent == NULL)
25864 	    {
25865 	      gcc_assert (in_lto_p);
25866 	      add_child_die (context_die, die);
25867 	    }
25868 	}
25869 
25870       gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
25871     }
25872 }
25873 
25874 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
25875    all of its sub-blocks.  */
25876 
25877 static void
25878 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
25879 {
25880   tree decl;
25881   unsigned int i;
25882   tree subblocks;
25883 
25884   /* Ignore NULL blocks.  */
25885   if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
25886     return;
25887 
25888   /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
25889      declared directly within this block but not within any nested
25890      sub-blocks.  Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
25891      generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now.  We don't
25892      have to do this if we're at -g1.  */
25893   if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25894     {
25895       for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
25896 	process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
25897       /* BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARs simply generate DIE stubs with abstract
25898 	 origin - avoid doing this twice as we have no good way to see
25899 	 if we've done it once already.  */
25900       if (! early_dwarf)
25901 	for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
25902 	  {
25903 	    decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
25904 	    if (decl == current_function_decl)
25905 	      /* Ignore declarations of the current function, while they
25906 		 are declarations, gen_subprogram_die would treat them
25907 		 as definitions again, because they are equal to
25908 		 current_function_decl and endlessly recurse.  */;
25909 	    else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25910 	      process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
25911 	    else
25912 	      process_scope_var (stmt, NULL_TREE, decl, context_die);
25913 	  }
25914     }
25915 
25916   /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
25917      inlined call information.  */
25918 
25919   /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
25920      therein) of this block.  */
25921   for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
25922        subblocks != NULL;
25923        subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
25924     gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
25925 }
25926 
25927 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting?  */
25928 
25929 bool
25930 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
25931 {
25932   if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
25933     return true;
25934 
25935   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
25936       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
25937       && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
25938       && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
25939       && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
25940     /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name.  */
25941     return true;
25942 
25943   return false;
25944 }
25945 
25946 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
25947    purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
25948    constructs like:
25949 
25950    typedef struct {...} foo;
25951 
25952    In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
25953    Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
25954    struct type.  */
25955 
25956 static bool
25957 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
25958 {
25959   if (decl == NULL_TREE
25960       || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
25961       || DECL_NAMELESS (decl)
25962       || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
25963       || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
25964       || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
25965       /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
25966          to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
25967          semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now.  */
25968       || !is_cxx (decl))
25969     return FALSE;
25970 
25971   return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
25972 	  && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
25973 	  && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
25974 	      != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
25975 }
25976 
25977 /* Looks up the DIE for a context.  */
25978 
25979 static inline dw_die_ref
25980 lookup_context_die (tree context)
25981 {
25982   if (context)
25983     {
25984       /* Find die that represents this context.  */
25985       if (TYPE_P (context))
25986 	{
25987 	  context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
25988 	  dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
25989 	  if (!ctx)
25990 	    return NULL;
25991 	  return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
25992 	}
25993       else
25994 	return lookup_decl_die (context);
25995     }
25996   return comp_unit_die ();
25997 }
25998 
25999 /* Returns the DIE for a context.  */
26000 
26001 static inline dw_die_ref
26002 get_context_die (tree context)
26003 {
26004   if (context)
26005     {
26006       /* Find die that represents this context.  */
26007       if (TYPE_P (context))
26008 	{
26009 	  context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
26010 	  return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
26011 	}
26012       else
26013 	return force_decl_die (context);
26014     }
26015   return comp_unit_die ();
26016 }
26017 
26018 /* Returns the DIE for decl.  A DIE will always be returned.  */
26019 
26020 static dw_die_ref
26021 force_decl_die (tree decl)
26022 {
26023   dw_die_ref decl_die;
26024   unsigned saved_external_flag;
26025   tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
26026   decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26027   if (!decl_die)
26028     {
26029       dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
26030 
26031       decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26032       if (decl_die)
26033 	return decl_die;
26034 
26035       switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
26036 	{
26037 	case FUNCTION_DECL:
26038 	  /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
26039 	     that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
26040 	     declaration die.  */
26041 	  save_fn = current_function_decl;
26042 	  current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
26043 	  gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
26044 	  current_function_decl = save_fn;
26045 	  break;
26046 
26047 	case VAR_DECL:
26048 	  /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
26049 	   gen_decl_die() call.  */
26050 	  saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
26051 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
26052 	  gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
26053 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
26054 	  break;
26055 
26056 	case NAMESPACE_DECL:
26057 	  if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
26058 	    dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26059 	  else
26060 	    /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace.  */
26061 	    decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
26062 	  break;
26063 
26064 	case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
26065 	  decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
26066 	  break;
26067 
26068 	default:
26069 	  gcc_unreachable ();
26070 	}
26071 
26072       /* We should be able to find the DIE now.  */
26073       if (!decl_die)
26074 	decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26075       gcc_assert (decl_die);
26076     }
26077 
26078   return decl_die;
26079 }
26080 
26081 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type.  A DIE is
26082    always returned.  */
26083 
26084 static dw_die_ref
26085 force_type_die (tree type)
26086 {
26087   dw_die_ref type_die;
26088 
26089   type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
26090   if (!type_die)
26091     {
26092       dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
26093 
26094       type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
26095 				    false, context_die);
26096       gcc_assert (type_die);
26097     }
26098   return type_die;
26099 }
26100 
26101 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
26102    and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed.  */
26103 
26104 static dw_die_ref
26105 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
26106 {
26107   tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
26108 		  ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
26109   if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
26110     /* Force out the namespace.  */
26111     context_die = force_decl_die (context);
26112 
26113   return context_die;
26114 }
26115 
26116 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
26117    type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
26118 
26119    For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
26120    declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
26121    DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
26122    members).  */
26123 
26124 static dw_die_ref
26125 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
26126 {
26127   dw_die_ref ns_context;
26128 
26129   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26130     return context_die;
26131 
26132   /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
26133      once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
26134 
26135      This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
26136      namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
26137 
26138           namespace S
26139 	  {
26140             int i=5;
26141             int foo()
26142 	    {
26143               int i=8;
26144               extern int i;
26145      	      return i;
26146 	    }
26147           }
26148   */
26149   if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
26150     return context_die;
26151 
26152   /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
26153      namespace, as we will get confused.  It would have already been emitted
26154      when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways.  */
26155   if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
26156     return context_die;
26157 
26158   ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
26159 
26160   if (ns_context != context_die)
26161     {
26162       if (is_fortran ())
26163 	return ns_context;
26164       if (DECL_P (thing))
26165 	gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
26166       else
26167 	gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
26168     }
26169   return context_die;
26170 }
26171 
26172 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias.  */
26173 
26174 static void
26175 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
26176 {
26177   dw_die_ref namespace_die;
26178 
26179   /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
26180      they are an alias of.  */
26181   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
26182     {
26183       /* Output a real namespace or module.  */
26184       context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
26185       namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
26186 			       ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
26187 			       context_die, decl);
26188       /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords.  */
26189       if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
26190 	{
26191 	  const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
26192 	  if (name)
26193 	    add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
26194 	}
26195       else
26196 	add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
26197       if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
26198 	add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
26199       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
26200     }
26201   else
26202     {
26203       /* Output a namespace alias.  */
26204 
26205       /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary.  */
26206       dw_die_ref origin_die
26207 	= force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
26208 
26209       if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
26210 	  || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
26211 	context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
26212       /* Now create the namespace alias DIE.  */
26213       namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
26214       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
26215       add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
26216       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
26217     }
26218   if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
26219       && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
26220 						DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
26221     add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_export_symbols, 1);
26222 
26223   /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS.  */
26224   if (want_pubnames ())
26225     add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
26226 }
26227 
26228 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
26229    The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
26230    for all other decls it returns NULL.
26231 
26232    If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
26233    It can be NULL otherwise.  */
26234 
26235 static dw_die_ref
26236 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
26237 	      dw_die_ref context_die)
26238 {
26239   tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
26240   tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
26241 
26242   if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
26243     return NULL;
26244 
26245   /* Ignore pointer bounds decls.  */
26246   if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
26247       && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
26248       && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
26249     return NULL;
26250 
26251   switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
26252     {
26253     case ERROR_MARK:
26254       break;
26255 
26256     case CONST_DECL:
26257       if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
26258 	{
26259 	  /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
26260 	     the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself.  */
26261 	  break;
26262 	}
26263 
26264       /* Emit its type.  */
26265       gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
26266 
26267       /* And its containing namespace.  */
26268       context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
26269 
26270       gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
26271       break;
26272 
26273     case FUNCTION_DECL:
26274 #if 0
26275       /* FIXME */
26276       /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
26277 	 on local redeclarations of global functions.  That seems broken.  */
26278       if (current_function_decl != decl)
26279 	/* This is only a declaration.  */;
26280 #endif
26281 
26282       /* We should have abstract copies already and should not generate
26283 	 stray type DIEs in late LTO dumping.  */
26284       if (! early_dwarf)
26285 	;
26286 
26287       /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance.  */
26288       else if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
26289 	dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
26290 				     ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
26291 				     : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
26292 
26293       /* If we're emitting a possibly inlined function emit it as
26294          abstract instance.  */
26295       else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
26296 	       && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
26297 	       && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
26298 	       /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
26299 		  a declaration.  We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
26300 		  that case, because that works only if we have a die.  */
26301 	       && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
26302 	dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
26303 
26304       /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl.  */
26305       else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26306 	{
26307 	  /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
26308 	     have its containing type.  */
26309 	  if (!origin)
26310 	    origin = decl_class_context (decl);
26311 	  if (origin != NULL_TREE)
26312 	    gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
26313 
26314 	  /* And its return type.  */
26315 	  gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
26316 
26317 	  /* And its virtual context.  */
26318 	  if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
26319 	    gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
26320 
26321 	  /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl.  */
26322 	  if (origin != NULL_TREE)
26323 	    gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
26324 
26325 	  /* And its containing namespace.  */
26326 	  context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
26327 	}
26328 
26329       /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself.  */
26330       if (decl)
26331         gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
26332       break;
26333 
26334     case TYPE_DECL:
26335       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
26336 	 actual typedefs.  */
26337       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26338 	break;
26339 
26340       /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
26341 	 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
26342 	 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
26343 	 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
26344 	 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
26345 	 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here.  But nothing
26346 	 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
26347 	 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
26348 	 removed during unused type prunning.  Don't add anything in this
26349 	 case.  */
26350       if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
26351 	break;
26352 
26353       if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
26354 	gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
26355       else
26356 	/* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself.  */
26357 	gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
26358       break;
26359 
26360     case LABEL_DECL:
26361       if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
26362 	gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
26363       break;
26364 
26365     case VAR_DECL:
26366     case RESULT_DECL:
26367       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
26368 	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
26369       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26370 	break;
26371 
26372       /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
26373          All types have been dumped early.  */
26374       if (early_dwarf
26375 	  /* ???  But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
26376 	     modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
26377 	     references to them.  Dump them again as happens for inlining
26378 	     which copies both the decl and the types.  */
26379 	  /* ???  And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
26380 	     in VLA bound information for example.  */
26381 	  || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
26382 						current_function_decl)))
26383 	{
26384 	  /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
26385 	     object.  */
26386 	  if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
26387 	    gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
26388 	  else
26389 	    gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
26390 	}
26391 
26392       if (early_dwarf)
26393 	{
26394 	  /* And its containing type.  */
26395 	  class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
26396 	  if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
26397 	    gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
26398 
26399 	  /* And its containing namespace.  */
26400 	  context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
26401 	}
26402 
26403       /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself.  This gets
26404 	 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
26405 	 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
26406 	 function.  */
26407       ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
26408       if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
26409 	  && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
26410 	gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
26411 				  true /* Emit name attribute.  */,
26412 				  context_die);
26413       else
26414 	gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
26415       break;
26416 
26417     case FIELD_DECL:
26418       gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
26419       /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
26420 	 anonymous unions and structs.  */
26421       if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
26422 	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
26423 	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
26424 	{
26425 	  gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
26426 	  gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
26427 	}
26428       break;
26429 
26430     case PARM_DECL:
26431       /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
26432          All types have been dumped early.  */
26433       if (early_dwarf
26434 	  /* ???  But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
26435 	     modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
26436 	     references to them.  Dump them again as happens for inlining
26437 	     which copies both the decl and the types.  */
26438 	  /* ???  And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
26439 	     in VLA bound information for example.  */
26440 	  || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
26441 						current_function_decl)))
26442 	{
26443 	  if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
26444 	    gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
26445 	  else
26446 	    gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
26447 	}
26448       return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
26449 				       true /* Emit name attribute.  */,
26450 				       context_die);
26451 
26452     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
26453       if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
26454 	gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
26455       break;
26456 
26457     case IMPORTED_DECL:
26458       dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
26459 					   DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
26460       break;
26461 
26462     case NAMELIST_DECL:
26463       gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
26464 			 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
26465       break;
26466 
26467     default:
26468       /* Probably some frontend-internal decl.  Assume we don't care.  */
26469       gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
26470       break;
26471     }
26472 
26473   return NULL;
26474 }
26475 
26476 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL.  Called at the
26477    end of the parsing process.
26478 
26479    This is the initial debug generation process.  As such, the DIEs
26480    generated may be incomplete.  A later debug generation pass
26481    (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
26482    in this pass (e.g., with complete location info).  */
26483 
26484 static void
26485 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
26486 {
26487   set_early_dwarf s;
26488 
26489   /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
26490      cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true.  This is in
26491      turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
26492 
26493      This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
26494      cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
26495      to return true.  Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
26496      while we generate dwarf early.  */
26497   bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
26498   symtab->global_info_ready = true;
26499 
26500   /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs.  If required, they'll be reached via
26501      other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
26502      that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl.  */
26503   if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
26504       && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
26505     {
26506       if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26507 	{
26508 	  tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
26509 
26510 	  /* For nested functions, make sure we have DIEs for the parents first
26511 	     so that all nested DIEs are generated at the proper scope in the
26512 	     first shot.  */
26513 	  tree context = decl_function_context (decl);
26514 	  if (context != NULL)
26515 	    {
26516 	      dw_die_ref context_die = lookup_decl_die (context);
26517 	      current_function_decl = context;
26518 
26519 	      /* Avoid emitting DIEs multiple times, but still process CONTEXT
26520 		 enough so that it lands in its own context.  This avoids type
26521 		 pruning issues later on.  */
26522 	      if (context_die == NULL || is_declaration_die (context_die))
26523 		dwarf2out_early_global_decl (context);
26524 	    }
26525 
26526 	  /* Emit an abstract origin of a function first.  This happens
26527 	     with C++ constructor clones for example and makes
26528 	     dwarf2out_abstract_function happy which requires the early
26529 	     DIE of the abstract instance to be present.  */
26530 	  tree origin = DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
26531 	  dw_die_ref origin_die;
26532 	  if (origin != NULL
26533 	      /* Do not emit the DIE multiple times but make sure to
26534 	         process it fully here in case we just saw a declaration.  */
26535 	      && ((origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin)) == NULL
26536 		  || is_declaration_die (origin_die)))
26537 	    {
26538 	      current_function_decl = origin;
26539 	      dwarf2out_decl (origin);
26540 	    }
26541 
26542 	  /* Emit the DIE for decl but avoid doing that multiple times.  */
26543 	  dw_die_ref old_die;
26544 	  if ((old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl)) == NULL
26545 	      || is_declaration_die (old_die))
26546 	    {
26547 	      current_function_decl = decl;
26548 	      dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26549 	    }
26550 
26551 	  current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
26552 	}
26553       else
26554 	dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26555     }
26556   symtab->global_info_ready = save;
26557 }
26558 
26559 /* Return whether EXPR is an expression with the following pattern:
26560    INDIRECT_REF (NOP_EXPR (INTEGER_CST)).  */
26561 
26562 static bool
26563 is_trivial_indirect_ref (tree expr)
26564 {
26565   if (expr == NULL_TREE || TREE_CODE (expr) != INDIRECT_REF)
26566     return false;
26567 
26568   tree nop = TREE_OPERAND (expr, 0);
26569   if (nop == NULL_TREE || TREE_CODE (nop) != NOP_EXPR)
26570     return false;
26571 
26572   tree int_cst = TREE_OPERAND (nop, 0);
26573   return int_cst != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (int_cst) == INTEGER_CST;
26574 }
26575 
26576 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL.  Called from
26577    toplev.c after compilation proper has finished.  */
26578 
26579 static void
26580 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
26581 {
26582   /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
26583      on the first pass.  */
26584   if (VAR_P (decl) && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
26585     {
26586       dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26587 
26588       /* We may have to generate early debug late for LTO in case debug
26589          was not enabled at compile-time or the target doesn't support
26590 	 the LTO early debug scheme.  */
26591       if (! die && in_lto_p)
26592 	{
26593 	  dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26594 	  die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26595 	}
26596 
26597       if (die)
26598 	{
26599 	  /* We get called via the symtab code invoking late_global_decl
26600 	     for symbols that are optimized out.
26601 
26602 	     Do not add locations for those, except if they have a
26603 	     DECL_VALUE_EXPR, in which case they are relevant for debuggers.
26604 	     Still don't add a location if the DECL_VALUE_EXPR is not a trivial
26605 	     INDIRECT_REF expression, as this could generate relocations to
26606 	     text symbols in LTO object files, which is invalid.  */
26607 	  varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (decl);
26608 	  if ((! node || ! node->definition)
26609 	      && ! (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
26610 		    && is_trivial_indirect_ref (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl))))
26611 	    tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
26612 	  else
26613 	    add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
26614 	}
26615     }
26616 }
26617 
26618 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c
26619    and from language front ends (to record built-in types).  */
26620 static void
26621 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
26622 {
26623   if (!local)
26624     {
26625       set_early_dwarf s;
26626       dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26627     }
26628 }
26629 
26630 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
26631    NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
26632    LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
26633    that DECL belongs to.
26634    LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK.  */
26635 static void
26636 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
26637 				     tree name,
26638 				     tree lexical_block,
26639 				     dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
26640 {
26641   expanded_location xloc;
26642   dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
26643   dw_die_ref at_import_die;
26644 
26645   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
26646     {
26647       xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
26648       decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
26649       gcc_assert (decl);
26650     }
26651   else
26652     xloc = expand_location (input_location);
26653 
26654   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
26655     {
26656       at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
26657       /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
26658 	 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
26659 	 the DW_AT_import tag.  Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef.  */
26660       if (!at_import_die)
26661 	{
26662 	  gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
26663 	  gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
26664 	  at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
26665 	  gcc_assert (at_import_die);
26666 	}
26667     }
26668   else
26669     {
26670       at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26671       if (!at_import_die)
26672 	{
26673 	  /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
26674 	     emitted the member decl for this field.  Emit it now.  */
26675 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
26676 	    {
26677 	      tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
26678 
26679 	      if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
26680 		  && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
26681 		  && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
26682 						DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
26683 		return;
26684 	      gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
26685 				       get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
26686 	    }
26687 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
26688 	    at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
26689 					 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
26690 					 NULL_TREE);
26691 	  else
26692 	    at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
26693 	}
26694     }
26695 
26696   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
26697     {
26698       if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
26699 	imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
26700 				lexical_block_die,
26701 				lexical_block);
26702       else
26703 	return;
26704     }
26705   else
26706     imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
26707 			    lexical_block_die,
26708 			    lexical_block);
26709 
26710   add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
26711   add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
26712   if (debug_column_info && xloc.column)
26713     add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_column, xloc.column);
26714   if (name)
26715     add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
26716 		   IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
26717   add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
26718 }
26719 
26720 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
26721    NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
26722    CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
26723    importing whole module.
26724    IMPLICIT is set if this hook is called for an implicit import
26725    such as inline namespace.  */
26726 
26727 static void
26728 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
26729 				   bool child, bool implicit)
26730 {
26731   /* dw_die_ref at_import_die;  */
26732   dw_die_ref scope_die;
26733 
26734   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26735     return;
26736 
26737   gcc_assert (decl);
26738 
26739   /* For DWARF5, just DW_AT_export_symbols on the DW_TAG_namespace
26740      should be enough, for DWARF4 and older even if we emit as extension
26741      DW_AT_export_symbols add the implicit DW_TAG_imported_module anyway
26742      for the benefit of consumers unaware of DW_AT_export_symbols.  */
26743   if (implicit
26744       && dwarf_version >= 5
26745       && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
26746 						DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
26747     return;
26748 
26749   set_early_dwarf s;
26750 
26751   /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
26752      We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
26753      itself.  */
26754 
26755   /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
26756      or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die.  */
26757   if (context
26758       && TYPE_P (context)
26759       && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
26760     return;
26761 
26762   scope_die = get_context_die (context);
26763 
26764   if (child)
26765     {
26766       /* DW_TAG_imported_module was introduced in the DWARFv3 specification, so
26767 	 there is nothing we can do, here.  */
26768       if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
26769 	return;
26770 
26771       gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
26772       gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
26773       gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
26774       scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
26775     }
26776 
26777   /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die.  */
26778   dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
26779 }
26780 
26781 /* Output debug information for namelists.   */
26782 
26783 static dw_die_ref
26784 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
26785 {
26786   dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
26787   tree value;
26788   unsigned i;
26789 
26790   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26791     return NULL;
26792 
26793   gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
26794   nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
26795   add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
26796 
26797   /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
26798      with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration.  */
26799   if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
26800     {
26801       add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
26802       return nml_die;
26803     }
26804 
26805   FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
26806     {
26807       nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
26808       if (!nml_item_ref_die)
26809 	nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
26810 
26811       nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
26812       add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
26813     }
26814   return nml_die;
26815 }
26816 
26817 
26818 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE.  */
26819 
26820 static void
26821 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
26822 {
26823   dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
26824 
26825   switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
26826     {
26827     case ERROR_MARK:
26828       return;
26829 
26830     case FUNCTION_DECL:
26831       /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
26832 	 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  If
26833 	 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE.  */
26834       if (decl_function_context (decl)
26835 	  /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope.  */
26836 	  && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26837 	context_die = NULL;
26838       break;
26839 
26840     case VAR_DECL:
26841       /* For local statics lookup proper context die.  */
26842       if (local_function_static (decl))
26843 	context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
26844 
26845       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
26846 	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
26847       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26848 	return;
26849       break;
26850 
26851     case CONST_DECL:
26852       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26853 	return;
26854       if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
26855 	return;
26856       if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
26857 	context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
26858       break;
26859 
26860     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
26861     case IMPORTED_DECL:
26862       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26863 	return;
26864       if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
26865 	return;
26866       break;
26867 
26868     case TYPE_DECL:
26869       /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs.  */
26870       if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
26871 	return;
26872 
26873       /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
26874 	 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling.  */
26875       if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
26876 	return;
26877 
26878       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types.  */
26879       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26880 	return;
26881 
26882       /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
26883 	 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  */
26884       if (decl_function_context (decl))
26885 	context_die = NULL;
26886 
26887       break;
26888 
26889     case NAMELIST_DECL:
26890       break;
26891 
26892     default:
26893       return;
26894     }
26895 
26896   gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
26897 
26898   if (flag_checking)
26899     {
26900       dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26901       if (die)
26902 	check_die (die);
26903     }
26904 }
26905 
26906 /* Write the debugging output for DECL.  */
26907 
26908 static void
26909 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
26910 {
26911   dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26912   call_arg_locations = NULL;
26913   call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
26914   call_site_count = -1;
26915   tail_call_site_count = -1;
26916   decl_loc_table->empty ();
26917   cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
26918 }
26919 
26920 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
26921    a lexical block.  */
26922 
26923 static void
26924 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26925 		       unsigned int blocknum)
26926 {
26927   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26928   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
26929 }
26930 
26931 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
26932    lexical block.  */
26933 
26934 static void
26935 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
26936 {
26937   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26938   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
26939 }
26940 
26941 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
26942    information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
26943 
26944    Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
26945    as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
26946    we may end up calling them anyway.  */
26947 
26948 static bool
26949 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
26950 {
26951   tree decl;
26952   unsigned int i;
26953 
26954   for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
26955     if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
26956 	|| (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
26957       return 0;
26958   for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
26959     {
26960       decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
26961       if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
26962 	  || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
26963       return 0;
26964     }
26965 
26966   return 1;
26967 }
26968 
26969 /* Hash table routines for file_hash.  */
26970 
26971 bool
26972 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
26973 {
26974   return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
26975 }
26976 
26977 hashval_t
26978 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
26979 {
26980   return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
26981 }
26982 
26983 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
26984    dwarf2out.c) and return its "index".  The index of each (known) filename is
26985    just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename.  We
26986    need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
26987    section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
26988    and .debug_macinfo sections).  If the filename given as an argument is not
26989    found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
26990    available unique index number.  */
26991 
26992 static struct dwarf_file_data *
26993 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
26994 {
26995   struct dwarf_file_data * created;
26996 
26997   if (!file_name)
26998     return NULL;
26999 
27000   dwarf_file_data **slot
27001     = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
27002 				       INSERT);
27003   if (*slot)
27004     return *slot;
27005 
27006   created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
27007   created->filename = file_name;
27008   created->emitted_number = 0;
27009   *slot = created;
27010   return created;
27011 }
27012 
27013 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
27014    internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
27015    a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet.  The file table
27016    numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
27017    types, which may include filenames.  */
27018 
27019 static int
27020 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
27021 {
27022   if (! fd->emitted_number)
27023     {
27024       if (last_emitted_file)
27025 	fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
27026       else
27027 	fd->emitted_number = 1;
27028       last_emitted_file = fd;
27029 
27030       if (output_asm_line_debug_info ())
27031 	{
27032 	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
27033 	  output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
27034 				remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
27035 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27036 	}
27037     }
27038 
27039   return fd->emitted_number;
27040 }
27041 
27042 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
27043    That generation should happen after function debug info has been
27044    generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG.  */
27045 
27046 static void
27047 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
27048 {
27049   die_arg_entry entry;
27050 
27051   if (!die || !arg)
27052     return;
27053 
27054   gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
27055 
27056   if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
27057     vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
27058 
27059   entry.die = die;
27060   entry.arg = arg;
27061   vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
27062 }
27063 
27064 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
27065    otherwise.  */
27066 
27067 static bool
27068 generic_type_p (tree t)
27069 {
27070   if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
27071     return false;
27072   return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
27073 }
27074 
27075 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
27076   instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
27077   done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
27078 
27079 static void
27080 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
27081 {
27082   if (!generic_type_p (t))
27083     return;
27084 
27085   gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
27086 
27087   if (!generic_type_instances)
27088     vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
27089 
27090   vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
27091 }
27092 
27093 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
27094    by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
27095    be called after function DIEs have been generated.  */
27096 
27097 static void
27098 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
27099 {
27100   if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
27101     {
27102       unsigned i, j;
27103       die_arg_entry *e;
27104 
27105       /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
27106 	 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
27107 	 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
27108 	 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
27109 	 For those we try again at late-finish.  */
27110       j = 0;
27111       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
27112 	{
27113 	  if (!e->die->removed
27114 	      && !tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
27115 	    {
27116 	      dw_loc_descr_ref loc = NULL;
27117 	      if (! early_dwarf
27118 		  && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
27119 		loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (e->arg, 2, NULL);
27120 	      if (loc)
27121 		add_AT_loc (e->die, DW_AT_location, loc);
27122 	      else
27123 		(*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
27124 	    }
27125 	}
27126       tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
27127     }
27128 }
27129 
27130 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
27131    that have been previously scheduled by
27132    schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
27133    after all the types of the CU have been laid out.  */
27134 
27135 static void
27136 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
27137 {
27138   unsigned i;
27139   tree t;
27140 
27141   if (!generic_type_instances)
27142     return;
27143 
27144   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
27145     if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
27146       gen_generic_params_dies (t);
27147 
27148   generic_type_instances = NULL;
27149 }
27150 
27151 
27152 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name.  */
27153 
27154 static void
27155 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
27156 {
27157   dw_die_ref die;
27158   dw_attr_node *attr;
27159   const char *dname;
27160 
27161   die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
27162   if (!die)
27163     return;
27164 
27165   dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
27166   if (!dname)
27167     return;
27168 
27169   attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
27170   if (attr)
27171     {
27172       struct indirect_string_node *node;
27173 
27174       node = find_AT_string (dname);
27175       /* replace the string.  */
27176       attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
27177     }
27178 
27179   else
27180     add_name_attribute (die, dname);
27181 }
27182 
27183 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted.  */
27184 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
27185 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
27186    before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0.  */
27187 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
27188 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label.  */
27189 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
27190 
27191 /* Look ahead for a real insn, or for a begin stmt marker.  */
27192 
27193 static rtx_insn *
27194 dwarf2out_next_real_insn (rtx_insn *loc_note)
27195 {
27196   rtx_insn *next_real = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
27197 
27198   while (next_real)
27199     if (INSN_P (next_real))
27200       break;
27201     else
27202       next_real = NEXT_INSN (next_real);
27203 
27204   return next_real;
27205 }
27206 
27207 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location.  We
27208    use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
27209    our lookup table.  */
27210 
27211 static void
27212 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
27213 {
27214   char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
27215   struct var_loc_node *newloc;
27216   rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
27217   rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
27218   static const char *last_label;
27219   static const char *last_postcall_label;
27220   static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
27221   static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
27222   tree decl;
27223   bool var_loc_p;
27224   var_loc_view view = 0;
27225 
27226   if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
27227     {
27228       if (CALL_P (loc_note))
27229 	{
27230 	  maybe_reset_location_view (loc_note, cur_line_info_table);
27231 	  call_site_count++;
27232 	  if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
27233 	    tail_call_site_count++;
27234 	  if (find_reg_note (loc_note, REG_CALL_ARG_LOCATION, NULL_RTX))
27235 	    {
27236 	      call_insn = loc_note;
27237 	      loc_note = NULL;
27238 	      var_loc_p = false;
27239 
27240 	      next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (call_insn);
27241 	      next_note = NULL;
27242 	      cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27243 	      goto create_label;
27244 	    }
27245 	  if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
27246 	    {
27247 	      /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
27248 		 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
27249 		 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
27250 		 sites for them anyway.  */
27251 	      rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
27252 	      if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
27253 		x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
27254 	      if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
27255 		x = SET_SRC (x);
27256 	      if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
27257 		x = XEXP (x, 0);
27258 	      if (!MEM_P (x)
27259 		  || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
27260 		  || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
27261 		  || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
27262 		      != FUNCTION_DECL))
27263 		{
27264 		  call_insn = loc_note;
27265 		  loc_note = NULL;
27266 		  var_loc_p = false;
27267 
27268 		  next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (call_insn);
27269 		  next_note = NULL;
27270 		  cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27271 		  goto create_label;
27272 		}
27273 	    }
27274 	}
27275       else if (!debug_variable_location_views)
27276 	gcc_unreachable ();
27277       else
27278 	maybe_reset_location_view (loc_note, cur_line_info_table);
27279 
27280       return;
27281     }
27282 
27283   var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
27284   if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
27285     return;
27286 
27287   /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
27288      notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn.  If the
27289      next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
27290      calculation for next time.  */
27291   next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
27292   if (next_real)
27293     {
27294       if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
27295 	next_real = NULL;
27296     }
27297 
27298   next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
27299   if (! next_note
27300       || next_note->deleted ()
27301       || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
27302       || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
27303 	  && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_BEGIN_STMT
27304 	  && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_INLINE_ENTRY))
27305     next_note = NULL;
27306 
27307   if (! next_real)
27308     next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (loc_note);
27309 
27310   if (next_note)
27311     {
27312       expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
27313       cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
27314     }
27315   else
27316     cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27317 
27318   /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
27319      don't do anything.  */
27320   if (var_loc_p
27321       && next_real == NULL_RTX
27322       && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
27323     return;
27324 
27325 create_label:
27326 
27327   if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
27328     next_real = get_last_insn ();
27329 
27330   /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
27331      and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
27332      last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time.  */
27333   if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
27334       || last_var_location_insn != next_real
27335       || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
27336     {
27337       last_label = NULL;
27338       last_postcall_label = NULL;
27339     }
27340 
27341   if (var_loc_p)
27342     {
27343       const char *label
27344 	= NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note) ? last_postcall_label : last_label;
27345       view = cur_line_info_table->view;
27346       decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
27347       newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note, label, view);
27348       if (newloc == NULL)
27349 	return;
27350     }
27351   else
27352     {
27353       decl = NULL_TREE;
27354       newloc = NULL;
27355     }
27356 
27357   /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
27358      and this note, use the label we emitted last time.  Otherwise
27359      create a new label and emit it.  */
27360   if (last_label == NULL)
27361     {
27362       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
27363       ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
27364       loclabel_num++;
27365       last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
27366       /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0.  If yes,
27367 	 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label.  */
27368       if (!have_multiple_function_sections
27369 	  && in_first_function_p
27370 	  && maybe_at_text_label_p)
27371 	{
27372 	  static rtx_insn *last_start;
27373 	  rtx_insn *insn;
27374 	  for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
27375 	    if (insn == last_start)
27376 	      break;
27377 	    else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
27378 	      continue;
27379 	    else
27380 	      {
27381 		rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
27382 		if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
27383 		  continue;
27384 		/* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes.  */
27385 		else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
27386 			 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
27387 		  continue;
27388 #ifdef HAVE_ATTR_length /* ??? We don't include insn-attr.h.  */
27389 		else if (HAVE_ATTR_length && get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
27390 		  continue;
27391 #endif
27392 		else
27393 		  {
27394 		    /* Assume insn has non-zero length.  */
27395 		    maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
27396 		    break;
27397 		  }
27398 	      }
27399 	  if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
27400 	    {
27401 	      last_start = loc_note;
27402 	      first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
27403 	    }
27404 	}
27405     }
27406 
27407   gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
27408 	      || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
27409 
27410   if (!var_loc_p)
27411     {
27412       struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
27413 	= ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
27414       rtx_insn *prev = call_insn;
27415 
27416       ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note
27417 	= find_reg_note (call_insn, REG_CALL_ARG_LOCATION, NULL_RTX);
27418       ca_loc->next = NULL;
27419       ca_loc->label = last_label;
27420       gcc_assert (prev
27421 		  && (CALL_P (prev)
27422 		      || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
27423 			  && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
27424 			  && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
27425       if (!CALL_P (prev))
27426 	prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
27427       ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
27428 
27429       /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction.  */
27430       rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
27431       if (x)
27432 	{
27433 	  /* Try to get the call symbol, if any.  */
27434 	  if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
27435 	    x = XEXP (x, 0);
27436 	  /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref.  */
27437 	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
27438 	      && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
27439 	      && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
27440 	    ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
27441 	  /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
27442 	     declaration.  */
27443 	  else if (MEM_P (x)
27444 		   && MEM_EXPR (x)
27445 		   && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
27446 	    ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
27447 	}
27448 
27449       ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
27450       if (call_arg_locations)
27451 	call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
27452       else
27453 	call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
27454       call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
27455     }
27456   else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
27457     {
27458       newloc->label = last_label;
27459       newloc->view = view;
27460     }
27461   else
27462     {
27463       if (!last_postcall_label)
27464 	{
27465 	  sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
27466 	  last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
27467 	}
27468       newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
27469       /* ??? This view is at last_label, not last_label-1, but we
27470 	 could only assume view at last_label-1 is zero if we could
27471 	 assume calls always have length greater than one.  This is
27472 	 probably true in general, though there might be a rare
27473 	 exception to this rule, e.g. if a call insn is optimized out
27474 	 by target magic.  Then, even the -1 in the label will be
27475 	 wrong, which might invalidate the range.  Anyway, using view,
27476 	 though technically possibly incorrect, will work as far as
27477 	 ranges go: since L-1 is in the middle of the call insn,
27478 	 (L-1).0 and (L-1).V shouldn't make any difference, and having
27479 	 the loclist entry refer to the .loc entry might be useful, so
27480 	 leave it like this.  */
27481       newloc->view = view;
27482     }
27483 
27484   if (var_loc_p && flag_debug_asm)
27485     {
27486       const char *name, *sep, *patstr;
27487       if (decl && DECL_NAME (decl))
27488 	name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl));
27489       else
27490 	name = "";
27491       if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
27492 	{
27493 	  sep = " => ";
27494 	  patstr = str_pattern_slim (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note));
27495 	}
27496       else
27497 	{
27498 	  sep = " ";
27499 	  patstr = "RESET";
27500 	}
27501       fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s DEBUG %s%s%s\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
27502 	       name, sep, patstr);
27503     }
27504 
27505   last_var_location_insn = next_real;
27506   last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
27507 }
27508 
27509 /* Check whether BLOCK, a lexical block, is nested within OUTER, or is
27510    OUTER itself.  If BOTHWAYS, check not only that BLOCK can reach
27511    OUTER through BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT links, but also that there is a
27512    path from OUTER to BLOCK through BLOCK_SUBBLOCKs and
27513    BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN links.  */
27514 static bool
27515 block_within_block_p (tree block, tree outer, bool bothways)
27516 {
27517   if (block == outer)
27518     return true;
27519 
27520   /* Quickly check that OUTER is up BLOCK's supercontext chain.  */
27521   for (tree context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
27522        context != outer;
27523        context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (context))
27524     if (!context || TREE_CODE (context) != BLOCK)
27525       return false;
27526 
27527   if (!bothways)
27528     return true;
27529 
27530   /* Now check that each block is actually referenced by its
27531      parent.  */
27532   for (tree context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block); ;
27533        context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (context))
27534     {
27535       if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (context))
27536 	{
27537 	  gcc_assert (!BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (context));
27538 	  context = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (context);
27539 	}
27540       for (tree sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (context);
27541 	   sub != block;
27542 	   sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
27543 	if (!sub)
27544 	  return false;
27545       if (context == outer)
27546 	return true;
27547       else
27548 	block = context;
27549     }
27550 }
27551 
27552 /* Called during final while assembling the marker of the entry point
27553    for an inlined function.  */
27554 
27555 static void
27556 dwarf2out_inline_entry (tree block)
27557 {
27558   gcc_assert (debug_inline_points);
27559 
27560   /* If we can't represent it, don't bother.  */
27561   if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
27562     return;
27563 
27564   gcc_assert (DECL_P (block_ultimate_origin (block)));
27565 
27566   /* Sanity check the block tree.  This would catch a case in which
27567      BLOCK got removed from the tree reachable from the outermost
27568      lexical block, but got retained in markers.  It would still link
27569      back to its parents, but some ancestor would be missing a link
27570      down the path to the sub BLOCK.  If the block got removed, its
27571      BLOCK_NUMBER will not be a usable value.  */
27572   if (flag_checking)
27573     gcc_assert (block_within_block_p (block,
27574 				      DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl),
27575 				      true));
27576 
27577   gcc_assert (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (block));
27578   gcc_assert (!BLOCK_DIE (block));
27579 
27580   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block))
27581     block = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block);
27582   /* Can the entry point ever not be at the beginning of an
27583      unfragmented lexical block?  */
27584   else if (!(BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (block)
27585 	     || (cur_line_info_table
27586 		 && !ZERO_VIEW_P (cur_line_info_table->view))))
27587     return;
27588 
27589   if (!inline_entry_data_table)
27590     inline_entry_data_table
27591       = hash_table<inline_entry_data_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27592 
27593 
27594   inline_entry_data **iedp
27595     = inline_entry_data_table->find_slot_with_hash (block,
27596 						    htab_hash_pointer (block),
27597 						    INSERT);
27598   if (*iedp)
27599     /* ??? Ideally, we'd record all entry points for the same inlined
27600        function (some may have been duplicated by e.g. unrolling), but
27601        we have no way to represent that ATM.  */
27602     return;
27603 
27604   inline_entry_data *ied = *iedp = ggc_cleared_alloc<inline_entry_data> ();
27605   ied->block = block;
27606   ied->label_pfx = BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL;
27607   ied->label_num = BLOCK_NUMBER (block);
27608   if (cur_line_info_table)
27609     ied->view = cur_line_info_table->view;
27610 
27611   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27612 
27613   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL,
27614 			       BLOCK_NUMBER (block));
27615   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
27616 }
27617 
27618 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
27619    can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
27620    structures.  */
27621 
27622 static void
27623 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
27624 {
27625   function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
27626 }
27627 
27628 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed.  */
27629 
27630 int
27631 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
27632 {
27633   var_loc_list *list = *slot;
27634   if (list->first)
27635     list->last_before_switch
27636       = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
27637   return 1;
27638 }
27639 
27640 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed.  */
27641 
27642 static void
27643 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
27644 {
27645   if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
27646     return;
27647 
27648   decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
27649 }
27650 
27651 /* Create a new line number table.  */
27652 
27653 static dw_line_info_table *
27654 new_line_info_table (void)
27655 {
27656   dw_line_info_table *table;
27657 
27658   table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
27659   table->file_num = 1;
27660   table->line_num = 1;
27661   table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
27662   FORCE_RESET_NEXT_VIEW (table->view);
27663   table->symviews_since_reset = 0;
27664 
27665   return table;
27666 }
27667 
27668 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
27669    that we don't have to do it for every source line.  */
27670 
27671 static void
27672 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
27673 {
27674   dw_line_info_table *table;
27675 
27676   if (sec == text_section)
27677     table = text_section_line_info;
27678   else if (sec == cold_text_section)
27679     {
27680       table = cold_text_section_line_info;
27681       if (!table)
27682 	{
27683 	  cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
27684 	  table->end_label = cold_end_label;
27685 	}
27686     }
27687   else
27688     {
27689       const char *end_label;
27690 
27691       if (crtl->has_bb_partition)
27692 	{
27693 	  if (in_cold_section_p)
27694 	    end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
27695 	  else
27696 	    end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
27697 	}
27698       else
27699 	{
27700 	  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27701 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
27702 				       current_function_funcdef_no);
27703 	  end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
27704 	}
27705 
27706       table = new_line_info_table ();
27707       table->end_label = end_label;
27708 
27709       vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
27710     }
27711 
27712   if (output_asm_line_debug_info ())
27713     table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
27714 		      ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
27715 		      : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
27716   cur_line_info_table = table;
27717 }
27718 
27719 
27720 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
27721    function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
27722    declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
27723    that hook is called.  Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here.  */
27724 
27725 static void
27726 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
27727 {
27728   section *sec = function_section (fun);
27729 
27730   if (sec != text_section)
27731     have_multiple_function_sections = true;
27732 
27733   if (crtl->has_bb_partition && !cold_text_section)
27734     {
27735       gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
27736       cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
27737       switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
27738       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
27739       switch_to_section (sec);
27740     }
27741 
27742   dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
27743   call_site_count = 0;
27744   tail_call_site_count = 0;
27745 
27746   set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
27747   FORCE_RESET_NEXT_VIEW (cur_line_info_table->view);
27748 }
27749 
27750 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
27751    the very first function into assembly.  Check if some .debug_loc range
27752    might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
27753    In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
27754    because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
27755    .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
27756    list terminator.
27757    Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
27758    terminate htab traversal.  */
27759 
27760 int
27761 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
27762 {
27763   var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
27764   struct var_loc_node *node;
27765 
27766   node = entry->first;
27767   if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
27768     {
27769       unsigned int i;
27770       const char *label = node->next->label;
27771       char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27772 
27773       for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
27774 	{
27775 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
27776 	  if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
27777 	    {
27778 	      have_multiple_function_sections = true;
27779 	      return 0;
27780 	    }
27781 	}
27782     }
27783   return 1;
27784 }
27785 
27786 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
27787    This does something only for the very first function emitted.  */
27788 
27789 static void
27790 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
27791 {
27792   if (in_first_function_p
27793       && !have_multiple_function_sections
27794       && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
27795       && decl_loc_table)
27796     decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
27797   in_first_function_p = false;
27798   maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
27799 }
27800 
27801 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit.  Used to let
27802    front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
27803    called.  */
27804 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
27805 
27806 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
27807    Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT.  */
27808 
27809 static void
27810 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
27811 {
27812   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
27813 	      && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
27814   main_translation_unit = unit;
27815   /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
27816      itself looking at main_translation_unit.  */
27817   if (decl_die_table != NULL)
27818     equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
27819 }
27820 
27821 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE.  */
27822 
27823 static void
27824 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
27825 			 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
27826 {
27827   dw_line_info_entry e;
27828   e.opcode = opcode;
27829   e.val = val;
27830   vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
27831 }
27832 
27833 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
27834    and record information relating to this source line, in
27835    'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section.  */
27836 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned.  */
27837 
27838 static void
27839 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, unsigned int column,
27840 		       const char *filename,
27841                        int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
27842 {
27843   unsigned int file_num;
27844   dw_line_info_table *table;
27845   static var_loc_view lvugid;
27846 
27847   if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
27848     return;
27849 
27850   table = cur_line_info_table;
27851 
27852   if (line == 0)
27853     {
27854       if (debug_variable_location_views
27855 	  && output_asm_line_debug_info ()
27856 	  && table && !RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27857 	{
27858 	  /* If we're using the assembler to compute view numbers, we
27859 	     can't issue a .loc directive for line zero, so we can't
27860 	     get a view number at this point.  We might attempt to
27861 	     compute it from the previous view, or equate it to a
27862 	     subsequent view (though it might not be there!), but
27863 	     since we're omitting the line number entry, we might as
27864 	     well omit the view number as well.  That means pretending
27865 	     it's a view number zero, which might very well turn out
27866 	     to be correct.  ??? Extend the assembler so that the
27867 	     compiler could emit e.g. ".locview .LVU#", to output a
27868 	     view without changing line number information.  We'd then
27869 	     have to count it in symviews_since_reset; when it's omitted,
27870 	     it doesn't count.  */
27871 	  if (!zero_view_p)
27872 	    zero_view_p = BITMAP_GGC_ALLOC ();
27873 	  bitmap_set_bit (zero_view_p, table->view);
27874 	  if (flag_debug_asm)
27875 	    {
27876 	      char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27877 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", table->view);
27878 	      fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s line 0, omitted view ",
27879 		       ASM_COMMENT_START);
27880 	      assemble_name (asm_out_file, label);
27881 	      putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27882 	    }
27883 	  table->view = ++lvugid;
27884 	}
27885       return;
27886     }
27887 
27888   /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4.  Simplify the below
27889      by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it.  */
27890   if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
27891     discriminator = 0;
27892 
27893   if (!debug_column_info)
27894     column = 0;
27895 
27896   file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
27897 
27898   /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries.  Traditionally,
27899      the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
27900      at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
27901      We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function.  For
27902      Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
27903      that second line number entry.  */
27904   /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
27905      as the end_prologue debug hook.  The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
27906      to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
27907      emitted by gen_prologue.  What we need is to precede the first insn
27908      that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
27909      insn that corresponds to something the user wrote.  These may be
27910      very different locations once scheduling is enabled.  */
27911 
27912   if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
27913       && line == table->line_num
27914       && column == table->column_num
27915       && discriminator == table->discrim_num
27916       && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
27917     return;
27918 
27919   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
27920 
27921   /* If requested, emit something human-readable.  */
27922   if (flag_debug_asm)
27923     {
27924       if (debug_column_info)
27925 	fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
27926 		 filename, line, column);
27927       else
27928 	fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
27929 		 filename, line);
27930     }
27931 
27932   if (output_asm_line_debug_info ())
27933     {
27934       /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as.  */
27935       /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
27936 	 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
27937       fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
27938       fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
27939       putc (' ', asm_out_file);
27940       fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
27941       putc (' ', asm_out_file);
27942       fprint_ul (asm_out_file, column);
27943 
27944       if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
27945 	{
27946 	  fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
27947 	  putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
27948 	}
27949       if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
27950 	{
27951 	  gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
27952 	  fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
27953 	  fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
27954 	}
27955       if (debug_variable_location_views)
27956 	{
27957 	  if (!RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27958 	    {
27959 	      table->symviews_since_reset++;
27960 	      if (table->symviews_since_reset > symview_upper_bound)
27961 		symview_upper_bound = table->symviews_since_reset;
27962 	      /* When we're using the assembler to compute view
27963 		 numbers, we output symbolic labels after "view" in
27964 		 .loc directives, and the assembler will set them for
27965 		 us, so that we can refer to the view numbers in
27966 		 location lists.  The only exceptions are when we know
27967 		 a view will be zero: "-0" is a forced reset, used
27968 		 e.g. in the beginning of functions, whereas "0" tells
27969 		 the assembler to check that there was a PC change
27970 		 since the previous view, in a way that implicitly
27971 		 resets the next view.  */
27972 	      fputs (" view ", asm_out_file);
27973 	      char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27974 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", table->view);
27975 	      assemble_name (asm_out_file, label);
27976 	      table->view = ++lvugid;
27977 	    }
27978 	  else
27979 	    {
27980 	      table->symviews_since_reset = 0;
27981 	      if (FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27982 		fputs (" view -0", asm_out_file);
27983 	      else
27984 		fputs (" view 0", asm_out_file);
27985 	      /* Mark the present view as a zero view.  Earlier debug
27986 		 binds may have already added its id to loclists to be
27987 		 emitted later, so we can't reuse the id for something
27988 		 else.  However, it's good to know whether a view is
27989 		 known to be zero, because then we may be able to
27990 		 optimize out locviews that are all zeros, so take
27991 		 note of it in zero_view_p.  */
27992 	      if (!zero_view_p)
27993 		zero_view_p = BITMAP_GGC_ALLOC ();
27994 	      bitmap_set_bit (zero_view_p, lvugid);
27995 	      table->view = ++lvugid;
27996 	    }
27997 	}
27998       putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27999     }
28000   else
28001     {
28002       unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
28003 
28004       targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
28005 
28006       if (debug_variable_location_views && !RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
28007 	push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_adv_address, label_num);
28008       else
28009 	push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
28010       if (debug_variable_location_views)
28011 	{
28012 	  bool resetting = FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view);
28013 	  if (resetting)
28014 	    table->view = 0;
28015 
28016 	  if (flag_debug_asm)
28017 	    fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s view %s%d\n",
28018 		     ASM_COMMENT_START,
28019 		     resetting ? "-" : "",
28020 		     table->view);
28021 
28022 	  table->view++;
28023 	}
28024       if (file_num != table->file_num)
28025 	push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
28026       if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
28027 	push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
28028       if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
28029 	push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
28030       push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
28031       if (debug_column_info)
28032 	push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_column, column);
28033     }
28034 
28035   table->file_num = file_num;
28036   table->line_num = line;
28037   table->column_num = column;
28038   table->discrim_num = discriminator;
28039   table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
28040   table->in_use = true;
28041 }
28042 
28043 /* Record the beginning of a new source file.  */
28044 
28045 static void
28046 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
28047 {
28048   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28049     {
28050       macinfo_entry e;
28051       e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
28052       e.lineno = lineno;
28053       e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
28054       vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28055     }
28056 }
28057 
28058 /* Record the end of a source file.  */
28059 
28060 static void
28061 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
28062 {
28063   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28064     {
28065       macinfo_entry e;
28066       e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
28067       e.lineno = lineno;
28068       e.info = NULL;
28069       vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28070     }
28071 }
28072 
28073 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
28074    the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
28075    initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
28076 
28077 static void
28078 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
28079 		  const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
28080 {
28081   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28082     {
28083       macinfo_entry e;
28084       /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
28085 	 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import.  */
28086       if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
28087 	{
28088 	  e.code = 0;
28089 	  e.lineno = 0;
28090 	  e.info = NULL;
28091 	  vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28092 	}
28093       e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
28094       e.lineno = lineno;
28095       e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
28096       vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28097     }
28098 }
28099 
28100 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
28101    the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
28102    initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
28103 
28104 static void
28105 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
28106 		 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
28107 {
28108   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28109     {
28110       macinfo_entry e;
28111       /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
28112 	 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import.  */
28113       if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
28114 	{
28115 	  e.code = 0;
28116 	  e.lineno = 0;
28117 	  e.info = NULL;
28118 	  vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28119 	}
28120       e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
28121       e.lineno = lineno;
28122       e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
28123       vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28124     }
28125 }
28126 
28127 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs.  */
28128 
28129 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
28130 {
28131   static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
28132   static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
28133 };
28134 
28135 inline hashval_t
28136 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
28137 {
28138   return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
28139 }
28140 
28141 inline bool
28142 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
28143 			     const macinfo_entry *entry2)
28144 {
28145   return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
28146 }
28147 
28148 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
28149 
28150 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry.  */
28151 
28152 static void
28153 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
28154 {
28155   int file_num;
28156   size_t len;
28157   struct indirect_string_node *node;
28158   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
28159   struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
28160 
28161   switch (ref->code)
28162     {
28163     case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
28164       fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
28165       file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
28166       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
28167       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
28168 				   "Included from line number %lu",
28169 				   (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
28170       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
28171       break;
28172     case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
28173       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
28174       break;
28175     case DW_MACINFO_define:
28176     case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28177       len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
28178       if (!dwarf_strict
28179 	  && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
28180 	  && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
28181 	  && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
28182 	{
28183 	  ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
28184 		      ? DW_MACRO_define_strp : DW_MACRO_undef_strp;
28185 	  output_macinfo_op (ref);
28186 	  return;
28187 	}
28188       dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
28189 			   ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
28190 			   ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
28191       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
28192 				   (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
28193       dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
28194       break;
28195     case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
28196     case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
28197       node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
28198       gcc_assert (node
28199 		  && (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
28200 		      || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index));
28201       dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
28202 			   ref->code == DW_MACRO_define_strp
28203 			   ? "Define macro strp"
28204 			   : "Undefine macro strp");
28205       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
28206 				   (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
28207       if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
28208         dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
28209                                debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
28210                                ref->info);
28211       else
28212         dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
28213                                      ref->info);
28214       break;
28215     case DW_MACRO_import:
28216       dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Import");
28217       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
28218 				   DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
28219 				   ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
28220       dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
28221       break;
28222     default:
28223       fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
28224 	       ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
28225       break;
28226     }
28227 }
28228 
28229 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
28230    other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections.  IDX is the first
28231    index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
28232    emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
28233    a DW_MACRO_import entry referencing it.
28234    If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0.  */
28235 
28236 static unsigned
28237 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
28238 			macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
28239 {
28240   macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
28241   char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
28242   unsigned char checksum[16];
28243   struct md5_ctx ctx;
28244   char *grp_name, *tail;
28245   const char *base;
28246   unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
28247   macinfo_entry **slot;
28248 
28249   first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
28250   second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
28251 
28252   /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
28253      and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
28254      with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
28255      in some included header file.  */
28256   if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
28257     return 0;
28258   if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
28259     {
28260       if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
28261 	return 0;
28262     }
28263   else if (first->lineno == 0)
28264     return 0;
28265 
28266   /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
28267      with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
28268      codes, linenumbers and strings.  */
28269   md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
28270   for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
28271     if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
28272       break;
28273     else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
28274       break;
28275     else
28276       {
28277 	unsigned char code = cur->code;
28278 	md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
28279 	checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
28280 	md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
28281       }
28282   md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
28283   count = i - idx;
28284 
28285   /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
28286      usable characters from its basename.  */
28287   if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
28288     base = "";
28289   else
28290     base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
28291   for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
28292     if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
28293       encoded_filename_len++;
28294   /* Count . at the end.  */
28295   if (encoded_filename_len)
28296     encoded_filename_len++;
28297 
28298   sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
28299   linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
28300 
28301   /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum>  */
28302   grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
28303 			 + 16 * 2 + 1);
28304   memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
28305   tail = grp_name + 4;
28306   if (encoded_filename_len)
28307     {
28308       for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
28309 	if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
28310 	  *tail++ = base[i];
28311       *tail++ = '.';
28312     }
28313   memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
28314   tail += linebuf_len;
28315   *tail++ = '.';
28316   for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
28317     sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
28318 
28319   /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_import
28320      in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef.  */
28321   inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
28322   inc->code = DW_MACRO_import;
28323   inc->lineno = 0;
28324   inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
28325   if (!*macinfo_htab)
28326     *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
28327   /* Avoid emitting duplicates.  */
28328   slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
28329   if (*slot != NULL)
28330     {
28331       inc->code = 0;
28332       inc->info = NULL;
28333       /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
28334 	 a DW_MACRO_import op.  */
28335       inc = *slot;
28336       output_macinfo_op (inc);
28337       /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
28338 	 in the second pass.  */
28339       for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
28340 	{
28341 	  cur->code = 0;
28342 	  cur->info = NULL;
28343 	}
28344     }
28345   else
28346     {
28347       *slot = inc;
28348       inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
28349       output_macinfo_op (inc);
28350     }
28351   return count;
28352 }
28353 
28354 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
28355    table.  All strings must be collected into the table by the time
28356    index_string is called.  */
28357 
28358 static void
28359 save_macinfo_strings (void)
28360 {
28361   unsigned len;
28362   unsigned i;
28363   macinfo_entry *ref;
28364 
28365   for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
28366     {
28367       switch (ref->code)
28368         {
28369           /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
28370              indirect strings.  */
28371           case DW_MACINFO_define:
28372           case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28373             len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
28374             if (!dwarf_strict
28375                 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
28376                 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
28377                 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
28378               set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
28379             break;
28380 	  case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
28381 	  case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
28382             set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
28383             break;
28384           default:
28385             break;
28386         }
28387     }
28388 }
28389 
28390 /* Output macinfo section(s).  */
28391 
28392 static void
28393 output_macinfo (const char *debug_line_label, bool early_lto_debug)
28394 {
28395   unsigned i;
28396   unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
28397   macinfo_entry *ref;
28398   vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
28399   macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
28400   char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
28401 
28402   if (! length)
28403     return;
28404 
28405   /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably.  */
28406   gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_define
28407 	      && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_undef
28408 	      && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_start_file
28409 	      && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_end_file);
28410 
28411   /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
28412      offset expected by debuggers.  */
28413   strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_label);
28414   if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
28415     strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
28416 
28417   /* For .debug_macro emit the section header.  */
28418   if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28419     {
28420       dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
28421 			   "DWARF macro version number");
28422       if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
28423 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
28424       else
28425 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
28426       dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_line_label,
28427                              debug_line_section, NULL);
28428     }
28429 
28430   /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
28431      and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
28432      If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
28433      DW_MACRO_import, the DW_MACRO_import op is emitted and kept in
28434      the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
28435      whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept.  */
28436   for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
28437     {
28438       switch (ref->code)
28439 	{
28440 	case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
28441 	  vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
28442 	  break;
28443 	case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
28444 	  if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
28445 	    files->pop ();
28446 	  break;
28447 	case DW_MACINFO_define:
28448 	case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28449 	  if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28450 	      && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
28451 	      && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
28452 	      && i > 0
28453 	      && i + 1 < length
28454 	      && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
28455 	    {
28456 	      unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
28457 	      if (count)
28458 		{
28459 		  i += count - 1;
28460 		  continue;
28461 		}
28462 	    }
28463 	  break;
28464 	case 0:
28465 	  /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
28466 	     to optimize the whole block of predefined macros.  */
28467 	  if (i == 0)
28468 	    continue;
28469 	default:
28470 	  break;
28471 	}
28472       output_macinfo_op (ref);
28473       ref->info = NULL;
28474       ref->code = 0;
28475     }
28476 
28477   if (!macinfo_htab)
28478     return;
28479 
28480   /* Save the number of transparent includes so we can adjust the
28481      label number for the fat LTO object DWARF.  */
28482   unsigned macinfo_label_base_adj = macinfo_htab->elements ();
28483 
28484   delete macinfo_htab;
28485   macinfo_htab = NULL;
28486 
28487   /* If any DW_MACRO_import were used, on those DW_MACRO_import entries
28488      terminate the current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
28489      section and emit the define/undef entries within it.  */
28490   for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
28491     switch (ref->code)
28492       {
28493       case 0:
28494 	continue;
28495       case DW_MACRO_import:
28496 	{
28497 	  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
28498 	  tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
28499 	  /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section.  */
28500 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
28501 	  targetm.asm_out.named_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28502 					 SECTION_DEBUG
28503 					 | SECTION_LINKONCE
28504 					 | (early_lto_debug
28505 					    ? SECTION_EXCLUDE : 0),
28506 					 comdat_key);
28507 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
28508 				       DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
28509 				       ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
28510 	  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
28511 	  ref->code = 0;
28512 	  ref->info = NULL;
28513 	  dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
28514 			       "DWARF macro version number");
28515 	  if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
28516 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
28517 	  else
28518 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
28519 	}
28520 	break;
28521       case DW_MACINFO_define:
28522       case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28523 	output_macinfo_op (ref);
28524 	ref->code = 0;
28525 	ref->info = NULL;
28526 	break;
28527       default:
28528 	gcc_unreachable ();
28529       }
28530 
28531   macinfo_label_base += macinfo_label_base_adj;
28532 }
28533 
28534 /* Initialize the various sections and labels for dwarf output and prefix
28535    them with PREFIX if non-NULL.  Returns the generation (zero based
28536    number of times function was called).  */
28537 
28538 static unsigned
28539 init_sections_and_labels (bool early_lto_debug)
28540 {
28541   /* As we may get called multiple times have a generation count for
28542      labels.  */
28543   static unsigned generation = 0;
28544 
28545   if (early_lto_debug)
28546     {
28547       if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28548 	{
28549 	  debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
28550 					    SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28551 					    NULL);
28552 	  debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28553 					      SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28554 					      NULL);
28555 	  debug_macinfo_section_name
28556 	    = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28557 	       ? DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION);
28558 	  debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28559 					       SECTION_DEBUG
28560 					       | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28561 	}
28562       else
28563 	{
28564 	  /* ???  Which of the following do we need early?  */
28565 	  debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
28566 					    SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28567 					    NULL);
28568 	  debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28569 					      SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28570 					      NULL);
28571 	  debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
28572 						     SECTION_DEBUG
28573 						     | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28574 	  debug_skeleton_abbrev_section
28575 	    = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28576 			   SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28577 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
28578 				       DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
28579 				       generation);
28580 
28581 	  /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
28582 	     stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split
28583 	     off dwo.  */
28584 	  debug_skeleton_line_section
28585 	    = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
28586 			   SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28587 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
28588 				       DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
28589 				       generation);
28590 	  debug_str_offsets_section
28591 	    = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
28592 			   SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28593 			   NULL);
28594 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
28595 				       DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
28596 				       generation);
28597 	  debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION,
28598 					       DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
28599 					       NULL);
28600 	  debug_macinfo_section_name
28601 	    = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28602 	       ? DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
28603 	  debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28604 					       SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28605 					       NULL);
28606 	}
28607       /* For macro info and the file table we have to refer to a
28608 	 debug_line section.  */
28609       debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
28610 					SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28611       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
28612 				   DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28613 
28614       debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION,
28615 				       DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
28616 				       | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28617       if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28618 	debug_line_str_section
28619 	  = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION,
28620 			 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28621     }
28622   else
28623     {
28624       if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28625 	{
28626 	  debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
28627 					    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28628 	  debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
28629 					      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28630 	  debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
28631 					   ? DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
28632 					   : DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
28633 					   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28634 	  debug_macinfo_section_name
28635 	    = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28636 	       ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION);
28637 	  debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28638 					       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28639 	}
28640       else
28641 	{
28642 	  debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
28643 					    SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28644 					    NULL);
28645 	  debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28646 					      SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28647 					      NULL);
28648 	  debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
28649 					    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28650 	  debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
28651 						     SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28652 	  debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
28653 						       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28654 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
28655 				       DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
28656 				       generation);
28657 
28658 	  /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
28659 	     stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the
28660 	     split off dwo.  */
28661 	  debug_skeleton_line_section
28662 	      = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
28663 			     SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28664 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
28665 				       DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
28666 				       generation);
28667 	  debug_str_offsets_section
28668 	    = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
28669 			   SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28670 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
28671 				       DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
28672 				       generation);
28673 	  debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
28674 					   ? DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
28675 					   : DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
28676 					   SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28677 					   NULL);
28678 	  debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
28679 					       DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
28680 					       NULL);
28681 	  debug_macinfo_section_name
28682 	    = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28683 	       ? DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
28684 	  debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28685 					       SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28686 					       NULL);
28687 	}
28688       debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
28689 					   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28690       debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
28691 					SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28692       debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
28693 					    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28694       debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
28695 					    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28696       debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
28697 				       DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
28698       if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !output_asm_line_debug_info ())
28699 	debug_line_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION,
28700 					      DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
28701 
28702       debug_ranges_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
28703 					  ? DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
28704 					  : DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
28705 					  SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28706       debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
28707 					 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28708     }
28709 
28710   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
28711 			       DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28712   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
28713 			       DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28714   info_section_emitted = false;
28715   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
28716 			       DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28717   /* There are up to 4 unique ranges labels per generation.
28718      See also output_rnglists.  */
28719   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
28720 			       DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, generation * 4);
28721   if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
28722     ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_base_label,
28723 				 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
28724 				 1 + generation * 4);
28725   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
28726 			       DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28727   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
28728 			       (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28729 			       ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
28730 			       : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28731   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL,
28732 			       generation);
28733 
28734   ++generation;
28735   return generation - 1;
28736 }
28737 
28738 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation.  */
28739 
28740 static void
28741 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
28742 {
28743   /* Allocate the file_table.  */
28744   file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
28745 
28746 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
28747   /* Allocate the decl_die_table.  */
28748   decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
28749 
28750   /* Allocate the decl_loc_table.  */
28751   decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
28752 
28753   /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table.  */
28754   cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
28755 
28756   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table.  */
28757   vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
28758 
28759   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table.  */
28760   vec_alloc (abbrev_die_table, 256);
28761   /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
28762   abbrev_die_table->quick_push (NULL);
28763 
28764   /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map.  */
28765   dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
28766 
28767   /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors.  */
28768   vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
28769   vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
28770 
28771   vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
28772 
28773   vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
28774 
28775   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28776     vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
28777 #endif
28778 
28779   /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
28780      ready to perform the association, do this now.  */
28781   if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
28782     equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
28783 }
28784 
28785 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
28786    and toplevel asms into assembly.  */
28787 
28788 static void
28789 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
28790 {
28791   if (text_section_line_info)
28792     return;
28793 
28794 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
28795   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
28796   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
28797   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
28798 			       COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
28799   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
28800 
28801   switch_to_section (text_section);
28802   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
28803 #endif
28804 
28805   /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists.  */
28806   text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
28807   text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
28808 
28809 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
28810   cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
28811 #endif
28812 
28813   if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
28814       && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
28815       && !dwarf2out_do_eh_frame ())
28816     fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
28817 }
28818 
28819 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
28820    htab_traverse.  Assign a string its index.  All strings must be
28821    collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
28822    because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
28823    in the same order for each run. */
28824 
28825 int
28826 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
28827 {
28828   indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28829 
28830   find_string_form (node);
28831   if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
28832     {
28833       gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
28834       node->index = *index;
28835       *index += 1;
28836     }
28837   return 1;
28838 }
28839 
28840 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
28841    htab_traverse.  Output the offset to a string and update the
28842    current offset.  */
28843 
28844 int
28845 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
28846 {
28847   indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28848 
28849   if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
28850     {
28851       /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index.  */
28852       gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
28853                   && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
28854       dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
28855                            "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
28856       *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
28857     }
28858   return 1;
28859 }
28860 
28861 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
28862    htab_traverse.  Output the indexed string.  */
28863 
28864 int
28865 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
28866 {
28867   struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28868 
28869   if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
28870     {
28871       /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
28872          indexes were assigned.  */
28873       gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
28874       assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
28875       *cur_idx += 1;
28876     }
28877   return 1;
28878 }
28879 
28880 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
28881    htab_traverse.  Emit one queued .debug_str string.  */
28882 
28883 int
28884 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, enum dwarf_form form)
28885 {
28886   struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28887 
28888   node->form = find_string_form (node);
28889   if (node->form == form && node->refcount > 0)
28890     {
28891       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
28892       assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
28893     }
28894 
28895   return 1;
28896 }
28897 
28898 /* Output the indexed string table.  */
28899 
28900 static void
28901 output_indirect_strings (void)
28902 {
28903   switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
28904   if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28905     debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
28906 			     output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
28907   else
28908     {
28909       unsigned int offset = 0;
28910       unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
28911 
28912       if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
28913         skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
28914 					  output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
28915 
28916       switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
28917       debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
28918 	<unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
28919       switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
28920       debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
28921 	(&cur_idx);
28922     }
28923 }
28924 
28925 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
28926    table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section.  */
28927 
28928 int
28929 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
28930 {
28931   addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
28932 
28933   if (entry->refcount == 0)
28934     {
28935       gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
28936                   || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
28937       return 1;
28938     }
28939 
28940   gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
28941   (*cur_index)++;
28942 
28943   switch (entry->kind)
28944     {
28945       case ate_kind_rtx:
28946         dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
28947                                  "0x%x", entry->index);
28948         break;
28949       case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
28950         gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
28951         targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
28952                                              DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
28953                                              entry->addr.rtl);
28954         fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
28955         break;
28956       case ate_kind_label:
28957         dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
28958                                  "0x%x", entry->index);
28959         break;
28960       default:
28961         gcc_unreachable ();
28962     }
28963   return 1;
28964 }
28965 
28966 /* Produce the .debug_addr section.  */
28967 
28968 static void
28969 output_addr_table (void)
28970 {
28971   unsigned int index = 0;
28972   if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
28973     return;
28974 
28975   switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
28976   addr_index_table
28977     ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
28978 }
28979 
28980 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
28981 /* Verify that all marks are clear.  */
28982 
28983 static void
28984 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
28985 {
28986   dw_die_ref c;
28987 
28988   gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
28989   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
28990 }
28991 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
28992 
28993 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
28994    Be cool if the mark isn't set.  */
28995 
28996 static void
28997 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
28998 {
28999   dw_die_ref c;
29000 
29001   if (die->die_mark)
29002     die->die_mark = 0;
29003   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
29004 }
29005 
29006 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
29007    referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used.  */
29008 
29009 static void
29010 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29011 {
29012   for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
29013     switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29014       {
29015       case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29016       case DW_OP_convert:
29017       case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29018       case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29019       case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29020       case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29021 	if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
29022 	  prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
29023 	break;
29024       case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
29025 	if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
29026 	  {
29027 	    dw_die_ref ref
29028 	      = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
29029 	    if (ref == NULL)
29030 	      break;
29031 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29032 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
29033 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29034 	  }
29035 	/* FALLTHRU */
29036       case DW_OP_call2:
29037       case DW_OP_call4:
29038       case DW_OP_call_ref:
29039       case DW_OP_const_type:
29040       case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29041       case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
29042 	gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
29043 	prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
29044 	break;
29045       case DW_OP_regval_type:
29046       case DW_OP_deref_type:
29047       case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29048       case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29049 	gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
29050 	prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
29051 	break;
29052       case DW_OP_entry_value:
29053       case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29054 	gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
29055 	prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
29056 	break;
29057       default:
29058 	break;
29059       }
29060 }
29061 
29062 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
29063    it references as attributes and mark them as used.  */
29064 
29065 static void
29066 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
29067 {
29068   dw_attr_node *a;
29069   unsigned ix;
29070 
29071   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29072     {
29073       switch (AT_class (a))
29074 	{
29075 	/* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
29076 	   get emitted.  */
29077 	case dw_val_class_loc:
29078 	  prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
29079 	  break;
29080 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
29081 	  for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29082 	       list != NULL;
29083 	       list = list->dw_loc_next)
29084 	    prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
29085 	  break;
29086 
29087 	case dw_val_class_view_list:
29088 	  /* This points to a loc_list in another attribute, so it's
29089 	     already covered.  */
29090 	  break;
29091 
29092 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
29093 	  /* A reference to another DIE.
29094 	     Make sure that it will get emitted.
29095 	     If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it.  */
29096           if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
29097               || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
29098 	    prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
29099 	  break;
29100 
29101 	case dw_val_class_str:
29102 	  /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
29103 	     accounts properly for it.  */
29104 	  a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
29105 	  break;
29106 
29107 	default:
29108 	  break;
29109 	}
29110     }
29111 }
29112 
29113 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE.  */
29114 
29115 static void
29116 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
29117 {
29118   dw_die_ref c;
29119 
29120   if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
29121     return;
29122   c = die->die_child;
29123   do
29124     {
29125       if (is_template_parameter (c))
29126 	prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
29127       c = c->die_sib;
29128     } while (c && c != die->die_child);
29129 }
29130 
29131 /* Mark DIE as being used.  If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
29132    to DIE's children.  */
29133 
29134 static void
29135 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
29136 {
29137   dw_die_ref c;
29138 
29139   if (die->die_mark == 0)
29140     {
29141       /* We haven't done this node yet.  Mark it as used.  */
29142       die->die_mark = 1;
29143       /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
29144 	 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
29145 	 args.  */
29146       prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
29147 
29148       /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
29149 	 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
29150 	 unless it is a class.)  */
29151       if (die->die_parent)
29152 	prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
29153 				 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
29154 
29155       /* Mark any referenced nodes.  */
29156       prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
29157 
29158       /* If this node is a specification,
29159 	 also mark the definition, if it exists.  */
29160       if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
29161 	prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
29162     }
29163 
29164   if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
29165     {
29166       /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
29167 	 Remember that we've walked the kids.  */
29168       die->die_mark = 2;
29169 
29170       /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
29171 	 kids get marked, even if they're types.  If we're
29172 	 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
29173 	 for all type definitions.  */
29174       if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
29175           || (use_debug_types
29176               && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
29177 	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
29178       else
29179 	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
29180     }
29181 }
29182 
29183 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
29184    and if so, mark them.  */
29185 
29186 static void
29187 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
29188 {
29189   dw_die_ref c;
29190 
29191   if (die->die_mark == 2)
29192     return;
29193 
29194   switch (die->die_tag)
29195     {
29196     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
29197     case DW_TAG_union_type:
29198     case DW_TAG_class_type:
29199       break;
29200 
29201     case DW_TAG_subprogram:
29202       if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
29203 	  || die->die_definition != NULL)
29204 	prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
29205       return;
29206 
29207     default:
29208       return;
29209     }
29210 
29211   /* Mark children.  */
29212   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
29213 }
29214 
29215 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use.  */
29216 
29217 static void
29218 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
29219 {
29220   dw_die_ref c;
29221 
29222   /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
29223      children have been marked as well.  */
29224   if (die->die_mark == 2)
29225     return;
29226 
29227   switch (die->die_tag)
29228     {
29229     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
29230     case DW_TAG_union_type:
29231     case DW_TAG_class_type:
29232       if (die->die_perennial_p)
29233 	break;
29234 
29235       for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
29236 	if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
29237 	  break;
29238 
29239       /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
29240 	 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
29241 	 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
29242 	 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type.  If we ever change
29243 	 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes.  */
29244       if (c)
29245 	prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
29246 
29247       /* It's a type node --- don't mark it.  */
29248       return;
29249 
29250     case DW_TAG_const_type:
29251     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
29252     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
29253     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
29254     case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
29255     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
29256     case DW_TAG_typedef:
29257     case DW_TAG_array_type:
29258     case DW_TAG_interface_type:
29259     case DW_TAG_friend:
29260     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
29261     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
29262     case DW_TAG_string_type:
29263     case DW_TAG_set_type:
29264     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
29265     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
29266     case DW_TAG_file_type:
29267       /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
29268 	 mark them.  */
29269       /* FALLTHROUGH */
29270 
29271     case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
29272       /* Likewise for DWARF procedures.  */
29273 
29274       if (die->die_perennial_p)
29275 	break;
29276 
29277       return;
29278 
29279     default:
29280       /* Mark everything else.  */
29281       break;
29282   }
29283 
29284   if (die->die_mark == 0)
29285     {
29286       die->die_mark = 1;
29287 
29288       /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here.  */
29289       prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
29290     }
29291 
29292   die->die_mark = 2;
29293 
29294   /* Mark children.  */
29295   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
29296 }
29297 
29298 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
29299    attributes.  */
29300 
29301 static void
29302 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
29303 {
29304   dw_attr_node *a;
29305   unsigned ix;
29306 
29307   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29308     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
29309       {
29310 	struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
29311 	s->refcount++;
29312 	/* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
29313 	   twice in the hash table.  */
29314 	if (s->refcount
29315 	    == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
29316 	  {
29317 	    indirect_string_node **slot
29318 	      = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
29319 						     htab_hash_string (s->str),
29320 						     INSERT);
29321 	    gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
29322 	    *slot = s;
29323 	  }
29324       }
29325 }
29326 
29327 /* Mark DIE and its children as removed.  */
29328 
29329 static void
29330 mark_removed (dw_die_ref die)
29331 {
29332   dw_die_ref c;
29333   die->removed = true;
29334   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_removed (c));
29335 }
29336 
29337 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked.  */
29338 
29339 static void
29340 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
29341 {
29342   dw_die_ref c;
29343 
29344   gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
29345   prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
29346 
29347   if (! die->die_child)
29348     return;
29349 
29350   c = die->die_child;
29351   do {
29352     dw_die_ref prev = c, next;
29353     for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = next)
29354       if (c == die->die_child)
29355 	{
29356 	  /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list.  */
29357 	  if (prev == c)
29358 	    /* No marked children at all.  */
29359 	    die->die_child = NULL;
29360 	  else
29361 	    {
29362 	      prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
29363 	      die->die_child = prev;
29364 	    }
29365 	  c->die_sib = NULL;
29366 	  mark_removed (c);
29367 	  return;
29368 	}
29369       else
29370 	{
29371 	  next = c->die_sib;
29372 	  c->die_sib = NULL;
29373 	  mark_removed (c);
29374 	}
29375 
29376     if (c != prev->die_sib)
29377       prev->die_sib = c;
29378     prune_unused_types_prune (c);
29379   } while (c != die->die_child);
29380 }
29381 
29382 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use.  */
29383 
29384 static void
29385 prune_unused_types (void)
29386 {
29387   unsigned int i;
29388   limbo_die_node *node;
29389   comdat_type_node *ctnode;
29390   pubname_entry *pub;
29391   dw_die_ref base_type;
29392 
29393 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
29394   /* All the marks should already be clear.  */
29395   verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
29396   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29397     verify_marks_clear (node->die);
29398   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29399     verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
29400 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
29401 
29402   /* Mark types that are used in global variables.  */
29403   premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
29404 
29405   /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used.  */
29406   prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
29407   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29408     prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
29409   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29410     {
29411       prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
29412       prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
29413     }
29414 
29415   /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table.  Enumerators
29416      are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
29417      They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
29418      not as roots in themselves.  */
29419   FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
29420     if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
29421       prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
29422   for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
29423     prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
29424 
29425   /* For -fvar-tracking-assignments, also set the mark on nodes that could be
29426      referenced by DW_TAG_call_site DW_AT_call_origin (i.e. direct call
29427      callees).  */
29428   cgraph_node *cnode;
29429   FOR_EACH_FUNCTION (cnode)
29430     if (cnode->referred_to_p (false))
29431       {
29432 	dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (cnode->decl);
29433 	if (die == NULL || die->die_mark)
29434 	  continue;
29435 	for (cgraph_edge *e = cnode->callers; e; e = e->next_caller)
29436 	  if (e->caller != cnode
29437 	      && opt_for_fn (e->caller->decl, flag_var_tracking_assignments))
29438 	    {
29439 	      prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
29440 	      break;
29441 	    }
29442       }
29443 
29444   if (debug_str_hash)
29445     debug_str_hash->empty ();
29446   if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
29447     skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
29448   prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
29449   for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
29450     {
29451       node = *pnode;
29452       if (!node->die->die_mark)
29453 	*pnode = node->next;
29454       else
29455 	{
29456 	  prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
29457 	  pnode = &node->next;
29458 	}
29459     }
29460   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29461     prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
29462 
29463   /* Leave the marks clear.  */
29464   prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
29465   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29466     prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
29467   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29468     prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
29469 }
29470 
29471 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units.  */
29472 
29473 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
29474 {
29475   static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
29476   static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
29477 };
29478 
29479 inline hashval_t
29480 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
29481 {
29482   hashval_t h;
29483   memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
29484   return h;
29485 }
29486 
29487 inline bool
29488 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
29489 			   const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
29490 {
29491   return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
29492                     DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
29493 }
29494 
29495 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
29496    to the location it would have been added, should we know its
29497    DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes.  This will
29498    probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
29499    abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
29500    computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH.  */
29501 
29502 static inline void
29503 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
29504 {
29505   unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
29506   dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
29507 
29508   gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
29509 	      || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
29510 
29511   while (--ix > 0)
29512     {
29513       dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
29514 
29515       if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line
29516 	  || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_column
29517 	  || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
29518 	break;
29519     }
29520 
29521   if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
29522     {
29523       die->die_attr->pop ();
29524       die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
29525     }
29526 }
29527 
29528 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
29529    referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used.  */
29530 
29531 static void
29532 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29533 {
29534   dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
29535 
29536   for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
29537     {
29538       switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29539 	{
29540 	case DW_OP_regval_type:
29541 	case DW_OP_deref_type:
29542 	case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29543 	case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29544 	  base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
29545 	  break;
29546 	case DW_OP_convert:
29547 	case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29548 	case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29549 	case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29550 	  if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29551 	    continue;
29552 	  /* FALLTHRU */
29553 	case DW_OP_const_type:
29554 	case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29555 	  base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29556 	  break;
29557 	case DW_OP_entry_value:
29558 	case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29559 	  mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
29560 	  continue;
29561 	default:
29562 	  continue;
29563 	}
29564       gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
29565       if (base_type->die_mark)
29566 	base_type->die_mark++;
29567       else
29568 	{
29569 	  base_types.safe_push (base_type);
29570 	  base_type->die_mark = 1;
29571 	}
29572     }
29573 }
29574 
29575 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types.  */
29576 
29577 static int
29578 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
29579 {
29580   dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
29581   dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
29582   unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
29583   unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
29584   unsigned int align1, align2;
29585   if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
29586     return -1;
29587   if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
29588     return 1;
29589   byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
29590   byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
29591   if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
29592     return 1;
29593   if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
29594     return -1;
29595   encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
29596   encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
29597   if (encoding1 < encoding2)
29598     return 1;
29599   if (encoding1 > encoding2)
29600     return -1;
29601   align1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_alignment);
29602   align2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_alignment);
29603   if (align1 < align2)
29604     return 1;
29605   if (align1 > align2)
29606     return -1;
29607   return 0;
29608 }
29609 
29610 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
29611    in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
29612    uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
29613    will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
29614    sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed.  */
29615 
29616 static void
29617 move_marked_base_types (void)
29618 {
29619   unsigned int i;
29620   dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
29621 
29622   if (base_types.is_empty ())
29623     return;
29624 
29625   /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
29626      order later on.  */
29627   base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
29628   die = comp_unit_die ();
29629   c = die->die_child;
29630   do
29631     {
29632       dw_die_ref prev = c;
29633       c = c->die_sib;
29634       while (c->die_mark)
29635 	{
29636 	  remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
29637 	  /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
29638 	     one node other than DW_TAG_base_type.  */
29639 	  gcc_assert (die->die_child != NULL);
29640 	  c = prev->die_sib;
29641 	}
29642     }
29643   while (c != die->die_child);
29644   gcc_assert (die->die_child);
29645   c = die->die_child;
29646   for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
29647     {
29648       base_type->die_mark = 0;
29649       base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
29650       c->die_sib = base_type;
29651       c = base_type;
29652     }
29653 }
29654 
29655 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
29656    one CONST_STRING, return true if successful.  Similarly verify that
29657    SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU.  */
29658 
29659 static bool
29660 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
29661 {
29662   rtx rtl = *addr;
29663 
29664   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
29665     {
29666       size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
29667       tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
29668       tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
29669       TREE_TYPE (t)
29670 	= build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
29671       rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
29672       if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
29673 	return false;
29674       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
29675       if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
29676 	  && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
29677 	  && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
29678 	return false;
29679       vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
29680       *addr = rtl;
29681       return true;
29682     }
29683 
29684   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
29685       && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
29686     {
29687       if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
29688 	{
29689 	  if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
29690 	    return false;
29691 	}
29692       else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
29693 	return false;
29694     }
29695 
29696   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
29697     {
29698       subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
29699       FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
29700 	if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
29701 	  return false;
29702     }
29703 
29704   return true;
29705 }
29706 
29707 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
29708    if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
29709    from DW_OP_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet.  */
29710 
29711 static rtx
29712 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
29713 {
29714   rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
29715   unsigned char *array;
29716   dw_loc_descr_ref l;
29717   tree decl;
29718   size_t len;
29719   dw_die_ref ref;
29720 
29721   if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
29722     return NULL_RTX;
29723   rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
29724   if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
29725       || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
29726     return NULL_RTX;
29727 
29728   decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
29729   if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
29730     {
29731       len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
29732       vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
29733       ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
29734       array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
29735       memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
29736       l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
29737       l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
29738       l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
29739       l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
29740       l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
29741       add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
29742       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
29743     }
29744   return rtl;
29745 }
29746 
29747 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr.  LOC is
29748    a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
29749    of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
29750    resolved.  Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
29751    with DW_OP_implicit_pointer if possible
29752    and return true, if unsuccessful, return false.  */
29753 
29754 static bool
29755 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29756 {
29757   rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
29758   HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
29759   dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
29760   tree decl;
29761 
29762   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
29763       && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
29764       && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
29765     {
29766       offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
29767       rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
29768     }
29769   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
29770     {
29771       size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
29772       tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
29773       tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
29774 
29775       TREE_TYPE (t)
29776 	= build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
29777       rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
29778       if (!rtl)
29779 	return false;
29780     }
29781   if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
29782     {
29783       decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
29784       if (VAR_P (decl) && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
29785 	{
29786 	  ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
29787 	  if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
29788 		      || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
29789 	    {
29790 	      loc->dw_loc_opc = dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer);
29791 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29792 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
29793 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
29794 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29795 	      loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
29796 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
29797 	      return true;
29798 	    }
29799 	}
29800     }
29801   return false;
29802 }
29803 
29804 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
29805    expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
29806    the location list couldn't be resolved.  */
29807 
29808 static bool
29809 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29810 {
29811   dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
29812   for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
29813     switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29814       {
29815       case DW_OP_addr:
29816 	if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
29817 	  {
29818 	    if ((prev == NULL
29819 		 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
29820 		 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
29821 		&& loc->dw_loc_next
29822 		&& loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
29823 		&& (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
29824 		&& optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
29825 	      break;
29826 	    return false;
29827 	  }
29828 	break;
29829       case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29830       case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29831 	if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
29832             || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
29833           {
29834             rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
29835             if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
29836               return false;
29837             remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
29838 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
29839 	      = add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
29840           }
29841 	break;
29842       case DW_OP_const4u:
29843       case DW_OP_const8u:
29844 	if (loc->dtprel
29845 	    && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
29846 	  return false;
29847 	break;
29848       case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29849 	if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
29850 	    > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
29851 	      + 1
29852 	    && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
29853 	  {
29854 	    dw_loc_descr_ref repl
29855 	      = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
29856 	    add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
29857 	    add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
29858 	    *loc = *repl;
29859 	  }
29860 	break;
29861       case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29862 	if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
29863 	    && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
29864 	  return false;
29865 	break;
29866       case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29867       case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29868       case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
29869       case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
29870 	if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
29871 	  {
29872 	    dw_die_ref ref
29873 	      = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
29874 	    if (ref == NULL)
29875 	      return false;
29876 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29877 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
29878 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29879 	  }
29880 	if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value)
29881 	  {
29882 	    if (prev == NULL
29883 		&& loc->dw_loc_next == NULL
29884 		&& AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
29885 	      switch (a->dw_attr)
29886 		{
29887 		  /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
29888 		     so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
29889 		     alone we could transform it into reference.  */
29890 		case DW_AT_byte_size:
29891 		case DW_AT_bit_size:
29892 		case DW_AT_lower_bound:
29893 		case DW_AT_upper_bound:
29894 		case DW_AT_bit_stride:
29895 		case DW_AT_count:
29896 		case DW_AT_allocated:
29897 		case DW_AT_associated:
29898 		case DW_AT_byte_stride:
29899 		  a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29900 		  a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
29901 		  a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die
29902 		    = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29903 		  a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29904 		  return true;
29905 		default:
29906 		  break;
29907 		}
29908 	    if (dwarf_strict)
29909 	      return false;
29910 	  }
29911 	break;
29912       case DW_OP_const_type:
29913       case DW_OP_regval_type:
29914       case DW_OP_deref_type:
29915       case DW_OP_convert:
29916       case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29917       case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29918       case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29919       case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29920       case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29921       case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29922 	while (loc->dw_loc_next
29923 	       && (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_convert
29924 		   || loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert))
29925 	  {
29926 	    dw_die_ref base1, base2;
29927 	    unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
29928 	    if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
29929 		|| loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
29930 		|| loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
29931 		|| loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
29932 	      base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
29933 	    else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
29934 		     == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29935 	      break;
29936 	    else
29937 	      base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29938 	    if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
29939 		== dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29940 	      break;
29941 	    base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29942 	    gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
29943 			&& base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
29944 	    enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
29945 	    enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
29946 	    size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
29947 	    size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
29948 	    if (size1 == size2
29949 		&& (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
29950 		     && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
29951 		     && loc != keep)
29952 		    || enc1 == enc2))
29953 	      {
29954 		/* Optimize away next DW_OP_convert after
29955 		   adjusting LOC's base type die reference.  */
29956 		if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
29957 		    || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
29958 		    || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
29959 		    || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
29960 		  loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
29961 		else
29962 		  loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
29963 		loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
29964 		continue;
29965 	      }
29966 	    /* Don't change integer DW_OP_convert after e.g. floating
29967 	       point typed stack entry.  */
29968 	    else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
29969 	      keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
29970 	    break;
29971 	  }
29972 	break;
29973       default:
29974 	break;
29975       }
29976   return true;
29977 }
29978 
29979 /* Helper function of resolve_addr.  DIE had DW_AT_location of
29980    DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
29981    and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved.  resolve_addr has already
29982    removed the DW_AT_location attribute.  This function attempts to
29983    add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_implicit_pointer
29984    to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible.  */
29985 
29986 static void
29987 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
29988 {
29989   if (!VAR_P (decl)
29990       || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
29991       || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
29992       || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
29993       || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
29994       || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
29995       || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
29996     return;
29997 
29998   tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
29999   HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
30000   /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
30001      don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
30002      DW_AT_const_value instead.  */
30003   if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
30004     return;
30005   if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
30006     return;
30007   /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
30008      and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
30009      DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
30010      resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
30011      we can add DW_OP_implicit_pointer.  */
30012   STRIP_NOPS (init);
30013   if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
30014       && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
30015     {
30016       offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
30017       init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
30018       STRIP_NOPS (init);
30019     }
30020   if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
30021     return;
30022   if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
30023        && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
30024       || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
30025 	  && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
30026 	  && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
30027     {
30028       dw_die_ref ref;
30029       dw_loc_descr_ref l;
30030 
30031       if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
30032 	{
30033 	  rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
30034 	  if (!rtl)
30035 	    return;
30036 	  decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
30037 	}
30038       else
30039 	decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
30040       ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30041       if (ref == NULL
30042 	  || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
30043 	      && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
30044 	return;
30045       l = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
30046       l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30047       l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30048       l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30049       add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
30050     }
30051 }
30052 
30053 /* Return NULL if l is a DWARF expression, or first op that is not
30054    valid DWARF expression.  */
30055 
30056 static dw_loc_descr_ref
30057 non_dwarf_expression (dw_loc_descr_ref l)
30058 {
30059   while (l)
30060     {
30061       if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
30062 	return l;
30063       switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
30064 	{
30065 	case DW_OP_regx:
30066 	case DW_OP_implicit_value:
30067 	case DW_OP_stack_value:
30068 	case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
30069 	case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
30070 	case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
30071 	case DW_OP_piece:
30072 	case DW_OP_bit_piece:
30073 	  return l;
30074 	default:
30075 	  break;
30076 	}
30077       l = l->dw_loc_next;
30078     }
30079   return NULL;
30080 }
30081 
30082 /* Return adjusted copy of EXPR:
30083    If it is empty DWARF expression, return it.
30084    If it is valid non-empty DWARF expression,
30085    return copy of EXPR with DW_OP_deref appended to it.
30086    If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_reg{N,x}, return
30087    copy of the DWARF expression with DW_OP_breg{N,x} <0> appended.
30088    If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_stack_value, return
30089    copy of the DWARF expression without anything appended.
30090    Otherwise, return NULL.  */
30091 
30092 static dw_loc_descr_ref
30093 copy_deref_exprloc (dw_loc_descr_ref expr)
30094 {
30095   dw_loc_descr_ref tail = NULL;
30096 
30097   if (expr == NULL)
30098     return NULL;
30099 
30100   dw_loc_descr_ref l = non_dwarf_expression (expr);
30101   if (l && l->dw_loc_next)
30102     return NULL;
30103 
30104   if (l)
30105     {
30106       if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
30107 	tail = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom)
30108 			      (DW_OP_breg0 + (l->dw_loc_opc - DW_OP_reg0)),
30109 			      0, 0);
30110       else
30111 	switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
30112 	  {
30113 	  case DW_OP_regx:
30114 	    tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx,
30115 				  l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned, 0);
30116 	    break;
30117 	  case DW_OP_stack_value:
30118 	    break;
30119 	  default:
30120 	    return NULL;
30121 	  }
30122     }
30123   else
30124     tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
30125 
30126   dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, *p = &ret;
30127   while (expr != l)
30128     {
30129       *p = new_loc_descr (expr->dw_loc_opc, 0, 0);
30130       (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd1 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30131       (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd2 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30132       p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
30133       expr = expr->dw_loc_next;
30134     }
30135   *p = tail;
30136   return ret;
30137 }
30138 
30139 /* For DW_AT_string_length attribute with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30140    reference to a variable or argument, adjust it if needed and return:
30141    -1 if the DW_AT_string_length attribute and DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size
30142       attribute if present should be removed
30143    0 keep the attribute perhaps with minor modifications, no need to rescan
30144    1 if the attribute has been successfully adjusted.  */
30145 
30146 static int
30147 optimize_string_length (dw_attr_node *a)
30148 {
30149   dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a), lv;
30150   dw_die_ref die;
30151   if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30152     {
30153       tree decl = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30154       die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30155       if (die)
30156 	{
30157 	  l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30158 	  l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
30159 	  l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30160 	}
30161       else
30162 	return -1;
30163     }
30164   else
30165     die = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
30166 
30167   /* DWARF5 allows reference class, so we can then reference the DIE.
30168      Only do this for DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value.  */
30169   if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL && dwarf_version >= 5)
30170     {
30171       a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30172       a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
30173       a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
30174       a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30175       return 0;
30176     }
30177 
30178   dw_attr_node *av = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
30179   dw_loc_list_ref d;
30180   bool non_dwarf_expr = false;
30181 
30182   if (av == NULL)
30183     return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30184   switch (AT_class (av))
30185     {
30186     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30187       for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
30188 	if (d->expr && non_dwarf_expression (d->expr))
30189 	  non_dwarf_expr = true;
30190       break;
30191     case dw_val_class_view_list:
30192       gcc_unreachable ();
30193     case dw_val_class_loc:
30194       lv = AT_loc (av);
30195       if (lv == NULL)
30196 	return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30197       if (non_dwarf_expression (lv))
30198 	non_dwarf_expr = true;
30199       break;
30200     default:
30201       return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30202     }
30203 
30204   /* If it is safe to transform DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value
30205      into DW_OP_call4  or DW_OP_GNU_variable_value into
30206      DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, do so.  */
30207   if (!non_dwarf_expr
30208       && (l->dw_loc_next != NULL || AT_class (av) == dw_val_class_loc))
30209     {
30210       l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_call4;
30211       if (l->dw_loc_next)
30212 	l->dw_loc_next = NULL;
30213       else
30214 	l->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
30215       return 0;
30216     }
30217 
30218   /* For DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value, we can just
30219      copy over the DW_AT_location attribute from die to a.  */
30220   if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
30221     {
30222       a->dw_attr_val = av->dw_attr_val;
30223       return 1;
30224     }
30225 
30226   dw_loc_list_ref list, *p;
30227   switch (AT_class (av))
30228     {
30229     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30230       p = &list;
30231       list = NULL;
30232       for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
30233 	{
30234 	  lv = copy_deref_exprloc (d->expr);
30235 	  if (lv)
30236 	    {
30237 	      *p = new_loc_list (lv, d->begin, d->vbegin, d->end, d->vend, d->section);
30238 	      p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
30239 	    }
30240 	  else if (!dwarf_strict && d->expr)
30241 	    return 0;
30242 	}
30243       if (list == NULL)
30244 	return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30245       a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
30246       gen_llsym (list);
30247       *AT_loc_list_ptr (a) = list;
30248       return 1;
30249     case dw_val_class_loc:
30250       lv = copy_deref_exprloc (AT_loc (av));
30251       if (lv == NULL)
30252 	return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30253       a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = lv;
30254       return 1;
30255     default:
30256       gcc_unreachable ();
30257     }
30258 }
30259 
30260 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
30261    an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
30262    or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
30263    with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
30264    in .rodata.  Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
30265    to something that has been emitted in the current CU.  */
30266 
30267 static void
30268 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
30269 {
30270   dw_die_ref c;
30271   dw_attr_node *a;
30272   dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
30273   unsigned ix;
30274   bool remove_AT_byte_size = false;
30275 
30276   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30277     switch (AT_class (a))
30278       {
30279       case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30280 	start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
30281 	loc = *curr;
30282 	gcc_assert (loc);
30283 	/* The same list can be referenced more than once.  See if we have
30284 	   already recorded the result from a previous pass.  */
30285 	if (loc->replaced)
30286 	  *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
30287 	else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
30288 	  {
30289 	    /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
30290 	       reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
30291 	       References must be identical or completely separate.
30292 	       There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
30293 	       pass on any list other than the first; doing so
30294 	       would lead to unnecessary writes.  */
30295 	    while (*curr)
30296 	      {
30297 		gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
30298 		if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (a, (*curr)->expr))
30299 		  {
30300 		    dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
30301                     dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
30302 
30303 		    if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
30304 		      {
30305 			gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
30306 			next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
30307 			next->vl_symbol = (*curr)->vl_symbol;
30308 		      }
30309                     if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30310                       remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
30311 		    *curr = next;
30312 		  }
30313 		else
30314 		  {
30315 		    mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
30316 		    curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
30317 		  }
30318 	      }
30319 	    if (loc == *start)
30320 	      loc->resolved_addr = 1;
30321 	    else
30322 	      {
30323 		loc->replaced = 1;
30324 		loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
30325 	      }
30326 	  }
30327 	if (!*start)
30328 	  {
30329 	    remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30330 	    ix--;
30331 	  }
30332 	break;
30333       case dw_val_class_view_list:
30334 	{
30335 	  gcc_checking_assert (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
30336 	  gcc_checking_assert (dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ());
30337 	  dw_val_node *llnode
30338 	    = view_list_to_loc_list_val_node (&a->dw_attr_val);
30339 	  /* If we no longer have a loclist, or it no longer needs
30340 	     views, drop this attribute.  */
30341 	  if (!llnode || !llnode->v.val_loc_list->vl_symbol)
30342 	    {
30343 	      remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30344 	      ix--;
30345 	    }
30346 	  break;
30347 	}
30348       case dw_val_class_loc:
30349 	{
30350 	  dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
30351 	  /* DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value or
30352 	     DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in DW_AT_string_length can be converted
30353 	     into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, which is standard
30354 	     DWARF4 unlike DW_OP_GNU_variable_value.  Or for DWARF5
30355 	     DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value can be replaced
30356 	     with DW_FORM_ref referencing the same DIE as
30357 	     DW_OP_GNU_variable_value used to reference.  */
30358 	  if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length
30359 	      && l
30360 	      && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30361 	      && (l->dw_loc_next == NULL
30362 		  || (l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next == NULL
30363 		      && l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value)))
30364 	    {
30365 	      switch (optimize_string_length (a))
30366 		{
30367 		case -1:
30368 		  remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30369 		  ix--;
30370 		  /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
30371 		     DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size.  */
30372 		  remove_AT_byte_size = true;
30373 		  continue;
30374 		default:
30375 		  break;
30376 		case 1:
30377 		  /* Even if we keep the optimized DW_AT_string_length,
30378 		     it might have changed AT_class, so process it again.  */
30379 		  ix--;
30380 		  continue;
30381 		}
30382 	    }
30383 	  /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
30384 	     DW_AT_data_member_location containing
30385 	     DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
30386 	     rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
30387 	     but shorter, location description.  */
30388 	  if ((dwarf_version > 2
30389 	       || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
30390 	       || l == NULL
30391 	       || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
30392 	       || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
30393 	      && !resolve_addr_in_expr (a, l))
30394 	    {
30395 	      if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30396 		remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
30397 	      if (l != NULL
30398 		  && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
30399 		  && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
30400 		  && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
30401 		  && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
30402 		  && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
30403 		{
30404 		  tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
30405 		  remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30406 		  ix--;
30407 		  optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
30408 		  break;
30409 		}
30410 	      if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length)
30411 		/* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
30412 		   DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size.  */
30413 		remove_AT_byte_size = true;
30414 	      remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30415 	      ix--;
30416 	    }
30417 	  else
30418 	    mark_base_types (l);
30419 	}
30420 	break;
30421       case dw_val_class_addr:
30422 	if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
30423 	    && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
30424 	  {
30425             if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
30426               remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
30427 	    remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30428 	    ix--;
30429 	  }
30430 	if ((die->die_tag == DW_TAG_call_site
30431 	     && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_origin)
30432 	    || (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
30433 		&& a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin))
30434 	  {
30435 	    tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
30436 	    dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
30437 	    dw_die_ref cdie;
30438 	    if (tdie == NULL
30439 		&& DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
30440 		&& DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
30441 		&& (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
30442 	      {
30443 		dw_die_ref pdie = cdie;
30444 		/* Make sure we don't add these DIEs into type units.
30445 		   We could emit skeleton DIEs for context (namespaces,
30446 		   outer structs/classes) and a skeleton DIE for the
30447 		   innermost context with DW_AT_signature pointing to the
30448 		   type unit.  See PR78835.  */
30449 		while (pdie && pdie->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
30450 		  pdie = pdie->die_parent;
30451 		if (pdie == NULL)
30452 		  {
30453 		    /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
30454 		       at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
30455 		       as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
30456 		       output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash.  */
30457 		    tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
30458 		    add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
30459 		    add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
30460 		    add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
30461 		    add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl, true);
30462 		    equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
30463 		  }
30464 	      }
30465 	    if (tdie)
30466 	      {
30467 		a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30468 		a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
30469 		a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30470 	      }
30471 	    else
30472 	      {
30473                 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
30474                   remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
30475 		remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30476 		ix--;
30477 	      }
30478 	  }
30479 	break;
30480       default:
30481 	break;
30482       }
30483 
30484   if (remove_AT_byte_size)
30485     remove_AT (die, dwarf_version >= 5
30486 		    ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
30487 		    : DW_AT_byte_size);
30488 
30489   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
30490 }
30491 
30492 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
30493    This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
30494    section.  */
30495 
30496 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE.  */
30497 
30498 static void
30499 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
30500 {
30501   dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30502   dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30503 
30504   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
30505     {
30506     case DW_OP_const4u:
30507     case DW_OP_const8u:
30508       if (loc->dtprel)
30509 	goto hash_addr;
30510       /* FALLTHRU */
30511     case DW_OP_const1u:
30512     case DW_OP_const1s:
30513     case DW_OP_const2u:
30514     case DW_OP_const2s:
30515     case DW_OP_const4s:
30516     case DW_OP_const8s:
30517     case DW_OP_constu:
30518     case DW_OP_consts:
30519     case DW_OP_pick:
30520     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
30521     case DW_OP_breg0:
30522     case DW_OP_breg1:
30523     case DW_OP_breg2:
30524     case DW_OP_breg3:
30525     case DW_OP_breg4:
30526     case DW_OP_breg5:
30527     case DW_OP_breg6:
30528     case DW_OP_breg7:
30529     case DW_OP_breg8:
30530     case DW_OP_breg9:
30531     case DW_OP_breg10:
30532     case DW_OP_breg11:
30533     case DW_OP_breg12:
30534     case DW_OP_breg13:
30535     case DW_OP_breg14:
30536     case DW_OP_breg15:
30537     case DW_OP_breg16:
30538     case DW_OP_breg17:
30539     case DW_OP_breg18:
30540     case DW_OP_breg19:
30541     case DW_OP_breg20:
30542     case DW_OP_breg21:
30543     case DW_OP_breg22:
30544     case DW_OP_breg23:
30545     case DW_OP_breg24:
30546     case DW_OP_breg25:
30547     case DW_OP_breg26:
30548     case DW_OP_breg27:
30549     case DW_OP_breg28:
30550     case DW_OP_breg29:
30551     case DW_OP_breg30:
30552     case DW_OP_breg31:
30553     case DW_OP_regx:
30554     case DW_OP_fbreg:
30555     case DW_OP_piece:
30556     case DW_OP_deref_size:
30557     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
30558       hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
30559       break;
30560     case DW_OP_skip:
30561     case DW_OP_bra:
30562       {
30563 	int offset;
30564 
30565 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
30566 	offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
30567 	hstate.add_object (offset);
30568       }
30569       break;
30570     case DW_OP_implicit_value:
30571       hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
30572       switch (val2->val_class)
30573 	{
30574 	case dw_val_class_const:
30575 	  hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
30576 	  break;
30577 	case dw_val_class_vec:
30578 	  {
30579 	    unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
30580 	    unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
30581 
30582 	    hstate.add_int (elt_size);
30583 	    hstate.add_int (len);
30584 	    hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
30585 	  }
30586 	  break;
30587 	case dw_val_class_const_double:
30588 	  hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
30589 	  hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
30590 	  break;
30591 	case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30592 	  hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
30593 		      get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
30594 		      * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
30595 	  break;
30596 	case dw_val_class_addr:
30597 	  inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
30598 	  break;
30599 	default:
30600 	  gcc_unreachable ();
30601 	}
30602       break;
30603     case DW_OP_bregx:
30604     case DW_OP_bit_piece:
30605       hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
30606       hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
30607       break;
30608     case DW_OP_addr:
30609     hash_addr:
30610       if (loc->dtprel)
30611 	{
30612 	  unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
30613 	  hstate.add_object (dtprel);
30614 	}
30615       inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
30616       break;
30617     case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
30618     case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
30619       {
30620         if (loc->dtprel)
30621           {
30622             unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
30623 	    hstate.add_object (dtprel);
30624           }
30625         inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
30626       }
30627       break;
30628     case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
30629     case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
30630       hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
30631       break;
30632     case DW_OP_entry_value:
30633     case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
30634       hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
30635       break;
30636     case DW_OP_regval_type:
30637     case DW_OP_deref_type:
30638     case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
30639     case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
30640       {
30641 	unsigned int byte_size
30642 	  = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
30643 	unsigned int encoding
30644 	  = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
30645 	hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
30646 	hstate.add_object (byte_size);
30647 	hstate.add_object (encoding);
30648       }
30649       break;
30650     case DW_OP_convert:
30651     case DW_OP_reinterpret:
30652     case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
30653     case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
30654       if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
30655 	{
30656 	  hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
30657 	  break;
30658 	}
30659       /* FALLTHRU */
30660     case DW_OP_const_type:
30661     case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
30662       {
30663 	unsigned int byte_size
30664 	  = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
30665 	unsigned int encoding
30666 	  = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
30667 	hstate.add_object (byte_size);
30668 	hstate.add_object (encoding);
30669 	if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_const_type
30670 	    && loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
30671 	  break;
30672 	hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
30673 	switch (val2->val_class)
30674 	  {
30675 	  case dw_val_class_const:
30676 	    hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
30677 	    break;
30678 	  case dw_val_class_vec:
30679 	    {
30680 	      unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
30681 	      unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
30682 
30683 	      hstate.add_object (elt_size);
30684 	      hstate.add_object (len);
30685 	      hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
30686 	    }
30687 	    break;
30688 	  case dw_val_class_const_double:
30689 	    hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
30690 	    hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
30691 	    break;
30692 	  case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30693 	    hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
30694 			get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
30695 			* HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
30696 	    break;
30697 	  default:
30698 	    gcc_unreachable ();
30699 	  }
30700       }
30701       break;
30702 
30703     default:
30704       /* Other codes have no operands.  */
30705       break;
30706     }
30707 }
30708 
30709 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE.  */
30710 
30711 static inline void
30712 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
30713 {
30714   dw_loc_descr_ref l;
30715   bool sizes_computed = false;
30716   /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed.  */
30717   size_of_locs (loc);
30718 
30719   for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
30720     {
30721       enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
30722       hstate.add_object (opc);
30723       if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
30724 	{
30725 	  size_of_locs (loc);
30726 	  sizes_computed = true;
30727 	}
30728       hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
30729     }
30730 }
30731 
30732 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD.  */
30733 
30734 static inline void
30735 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
30736 {
30737   dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
30738   inchash::hash hstate;
30739 
30740   for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
30741     {
30742       hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
30743       hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
30744       hstate.add_object (curr->vbegin);
30745       hstate.add_object (curr->vend);
30746       if (curr->section)
30747 	hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
30748       hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
30749     }
30750   list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
30751 }
30752 
30753 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands.  */
30754 
30755 static inline bool
30756 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
30757 {
30758   dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30759   dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30760   dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30761   dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30762 
30763   switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
30764     {
30765     case DW_OP_const4u:
30766     case DW_OP_const8u:
30767       if (x->dtprel)
30768 	goto hash_addr;
30769       /* FALLTHRU */
30770     case DW_OP_const1u:
30771     case DW_OP_const1s:
30772     case DW_OP_const2u:
30773     case DW_OP_const2s:
30774     case DW_OP_const4s:
30775     case DW_OP_const8s:
30776     case DW_OP_constu:
30777     case DW_OP_consts:
30778     case DW_OP_pick:
30779     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
30780     case DW_OP_breg0:
30781     case DW_OP_breg1:
30782     case DW_OP_breg2:
30783     case DW_OP_breg3:
30784     case DW_OP_breg4:
30785     case DW_OP_breg5:
30786     case DW_OP_breg6:
30787     case DW_OP_breg7:
30788     case DW_OP_breg8:
30789     case DW_OP_breg9:
30790     case DW_OP_breg10:
30791     case DW_OP_breg11:
30792     case DW_OP_breg12:
30793     case DW_OP_breg13:
30794     case DW_OP_breg14:
30795     case DW_OP_breg15:
30796     case DW_OP_breg16:
30797     case DW_OP_breg17:
30798     case DW_OP_breg18:
30799     case DW_OP_breg19:
30800     case DW_OP_breg20:
30801     case DW_OP_breg21:
30802     case DW_OP_breg22:
30803     case DW_OP_breg23:
30804     case DW_OP_breg24:
30805     case DW_OP_breg25:
30806     case DW_OP_breg26:
30807     case DW_OP_breg27:
30808     case DW_OP_breg28:
30809     case DW_OP_breg29:
30810     case DW_OP_breg30:
30811     case DW_OP_breg31:
30812     case DW_OP_regx:
30813     case DW_OP_fbreg:
30814     case DW_OP_piece:
30815     case DW_OP_deref_size:
30816     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
30817       return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
30818     case DW_OP_skip:
30819     case DW_OP_bra:
30820       /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
30821         can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr.  */
30822       gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
30823 		  && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
30824                   && (dwarf_split_debug_info
30825                       || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
30826       return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
30827     case DW_OP_implicit_value:
30828       if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
30829 	  || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
30830 	return false;
30831       switch (valx2->val_class)
30832 	{
30833 	case dw_val_class_const:
30834 	  return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30835 	case dw_val_class_vec:
30836 	  return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30837 		 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
30838 		 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
30839 			    valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30840 			    * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
30841 	case dw_val_class_const_double:
30842 	  return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
30843 		 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
30844 	case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30845 	  return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
30846 	case dw_val_class_addr:
30847 	  return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
30848 	default:
30849 	  gcc_unreachable ();
30850 	}
30851     case DW_OP_bregx:
30852     case DW_OP_bit_piece:
30853       return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
30854 	     && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30855     case DW_OP_addr:
30856     hash_addr:
30857       return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
30858     case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
30859     case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
30860       {
30861         rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
30862         rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
30863         return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
30864       }
30865     case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
30866     case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
30867       return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
30868 	     && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
30869 	     && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
30870 	     && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30871     case DW_OP_entry_value:
30872     case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
30873       return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
30874     case DW_OP_const_type:
30875     case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
30876       if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
30877 	  || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
30878 	return false;
30879       switch (valx2->val_class)
30880 	{
30881 	case dw_val_class_const:
30882 	  return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30883 	case dw_val_class_vec:
30884 	  return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30885 		 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
30886 		 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
30887 			    valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30888 			    * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
30889 	case dw_val_class_const_double:
30890 	  return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
30891 		 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
30892 	case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30893 	  return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
30894 	default:
30895 	  gcc_unreachable ();
30896 	}
30897     case DW_OP_regval_type:
30898     case DW_OP_deref_type:
30899     case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
30900     case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
30901       return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
30902 	     && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
30903     case DW_OP_convert:
30904     case DW_OP_reinterpret:
30905     case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
30906     case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
30907       if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
30908 	return false;
30909       if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
30910 	return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
30911       return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
30912     case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
30913       return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
30914 	     && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
30915 	     && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
30916     default:
30917       /* Other codes have no operands.  */
30918       return true;
30919     }
30920 }
30921 
30922 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same.  */
30923 
30924 static inline bool
30925 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
30926 {
30927   for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
30928     if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
30929 	|| x->dtprel != y->dtprel
30930 	|| !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
30931       break;
30932   return x == NULL && y == NULL;
30933 }
30934 
30935 /* Hashtable helpers.  */
30936 
30937 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
30938 {
30939   static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
30940   static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
30941 			    const dw_loc_list_struct *);
30942 };
30943 
30944 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X.  */
30945 
30946 inline hashval_t
30947 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
30948 {
30949   return x->hash;
30950 }
30951 
30952 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same.  */
30953 
30954 inline bool
30955 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
30956 			const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
30957 {
30958   if (a == b)
30959     return 1;
30960   if (a->hash != b->hash)
30961     return 0;
30962   for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
30963     if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
30964 	|| strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
30965 	|| (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
30966 	|| (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
30967 	|| a->vbegin != b->vbegin || a->vend != b->vend
30968 	|| !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
30969       break;
30970   return a == NULL && b == NULL;
30971 }
30972 
30973 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
30974 
30975 
30976 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
30977    children and share them whenever possible.  */
30978 
30979 static void
30980 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
30981 {
30982   dw_die_ref c;
30983   dw_attr_node *a;
30984   unsigned ix;
30985   dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
30986   bool drop_locviews = false;
30987   bool has_locviews = false;
30988 
30989   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30990     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
30991       {
30992 	dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
30993 	/* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
30994 	   it and storing into the hash table.  */
30995 	hash_loc_list (list);
30996 	slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
30997 	if (*slot == NULL)
30998 	  {
30999 	    *slot = list;
31000 	    if (loc_list_has_views (list))
31001 	      gcc_assert (list->vl_symbol);
31002 	    else if (list->vl_symbol)
31003 	      {
31004 		drop_locviews = true;
31005 		list->vl_symbol = NULL;
31006 	      }
31007 	  }
31008 	else
31009 	  {
31010 	    if (list->vl_symbol && !(*slot)->vl_symbol)
31011 	      drop_locviews = true;
31012 	    a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
31013 	  }
31014       }
31015     else if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_view_list)
31016       {
31017 	gcc_checking_assert (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
31018 	has_locviews = true;
31019       }
31020 
31021 
31022   if (drop_locviews && has_locviews)
31023     remove_AT (die, DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
31024 
31025   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
31026 }
31027 
31028 
31029 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
31030    section.  */
31031 
31032 static void
31033 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
31034 {
31035   dw_die_ref c;
31036   dw_attr_node *a;
31037   unsigned ix;
31038 
31039   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
31040     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
31041       {
31042         dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
31043         dw_loc_list_ref curr;
31044         for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
31045           {
31046             /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
31047 	       or won't be output.  Make sure skip_loc_list_entry doesn't
31048 	       call size_of_locs, because that might cause circular dependency,
31049 	       index_location_lists requiring address table indexes to be
31050 	       computed, but adding new indexes through add_addr_table_entry
31051 	       and address table index computation requiring no new additions
31052 	       to the hash table.  In the rare case of DWARF[234] >= 64KB
31053 	       location expression, we'll just waste unused address table entry
31054 	       for it.  */
31055             if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
31056                 || skip_loc_list_entry (curr))
31057               continue;
31058 
31059             curr->begin_entry
31060 	      = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin), ate_kind_label);
31061           }
31062       }
31063 
31064   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
31065 }
31066 
31067 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
31068    children and share them whenever possible.  */
31069 
31070 static void
31071 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
31072 {
31073   loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
31074   optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
31075 }
31076 
31077 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links.  The only
31078    dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
31079    inline functions, and the comp_unit_die.  We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
31080    For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
31081    instance.  */
31082 
31083 static void
31084 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
31085 {
31086   limbo_die_node *node;
31087 
31088   /* get_context_die calls force_decl_die, which can put new DIEs on the
31089      limbo list in LTO mode when nested functions are put in a different
31090      partition than that of their parent function.  */
31091   while ((node = limbo_die_list))
31092     {
31093       dw_die_ref die = node->die;
31094       limbo_die_list = node->next;
31095 
31096       if (die->die_parent == NULL)
31097 	{
31098 	  dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
31099 
31100 	  if (origin && origin->die_parent)
31101 	    add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
31102 	  else if (is_cu_die (die))
31103 	    ;
31104 	  else if (seen_error ())
31105 	    /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input.  */
31106 	    add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
31107 	  else
31108 	    {
31109 	      /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
31110 		 nested function can be optimized away, which results
31111 		 in the nested function die being orphaned.  Likewise
31112 		 with the return type of that nested function.  Force
31113 		 this to be a child of the containing function.
31114 
31115 		 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
31116 		 inlined and optimized out.  In that case we are lost and
31117 		 assign the empty child.  This should not be big issue as
31118 		 the function is likely unreachable too.  */
31119 	      gcc_assert (node->created_for);
31120 
31121 	      if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
31122 		origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
31123 	      else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
31124 		origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
31125 	      else
31126 		origin = comp_unit_die ();
31127 
31128 	      add_child_die (origin, die);
31129 	    }
31130 	}
31131     }
31132 }
31133 
31134 /* Reset DIEs so we can output them again.  */
31135 
31136 static void
31137 reset_dies (dw_die_ref die)
31138 {
31139   dw_die_ref c;
31140 
31141   /* Remove stuff we re-generate.  */
31142   die->die_mark = 0;
31143   die->die_offset = 0;
31144   die->die_abbrev = 0;
31145   remove_AT (die, DW_AT_sibling);
31146 
31147   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, reset_dies (c));
31148 }
31149 
31150 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
31151    and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info.  */
31152 
31153 static void
31154 dwarf2out_finish (const char *)
31155 {
31156   comdat_type_node *ctnode;
31157   dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
31158   unsigned char checksum[16];
31159   char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31160 
31161   /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party.  */
31162   flush_limbo_die_list ();
31163 
31164   if (inline_entry_data_table)
31165     gcc_assert (inline_entry_data_table->elements () == 0);
31166 
31167   if (flag_checking)
31168     {
31169       verify_die (comp_unit_die ());
31170       for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31171 	verify_die (node->die);
31172     }
31173 
31174   /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
31175      DIEs generated after early finish.  */
31176   gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
31177 
31178   gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
31179 
31180   if (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload)
31181     {
31182       gcc_assert (flag_fat_lto_objects || flag_generate_offload);
31183 
31184       /* Prune stuff so that dwarf2out_finish runs successfully
31185 	 for the fat part of the object.  */
31186       reset_dies (comp_unit_die ());
31187       for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31188 	reset_dies (node->die);
31189 
31190       hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
31191       for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31192 	{
31193 	  comdat_type_node **slot
31194 	      = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
31195 
31196 	  /* Don't reset types twice.  */
31197 	  if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
31198 	    continue;
31199 
31200 	  /* Remove the pointer to the line table.  */
31201 	  remove_AT (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list);
31202 
31203 	  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31204 	    reset_dies (ctnode->root_die);
31205 
31206 	  *slot = ctnode;
31207 	}
31208 
31209       /* Reset die CU symbol so we don't output it twice.  */
31210       comp_unit_die ()->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
31211 
31212       /* Remove DW_AT_macro and DW_AT_stmt_list from the early output.  */
31213       remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list);
31214       if (have_macinfo)
31215 	remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE);
31216 
31217       /* Remove indirect string decisions.  */
31218       debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, reset_indirect_string> (NULL);
31219       if (debug_line_str_hash)
31220 	{
31221 	  debug_line_str_hash->traverse<void *, reset_indirect_string> (NULL);
31222 	  debug_line_str_hash = NULL;
31223 	}
31224     }
31225 
31226 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
31227   {
31228     dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
31229     FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
31230   }
31231 #endif
31232   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31233     resolve_addr (ctnode->root_die);
31234   resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
31235   move_marked_base_types ();
31236 
31237   /* Initialize sections and labels used for actual assembler output.  */
31238   unsigned generation = init_sections_and_labels (false);
31239 
31240   /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
31241      have children.  */
31242   add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
31243   limbo_die_node *node;
31244   for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31245     add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
31246   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31247     add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
31248 
31249   /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
31250      skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
31251      most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die.  */
31252   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31253     {
31254       limbo_die_node *cu;
31255       main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
31256       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31257 	main_comp_unit_die->die_tag = DW_TAG_skeleton_unit;
31258       cu = limbo_die_list;
31259       gcc_assert (cu->die == main_comp_unit_die);
31260       limbo_die_list = limbo_die_list->next;
31261       cu->next = cu_die_list;
31262       cu_die_list = cu;
31263     }
31264   else
31265     main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
31266 
31267   /* Output a terminator label for the .text section.  */
31268   switch_to_section (text_section);
31269   targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
31270   if (cold_text_section)
31271     {
31272       switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
31273       targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
31274     }
31275 
31276   /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
31277      in .text.  */
31278   if (!have_multiple_function_sections
31279       || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
31280     {
31281       /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code.  */
31282       if (text_section_used)
31283         add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
31284                             text_end_label, true);
31285     }
31286   else
31287     {
31288       unsigned fde_idx;
31289       dw_fde_ref fde;
31290       bool range_list_added = false;
31291 
31292       if (text_section_used)
31293         add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
31294                               text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
31295       if (cold_text_section_used)
31296         add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
31297                               cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
31298 
31299       FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
31300 	{
31301 	  if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
31302 	    continue;
31303 	  if (!fde->in_std_section)
31304             add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
31305                                   fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
31306                                   true);
31307 	  if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
31308             add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
31309                                   fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
31310                                   true);
31311 	}
31312 
31313       if (range_list_added)
31314 	{
31315 	  /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
31316 	     "base address".  Use zero so that these addresses become
31317 	     absolute.  Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
31318 	     DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
31319 	     Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt.  */
31320           add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
31321 	  if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
31322             add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
31323 
31324 	  add_ranges (NULL);
31325 	}
31326     }
31327 
31328   /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
31329      offset expected by debuggers.  */
31330   strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
31331   if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
31332     strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
31333 
31334   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31335     add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
31336 		    dl_section_ref);
31337 
31338   if (have_macinfo)
31339     add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
31340 		   macinfo_section_label);
31341 
31342   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31343     {
31344       if (have_location_lists)
31345 	{
31346 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31347 	    add_AT_loclistsptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_loclists_base,
31348 				loc_section_label);
31349 	  /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
31350 	     so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
31351 	     Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
31352 	     the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
31353 	     only reduces ref_counts to 1.  */
31354 	  index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
31355 	}
31356 
31357       if (addr_index_table != NULL)
31358         {
31359           unsigned int index = 0;
31360           addr_index_table
31361 	    ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
31362 	    (&index);
31363         }
31364     }
31365 
31366   loc_list_idx = 0;
31367   if (have_location_lists)
31368     {
31369       optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
31370       /* And finally assign indexes to the entries for -gsplit-dwarf.  */
31371       if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
31372 	assign_location_list_indexes (comp_unit_die ());
31373     }
31374 
31375   save_macinfo_strings ();
31376 
31377   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31378     {
31379       unsigned int index = 0;
31380 
31381       /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
31382          type_units.  Because these attributes include strings, it
31383          must be done before freezing the string table.  Top-level
31384          skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
31385          created, so ensure it is created by this point.  */
31386       add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
31387       debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
31388     }
31389 
31390   /* Output all of the compilation units.  We put the main one last so that
31391      the offsets are available to output_pubnames.  */
31392   for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31393     output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
31394 
31395   hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
31396   for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31397     {
31398       comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
31399 
31400       /* Don't output duplicate types.  */
31401       if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
31402         continue;
31403 
31404       /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
31405          so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
31406          attributes.  */
31407       if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31408         add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
31409                         (!dwarf_split_debug_info
31410                          ? dl_section_ref
31411                          : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
31412 
31413       output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode, false);
31414       *slot = ctnode;
31415     }
31416 
31417   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31418     {
31419       int mark;
31420       struct md5_ctx ctx;
31421 
31422       if (dwarf_version >= 5 && !vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
31423 	index_rnglists ();
31424 
31425       /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id.  */
31426       md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
31427       mark = 0;
31428       die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
31429       unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
31430       md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
31431 
31432       if (dwarf_version < 5)
31433 	{
31434 	  /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
31435 	     and add it to both comp-unit DIEs.  */
31436 	  add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
31437 	  add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
31438 	}
31439 
31440       /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
31441         comp-unit DIE.  */
31442       if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
31443 	{
31444 	  if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31445 	    add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_rnglists_base,
31446 			    ranges_base_label);
31447 	  else
31448 	    add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
31449 			    ranges_section_label);
31450 	}
31451 
31452       switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
31453       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
31454       output_addr_table ();
31455     }
31456 
31457   /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
31458      or .debug_macro will be emitted.  */
31459   output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo,
31460 		    dwarf_split_debug_info ? checksum : NULL);
31461 
31462   if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
31463     output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die, checksum);
31464 
31465   /* Output the abbreviation table.  */
31466   if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
31467     {
31468       switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
31469       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
31470       output_abbrev_section ();
31471     }
31472 
31473   /* Output location list section if necessary.  */
31474   if (have_location_lists)
31475     {
31476       char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31477       char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31478       /* Output the location lists info.  */
31479       switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
31480       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31481 	{
31482 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
31483 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 3);
31484 	  if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
31485 	    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
31486 				 "Initial length escape value indicating "
31487 				 "64-bit DWARF extension");
31488 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
31489 			    "Length of Location Lists");
31490 	  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
31491 	  output_dwarf_version ();
31492 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
31493 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
31494 	  dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? loc_list_idx : 0,
31495 			       "Offset Entry Count");
31496 	}
31497       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
31498       if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
31499 	{
31500 	  unsigned int save_loc_list_idx = loc_list_idx;
31501 	  loc_list_idx = 0;
31502 	  output_loclists_offsets (comp_unit_die ());
31503 	  gcc_assert (save_loc_list_idx == loc_list_idx);
31504 	}
31505       output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
31506       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31507 	ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
31508     }
31509 
31510   output_pubtables ();
31511 
31512   /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
31513      was emitted.  We output an empty table even if we had no functions
31514      to put in it.  This because the consumer has no way to tell the
31515      difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
31516      generate a table that would have contained data.  */
31517   if (info_section_emitted)
31518     {
31519       switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
31520       output_aranges ();
31521     }
31522 
31523   /* Output ranges section if necessary.  */
31524   if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
31525     {
31526       if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31527 	output_rnglists (generation);
31528       else
31529 	output_ranges ();
31530     }
31531 
31532   /* Have to end the macro section.  */
31533   if (have_macinfo)
31534     {
31535       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
31536       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
31537       output_macinfo (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
31538 		      : debug_skeleton_line_section_label, false);
31539       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
31540     }
31541 
31542   /* Output the source line correspondence table.  We must do this
31543      even if there is no line information.  Otherwise, on an empty
31544      translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
31545      .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
31546      examining the file.  This is done late so that any filenames
31547      used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'.  */
31548   switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
31549   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
31550   if (! output_asm_line_debug_info ())
31551     output_line_info (false);
31552 
31553   if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
31554     {
31555       switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
31556       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
31557       output_line_info (true);
31558     }
31559 
31560   /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too.  */
31561   if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
31562     output_indirect_strings ();
31563   if (debug_line_str_hash)
31564     {
31565       switch_to_section (debug_line_str_section);
31566       const enum dwarf_form form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
31567       debug_line_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
31568 				    output_indirect_string> (form);
31569     }
31570 
31571   /* ??? Move lvugid out of dwarf2out_source_line and reset it too?  */
31572   symview_upper_bound = 0;
31573   if (zero_view_p)
31574     bitmap_clear (zero_view_p);
31575 }
31576 
31577 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a variable_value_struct).  */
31578 
31579 inline hashval_t
31580 variable_value_hasher::hash (variable_value_struct *x)
31581 {
31582   return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
31583 }
31584 
31585 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of variable_value_struct X is the same as
31586    UID of decl Y.  */
31587 
31588 inline bool
31589 variable_value_hasher::equal (variable_value_struct *x, tree y)
31590 {
31591   return x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y);
31592 }
31593 
31594 /* Helper function for resolve_variable_value, handle
31595    DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in one location expression.
31596    Return true if exprloc has been changed into loclist.  */
31597 
31598 static bool
31599 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
31600 {
31601   dw_loc_descr_ref next;
31602   for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = next)
31603     {
31604       next = loc->dw_loc_next;
31605       if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
31606 	  || loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_decl_ref)
31607 	continue;
31608 
31609       tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
31610       if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) != current_function_decl)
31611 	continue;
31612 
31613       dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31614       if (ref)
31615 	{
31616 	  loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
31617 	  loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
31618 	  loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
31619 	  continue;
31620 	}
31621       dw_loc_list_ref l = loc_list_from_tree (decl, 0, NULL);
31622       if (l == NULL)
31623 	continue;
31624       if (l->dw_loc_next)
31625 	{
31626 	  if (AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
31627 	    continue;
31628 	  switch (a->dw_attr)
31629 	    {
31630 	    /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and loclist
31631 	       classes, so we can change them into a loclist.  */
31632 	    case DW_AT_location:
31633 	    case DW_AT_string_length:
31634 	    case DW_AT_return_addr:
31635 	    case DW_AT_data_member_location:
31636 	    case DW_AT_frame_base:
31637 	    case DW_AT_segment:
31638 	    case DW_AT_static_link:
31639 	    case DW_AT_use_location:
31640 	    case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
31641 	      if (prev)
31642 		{
31643 		  prev->dw_loc_next = NULL;
31644 		  prepend_loc_descr_to_each (l, AT_loc (a));
31645 		}
31646 	      if (next)
31647 		add_loc_descr_to_each (l, next);
31648 	      a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
31649 	      a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
31650 	      a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = l;
31651 	      have_location_lists = true;
31652 	      return true;
31653 	    /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
31654 	       so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value alone
31655 	       we could transform it into reference.  */
31656 	    case DW_AT_byte_size:
31657 	    case DW_AT_bit_size:
31658 	    case DW_AT_lower_bound:
31659 	    case DW_AT_upper_bound:
31660 	    case DW_AT_bit_stride:
31661 	    case DW_AT_count:
31662 	    case DW_AT_allocated:
31663 	    case DW_AT_associated:
31664 	    case DW_AT_byte_stride:
31665 	      if (prev == NULL && next == NULL)
31666 		break;
31667 	      /* FALLTHRU */
31668 	    default:
31669 	      if (dwarf_strict)
31670 		continue;
31671 	      break;
31672 	    }
31673 	  /* Create DW_TAG_variable that we can refer to.  */
31674 	  gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL,
31675 			lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl));
31676 	  ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31677 	  if (ref)
31678 	    {
31679 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
31680 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
31681 	      loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
31682 	    }
31683 	  continue;
31684 	}
31685       if (prev)
31686 	{
31687 	  prev->dw_loc_next = l->expr;
31688 	  add_loc_descr (&prev->dw_loc_next, next);
31689 	  free_loc_descr (loc, NULL);
31690 	  next = prev->dw_loc_next;
31691 	}
31692       else
31693 	{
31694 	  memcpy (loc, l->expr, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
31695 	  add_loc_descr (&loc, next);
31696 	  next = loc;
31697 	}
31698       loc = prev;
31699     }
31700   return false;
31701 }
31702 
31703 /* Attempt to resolve DW_OP_GNU_variable_value using loc_list_from_tree.  */
31704 
31705 static void
31706 resolve_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
31707 {
31708   dw_attr_node *a;
31709   dw_loc_list_ref loc;
31710   unsigned ix;
31711 
31712   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
31713     switch (AT_class (a))
31714       {
31715       case dw_val_class_loc:
31716 	if (!resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, AT_loc (a)))
31717 	  break;
31718 	/* FALLTHRU */
31719       case dw_val_class_loc_list:
31720 	loc = AT_loc_list (a);
31721 	gcc_assert (loc);
31722 	for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
31723 	  resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, loc->expr);
31724 	break;
31725       default:
31726 	break;
31727       }
31728 }
31729 
31730 /* Attempt to optimize DW_OP_GNU_variable_value refering to
31731    temporaries in the current function.  */
31732 
31733 static void
31734 resolve_variable_values (void)
31735 {
31736   if (!variable_value_hash || !current_function_decl)
31737     return;
31738 
31739   struct variable_value_struct *node
31740     = variable_value_hash->find_with_hash (current_function_decl,
31741 					   DECL_UID (current_function_decl));
31742 
31743   if (node == NULL)
31744     return;
31745 
31746   unsigned int i;
31747   dw_die_ref die;
31748   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (node->dies, i, die)
31749     resolve_variable_value (die);
31750 }
31751 
31752 /* Helper function for note_variable_value, handle one location
31753    expression.  */
31754 
31755 static void
31756 note_variable_value_in_expr (dw_die_ref die, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
31757 {
31758   for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
31759     if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
31760 	&& loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
31761       {
31762 	tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
31763 	dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31764 	if (! ref && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
31765 	  {
31766 	    /* ???  This is somewhat a hack because we do not create DIEs
31767 	       for variables not in BLOCK trees early but when generating
31768 	       early LTO output we need the dw_val_class_decl_ref to be
31769 	       fully resolved.  For fat LTO objects we'd also like to
31770 	       undo this after LTO dwarf output.  */
31771 	    gcc_assert (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
31772 	    dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
31773 	    gcc_assert (ctx != NULL);
31774 	    gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL, ctx);
31775 	    ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31776 	    gcc_assert (ref != NULL);
31777 	  }
31778 	if (ref)
31779 	  {
31780 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
31781 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
31782 	    loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
31783 	    continue;
31784 	  }
31785 	if (VAR_P (decl)
31786 	    && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
31787 	    && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL
31788 	    && lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)))
31789 	  {
31790 	    if (!variable_value_hash)
31791 	      variable_value_hash
31792 		= hash_table<variable_value_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
31793 
31794 	    tree fndecl = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
31795 	    struct variable_value_struct *node;
31796 	    struct variable_value_struct **slot
31797 	      = variable_value_hash->find_slot_with_hash (fndecl,
31798 							  DECL_UID (fndecl),
31799 							  INSERT);
31800 	    if (*slot == NULL)
31801 	      {
31802 		node = ggc_cleared_alloc<variable_value_struct> ();
31803 		node->decl_id = DECL_UID (fndecl);
31804 		*slot = node;
31805 	      }
31806 	    else
31807 	      node = *slot;
31808 
31809 	    vec_safe_push (node->dies, die);
31810 	  }
31811       }
31812 }
31813 
31814 /* Walk the tree DIE and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
31815    with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand.  */
31816 
31817 static void
31818 note_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
31819 {
31820   dw_die_ref c;
31821   dw_attr_node *a;
31822   dw_loc_list_ref loc;
31823   unsigned ix;
31824 
31825   FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
31826     switch (AT_class (a))
31827       {
31828       case dw_val_class_loc_list:
31829 	loc = AT_loc_list (a);
31830 	gcc_assert (loc);
31831 	if (!loc->noted_variable_value)
31832 	  {
31833 	    loc->noted_variable_value = 1;
31834 	    for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
31835 	      note_variable_value_in_expr (die, loc->expr);
31836 	  }
31837 	break;
31838       case dw_val_class_loc:
31839 	note_variable_value_in_expr (die, AT_loc (a));
31840 	break;
31841       default:
31842 	break;
31843       }
31844 
31845   /* Mark children.  */
31846   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, note_variable_value (c));
31847 }
31848 
31849 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
31850    has run.  */
31851 
31852 static void
31853 dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *filename)
31854 {
31855   set_early_dwarf s;
31856   char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31857 
31858   /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
31859      header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
31860      and overwrite only here.  */
31861   dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
31862   producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
31863   producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
31864   producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
31865 
31866   /* Add the name for the main input file now.  We delayed this from
31867      dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.  */
31868   add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
31869   add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
31870 
31871   /* When emitting DWARF5 .debug_line_str, move DW_AT_name and
31872      DW_AT_comp_dir into .debug_line_str section.  */
31873   if (!output_asm_line_debug_info ()
31874       && dwarf_version >= 5
31875       && DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
31876     {
31877       for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
31878 	{
31879 	  dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (comp_unit_die (),
31880 				    i ? DW_AT_comp_dir : DW_AT_name);
31881 	  if (a == NULL
31882 	      || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_str
31883 	      || strlen (AT_string (a)) + 1 <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
31884 	    continue;
31885 
31886 	  if (! debug_line_str_hash)
31887 	    debug_line_str_hash
31888 	      = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
31889 
31890 	  struct indirect_string_node *node
31891 	    = find_AT_string_in_table (AT_string (a), debug_line_str_hash);
31892 	  set_indirect_string (node);
31893 	  node->form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
31894 	  a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
31895 	  a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
31896 	}
31897     }
31898 
31899   /* With LTO early dwarf was really finished at compile-time, so make
31900      sure to adjust the phase after annotating the LTRANS CU DIE.  */
31901   if (in_lto_p)
31902     {
31903       early_dwarf_finished = true;
31904       return;
31905     }
31906 
31907   /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
31908      emit full debugging info for them.  */
31909   retry_incomplete_types ();
31910 
31911   /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
31912      and we don't need to stream it for LTO.  */
31913   flush_limbo_die_list ();
31914 
31915   gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
31916   gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
31917 
31918   /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs.  */
31919   for (limbo_die_node *node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
31920     {
31921       tree decl = node->created_for;
31922       if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
31923 	  /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
31924 	     ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
31925 	     constant and never written to disk.  */
31926 	  && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
31927 	{
31928 	  add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
31929 	  move_linkage_attr (node->die);
31930 	}
31931     }
31932   deferred_asm_name = NULL;
31933 
31934   if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
31935     prune_unused_types ();
31936 
31937   /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
31938   if (use_debug_types)
31939     {
31940       break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
31941 
31942       /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
31943          Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
31944          limbo die list.  */
31945       limbo_die_list = NULL;
31946 
31947       /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
31948          types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
31949          references to the main compile unit).  */
31950       for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
31951 	   ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31952         copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
31953       copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
31954 
31955       /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
31956          we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
31957          referenced.  Prune them.  */
31958       prune_unused_types ();
31959     }
31960 
31961   /* Traverse the DIE's and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
31962      with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand.  */
31963   note_variable_value (comp_unit_die ());
31964   for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31965     note_variable_value (node->die);
31966   for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL;
31967        ctnode = ctnode->next)
31968     note_variable_value (ctnode->root_die);
31969   for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31970     note_variable_value (node->die);
31971 
31972   /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
31973      both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs.  Making this call unconditional
31974      would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
31975      requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs.  */
31976   if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
31977     add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
31978 
31979   /* The early debug phase is now finished.  */
31980   early_dwarf_finished = true;
31981 
31982   /* Do not generate DWARF assembler now when not producing LTO bytecode.  */
31983   if ((!flag_generate_lto && !flag_generate_offload)
31984       /* FIXME: Disable debug info generation for (PE-)COFF targets since the
31985 	 copy_lto_debug_sections operation of the simple object support in
31986 	 libiberty is not implemented for them yet.  */
31987       || TARGET_PECOFF || TARGET_COFF)
31988     return;
31989 
31990   /* Now as we are going to output for LTO initialize sections and labels
31991      to the LTO variants.  We don't need a random-seed postfix as other
31992      LTO sections as linking the LTO debug sections into one in a partial
31993      link is fine.  */
31994   init_sections_and_labels (true);
31995 
31996   /* The output below is modeled after dwarf2out_finish with all
31997      location related output removed and some LTO specific changes.
31998      Some refactoring might make both smaller and easier to match up.  */
31999 
32000   /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
32001      that have children.  */
32002   add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
32003   for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
32004     add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
32005   for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
32006        ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
32007     add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
32008 
32009   /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
32010      offset expected by debuggers.  */
32011   strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
32012   if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
32013     strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
32014 
32015   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
32016     add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list, dl_section_ref);
32017 
32018   if (have_macinfo)
32019     add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
32020 		   macinfo_section_label);
32021 
32022   save_macinfo_strings ();
32023 
32024   if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
32025     {
32026       unsigned int index = 0;
32027       debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
32028     }
32029 
32030   /* Output all of the compilation units.  We put the main one last so that
32031      the offsets are available to output_pubnames.  */
32032   for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
32033     output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
32034 
32035   hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
32036   for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
32037        ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
32038     {
32039       comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
32040 
32041       /* Don't output duplicate types.  */
32042       if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
32043         continue;
32044 
32045       /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
32046          so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
32047          attributes.  */
32048       if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
32049         add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
32050                         (!dwarf_split_debug_info
32051                          ? debug_line_section_label
32052                          : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
32053 
32054       output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode, true);
32055       *slot = ctnode;
32056     }
32057 
32058   /* Stick a unique symbol to the main debuginfo section.  */
32059   compute_comp_unit_symbol (comp_unit_die ());
32060 
32061   /* Output the main compilation unit.  We always need it if only for
32062      the CU symbol.  */
32063   output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), true, NULL);
32064 
32065   /* Output the abbreviation table.  */
32066   if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
32067     {
32068       switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
32069       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
32070       output_abbrev_section ();
32071     }
32072 
32073   /* Have to end the macro section.  */
32074   if (have_macinfo)
32075     {
32076       /* We have to save macinfo state if we need to output it again
32077 	 for the FAT part of the object.  */
32078       vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *saved_macinfo_table = macinfo_table;
32079       if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
32080 	macinfo_table = macinfo_table->copy ();
32081 
32082       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
32083       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
32084       output_macinfo (debug_line_section_label, true);
32085       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
32086 
32087       if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
32088 	{
32089 	  vec_free (macinfo_table);
32090 	  macinfo_table = saved_macinfo_table;
32091 	}
32092     }
32093 
32094   /* Emit a skeleton debug_line section.  */
32095   switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
32096   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
32097   output_line_info (true);
32098 
32099   /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too.  */
32100   if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
32101     output_indirect_strings ();
32102   if (debug_line_str_hash)
32103     {
32104       switch_to_section (debug_line_str_section);
32105       const enum dwarf_form form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
32106       debug_line_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
32107 				    output_indirect_string> (form);
32108     }
32109 
32110   /* Switch back to the text section.  */
32111   switch_to_section (text_section);
32112 }
32113 
32114 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
32115    within the same process.  For use by toplev::finalize.  */
32116 
32117 void
32118 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
32119 {
32120   last_var_location_insn = NULL;
32121   cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
32122   used_rtx_array = NULL;
32123   incomplete_types = NULL;
32124   decl_scope_table = NULL;
32125   debug_info_section = NULL;
32126   debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
32127   debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
32128   debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
32129   debug_aranges_section = NULL;
32130   debug_addr_section = NULL;
32131   debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
32132   debug_line_section = NULL;
32133   debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
32134   debug_loc_section = NULL;
32135   debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
32136   debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
32137   debug_str_section = NULL;
32138   debug_line_str_section = NULL;
32139   debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
32140   debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
32141   debug_ranges_section = NULL;
32142   debug_frame_section = NULL;
32143   fde_vec = NULL;
32144   debug_str_hash = NULL;
32145   debug_line_str_hash = NULL;
32146   skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
32147   dw2_string_counter = 0;
32148   have_multiple_function_sections = false;
32149   text_section_used = false;
32150   cold_text_section_used = false;
32151   cold_text_section = NULL;
32152   current_unit_personality = NULL;
32153 
32154   early_dwarf = false;
32155   early_dwarf_finished = false;
32156 
32157   next_die_offset = 0;
32158   single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
32159   comdat_type_list = NULL;
32160   limbo_die_list = NULL;
32161   file_table = NULL;
32162   decl_die_table = NULL;
32163   common_block_die_table = NULL;
32164   decl_loc_table = NULL;
32165   call_arg_locations = NULL;
32166   call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
32167   call_site_count = -1;
32168   tail_call_site_count = -1;
32169   cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
32170   abbrev_die_table = NULL;
32171   delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
32172   dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
32173   line_info_label_num = 0;
32174   cur_line_info_table = NULL;
32175   text_section_line_info = NULL;
32176   cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
32177   separate_line_info = NULL;
32178   info_section_emitted = false;
32179   pubname_table = NULL;
32180   pubtype_table = NULL;
32181   macinfo_table = NULL;
32182   ranges_table = NULL;
32183   ranges_by_label = NULL;
32184   rnglist_idx = 0;
32185   have_location_lists = false;
32186   loclabel_num = 0;
32187   poc_label_num = 0;
32188   last_emitted_file = NULL;
32189   label_num = 0;
32190   tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
32191   generic_type_instances = NULL;
32192   frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
32193   frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
32194   base_types.release ();
32195   XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
32196   producer_string = NULL;
32197 }
32198 
32199 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"
32200